1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 193 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 228 229 230 231 232 233 234 235 236 237 238 239 240 241 242 243 244 245 246 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 265 266 267 268 269 270 271 272 273 274 275 276 277 278 279 280 281 282 283 284 285 286 287 288 289 290 291 292 293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317 318 319 320 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 328 329 330 331 332 333 334 335 336 337 338 339 340 341 342 343 344 345 346 347 348 349 350 351 352 353 354 355 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 369 370 371 372 373 374 375 376 377 378 379 380 381 382 383 384 385 386 387 388 389 390 391 392 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 403 404 405 406 407 408 409 410 411 412 413 414 415 416 417 418 419 420 421 422 423 424 425 426 427 428 429 430 431 432 433 434 435 436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443 444 445 446 447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468 469 470 471 472 473 474 475 476 477 478 479 480 481 482 483 484 485 486 487 488 489 490 491 492 493 494 495 496 497 498 499 500 501 502 503 504 505 506 507 508 509 510 511 512 513 514 515 516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532 533 534 535 536 537 538 539 540 541 542 543 544 545 546 547 548 549 550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557 558 559 560 561 562 563 564 565 566 567 568 569 570 571 572 573 574 575 576 577 578 579 580 581 582 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590 591 592 593 594 595 596 597 598 599 600 601 602 603 604 605 606 607 608 609 610 611 612 613 614 615 616 617 618 619 620 621 622 623 624 625 626 627 628 629 630 631 632 633 634 635 636 637 638 639 640 641 642 643 644 645 646 647 648 649 650 651 652 653 654 655 656 657 658 659 660 661 662 663 664 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673 674 675 676 677 678 679 680 681 682 683 684 685 686 687 688 689 690 691 692 693 694 695 696 697 698 699 700 701 702 703 704 705 706 707 708 709 710 711 712 713 714 715 716 717 718 719 720 721 722 723 724 725 726 727 728 729 730 731 732 733 734 735 736 737 738 739 740 741 742 743 744 745 746 747 748 749 750 751 752 753 754 755 756 757 758 759 760 761 762 763 764 765 766 767 768 769 770 771 772 773 774 775 776 777 778 779 780 781 782 783 784 785 786 787 788 789 790 791 792 793 794 795 796 797 798 799 800 801 802 803 804 805 806 807 808 809 810 811 812 813 814 815 816 817 818 819 820 821 822 823 824 825 826 827 828 829 830 831 832 833 834 835 836 837 838 839 840 841 842 843 844 845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857 858 859 860 861 862 863 864 865 866 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884 885 886 887 888 889 890 891 892 893 894 895 896 897 898 899 900 901 902 903 904 905 906 907 908 909 910 911 912 913 914 915 916 917 918 919 920 921 922 923 924 925 926 927 928 929 930 931 932 933 934 935 936 937 938 939 940 941 942 943 944 945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957 958 959 960 961 962 963 964 965 966 967 968 969 970 971 972 973 974 975 976 977 978 979 980 981 982 983 984 985 986 987 988 989 990 991 992 993 994 995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 1008 1009 1010 1011 1012 1013 1014 1015 1016 1017 1018 1019 1020 1021 1022 1023 1024 1025 1026 1027 1028 1029 1030 1031 1032 1033 1034 1035 1036 1037 1038 1039 1040 1041 1042 1043 1044 1045 1046 1047 1048 1049 1050 1051 1052 1053 1054 1055 1056 1057 1058 1059 1060 1061 1062 1063 1064 1065 1066 1067 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075 1076 1077 1078 1079 1080 1081 1082 1083 1084 1085 1086 1087 1088 1089 1090 1091 1092 1093 1094 1095 1096 1097 1098 1099 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 1105 1106 1107 1108 1109 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135 1136 1137 1138 1139 1140 1141 1142 1143 1144 1145 1146 1147 1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153 1154 1155 1156 1157 1158 1159 1160 1161 1162 1163 1164 1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171 1172 1173 1174 1175 1176 1177 1178 1179 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184 1185 1186 1187 1188 1189 1190 1191 1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198 1199 1200 1201 1202 1203 1204 1205 1206 1207 1208 1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216 1217 1218 1219 1220 1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229 1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256 1257 1258 1259 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294 1295 1296 1297 1298 1299 1300 1301 1302 1303 1304 1305 1306 1307 1308 1309 1310 1311 1312 1313 1314 1315 1316 1317 1318 1319 1320 1321 1322 1323 1324 1325 1326 1327 1328 1329 1330 1331 1332 1333 1334 1335 1336 1337 1338 1339 1340 1341 1342 1343 1344 1345 1346 1347 1348 1349 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373 1374 1375 1376 1377 1378 1379 1380 1381 1382 1383 1384 1385 1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391 1392 1393 1394 1395 1396 1397 1398 1399 1400 1401 1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410 1411 1412 1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419 1420 1421 1422 1423 1424 1425 1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431 1432 1433 1434 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 1440 1441 1442 1443 1444 1445 1446 1447 1448 1449 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 1455 1456 1457 1458 1459 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 1465 1466 1467 1468 1469 1470 1471 1472 1473 1474 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 1480 1481 1482 1483 1484 1485 1486 1487 1488 1489 1490 1491 1492 1493 1494 1495 1496 1497 1498 1499 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509 1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 1520 1521 1522 1523 1524 1525 1526 1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 1540 1541 1542 1543 1544 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 1555 1556 1557 1558 1559 1560 1561 1562 1563 1564 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 1575 1576 1577 1578 1579 1580 1581 1582 1583 1584 1585 1586 1587 1588 1589 1590 1591 1592 1593 1594 1595 1596 1597 1598 1599 1600 1601 1602 1603 1604 1605 1606 1607 1608 1609 1610 1611 1612 1613 1614 1615 1616 1617 1618 1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624 1625 1626 1627 1628 1629 1630 1631 1632 1633 1634 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 1645 1646 1647 1648 1649 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 1655 1656 1657 1658 1659 1660 1661 1662 1663 1664 1665 1666 1667 1668 1669 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674 1675 1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681 1682 1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718 1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1727 1728 1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740 1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753 1754 1755 1756 1757 1758 1759 1760 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1766 1767 1768 1769 1770 1771 1772 1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785 1786 1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792 1793 1794 1795 1796 1797 1798 1799 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 1805 1806 1807 1808 1809 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 1830 1831 1832 1833 1834 1835 1836 1837 1838 1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861 1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875 1876 1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 1905 1906 1907 1908 1909 1910 1911 1912 1913 1914 1915 1916 1917 1918 1919 1920 1921 1922 1923 1924 1925 1926 1927 1928 1929 1930 1931 1932 1933 1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940 1941 1942 1943 1944 1945 1946 1947 1948 1949 1950 1951 1952 1953 1954 1955 1956 1957 1958 1959 1960 1961 1962 1963 1964 1965 1966 1967 1968 1969 1970 1971 1972 1973 1974 1975 1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986 1987 1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2059 2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085 2086 2087 2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2098 2099 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 2115 2116 2117 2118 2119 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167 2168 2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176 2177 2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183 2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218 2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225 2226 2227 2228 2229 2230 2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244 2245 2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284 2285 2286 2287 2288 2289 2290 2291 2292 2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309 2310 2311 2312 2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320 2321 2322 2323 2324 2325 2326 2327 2328 2329 2330 2331 2332 2333 2334 2335 2336 2337 2338 2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344 2345 2346 2347 2348 2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369 2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394 2395 2396 2397 2398 2399 2400 2401 2402 2403 2404 2405 2406 2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415 2416 2417 2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424 2425 2426 2427 2428 2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434 2435 2436 2437 2438 2439 2440 2441 2442 2443 2444 2445 2446 2447 2448 2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455 2456 2457 2458 2459 2460 2461 2462 2463 2464 2465 2466 2467 2468 2469 2470 2471 2472 2473 2474 2475 2476 2477 2478 2479 2480 2481 2482 2483 2484 2485 2486 2487 2488 2489 2490 2491 2492 2493 2494 2495 2496 2497 2498 2499 2500 2501 2502 2503 2504 2505 2506 2507 2508 2509 2510 2511 2512 2513 2514 2515 2516 2517 2518 2519 2520 2521 2522 2523 2524 2525 2526 2527 2528 2529 2530 2531 2532 2533 2534 2535 2536 2537 2538 2539 2540 2541 2542 2543 2544 2545 2546 2547 2548 2549 2550 2551 2552 2553 2554 2555 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562 2563 2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570 2571 2572 2573 2574 2575 2576 2577 2578 2579 2580 2581 2582 2583 2584 2585 2586 2587 2588 2589 2590 2591 2592 2593 2594 2595 2596 2597 2598 2599 2600 2601 2602 2603 2604 2605 2606 2607 2608 2609 2610 2611 2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617 2618 2619 2620 2621 2622 2623 2624 2625 2626 2627 2628 2629 2630 2631 2632 2633 2634 2635 2636 2637 2638 2639 2640 2641 2642 2643 2644 2645 2646 2647 2648 2649 2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659 2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665 2666 2667 2668 2669 2670 2671 2672 2673 2674 2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692 2693 2694 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710 2711 2712 2713 2714 2715 2716 2717 2718 2719 2720 2721 2722 2723 2724 2725 2726 2727 2728 2729 2730 2731 2732 2733 2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739 2740 2741 2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752 2753 2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780 2781 2782 2783 2784 2785 2786 2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805 2806 2807 2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821 2822 2823 2824 2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839 2840 2841 2842 2843 2844 2845 2846 2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862 2863 2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870 2871 2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885 2886 2887 2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910 2911 2912 2913 2914 2915 2916 2917 2918 2919 2920 2921 2922 2923 2924 2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937 2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943 2944 2945 2946 2947 2948 2949 2950 2951 2952 2953 2954 2955 2956 2957 2958 2959 2960 2961 2962 2963 2964 2965 2966 2967 2968 2969 2970 2971 2972 2973 2974 2975 2976 2977 2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986 2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002 3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010 3011 3012 3013 3014 3015 3016 3017 3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026 3027 3028 3029 3030 3031 3032 3033 3034 3035 3036 3037 3038 3039 3040 3041 3042 3043 3044 3045 3046 3047 3048 3049 3050 3051 3052 3053 3054 3055 3056 3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062 3063 3064 3065 3066 3067 3068 3069 3070 3071 3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089 3090 3091 3092 3093 3094 3095 3096 3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103 3104 3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115 3116 3117 3118 3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131 3132 3133 3134 3135 3136 3137 3138 3139 3140 3141 3142 3143 3144 3145 3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152 3153 3154 3155 3156 3157 3158 3159 3160 3161 3162 3163 3164 3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173 3174 3175 3176 3177 3178 3179 3180 3181 3182 3183 3184 3185 3186 3187 3188 3189 3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195 3196 3197 3198 3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219 3220 3221 3222 3223 3224 3225 3226 3227 3228 3229 3230 3231 3232 3233 3234 3235 3236 3237 3238 3239 3240 3241 3242 3243 3244 3245 3246 3247 3248 3249 3250 3251 3252 3253 3254 3255 3256 3257 3258 3259 3260 3261 3262 3263 3264 3265 3266 3267 3268 3269 3270 3271 3272 3273 3274 3275 3276 3277 3278 3279 3280 3281 3282 3283 3284 3285 3286 3287 3288 3289 3290 3291 3292 3293 3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299 3300 3301 3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307 3308 3309 3310 3311 3312 3313 3314 3315 3316 3317 3318 3319 3320 3321 3322 3323 3324 3325 3326 3327 3328 3329 3330 3331 3332 3333 3334 3335 3336 3337 3338 3339 3340 3341 3342 3343 3344 3345 3346 3347 3348 3349 3350 3351 3352 3353 3354 3355 3356 3357 3358 3359 3360 3361 3362 3363 3364 3365 3366 3367 3368 3369 3370 3371 3372 3373 3374 3375 3376 3377 3378 3379 3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387 3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393 3394 3395 3396 3397 3398 3399 3400 3401 3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413 3414 3415 3416 3417 3418 3419 3420 3421 3422 3423 3424 3425 3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432 3433 3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439 3440 3441 3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448 3449 3450 3451 3452 3453 3454 3455 3456 3457 3458 3459 3460 3461 3462 3463 3464 3465 3466 3467 3468 3469 3470 3471 3472 3473 3474 3475 3476 3477 3478 3479 3480 3481 3482 3483 3484 3485 3486 3487 3488 3489 3490 3491 3492 3493 3494 3495 3496 3497 3498 3499 3500 3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506 3507 3508 3509 3510 3511 3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520 3521 3522 3523 3524 3525 3526 3527 3528 3529 3530 3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537 3538 3539 3540 3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546 3547 3548 3549 3550 3551 3552 3553 3554 3555 3556 3557 3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568 3569 3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587 3588 3589 3590 3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601 3602 3603 3604 3605 3606 3607 3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615 3616 3617 3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638 3639 3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647 3648 3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659 3660 3661 3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692 3693 3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701 3702 3703 3704 3705 3706 3707 3708 3709 3710 3711 3712 3713 3714 3715 3716 3717 3718 3719 3720 3721 3722 3723 3724 3725 3726 3727 3728 3729 3730 3731 3732 3733 3734 3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740 3741 3742 3743 3744 3745 3746 3747 3748 3749 3750 3751 3752 3753 3754 3755 3756 3757 3758 3759 3760 3761 3762 3763 3764 3765 3766 3767 3768 3769 3770 3771 3772 3773 3774 3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780 3781 3782 3783 3784 3785 3786 3787 3788 3789 3790 3791 3792 3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798 3799 3800 3801 3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820 3821 3822 3823 3824 3825 3826 3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834 3835 3836 3837 3838 3839 3840 3841 3842 3843 3844 3845 3846 3847 3848 3849 3850 3851 3852 3853 3854 3855 3856 3857 3858 3859 3860 3861 3862 3863 3864 3865 3866 3867 3868 3869 3870 3871 3872 3873 3874 3875 3876 3877 3878 3879 3880 3881 3882 3883 3884 3885 3886 3887 3888 3889 3890 3891 3892 3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907 3908 3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926 3927 3928 3929 3930 3931 3932 3933 3934 3935 3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943 3944 3945 3946 3947 3948 3949 3950 3951 3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957 3958 3959 3960 3961 3962 3963 3964 3965 3966 3967 3968 3969 3970 3971 3972 3973 3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979 3980 3981 3982 3983 3984 3985 3986 3987 3988 3989 3990 3991 3992 3993 3994 3995 3996 3997 3998 3999 4000 4001 4002 4003 4004 4005 4006 4007 4008 4009 4010 4011 4012 4013 4014 4015 4016 4017 4018 4019 4020 4021 4022 4023 4024 4025 4026 4027 4028 4029 4030 4031 4032 4033 4034 4035 4036 4037 4038 4039 4040 4041 4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047 4048 4049 4050 4051 4052 4053 4054 4055 4056 4057 4058 4059 4060 4061 4062 4063 4064 4065 4066 4067 4068 4069 4070 4071 4072 4073 4074 4075 4076 4077 4078 4079 4080 4081 4082 4083 4084 4085 4086 4087 4088 4089 4090 4091 4092 4093 4094 4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102 4103 4104 4105 4106 4107 4108 4109 4110 4111 4112 4113 4114 4115 4116 4117 4118 4119 4120 4121 4122 4123 4124 4125 4126 4127 4128 4129 4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137 4138 4139 4140 4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169 4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175 4176 4177 4178 4179 4180 4181 4182 4183 4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189 4190 4191 4192 4193 4194 4195 4196 4197 4198 4199 4200 4201 4202 4203 4204 4205 4206 4207 4208 4209 4210 4211 4212 4213 4214 4215 4216 4217 4218 4219 4220 4221 4222 4223 4224 4225 4226 4227 4228 4229 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234 4235 4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245 4246 4247 4248 4249 4250 4251 4252 4253 4254 4255 4256 4257 4258 4259 4260 4261 4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270 4271 4272 4273 4274 4275 4276 4277 4278 4279 4280 4281 4282 4283 4284 4285 4286 4287 4288 4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296 4297 4298 4299 4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 4312 4313 4314 4315 4316 4317 4318 4319 4320 4321 4322 4323 4324 4325 4326 4327 4328 4329 4330 4331 4332 4333 4334 4335 4336 4337 4338 4339 4340 4341 4342 4343 4344 4345 4346 4347 4348 4349 4350 4351 4352 4353 4354 4355 4356 4357 4358 4359 4360 4361 4362 4363 4364 4365 4366 4367 4368 4369 4370 4371 4372 4373 4374 4375 4376 4377 4378 4379 4380 4381 4382 4383 4384 4385 4386 4387 4388 4389 4390 4391 4392 4393 4394 4395 4396 4397 4398 4399 4400 4401 4402 4403 4404 4405 4406 4407 4408 4409 4410 4411 4412 4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418 4419 4420 4421 4422 4423 4424 4425 4426 4427 4428 4429 4430 4431 4432 4433 4434 4435 4436 4437 4438 4439 4440 4441 4442 4443 4444 4445 4446 4447 4448 4449 4450 4451 4452 4453 4454 4455 4456 4457 4458 4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468 4469 4470 4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476 4477 4478 4479 4480 4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487 4488 4489 4490 4491 4492 4493 4494 4495 4496 4497 4498 4499 4500 4501 4502 4503 4504 4505 4506 4507 4508 4509 4510 4511 4512 4513 4514 4515 4516 4517 4518 4519 4520 4521 4522 4523 4524 4525 4526 4527 4528 4529 4530 4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537 4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543 4544 4545 4546 4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554 4555 4556 4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562 4563 4564 4565 4566 4567 4568 4569 4570 4571 4572 4573 4574 4575 4576 4577 4578 4579 4580 4581 4582 4583 4584 4585 4586 4587 4588 4589 4590 4591 4592 4593 4594 4595 4596 4597 4598 4599 4600 4601 4602 4603 4604 4605 4606 4607 4608 4609 4610 4611 4612 4613 4614 4615 4616 4617 4618 4619 4620 4621 4622 4623 4624 4625 4626 4627 4628 4629 4630 4631 4632 4633 4634 4635 4636 4637 4638 4639 4640 4641 4642 4643 4644 4645 4646 4647 4648 4649 4650 4651 4652 4653 4654 4655 4656 4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662 4663 4664 4665 4666 4667 4668 4669 4670 4671 4672 4673 4674 4675 4676 4677 4678 4679 4680 4681 4682 4683 4684 4685 4686 4687 4688 4689 4690 4691 4692 4693 4694 4695 4696 4697 4698 4699 4700 4701 4702 4703 4704 4705 4706 4707 4708 4709 4710 4711 4712 4713 4714 4715 4716 4717 4718 4719 4720 4721 4722 4723 4724 4725 4726 4727 4728 4729 4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736 4737 4738 4739 4740 4741 4742 4743 4744 4745 4746 4747 4748 4749 4750 4751 4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764 4765 4766 4767 4768 4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774 4775 4776 4777 4778 4779 4780 4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788 4789 4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796 4797 4798 4799 4800 4801 4802 4803 4804 4805 4806 4807 4808 4809 4810 4811 4812 4813 4814 4815 4816 4817 4818 4819 4820 4821 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828 4829 4830 4831 4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843 4844 4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851 4852 4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858 4859 4860 4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866 4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873 4874 4875 4876 4877 4878 4879 4880 4881 4882 4883 4884 4885 4886 4887 4888 4889 4890 4891 4892 4893 4894 4895 4896 4897 4898 4899 4900 4901 4902 4903 4904 4905 4906 4907 4908 4909 4910 4911 4912 4913 4914 4915 4916 4917 4918 4919 4920 4921 4922 4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930 4931 4932 4933 4934 4935 4936 4937 4938 4939 4940 4941 4942 4943 4944 4945 4946 4947 4948 4949 4950 4951 4952 4953 4954 4955 4956 4957 4958 4959 4960 4961 4962 4963 4964 4965 4966 4967 4968 4969 4970 4971 4972 4973 4974 4975 4976 4977 4978 4979 4980 4981 4982 4983 4984 4985 4986 4987 4988 4989 4990 4991 4992 4993 4994 4995 4996 4997 4998 4999 5000 5001 5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007 5008 5009 5010 5011 5012 5013 5014 5015 5016 5017 5018 5019 5020 5021 5022 5023 5024 5025 5026 5027 5028 5029 5030 5031 5032 5033 5034 5035 5036 5037 5038 5039 5040 5041 5042 5043 5044 5045 5046 5047 5048 5049 5050 5051 5052 5053 5054 5055 5056 5057 5058 5059 5060 5061 5062 5063 5064 5065 5066 5067 5068 5069 5070 5071 5072 5073 5074 5075 5076 5077 5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085 5086 5087 5088 5089 5090 5091 5092 5093 5094 5095 5096 5097 5098 5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108 5109 5110 5111 5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125 5126 5127 5128 5129 5130 5131 5132 5133 5134 5135 5136 5137 5138 5139 5140 5141 5142 5143 5144 5145 5146 5147 5148 5149 5150 5151 5152 5153 5154 5155 5156 5157 5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164 5165 5166 5167 5168 5169 5170 5171 5172 5173 5174 5175 5176 5177 5178 5179 5180 5181 5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 5207 5208 5209 5210 5211 5212 5213 5214 5215 5216 5217 5218 5219 5220 5221 5222 5223 5224 5225 5226 5227 5228 5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241 5242 5243 5244 5245 5246 5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257 5258 5259 5260 5261 5262 5263 5264 5265 5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271 5272 5273 5274 5275 5276 5277 5278 5279 5280 5281 5282 5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289 5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298 5299 5300 5301 5302 5303 5304 5305 5306 5307 5308 5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317 5318 5319 5320 5321 5322 5323 5324 5325 5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331 5332 5333 5334 5335 5336 5337 5338 5339 5340 5341 5342 5343 5344 5345 5346 5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359 5360 5361 5362 5363 5364 5365 5366 5367 5368 5369 5370 5371 5372 5373 5374 5375 5376 5377 5378 5379 5380 5381 5382 5383 5384 5385 5386 5387 5388 5389 5390 5391 5392 5393 5394 5395 5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420 5421 5422 5423 5424 5425 5426 5427 5428 5429 5430 5431 5432 5433 5434 5435 5436 5437 5438 5439 5440 5441 5442 5443 5444 5445 5446 5447 5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453 5454 5455 5456 5457 5458 5459 5460 5461 5462 5463 5464 5465 5466 5467 5468 5469 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485 5486 5487 5488 5489 5490 5491 5492 5493 5494 5495 5496 5497 5498 5499 5500 5501 5502 5503 5504 5505 5506 5507 5508 5509 5510 5511 5512 5513 5514 5515 5516 5517 5518 5519 5520 5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537 5538 5539 5540 5541 5542 5543 5544 5545 5546 5547 5548 5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554 5555 5556 5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562 5563 5564 5565 5566 5567 5568 5569 5570 5571 5572 5573 5574 5575 5576 5577 5578 5579 5580 5581 5582 5583 5584 5585 5586 5587 5588 5589 5590 5591 5592 5593 5594 5595 5596 5597 5598 5599 5600 5601 5602 5603 5604 5605 5606 5607 5608 5609 5610 5611 5612 5613 5614 5615 5616 5617 5618 5619 5620 5621 5622 5623 5624 5625 5626 5627 5628 5629 5630 5631 5632 5633 5634 5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642 5643 5644 5645 5646 5647 5648 5649 5650 5651 5652 5653 5654 5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667 5668 5669 5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686 5687 5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700 5701 5702 5703 5704 5705 5706 5707 5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717 5718 5719 5720 5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 5727 5728 5729 5730 5731 5732 5733 5734 5735 5736 5737 5738 5739 5740 5741 5742 5743 5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753 5754 5755 5756 5757 5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763 5764 5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778 5779 5780 5781 5782 5783 5784 5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790 5791 5792 5793 5794 5795 5796 5797 5798 5799 5800 5801 5802 5803 5804 5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812 5813 5814 5815 5816 5817 5818 5819 5820 5821 5822 5823 5824 5825 5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832 5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838 5839 5840 5841 5842 5843 5844 5845 5846 5847 5848 5849 5850 5851 5852 5853 5854 5855 5856 5857 5858 5859 5860 5861 5862 5863 5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873 5874 5875 5876 5877 5878 5879 5880 5881 5882 5883 5884 5885 5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900 5901 5902 5903 5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910 5911 5912 5913 5914 5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926 5927 5928 5929 5930 5931 5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937 5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943 5944 5945 5946 5947 5948 5949 5950 5951 5952 5953 5954 5955 5956 5957 5958 5959 5960 5961 5962 5963 5964 5965 5966 5967 5968 5969 5970 5971 5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978 5979 5980 5981 5982 5983 5984 5985 5986 5987 5988 5989 5990 5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996 5997 5998 5999 6000 6001 6002 6003 6004 6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020 6021 6022 6023 6024 6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037 6038 6039 6040 6041 6042 6043 6044 6045 6046 6047 6048 6049 6050 6051 6052 6053 6054 6055 6056 6057 6058 6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 6068 6069 6070 6071 6072 6073 6074 6075 6076 6077 6078 6079 6080 6081 6082 6083 6084 6085 6086 6087 6088 6089 6090 6091 6092 6093 6094 6095 6096 6097 6098 6099 6100 6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109 6110 6111 6112 6113 6114 6115 6116 6117 6118 6119 6120 6121 6122 6123 6124 6125 6126 6127 6128 6129 6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135 6136 6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146 6147 6148 6149 6150 6151 6152 6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158 6159 6160 6161 6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167 6168 6169 6170 6171 6172 6173 6174 6175 6176 6177 6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183 6184 6185 6186 6187 6188 6189 6190 6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197 6198 6199 6200 6201 6202 6203 6204 6205 6206 6207 6208 6209 6210 6211 6212 6213 6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230 6231 6232 6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245 6246 6247 6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259 6260 6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275 6276 6277 6278 6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285 6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306 6307 6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328 6329 6330 6331 6332 6333 6334 6335 6336 6337 6338 6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345 6346 6347 6348 6349 6350 6351 6352 6353 6354 6355 6356 6357 6358 6359 6360 6361 6362 6363 6364 6365 6366 6367 6368 6369 6370 6371 6372 6373 6374 6375 6376 6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383 6384 6385 6386 6387 6388 6389 6390 6391 6392 6393 6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400 6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412 6413 6414 6415 6416 6417 6418 6419 6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425 6426 6427 6428 6429 6430 6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436 6437 6438 6439 6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449 6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464 6465 6466 6467 6468 6469 6470 6471 6472 6473 6474 6475 6476 6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486 6487 6488 6489 6490 6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499 6500 6501 6502 6503 6504 6505 6506 6507 6508 6509 6510 6511 6512 6513 6514 6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526 6527 6528 6529 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6535 6536 6537 6538 6539 6540 6541 6542 6543 6544 6545 6546 6547 6548 6549 6550 6551 6552 6553 6554 6555 6556 6557 6558 6559 6560 6561 6562 6563 6564 6565 6566 6567 6568 6569 6570 6571 6572 6573 6574 6575 6576 6577 6578 6579 6580 6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595 6596 6597 6598 6599 6600 6601 6602 6603 6604 6605 6606 6607 6608 6609 6610 6611 6612 6613 6614 6615 6616 6617 6618 6619 6620 6621 6622 6623 6624 6625 6626 6627 6628 6629 6630 6631 6632 6633 6634 6635 6636 6637 6638 6639 6640 6641 6642 6643 6644 6645 6646 6647 6648 6649 6650 6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657 6658 6659 6660 6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667 6668 6669 6670 6671 6672 6673 6674 6675 6676 6677 6678 6679 6680 6681 6682 6683 6684 6685 6686 6687 6688 6689 6690 6691 6692 6693 6694 6695 6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704 6705 6706 6707 6708 6709 6710 6711 6712 6713 6714 6715 6716 6717 6718 6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725 6726 6727 6728 6729 6730 6731 6732 6733 6734 6735 6736 6737 6738 6739 6740 6741 6742 6743 6744 6745 6746 6747 6748 6749 6750 6751 6752 6753 6754 6755 6756 6757 6758 6759 6760 6761 6762 6763 6764 6765 6766 6767 6768 6769 6770 6771 6772 6773 6774 6775 6776 6777 6778 6779 6780 6781 6782 6783 6784 6785 6786 6787 6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794 6795 6796 6797 6798 6799 6800 6801 6802 6803 6804 6805 6806 6807 6808 6809 6810 6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822 6823 6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829 6830 6831 6832 6833 6834 6835 6836 6837 6838 6839 6840 6841 6842 6843 6844 6845 6846 6847 6848 6849 6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856 6857 6858 6859 6860 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6866 6867 6868 6869 6870 6871 6872 6873 6874 6875 6876 6877 6878 6879 6880 6881 6882 6883 6884 6885 6886 6887 6888 6889 6890 6891 6892 6893 6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906 6907 6908 6909 6910 6911 6912 6913 6914 6915 6916 6917 6918 6919 6920 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938 6939 6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945 6946 6947 6948 6949 6950 6951 6952 6953 6954 6955 6956 6957 6958 6959 6960 6961 6962 6963 6964 6965 6966 6967 6968 6969 6970 6971 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6977 6978 6979 6980 6981 6982 6983 6984 6985 6986 6987 6988 6989 6990 6991 6992 6993 6994 6995 6996 6997 6998 6999 7000 7001 7002 7003 7004 7005 7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011 7012 7013 7014 7015 7016 7017 7018 7019 7020 7021 7022 7023 7024 7025 7026 7027 7028 7029 7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036 7037 7038 7039 7040 7041 7042 7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048 7049 7050 7051 7052 7053 7054 7055 7056 7057 7058 7059 7060 7061 7062 7063 7064 7065 7066 7067 7068 7069 7070 7071 7072 7073 7074 7075 7076 7077 7078 7079 7080 7081 7082 7083 7084 7085 7086 7087 7088 7089 7090 7091 7092 7093 7094 7095 7096 7097 7098 7099 7100 7101 7102 7103 7104 7105 7106 7107 7108 7109 7110 7111 7112 7113 7114 7115 7116 7117 7118 7119 7120 7121 7122 7123 7124 7125 7126 7127 7128 7129 7130 7131 7132 7133 7134 7135 7136 7137 7138 7139 7140 7141 7142 7143 7144 7145 7146 7147 7148 7149 7150 7151 7152 7153 7154 7155 7156 7157 7158 7159 7160 7161 7162 7163 7164 7165 7166 7167 7168 7169 7170 7171 7172 7173 7174 7175 7176 7177 7178 7179 7180 7181 7182 7183 7184 7185 7186 7187 7188 7189 7190 7191 7192 7193 7194 7195 7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201 7202 7203 7204 7205 7206 7207 7208 7209 7210 7211 7212 7213 7214 7215 7216 7217 7218 7219 7220 7221 7222 7223 7224 7225 7226 7227 7228 7229 7230 7231 7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237 7238 7239 7240 7241 7242 7243 7244 7245 7246 7247 7248 7249 7250 7251 7252 7253 7254 7255 7256 7257 7258 7259 7260 7261 7262 7263 7264 7265 7266 7267 7268 7269 7270 7271 7272 7273 7274 7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281 7282 7283 7284 7285 7286 7287 7288 7289 7290 7291 7292 7293 7294 7295 7296 7297 7298 7299 7300 7301 7302 7303 7304 7305 7306 7307 7308 7309 7310 7311 7312 7313 7314 7315 7316 7317 7318 7319 7320 7321 7322 7323 7324 7325 7326 7327 7328 7329 7330 7331 7332 7333 7334 7335 7336 7337 7338 7339 7340 7341 7342 7343 7344 7345 7346 7347 7348 7349 7350 7351 7352 7353 7354 7355 7356 7357 7358 7359 7360 7361 7362 7363 7364 7365 7366 7367 7368 7369 7370 7371 7372 7373 7374 7375 7376 7377 7378 7379 7380 7381 7382 7383 7384 7385 7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415 7416 7417 7418 7419 7420 7421 7422 7423 7424 7425 7426 7427 7428 7429 7430 7431 7432 7433 7434 7435 7436 7437 7438 7439 7440 7441 7442 7443 7444 7445 7446 7447 7448 7449 7450 7451 7452 7453 7454 7455 7456 7457 7458 7459 7460 7461 7462 7463 7464 7465 7466 7467 7468 7469 7470 7471 7472 7473 7474 7475 7476 7477 7478 7479 7480 7481 7482 7483 7484 7485 7486 7487 7488 7489 7490 7491 7492 7493 7494 7495 7496 7497 7498 7499 7500 7501 7502 7503 7504 7505 7506 7507 7508 7509 7510 7511 7512 7513 7514 7515 7516 7517 7518 7519 7520 7521 7522 7523 7524 7525 7526 7527 7528 7529 7530 7531 7532 7533 7534 7535 7536 7537 7538 7539 7540 7541 7542 7543 7544 7545 7546 7547 7548 7549 7550 7551 7552 7553 7554 7555 7556 7557 7558 7559 7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567 7568 7569 7570 7571 7572 7573 7574 7575 7576 7577 7578 7579 7580 7581 7582 7583 7584 7585 7586 7587 7588 7589 7590 7591 7592 7593 7594 7595 7596 7597 7598 7599 7600 7601 7602 7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608 7609 7610 7611 7612 7613 7614 7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622 7623 7624 7625 7626 7627 7628 7629 7630 7631 7632 7633 7634 7635 7636 7637 7638 7639 7640 7641 7642 7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652 7653 7654 7655 7656 7657 7658 7659 7660 7661 7662 7663 7664 7665 7666 7667 7668 7669 7670 7671 7672 7673 7674 7675 7676 7677 7678 7679 7680 7681 7682 7683 7684 7685 7686 7687 7688 7689 7690 7691 7692 7693 7694 7695 7696 7697 7698 7699 7700 7701 7702 7703 7704 7705 7706 7707 7708 7709 7710 7711 7712 7713 7714 7715 7716 7717 7718 7719 7720 7721 7722 7723 7724 7725 7726 7727 7728 7729 7730 7731 7732 7733 7734 7735 7736 7737 7738 7739 7740 7741 7742 7743 7744 7745 7746 7747 7748 7749 7750 7751 7752 7753 7754 7755 7756 7757 7758 7759 7760 7761 7762 7763 7764 7765 7766 7767 7768 7769 7770 7771 7772 7773 7774 7775 7776 7777 7778 7779 7780 7781 7782 7783 7784 7785 7786 7787 7788 7789 7790 7791 7792 7793 7794 7795 7796 7797 7798 7799 7800 7801 7802 7803 7804 7805 7806 7807 7808 7809 7810 7811 7812 7813 7814 7815 7816 7817 7818 7819 7820 7821 7822 7823 7824 7825 7826 7827 7828 7829 7830 7831 7832 7833 7834 7835 7836 7837 7838 7839 7840 7841 7842 7843 7844 7845 7846 7847 7848 7849 7850 7851 7852 7853 7854 7855 7856 7857 7858 7859 7860 7861 7862 7863 7864 7865 7866 7867 7868 7869 7870 7871 7872 7873 7874 7875 7876 7877 7878 7879 7880 7881 7882 7883 7884 7885 7886 7887 7888 7889 7890 7891 7892 7893 7894 7895 7896 7897 7898 7899 7900 7901 7902 7903 7904 7905 7906 7907 7908 7909 7910 7911 7912 7913 7914 7915 7916 7917 7918 7919 7920 7921 7922 7923 7924 7925 7926 7927 7928 7929 7930 7931 7932 7933 7934 7935 7936 7937 7938 7939 7940 7941 7942 7943 7944 7945 7946 7947 7948 7949 7950 7951 7952 7953 7954 7955 7956 7957 7958 7959 7960 7961 7962 7963 7964 7965 7966 7967 7968 7969 7970 7971 7972 7973 7974 7975 7976 7977 7978 7979 7980 7981 7982 7983 7984 7985 7986 7987 7988 7989 7990 7991 7992 7993 7994 7995 7996 7997 7998 7999 8000 8001 8002 8003 8004 8005 8006 8007 8008 8009 8010 8011 8012 8013 8014 8015 8016 8017 8018 8019 8020 8021 8022 8023 8024 8025 8026 8027 8028 8029 8030 8031 8032 8033 8034 8035 8036 8037 8038 8039 8040 8041 8042 8043 8044 8045 8046 8047 8048 8049 8050 8051 8052 8053 8054 8055 8056 8057 8058 8059 8060 8061 8062 8063 8064 8065 8066 8067 8068 8069 8070 8071 8072 8073 8074 8075 8076 8077 8078 8079 8080 8081 8082 8083 8084 8085 8086 8087 8088 8089 8090 8091 8092 8093 8094 8095 8096 8097 8098 8099 8100 8101 8102 8103 8104 8105 8106 8107 8108 8109 8110 8111 8112 8113 8114 8115 8116 8117 8118 8119 8120 8121 8122 8123 8124 8125 8126 8127 8128 8129 8130 8131 8132 8133 8134 8135 8136 8137 8138 8139 8140 8141 8142 8143 8144 8145 8146 8147 8148 8149 8150 8151 8152 8153 8154 8155 8156 8157 8158 8159 8160 8161 8162 8163 8164 8165 8166 8167 8168 8169 8170 8171 8172 8173 8174 8175 8176 8177 8178 8179 8180 8181 8182 8183 8184 8185 8186 8187 8188 8189 8190 8191 8192 8193 8194 8195 8196 8197 8198 8199 8200 8201 8202 8203 8204 8205 8206 8207 8208 8209 8210 8211 8212 8213 8214 8215 8216 8217 8218 8219 8220 8221 8222 8223 8224 8225 8226 8227 8228 8229 8230 8231 8232 8233 8234 8235 8236 8237 8238 8239 8240 8241 8242 8243 8244 8245 8246 8247 8248 8249 8250 8251 8252 8253 8254 8255 8256 8257 8258 8259 8260 8261 8262 8263 8264 8265 8266 8267 8268 8269 8270 8271 8272 8273 8274 8275 8276 8277 8278 8279 8280 8281 8282 8283 8284 8285 8286 8287 8288 8289 8290 8291 8292 8293 8294 8295 8296 8297 8298 8299 8300 8301 8302 8303 8304 8305 8306 8307 8308 8309 8310 8311 8312 8313 8314 8315 8316 8317 8318 8319 8320 8321 8322 8323 8324 8325 8326 8327 8328 8329 8330 8331 8332 8333 8334 8335 8336 8337 8338 8339 8340 8341 8342 8343 8344 8345 8346 8347 8348 8349 8350 8351 8352 8353 8354 8355 8356 8357 8358 8359 8360 8361 8362 8363 8364 8365 8366 8367 8368 8369 8370 8371 8372 8373 8374 8375 8376 8377 8378 8379 8380 8381 8382 8383 8384 8385 8386 8387 8388 8389 8390 8391 8392 8393 8394 8395 8396 8397 8398 8399 8400 8401 8402 8403 8404 8405 8406 8407 8408 8409 8410 8411 8412 8413 8414 8415 8416 8417 8418 8419 8420 8421 8422 8423 8424 8425 8426 8427 8428 8429 8430 8431 8432 8433 8434 8435 8436 8437 8438 8439 8440 8441 8442 8443 8444 8445 8446 8447 8448 8449 8450 8451 8452 8453 8454 8455 8456 8457 8458 8459 8460 8461 8462 8463 8464 8465 8466 8467 8468 8469 8470 8471 8472 8473 8474 8475 8476 8477 8478 8479 8480 8481 8482 8483 8484 8485 8486 8487 8488 8489 8490 8491 8492 8493 8494 8495 8496 8497 8498 8499 8500 8501 8502 8503 8504 8505 8506 8507 8508 8509 8510 8511 8512 8513 8514 8515 8516 8517 8518 8519 8520 8521 8522 8523 8524 8525 8526 8527 8528 8529 8530 8531 8532 8533 8534 8535 8536 8537 8538 8539 8540 8541 8542 8543 8544 8545 8546 8547 8548 8549 8550 8551 8552 8553 8554 8555 8556 8557 8558 8559 8560 8561 8562 8563 8564 8565 8566 8567 8568 8569 8570 8571 8572 8573 8574 8575 8576 8577 8578 8579 8580 8581 8582 8583 8584 8585 8586 8587 8588 8589 8590 8591 8592 8593 8594 8595 8596 8597 8598 8599 8600 8601 8602 8603 8604 8605 8606 8607 8608 8609 8610 8611 8612 8613 8614 8615 8616 8617 8618 8619 8620 8621 8622 8623 8624 8625 8626 8627 8628 8629 8630 8631 8632 8633 8634 8635 8636 8637 8638 8639 8640 8641 8642 8643 8644 8645 8646 8647 8648 8649 8650 8651 8652 8653 8654 8655 8656 8657 8658 8659 8660 8661 8662 8663 8664 8665 8666 8667 8668 8669 8670 8671 8672 8673 8674 8675 8676 8677 8678 8679 8680 8681 8682 8683 8684 8685 8686 8687 8688 8689 8690 8691 8692 8693 8694 8695 8696 8697 8698 8699 8700 8701 8702 8703 8704 8705 8706 8707 8708 8709 8710 8711 8712 8713 8714 8715 8716 8717 8718 8719 8720 8721 8722 8723 8724 8725 8726 8727 8728 8729 8730 8731 8732 8733 8734 8735 8736 8737 8738 8739 8740 8741 8742 8743 8744 8745 8746 8747 8748 8749 8750 8751 8752 8753 8754 8755 8756 8757 8758 8759 8760 8761 8762 8763 8764 8765 8766 8767 8768 8769 8770 8771 8772 8773 8774 8775 8776 8777 8778 8779 8780 8781 8782 8783 8784 8785 8786 8787 8788 8789 8790 8791 8792 8793 8794 8795 8796 8797 8798 8799 8800 8801 8802 8803 8804 8805 8806 8807 8808 8809 8810 8811 8812 8813 8814 8815 8816 8817 8818 8819 8820 8821 8822 8823 8824 8825 8826 8827 8828 8829 8830 8831 8832 8833 8834 8835 8836 8837 8838 8839 8840 8841 8842 8843 8844 8845 8846 8847 8848 8849 8850 8851 8852 8853 8854 8855 8856 8857 8858 8859 8860 8861 8862 8863 8864 8865 8866 8867 8868 8869 8870 8871 8872 8873 8874 8875 8876 8877 8878 8879 8880 8881 8882 8883 8884 8885 8886 8887 8888 8889 8890 8891 8892 8893 8894 8895 8896 8897 8898 8899 8900 8901 8902 8903 8904 8905 8906 8907 8908 8909 8910 8911 8912 8913 8914 8915 8916 8917 8918 8919 8920 8921 8922 8923 8924 8925 8926 8927 8928 8929 8930 8931 8932 8933 8934 8935 8936 8937 8938 8939 8940 8941 8942 8943 8944 8945 8946 8947 8948 8949 8950 8951 8952 8953 8954 8955 8956 8957 8958 8959 8960 8961 8962 8963 8964 8965 8966 8967 8968 8969 8970 8971 8972 8973 8974 8975 8976 8977 8978 8979 8980 8981 8982 8983 8984 8985 8986 8987 8988 8989 8990 8991 8992 8993 8994 8995 8996 8997 8998 8999 9000 9001 9002 9003 9004 9005 9006 9007 9008 9009 9010 9011 9012 9013 9014 9015 9016 9017 9018 9019 9020 9021 9022 9023 9024 9025 9026 9027 9028 9029 9030 9031 9032 9033 9034 9035 9036 9037 9038 9039 9040 9041 9042 9043 9044 9045 9046 9047 9048 9049 9050 9051 9052 9053 9054 9055 9056 9057 9058 9059 9060 9061 9062 9063 9064 9065 9066 9067 9068 9069 9070 9071 9072 9073 9074 9075 9076 9077 9078 9079 9080 9081 9082 9083 9084 9085 9086 9087 9088 9089 9090 9091 9092 9093 9094 9095 9096 9097 9098 9099 9100 9101 9102 9103 9104 9105 9106 9107 9108 9109 9110 9111 9112 9113 9114 9115 9116 9117 9118 9119 9120 9121 9122 9123 9124 9125 9126 9127 9128 9129 9130 9131 9132 9133 9134 9135 9136 9137 9138 9139 9140 9141 9142 9143 9144 9145 9146 9147 9148 9149 9150 9151 9152 9153 9154 9155 9156 9157 9158 9159 9160 9161 9162 9163 9164 9165 9166 9167 9168 9169 9170 9171 9172 9173 9174 9175 9176 9177 9178 9179 9180 9181 9182 9183 9184 9185 9186 9187 9188 9189 9190 9191 9192 9193 9194 9195 9196 9197 9198 9199 9200 9201 9202 9203 9204 9205 9206 9207 9208 9209 9210 9211 9212 9213 9214 9215 9216 9217 9218 9219 9220 9221 9222 9223 9224 9225 9226 9227 9228 9229 9230 9231 9232 9233 9234 9235 9236 9237 9238 9239 9240 9241 9242 9243 9244 9245 9246 9247 9248 9249 9250 9251 9252 9253 9254 9255 9256 9257 9258 9259 9260 9261 9262 9263 9264 9265 9266 9267 9268 9269 9270 9271 9272 9273 9274 9275 9276 9277 9278 9279 9280 9281 9282 9283 9284 9285 9286 9287 9288 9289 9290 9291 9292 9293 9294 9295 9296 9297 9298 9299 9300 9301 9302 9303 9304 9305 9306 9307 9308 9309 9310 9311 9312 9313 9314 9315 9316 9317 9318 9319 9320 9321 9322 9323 9324 9325 9326 9327 9328 9329 9330 9331 9332 9333 9334 9335 9336 9337 9338 9339 9340 9341 9342 9343 9344 9345 9346 9347 9348 9349 9350 9351 9352 9353 9354 9355 9356 9357 9358 9359 9360 9361 9362 9363 9364 9365 9366 9367 9368 9369 9370 9371 9372 9373 9374 9375 9376 9377 9378 9379 9380 9381 9382 9383 9384 9385 9386 9387 9388 9389 9390 9391 9392 9393 9394 9395 9396 9397 9398 9399 9400 9401 9402 9403 9404 9405 9406 9407 9408 9409 9410 9411 9412 9413 9414 9415 9416 9417 9418 9419 9420 9421 9422 9423 9424 9425 9426 9427 9428 9429 9430 9431 9432 9433 9434 9435 9436 9437 9438 9439 9440 9441 9442 9443 9444 9445 9446 9447 9448 9449 9450 9451 9452 9453 9454 9455 9456 9457 9458 9459 9460 9461 9462 9463 9464 9465 9466 9467 9468 9469 9470 9471 9472 9473 9474 9475 9476 9477 9478 9479 9480 9481 9482 9483 9484 9485 9486 9487 9488 9489 9490 9491 9492 9493 9494 9495 9496 9497 9498 9499 9500 9501 9502 9503 9504 9505 9506 9507 9508 9509 9510 9511 9512 9513 9514 9515 9516 9517 9518 9519 9520 9521 9522 9523 9524 9525 9526 9527 9528 9529 9530 9531 9532 9533 9534 9535 9536 9537 9538 9539 9540 9541 9542 9543 9544 9545 9546 9547 9548 9549 9550 9551 9552 9553 9554 9555 9556 9557 9558 9559 9560 9561 9562 9563 9564 9565 9566 9567 9568 9569 9570 9571 9572 9573 9574 9575 9576 9577 9578 9579 9580 9581 9582 9583 9584 9585 9586 9587 9588 9589 9590 9591 9592 9593 9594 9595 9596 9597 9598 9599 9600 9601 9602 9603 9604 9605 9606 9607 9608 9609 9610 9611 9612 9613 9614 9615 9616 9617 9618 9619 9620 9621 9622 9623 9624 9625 9626 9627 9628 9629 9630 9631 9632 9633 9634 9635 9636 9637 9638 9639 9640 9641 9642 9643 9644 9645 9646 9647 9648 9649 9650 9651 9652 9653 9654 9655 9656 9657 9658 9659 9660 9661 9662 9663 9664 9665 9666 9667 9668 9669 9670 9671 9672 9673 9674 9675 9676 9677 9678 9679 9680 9681 9682 9683 9684 9685 9686 9687 9688 9689 9690 9691 9692 9693 9694 9695 9696 9697 9698 9699 9700 9701 9702 9703 9704 9705 9706 9707 9708 9709 9710 9711 9712 9713 9714 9715 9716 9717 9718 9719 9720 9721 9722 9723 9724 9725 9726 9727 9728 9729 9730 9731 9732 9733 9734 9735 9736 9737 9738 9739 9740 9741 9742 9743 9744 9745 9746 9747 9748 9749 9750 9751 9752 9753 9754 9755 9756 9757 9758 9759 9760 9761 9762 9763 9764 9765 9766 9767 9768 9769 9770 9771 9772 9773 9774 9775 9776 9777 9778 9779 9780 9781 9782 9783 9784 9785 9786 9787 9788 9789 9790 9791 9792 9793 9794 9795 9796 9797 9798 9799 9800 9801 9802 9803 9804 9805 9806 9807 9808 9809 9810 9811 9812 9813 9814 9815 9816 9817 9818 9819 9820 9821 9822 9823 9824 9825 9826 9827 9828 9829 9830 9831 9832 9833 9834 9835 9836 9837 9838 9839 9840 9841 9842 9843 9844 9845 9846 9847 9848 9849 9850 9851 9852 9853 9854 9855 9856 9857 9858 9859 9860 9861 9862 9863 9864 9865 9866 9867 9868 9869 9870 9871 9872 9873 9874 9875 9876 9877 9878 9879 9880 9881 9882 9883 9884 9885 9886 9887 9888 9889 9890 9891 9892 9893 9894 9895 9896 9897 9898 9899 9900 9901 9902 9903 9904 9905 9906 9907 9908 9909 9910 9911 9912 9913 9914 9915 9916 9917 9918 9919 9920 9921 9922 9923 9924 9925 9926 9927 9928 9929 9930 9931 9932 9933 9934 9935 9936 9937 9938 9939 9940 9941 9942 9943 9944 9945 9946 9947 9948 9949 9950 9951 9952 9953 9954 9955 9956 9957 9958 9959 9960 9961 9962 9963 9964 9965 9966 9967 9968 9969 9970 9971 9972 9973 9974 9975 9976 9977 9978 9979 9980 9981 9982 9983 9984 9985 9986 9987 9988 9989 9990 9991 9992 9993 9994 9995 9996 9997 9998 9999 10000 10001 10002 10003 10004 10005 10006 10007 10008 10009 10010 10011 10012 10013 10014 10015 10016 10017 10018 10019 10020 10021 10022 10023 10024 10025 10026 10027 10028 10029 10030 10031 10032 10033 10034 10035 10036 10037 10038 10039 10040 10041 10042 10043 10044 10045 10046 10047 10048 10049 10050 10051 10052 10053 10054 10055 10056 10057 10058 10059 10060 10061 10062 10063 10064 10065 10066 10067 10068 10069 10070 10071 10072 10073 10074 10075 10076 10077 10078 10079 10080 10081 10082 10083 10084 10085 10086 10087 10088 10089 10090 10091 10092 10093 10094 10095 10096 10097 10098 10099 10100 10101 10102 10103 10104 10105 10106 10107 10108 10109 10110 10111 10112 10113 10114 10115 10116 10117 10118 10119 10120 10121 10122 10123 10124 10125 10126 10127 10128 10129 10130 10131 10132 10133 10134 10135 10136 10137 10138 10139 10140 10141 10142 10143 10144 10145 10146 10147 10148 10149 10150 10151 10152 10153 10154 10155 10156 10157 10158 10159 10160 10161 10162 10163 10164 10165 10166 10167 10168 10169 10170 10171 10172 10173 10174 10175 10176 10177 10178 10179 10180 10181 10182 10183 10184 10185 10186 10187 10188 10189 10190 10191 10192 10193 10194 10195 10196 10197 10198 10199 10200 10201 10202 10203 10204 10205 10206 10207 10208 10209 10210 10211 10212 10213 10214 10215 10216 10217 10218 10219 10220 10221 10222 10223 10224 10225 10226 10227 10228 10229 10230 10231 10232 10233 10234 10235 10236 10237 10238 10239 10240 10241 10242 10243 10244 10245 10246 10247 10248 10249 10250 10251 10252 10253 10254 10255 10256 10257 10258 10259 10260 10261 10262 10263 10264 10265 10266 10267 10268 10269 10270 10271 10272 10273 10274 10275 10276 10277 10278 10279 10280 10281 10282 10283 10284 10285 10286 10287 10288 10289 10290 10291 10292 10293 10294 10295 10296 10297 10298 10299 10300 10301 10302 10303 10304 10305 10306 10307 10308 10309 10310 10311 10312 10313 10314 10315 10316 10317 10318 10319 10320 10321 10322 10323 10324 10325 10326 10327 10328 10329 10330 10331 10332 10333 10334 10335 10336 10337 10338 10339 10340 10341 10342 10343 10344 10345 10346 10347 10348 10349 10350 10351 10352 10353 10354 10355 10356 10357 10358 10359 10360 10361 10362 10363 10364 10365 10366 10367 10368 10369 10370 10371 10372 10373 10374 10375 10376 10377 10378 10379 10380 10381 10382 10383 10384 10385 10386 10387 10388 10389 10390 10391 10392 10393 10394 10395 10396 10397 10398 10399 10400 10401 10402 10403 10404 10405 10406 10407 10408 10409 10410 10411 10412 10413 10414 10415 10416 10417 10418 10419 10420 10421 10422 10423 10424 10425 10426 10427 10428 10429 10430 10431 10432 10433 10434 10435 10436 10437 10438 10439 10440 10441 10442 10443 10444 10445 10446 10447 10448 10449 10450 10451 10452 10453 10454 10455 10456 10457 10458 10459 10460 10461 10462 10463 10464 10465 10466 10467 10468 10469 10470 10471 10472 10473 10474 10475 10476 10477 10478 10479 10480 10481 10482 10483 10484 10485 10486 10487 10488 10489 10490 10491 10492 10493 10494 10495 10496 10497 10498 10499 10500 10501 10502 10503 10504 10505 10506 10507 10508 10509 10510 10511 10512 10513 10514 10515 10516 10517 10518 10519 10520 10521 10522 10523 10524 10525 10526 10527 10528 10529 10530 10531 10532 10533 10534 10535 10536 10537 10538 10539 10540 10541 10542 10543 10544 10545 10546 10547 10548 10549 10550 10551 10552 10553 10554 10555 10556 10557 10558 10559 10560 10561 10562 10563 10564 10565 10566 10567 10568 10569 10570 10571 10572 10573 10574 10575 10576 10577 10578 10579 10580 10581 10582 10583 10584 10585 10586 10587 10588 10589 10590 10591 10592 10593 10594 10595 10596 10597 10598 10599 10600 10601 10602 10603 10604 10605 10606 10607 10608 10609 10610 10611 10612 10613 10614 10615 10616 10617 10618 10619 10620 10621 10622 10623 10624 10625 10626 10627 10628 10629 10630 10631 10632 10633 10634 10635 10636 10637 10638 10639 10640 10641 10642 10643 10644 10645 10646 10647 10648 10649 10650 10651 10652 10653 10654 10655 10656 10657 10658 10659 10660 10661 10662 10663 10664 10665 10666 10667 10668 10669 10670 10671 10672 10673 10674 10675 10676 10677 10678 10679 10680 10681 10682 10683 10684 10685 10686 10687 10688 10689 10690 10691 10692 10693 10694 10695 10696 10697 10698 10699 10700 10701 10702 10703 10704 10705 10706 10707 10708 10709 10710 10711 10712 10713 10714 10715 10716 10717 10718 10719 10720 10721 10722 10723 10724 10725 10726 10727 10728 10729 10730 10731 10732 10733 10734 10735 10736 10737 10738 10739 10740 10741 10742 10743 10744 10745 10746 10747 10748 10749 10750 10751 10752 10753 10754 10755 10756 10757 10758 10759 10760 10761 10762 10763 10764 10765 10766 10767 10768 10769 10770 10771 10772 10773 10774 10775 10776 10777 10778 10779 10780 10781 10782 10783 10784 10785 10786 10787 10788 10789 10790 10791 10792 10793 10794 10795 10796 10797 10798 10799 10800 10801 10802 10803 10804 10805 10806 10807 10808 10809 10810 10811 10812 10813 10814 10815 10816 10817 10818 10819 10820 10821 10822 10823 10824 10825 10826 10827 10828 10829 10830 10831 10832 10833 10834 10835 10836 10837 10838 10839 10840 10841 10842 10843 10844 10845 10846 10847 10848 10849 10850 10851 10852 10853 10854 10855 10856 10857 10858 10859 10860 10861 10862 10863 10864 10865 10866 10867 10868 10869 10870 10871 10872 10873 10874 10875 10876 10877 10878 10879 10880 10881 10882 10883 10884 10885 10886 10887 10888 10889 10890 10891 10892 10893 10894 10895 10896 10897 10898 10899 10900 10901 10902 10903 10904 10905 10906 10907 10908 10909 10910 10911 10912 10913 10914 10915 10916 10917 10918 10919 10920 10921 10922 10923 10924 10925 10926 10927 10928 10929 10930 10931 10932 10933 10934 10935 10936 10937 10938 10939 10940 10941 10942 10943 10944 10945 10946 10947 10948 10949 10950 10951 10952 10953 10954 10955 10956 10957 10958 10959 10960 10961 10962 10963 10964 10965 10966 10967 10968 10969 10970 10971 10972 10973 10974 10975 10976 10977 10978 10979 10980 10981 10982 10983 10984 10985 10986 10987 10988 10989 10990 10991 10992 10993 10994 10995 10996 10997 10998 10999 11000 11001 11002 11003 11004 11005 11006 11007 11008 11009 11010 11011 11012 11013 11014 11015 11016 11017 11018 11019 11020 11021 11022 11023 11024 11025 11026 11027 11028 11029 11030 11031 11032 11033 11034 11035 11036 11037 11038 11039 11040 11041 11042 11043 11044 11045 11046 11047 11048 11049 11050 11051 11052 11053 11054 11055 11056 11057 11058 11059 11060 11061 11062 11063 11064 11065 11066 11067 11068 11069 11070 11071 11072 11073 11074 11075 11076 11077 11078 11079 11080 11081 11082 11083 11084 11085 11086 11087 11088 11089 11090 11091 11092 11093 11094 11095 11096 11097 11098 11099 11100 11101 11102 11103 11104 11105 11106 11107 11108 11109 11110 11111 11112 11113 11114 11115 11116 11117 11118 11119 11120 11121 11122 11123 11124 11125 11126 11127 11128 11129 11130 11131 11132 11133 11134 11135 11136 11137 11138 11139 11140 11141 11142 11143 11144 11145 11146 11147 11148 11149 11150 11151 11152 11153 11154 11155 11156 11157 11158 11159 11160 11161 11162 11163 11164 11165 11166 11167 11168 11169 11170 11171 11172 11173 11174 11175 11176 11177 11178 11179 11180 11181 11182 11183 11184 11185 11186 11187 11188 11189 11190 11191 11192 11193 11194 11195 11196 11197 11198 11199 11200 11201 11202 11203 11204 11205 11206 11207 11208 11209 11210 11211 11212 11213 11214 11215 11216 11217 11218 11219 11220 11221 11222 11223 11224 11225 11226 11227 11228 11229 11230 11231 11232 11233 11234 11235 11236 11237 11238 11239 11240 11241 11242 11243 11244 11245 11246 11247 11248 11249 11250 11251 11252 11253 11254 11255 11256 11257 11258 11259 11260 11261 11262 11263 11264 11265 11266 11267 11268 11269 11270 11271 11272 11273 11274 11275 11276 11277 11278 11279 11280 11281 11282 11283 11284 11285 11286 11287 11288 11289 11290 11291 11292 11293 11294 11295 11296 11297 11298 11299 11300 11301 11302 11303 11304 11305 11306 11307 11308 11309 11310 11311 11312 11313 11314 11315 11316 11317 11318 11319 11320 11321 11322 11323 11324 11325 11326 11327 11328 11329 11330 11331 11332 11333 11334 11335 11336 11337 11338 11339 11340 11341 11342 11343 11344 11345 11346 11347 11348 11349 11350 11351 11352 11353 11354 11355
|
<!doctype html public "-//W30//DTD W3 HTML 2.0//EN">
<HTML>
<!-- This file was generated using SDF 2.001 by
Ian Clatworthy (ianc@mincom.com). SDF is freely
available from http://www.mincom.com/mtr/sdf. -->
<HEAD>
<TITLE>OpenLDAP Software 2.4 Administrator's Guide</TITLE>
</HEAD>
<BODY>
<DIV CLASS="header">
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/">
<P><IMG SRC="../images/LDAPlogo.gif" ALIGN="Left" BORDER=0></P>
</A>
<DIV CLASS="navigate">
<P ALIGN="Center"><A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">Home</A> | <A HREF="../index.html">Catalog</A></P>
</DIV>
<BR CLEAR="Left">
</DIV>
<DIV CLASS="title">
<H1 CLASS="doc-title">OpenLDAP Software 2.4 Administrator's Guide</H1>
<ADDRESS CLASS="doc-author">The OpenLDAP Project <<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">http://www.openldap.org/</A>></ADDRESS>
<ADDRESS CLASS="doc-modified">18 September 2014</ADDRESS>
<BR CLEAR="All">
</DIV>
<DIV CLASS="contents">
<HR>
<H2>Table of Contents</H2>
<UL>
<A HREF="#Preface">Preface</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Introduction to OpenLDAP Directory Services">1. Introduction to OpenLDAP Directory Services</A><UL>
<A HREF="#What is a directory service">1.1. What is a directory service?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What is LDAP">1.2. What is LDAP?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#When should I use LDAP">1.3. When should I use LDAP?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#When should I not use LDAP">1.4. When should I not use LDAP?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#How does LDAP work">1.5. How does LDAP work?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What about X.500">1.6. What about X.500?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What is the difference between LDAPv2 and LDAPv3">1.7. What is the difference between LDAPv2 and LDAPv3?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#LDAP vs RDBMS">1.8. LDAP vs RDBMS</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What is slapd and what can it do">1.9. What is slapd and what can it do?</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#A Quick-Start Guide">2. A Quick-Start Guide</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The Big Picture - Configuration Choices">3. The Big Picture - Configuration Choices</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Local Directory Service">3.1. Local Directory Service</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Local Directory Service with Referrals">3.2. Local Directory Service with Referrals</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Replicated Directory Service">3.3. Replicated Directory Service</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Distributed Local Directory Service">3.4. Distributed Local Directory Service</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software">4. Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Obtaining and Extracting the Software">4.1. Obtaining and Extracting the Software</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Prerequisite software">4.2. Prerequisite software</A><UL>
<A HREF="#{{TERM[expand]TLS}}">4.2.1. <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM></A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#{{TERM[expand]SASL}}">4.2.2. <TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM></A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#{{TERM[expand]Kerberos}}">4.2.3. <TERM>Kerberos Authentication Service</TERM></A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Database Software">4.2.4. Database Software</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Threads">4.2.5. Threads</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#TCP Wrappers">4.2.6. TCP Wrappers</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Running configure">4.3. Running configure</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Building the Software">4.4. Building the Software</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Testing the Software">4.5. Testing the Software</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Installing the Software">4.6. Installing the Software</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuring slapd">5. Configuring slapd</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Configuration Layout">5.1. Configuration Layout</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuration Directives">5.2. Configuration Directives</A><UL>
<A HREF="#cn=config">5.2.1. cn=config</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#cn=module">5.2.2. cn=module</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#cn=schema">5.2.3. cn=schema</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Backend-specific Directives">5.2.4. Backend-specific Directives</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Database-specific Directives">5.2.5. Database-specific Directives</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#BDB and HDB Database Directives">5.2.6. BDB and HDB Database Directives</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuration Example">5.3. Configuration Example</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Converting old style {{slapd.conf}}(5) file to {{cn=config}} format">5.4. Converting old style <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file to <EM>cn=config</EM> format</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">6. The slapd Configuration File</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Configuration File Format">6.1. Configuration File Format</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuration File Directives">6.2. Configuration File Directives</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Global Directives">6.2.1. Global Directives</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#General Backend Directives">6.2.2. General Backend Directives</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#General Database Directives">6.2.3. General Database Directives</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#BDB and HDB Database Directives">6.2.4. BDB and HDB Database Directives</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuration File Example">6.3. Configuration File Example</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Running slapd">7. Running slapd</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Command-Line Options">7.1. Command-Line Options</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Starting slapd">7.2. Starting slapd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Stopping slapd">7.3. Stopping slapd</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control">8. Access Control</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Introduction">8.1. Introduction</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control via Static Configuration">8.2. Access Control via Static Configuration</A><UL>
<A HREF="#What to control access to">8.2.1. What to control access to</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Who to grant access to">8.2.2. Who to grant access to</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The access to grant">8.2.3. The access to grant</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Evaluation">8.2.4. Access Control Evaluation</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Examples">8.2.5. Access Control Examples</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control via Dynamic Configuration">8.3. Access Control via Dynamic Configuration</A><UL>
<A HREF="#What to control access to">8.3.1. What to control access to</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Who to grant access to">8.3.2. Who to grant access to</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The access to grant">8.3.3. The access to grant</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Evaluation">8.3.4. Access Control Evaluation</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Examples">8.3.5. Access Control Examples</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Ordering">8.3.6. Access Control Ordering</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Control Common Examples">8.4. Access Control Common Examples</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Basic ACLs">8.4.1. Basic ACLs</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Matching Anonymous and Authenticated users">8.4.2. Matching Anonymous and Authenticated users</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Controlling rootdn access">8.4.3. Controlling rootdn access</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Managing access with Groups">8.4.4. Managing access with Groups</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Granting access to a subset of attributes">8.4.5. Granting access to a subset of attributes</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Allowing a user write to all entries below theirs">8.4.6. Allowing a user write to all entries below theirs</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Allowing entry creation">8.4.7. Allowing entry creation</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Tips for using regular expressions in Access Control">8.4.8. Tips for using regular expressions in Access Control</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Granting and Denying access based on security strength factors (ssf)">8.4.9. Granting and Denying access based on security strength factors (ssf)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#When things aren\'t working as expected">8.4.10. When things aren't working as expected</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Sets - Granting rights based on relationships">8.5. Sets - Granting rights based on relationships</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Groups of Groups">8.5.1. Groups of Groups</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Group ACLs without DN syntax">8.5.2. Group ACLs without DN syntax</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Following references">8.5.3. Following references</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Limits">9. Limits</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Introduction">9.1. Introduction</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Soft and Hard limits">9.2. Soft and Hard limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Global Limits">9.3. Global Limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Per-Database Limits">9.4. Per-Database Limits</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Specify who the limits apply to">9.4.1. Specify who the limits apply to</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Specify time limits">9.4.2. Specify time limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Specifying size limits">9.4.3. Specifying size limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Size limits and Paged Results">9.4.4. Size limits and Paged Results</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Example Limit Configurations">9.5. Example Limit Configurations</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Simple Global Limits">9.5.1. Simple Global Limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Global Hard and Soft Limits">9.5.2. Global Hard and Soft Limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Giving specific users larger limits">9.5.3. Giving specific users larger limits</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Limiting who can do paged searches">9.5.4. Limiting who can do paged searches</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">9.6. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Database Creation and Maintenance Tools">10. Database Creation and Maintenance Tools</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Creating a database over LDAP">10.1. Creating a database over LDAP</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Creating a database off-line">10.2. Creating a database off-line</A><UL>
<A HREF="#The {{EX:slapadd}} program">10.2.1. The <TT>slapadd</TT> program</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The {{EX:slapindex}} program">10.2.2. The <TT>slapindex</TT> program</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The {{EX:slapcat}} program">10.2.3. The <TT>slapcat</TT> program</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The LDIF text entry format">10.3. The LDIF text entry format</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Backends">11. Backends</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Berkeley DB Backends">11.1. Berkeley DB Backends</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.1.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-bdb/back-hdb Configuration">11.1.2. back-bdb/back-hdb Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.1.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#LDAP">11.2. LDAP</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.2.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-ldap Configuration">11.2.2. back-ldap Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.2.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#LDIF">11.3. LDIF</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.3.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-ldif Configuration">11.3.2. back-ldif Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.3.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#LMDB">11.4. LMDB</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.4.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-mdb Configuration">11.4.2. back-mdb Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.4.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Metadirectory">11.5. Metadirectory</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.5.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-meta Configuration">11.5.2. back-meta Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.5.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Monitor">11.6. Monitor</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.6.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-monitor Configuration">11.6.2. back-monitor Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.6.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Null">11.7. Null</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.7.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-null Configuration">11.7.2. back-null Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.7.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Passwd">11.8. Passwd</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.8.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-passwd Configuration">11.8.2. back-passwd Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.8.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Perl/Shell">11.9. Perl/Shell</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.9.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-perl/back-shell Configuration">11.9.2. back-perl/back-shell Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.9.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Relay">11.10. Relay</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.10.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-relay Configuration">11.10.2. back-relay Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.10.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SQL">11.11. SQL</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">11.11.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-sql Configuration">11.11.2. back-sql Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">11.11.3. Further Information</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Overlays">12. Overlays</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Access Logging">12.1. Access Logging</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.1.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Access Logging Configuration">12.1.2. Access Logging Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.1.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Audit Logging">12.2. Audit Logging</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.2.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Audit Logging Configuration">12.2.2. Audit Logging Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.2.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Chaining">12.3. Chaining</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.3.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Chaining Configuration">12.3.2. Chaining Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Handling Chaining Errors">12.3.3. Handling Chaining Errors</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Read-Back of Chained Modifications">12.3.4. Read-Back of Chained Modifications</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.3.5. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Constraints">12.4. Constraints</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.4.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Constraint Configuration">12.4.2. Constraint Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.4.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic Directory Services">12.5. Dynamic Directory Services</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.5.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic Directory Service Configuration">12.5.2. Dynamic Directory Service Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.5.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic Groups">12.6. Dynamic Groups</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.6.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic Group Configuration">12.6.2. Dynamic Group Configuration</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic Lists">12.7. Dynamic Lists</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.7.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Dynamic List Configuration">12.7.2. Dynamic List Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.7.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Reverse Group Membership Maintenance">12.8. Reverse Group Membership Maintenance</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.8.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Member Of Configuration">12.8.2. Member Of Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.8.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The Proxy Cache Engine">12.9. The Proxy Cache Engine</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.9.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Proxy Cache Configuration">12.9.2. Proxy Cache Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.9.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Password Policies">12.10. Password Policies</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.10.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Password Policy Configuration">12.10.2. Password Policy Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.10.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Referential Integrity">12.11. Referential Integrity</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.11.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Referential Integrity Configuration">12.11.2. Referential Integrity Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.11.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Return Code">12.12. Return Code</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.12.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Return Code Configuration">12.12.2. Return Code Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.12.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Rewrite/Remap">12.13. Rewrite/Remap</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.13.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Rewrite/Remap Configuration">12.13.2. Rewrite/Remap Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.13.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Sync Provider">12.14. Sync Provider</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.14.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Sync Provider Configuration">12.14.2. Sync Provider Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.14.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Translucent Proxy">12.15. Translucent Proxy</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.15.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Translucent Proxy Configuration">12.15.2. Translucent Proxy Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.15.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Attribute Uniqueness">12.16. Attribute Uniqueness</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.16.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Attribute Uniqueness Configuration">12.16.2. Attribute Uniqueness Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.16.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Value Sorting">12.17. Value Sorting</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.17.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Value Sorting Configuration">12.17.2. Value Sorting Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Further Information">12.17.3. Further Information</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Overlay Stacking">12.18. Overlay Stacking</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Overview">12.18.1. Overview</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Example Scenarios">12.18.2. Example Scenarios</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Schema Specification">13. Schema Specification</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Distributed Schema Files">13.1. Distributed Schema Files</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Extending Schema">13.2. Extending Schema</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Object Identifiers">13.2.1. Object Identifiers</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Naming Elements">13.2.2. Naming Elements</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Local schema file">13.2.3. Local schema file</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Attribute Type Specification">13.2.4. Attribute Type Specification</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Object Class Specification">13.2.5. Object Class Specification</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#OID Macros">13.2.6. OID Macros</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Security Considerations">14. Security Considerations</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Network Security">14.1. Network Security</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Selective Listening">14.1.1. Selective Listening</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#IP Firewall">14.1.2. IP Firewall</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#TCP Wrappers">14.1.3. TCP Wrappers</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Data Integrity and Confidentiality Protection">14.2. Data Integrity and Confidentiality Protection</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Security Strength Factors">14.2.1. Security Strength Factors</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Authentication Methods">14.3. Authentication Methods</A><UL>
<A HREF="#"simple" method">14.3.1. "simple" method</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL method">14.3.2. SASL method</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Password Storage">14.4. Password Storage</A><UL>
<A HREF="#SSHA password storage scheme">14.4.1. SSHA password storage scheme</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#CRYPT password storage scheme">14.4.2. CRYPT password storage scheme</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#MD5 password storage scheme">14.4.3. MD5 password storage scheme</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SMD5 password storage scheme">14.4.4. SMD5 password storage scheme</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SHA password storage scheme">14.4.5. SHA password storage scheme</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL password storage scheme">14.4.6. SASL password storage scheme</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Pass-Through authentication">14.5. Pass-Through authentication</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Configuring slapd to use an authentication provider">14.5.1. Configuring slapd to use an authentication provider</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuring saslauthd">14.5.2. Configuring saslauthd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Testing pass-through authentication">14.5.3. Testing pass-through authentication</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Using SASL">15. Using SASL</A><UL>
<A HREF="#SASL Security Considerations">15.1. SASL Security Considerations</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL Authentication">15.2. SASL Authentication</A><UL>
<A HREF="#GSSAPI">15.2.1. GSSAPI</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#KERBEROS_V4">15.2.2. KERBEROS_V4</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#DIGEST-MD5">15.2.3. DIGEST-MD5</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#EXTERNAL">15.2.4. EXTERNAL</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">15.2.5. Mapping Authentication Identities</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Direct Mapping">15.2.6. Direct Mapping</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Search-based mappings">15.2.7. Search-based mappings</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL Proxy Authorization">15.3. SASL Proxy Authorization</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Uses of Proxy Authorization">15.3.1. Uses of Proxy Authorization</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL Authorization Identities">15.3.2. SASL Authorization Identities</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Proxy Authorization Rules">15.3.3. Proxy Authorization Rules</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Using TLS">16. Using TLS</A><UL>
<A HREF="#TLS Certificates">16.1. TLS Certificates</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Server Certificates">16.1.1. Server Certificates</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Client Certificates">16.1.2. Client Certificates</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#TLS Configuration">16.2. TLS Configuration</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Server Configuration">16.2.1. Server Configuration</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Client Configuration">16.2.2. Client Configuration</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Constructing a Distributed Directory Service">17. Constructing a Distributed Directory Service</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Subordinate Knowledge Information">17.1. Subordinate Knowledge Information</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Superior Knowledge Information">17.2. Superior Knowledge Information</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#The ManageDsaIT Control">17.3. The ManageDsaIT Control</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Replication">18. Replication</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Replication Technology">18.1. Replication Technology</A><UL>
<A HREF="#LDAP Sync Replication">18.1.1. LDAP Sync Replication</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Deployment Alternatives">18.2. Deployment Alternatives</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Delta-syncrepl replication">18.2.1. Delta-syncrepl replication</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#N-Way Multi-Master replication">18.2.2. N-Way Multi-Master replication</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#MirrorMode replication">18.2.3. MirrorMode replication</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Syncrepl Proxy Mode">18.2.4. Syncrepl Proxy Mode</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuring the different replication types">18.3. Configuring the different replication types</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Syncrepl">18.3.1. Syncrepl</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Delta-syncrepl">18.3.2. Delta-syncrepl</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#N-Way Multi-Master">18.3.3. N-Way Multi-Master</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#MirrorMode">18.3.4. MirrorMode</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Syncrepl Proxy">18.3.5. Syncrepl Proxy</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Maintenance">19. Maintenance</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Directory Backups">19.1. Directory Backups</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Berkeley DB Logs">19.2. Berkeley DB Logs</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Checkpointing">19.3. Checkpointing</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Migration">19.4. Migration</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Monitoring">20. Monitoring</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Monitor configuration via cn=config(5)">20.1. Monitor configuration via cn=config(5)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)">20.2. Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Accessing Monitoring Information">20.3. Accessing Monitoring Information</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Monitor Information">20.4. Monitor Information</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Backends">20.4.1. Backends</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Connections">20.4.2. Connections</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Databases">20.4.3. Databases</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Listener">20.4.4. Listener</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Log">20.4.5. Log</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Operations">20.4.6. Operations</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Overlays">20.4.7. Overlays</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SASL">20.4.8. SASL</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Statistics">20.4.9. Statistics</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Threads">20.4.10. Threads</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Time">20.4.11. Time</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#TLS">20.4.12. TLS</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Waiters">20.4.13. Waiters</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Tuning">21. Tuning</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Performance Factors">21.1. Performance Factors</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Memory">21.1.1. Memory</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Disks">21.1.2. Disks</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Network Topology">21.1.3. Network Topology</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Directory Layout Design">21.1.4. Directory Layout Design</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Expected Usage">21.1.5. Expected Usage</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Indexes">21.2. Indexes</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Understanding how a search works">21.2.1. Understanding how a search works</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What to index">21.2.2. What to index</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Presence indexing">21.2.3. Presence indexing</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Logging">21.3. Logging</A><UL>
<A HREF="#What log level to use">21.3.1. What log level to use</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#What to watch out for">21.3.2. What to watch out for</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Improving throughput">21.3.3. Improving throughput</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Caching">21.4. Caching</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Berkeley DB Cache">21.4.1. Berkeley DB Cache</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#{{slapd}}(8) Entry Cache (cachesize)">21.4.2. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) Entry Cache (cachesize)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#{{TERM:IDL}} Cache (idlcachesize)">21.4.3. <TERM>IDL</TERM> Cache (idlcachesize)</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#{{slapd}}(8) Threads">21.5. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) Threads</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Troubleshooting">22. Troubleshooting</A><UL>
<A HREF="#User or Software errors">22.1. User or Software errors?</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Checklist">22.2. Checklist</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#OpenLDAP Bugs">22.3. OpenLDAP Bugs</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#3rd party software error">22.4. 3rd party software error</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#How to contact the OpenLDAP Project">22.5. How to contact the OpenLDAP Project</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#How to present your problem">22.6. How to present your problem</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Debugging {{slapd}}(8)">22.7. Debugging <EM>slapd</EM>(8)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Commercial Support">22.8. Commercial Support</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Changes Since Previous Release">A. Changes Since Previous Release</A><UL>
<A HREF="#New Guide Sections">A.1. New Guide Sections</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New Features and Enhancements in 2.4">A.2. New Features and Enhancements in 2.4</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Better {{B:cn=config}} functionality">A.2.1. Better <B>cn=config</B> functionality</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Better {{B:cn=schema}} functionality">A.2.2. Better <B>cn=schema</B> functionality</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#More sophisticated Syncrepl configurations">A.2.3. More sophisticated Syncrepl configurations</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#N-Way Multimaster Replication">A.2.4. N-Way Multimaster Replication</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Replicating {{slapd}} Configuration (syncrepl and {{B:cn=config}})">A.2.5. Replicating <EM>slapd</EM> Configuration (syncrepl and <B>cn=config</B>)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Push-Mode Replication">A.2.6. Push-Mode Replication</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#More extensive TLS configuration control">A.2.7. More extensive TLS configuration control</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Performance enhancements">A.2.8. Performance enhancements</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New overlays">A.2.9. New overlays</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New features in existing Overlays">A.2.10. New features in existing Overlays</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New features in slapd">A.2.11. New features in slapd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New features in libldap">A.2.12. New features in libldap</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New clients, tools and tool enhancements">A.2.13. New clients, tools and tool enhancements</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#New build options">A.2.14. New build options</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Obsolete Features Removed From 2.4">A.3. Obsolete Features Removed From 2.4</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Slurpd">A.3.1. Slurpd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#back-ldbm">A.3.2. back-ldbm</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Upgrading from 2.3.x">B. Upgrading from 2.3.x</A><UL>
<A HREF="#{{B:cn=config}} olc* attributes">B.1. <B>cn=config</B> olc* attributes</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ACLs: searches require privileges on the search base">B.2. ACLs: searches require privileges on the search base</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software">C. Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Common causes of LDAP errors">C.1. Common causes of LDAP errors</A><UL>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Can\'t contact LDAP server">C.1.1. ldap_*: Can't contact LDAP server</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: No such object">C.1.2. ldap_*: No such object</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Can\'t chase referral">C.1.3. ldap_*: Can't chase referral</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: server is unwilling to perform">C.1.4. ldap_*: server is unwilling to perform</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Insufficient access">C.1.5. ldap_*: Insufficient access</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Invalid DN syntax">C.1.6. ldap_*: Invalid DN syntax</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Referral hop limit exceeded">C.1.7. ldap_*: Referral hop limit exceeded</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: operations error">C.1.8. ldap_*: operations error</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: other error">C.1.9. ldap_*: other error</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add/modify: Invalid syntax">C.1.10. ldap_add/modify: Invalid syntax</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add/modify: Object class violation">C.1.11. ldap_add/modify: Object class violation</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add: No such object">C.1.12. ldap_add: No such object</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap add: invalid structural object class chain">C.1.13. ldap add: invalid structural object class chain</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add: no structuralObjectClass operational attribute">C.1.14. ldap_add: no structuralObjectClass operational attribute</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add/modify/rename: Naming violation">C.1.15. ldap_add/modify/rename: Naming violation</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_add/delete/modify/rename: no global superior knowledge">C.1.16. ldap_add/delete/modify/rename: no global superior knowledge</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_bind: Insufficient access">C.1.17. ldap_bind: Insufficient access</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_bind: Invalid credentials">C.1.18. ldap_bind: Invalid credentials</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_bind: Protocol error">C.1.19. ldap_bind: Protocol error</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_modify: cannot modify object class">C.1.20. ldap_modify: cannot modify object class</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: ..">C.1.21. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: ...</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such Object">C.1.22. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such Object</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such attribute">C.1.23. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such attribute</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Unknown authentication method">C.1.24. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Unknown authentication method</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Local error (82)">C.1.25. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Local error (82)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_search: Partial results and referral received">C.1.26. ldap_search: Partial results and referral received</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_start_tls: Operations error">C.1.27. ldap_start_tls: Operations error</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Other Errors">C.2. Other Errors</A><UL>
<A HREF="#ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=34 (Numerical result out of range)">C.2.1. ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=34 (Numerical result out of range)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=11 (Resource temporarily unavailable)">C.2.2. ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=11 (Resource temporarily unavailable)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#daemon: socket() failed errno=97 (Address family not supported)">C.2.3. daemon: socket() failed errno=97 (Address family not supported)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#GSSAPI: gss_acquire_cred: Miscellaneous failure; Permission denied;">C.2.4. GSSAPI: gss_acquire_cred: Miscellaneous failure; Permission denied;</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#access from unknown denied">C.2.5. access from unknown denied</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_read: want=# error=Resource temporarily unavailable">C.2.6. ldap_read: want=# error=Resource temporarily unavailable</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#`make test\' fails">C.2.7. `make test' fails</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_*: Internal (implementation specific) error (80) - additional info: entry index delete failed">C.2.8. ldap_*: Internal (implementation specific) error (80) - additional info: entry index delete failed</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Can\'t contact LDAP server (-1)">C.2.9. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Can't contact LDAP server (-1)</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions">D. Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Dependency Versions">D.1. Dependency Versions</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples">E. Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#OpenLDAP Software Contributions">F. OpenLDAP Software Contributions</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Client APIs">F.1. Client APIs</A><UL>
<A HREF="#ldapc++">F.1.1. ldapc++</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldaptcl">F.1.2. ldaptcl</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Overlays">F.2. Overlays</A><UL>
<A HREF="#acl">F.2.1. acl</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#addpartial">F.2.2. addpartial</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#allop">F.2.3. allop</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#autogroup">F.2.4. autogroup</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#comp_match">F.2.5. comp_match</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#denyop">F.2.6. denyop</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#dsaschema">F.2.7. dsaschema</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#lastmod">F.2.8. lastmod</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#nops">F.2.9. nops</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#nssov">F.2.10. nssov</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#passwd">F.2.11. passwd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#proxyOld">F.2.12. proxyOld</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#smbk5pwd">F.2.13. smbk5pwd</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#trace">F.2.14. trace</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#usn">F.2.15. usn</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Tools">F.3. Tools</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Statistic Logging">F.3.1. Statistic Logging</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#SLAPI Plugins">F.4. SLAPI Plugins</A><UL>
<A HREF="#addrdnvalues">F.4.1. addrdnvalues</A></UL></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Configuration File Examples">G. Configuration File Examples</A><UL>
<A HREF="#slapd.conf">G.1. slapd.conf</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#ldap.conf">G.2. ldap.conf</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#a-n-other.conf">G.3. a-n-other.conf</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#LDAP Result Codes">H. LDAP Result Codes</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Non-Error Result Codes">H.1. Non-Error Result Codes</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Result Codes">H.2. Result Codes</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#success (0)">H.3. success (0)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#operationsError (1)">H.4. operationsError (1)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#protocolError (2)">H.5. protocolError (2)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#timeLimitExceeded (3)">H.6. timeLimitExceeded (3)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#sizeLimitExceeded (4)">H.7. sizeLimitExceeded (4)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#compareFalse (5)">H.8. compareFalse (5)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#compareTrue (6)">H.9. compareTrue (6)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#authMethodNotSupported (7)">H.10. authMethodNotSupported (7)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#strongerAuthRequired (8)">H.11. strongerAuthRequired (8)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#referral (10)">H.12. referral (10)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#adminLimitExceeded (11)">H.13. adminLimitExceeded (11)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#unavailableCriticalExtension (12)">H.14. unavailableCriticalExtension (12)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#confidentialityRequired (13)">H.15. confidentialityRequired (13)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#saslBindInProgress (14)">H.16. saslBindInProgress (14)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#noSuchAttribute (16)">H.17. noSuchAttribute (16)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#undefinedAttributeType (17)">H.18. undefinedAttributeType (17)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#inappropriateMatching (18)">H.19. inappropriateMatching (18)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#constraintViolation (19)">H.20. constraintViolation (19)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#attributeOrValueExists (20)">H.21. attributeOrValueExists (20)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#invalidAttributeSyntax (21)">H.22. invalidAttributeSyntax (21)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#noSuchObject (32)">H.23. noSuchObject (32)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#aliasProblem (33)">H.24. aliasProblem (33)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#invalidDNSyntax (34)">H.25. invalidDNSyntax (34)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#aliasDereferencingProblem (36)">H.26. aliasDereferencingProblem (36)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#inappropriateAuthentication (48)">H.27. inappropriateAuthentication (48)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#invalidCredentials (49)">H.28. invalidCredentials (49)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#insufficientAccessRights (50)">H.29. insufficientAccessRights (50)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#busy (51)">H.30. busy (51)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#unavailable (52)">H.31. unavailable (52)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#unwillingToPerform (53)">H.32. unwillingToPerform (53)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#loopDetect (54)">H.33. loopDetect (54)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#namingViolation (64)">H.34. namingViolation (64)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#objectClassViolation (65)">H.35. objectClassViolation (65)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#notAllowedOnNonLeaf (66)">H.36. notAllowedOnNonLeaf (66)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#notAllowedOnRDN (67)">H.37. notAllowedOnRDN (67)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#entryAlreadyExists (68)">H.38. entryAlreadyExists (68)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#objectClassModsProhibited (69)">H.39. objectClassModsProhibited (69)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#affectsMultipleDSAs (71)">H.40. affectsMultipleDSAs (71)</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#other (80)">H.41. other (80)</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Glossary">I. Glossary</A><UL>
<A HREF="#Terms">I.1. Terms</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Related Organizations">I.2. Related Organizations</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Related Products">I.3. Related Products</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#References">I.4. References</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Generic configure Instructions">J. Generic configure Instructions</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices">K. OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices</A><UL>
<A HREF="#OpenLDAP Copyright Notice">K.1. OpenLDAP Copyright Notice</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#Additional Copyright Notices">K.2. Additional Copyright Notices</A>
<BR>
<A HREF="#University of Michigan Copyright Notice">K.3. University of Michigan Copyright Notice</A></UL>
<BR>
<A HREF="#OpenLDAP Public License">L. OpenLDAP Public License</A></UL>
</DIV>
<DIV CLASS="main">
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Preface">Preface</A></H1>
<H2>Copyright</H2>
<P>Copyright 1998-2012, The <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/foundation/">OpenLDAP Foundation</A>, <EM>All Rights Reserved</EM>.</P>
<P>Copyright 1992-1996, Regents of the <A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/">University of Michigan</A>, <EM>All Rights Reserved</EM>.</P>
<P>This document is considered a part of OpenLDAP Software. This document is subject to terms of conditions set forth in <A HREF="#OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices">OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices</A> and the <A HREF="#OpenLDAP Public License">OpenLDAP Public License</A>. Complete copies of the notices and associated license can be found in Appendix K and L, respectively.</P>
<P>Portions of OpenLDAP Software and this document may be copyright by other parties and/or subject to additional restrictions. Individual source files should be consulted for additional copyright notices.</P>
<H2>Scope of this Document</H2>
<P>This document provides a guide for installing OpenLDAP Software 2.4 (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/">http://www.openldap.org/software/</A>) on <TERM>UNIX</TERM> (and UNIX-like) systems. The document is aimed at experienced system administrators with basic understanding of <TERM>LDAP</TERM>-based directory services.</P>
<P>This document is meant to be used in conjunction with other OpenLDAP information resources provided with the software package and on the project's site (<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/</A>) on the <TERM>World Wide Web</TERM>. The site makes available a number of resources.</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>OpenLDAP Resources</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Resource</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>URL</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Document Catalog
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/doc/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/doc/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Frequently Asked Questions
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/faq/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/faq/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Issue Tracking System
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/its/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/its/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Mailing Lists
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/lists/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/lists/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Manual Pages
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/software/man.cgi">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/software/man.cgi</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Software Pages
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/software/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/software/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Support Pages
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/support/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/support/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>This document is not a complete reference for OpenLDAP software; the manual pages are the definitive documentation. For best results, you should use the manual pages that were installed on your system with your version of OpenLDAP software so that you're looking at documentation that matches the code. While the OpenLDAP web site also provides the manual pages for convenience, you can not assume that they corresond to the particular version you're running.</P>
<H2>Acknowledgments</H2>
<P>The <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/project/">OpenLDAP Project</A> is comprised of a team of volunteers. This document would not be possible without their contribution of time and energy.</P>
<P>The OpenLDAP Project would also like to thank the <A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">University of Michigan LDAP Team</A> for building the foundation of LDAP software and information to which OpenLDAP Software is built upon. This document is based upon University of Michigan document: <A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/doc/guides/slapd/guide.pdf">The SLAPD and SLURPD Administrators Guide</A>.</P>
<H2>Amendments</H2>
<P>Suggested enhancements and corrections to this document should be submitted using the <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A> <TERM>Issue Tracking System</TERM> (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">http://www.openldap.org/its/</A>).</P>
<H2>About this document</H2>
<P>This document was produced using the <TERM>Simple Document Format</TERM> (<TERM>SDF</TERM>) documentation system (<A HREF="http://search.cpan.org/src/IANC/sdf-2.001/doc/catalog.html">http://search.cpan.org/src/IANC/sdf-2.001/doc/catalog.html</A>) developed by <EM>Ian Clatworthy</EM>. Tools for SDF are available from <A HREF="http://cpan.org/">CPAN</A> (<A HREF="http://search.cpan.org/search?query=SDF&mode=dist">http://search.cpan.org/search?query=SDF&mode=dist</A>).</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Introduction to OpenLDAP Directory Services">1. Introduction to OpenLDAP Directory Services</A></H1>
<P>This document describes how to build, configure, and operate <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A> Software to provide directory services. This includes details on how to configure and run the Standalone <TERM>LDAP</TERM> Daemon, <EM>slapd</EM>(8). It is intended for new and experienced administrators alike. This section provides a basic introduction to directory services and, in particular, the directory services provided by <EM>slapd</EM>(8). This introduction is only intended to provide enough information so one might get started learning about <TERM>LDAP</TERM>, <TERM>X.500</TERM>, and directory services.</P>
<H2><A NAME="What is a directory service">1.1. What is a directory service?</A></H2>
<P>A directory is a specialized database specifically designed for searching and browsing, in additional to supporting basic lookup and update functions.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>A directory is defined by some as merely a database optimized for read access. This definition, at best, is overly simplistic.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Directories tend to contain descriptive, attribute-based information and support sophisticated filtering capabilities. Directories generally do not support complicated transaction or roll-back schemes found in database management systems designed for handling high-volume complex updates. Directory updates are typically simple all-or-nothing changes, if they are allowed at all. Directories are generally tuned to give quick response to high-volume lookup or search operations. They may have the ability to replicate information widely in order to increase availability and reliability, while reducing response time. When directory information is replicated, temporary inconsistencies between the replicas may be okay, as long as inconsistencies are resolved in a timely manner.</P>
<P>There are many different ways to provide a directory service. Different methods allow different kinds of information to be stored in the directory, place different requirements on how that information can be referenced, queried and updated, how it is protected from unauthorized access, etc. Some directory services are <EM>local</EM>, providing service to a restricted context (e.g., the finger service on a single machine). Other services are global, providing service to a much broader context (e.g., the entire Internet). Global services are usually <EM>distributed</EM>, meaning that the data they contain is spread across many machines, all of which cooperate to provide the directory service. Typically a global service defines a uniform <EM>namespace</EM> which gives the same view of the data no matter where you are in relation to the data itself.</P>
<P>A web directory, such as provided by the <EM>Open Directory Project</EM> <<A HREF="http://dmoz.org">http://dmoz.org</A>>, is a good example of a directory service. These services catalog web pages and are specifically designed to support browsing and searching.</P>
<P>While some consider the Internet <TERM>Domain Name System</TERM> (DNS) is an example of a globally distributed directory service, DNS is not browseable nor searchable. It is more properly described as a globally distributed <EM>lookup</EM> service.</P>
<H2><A NAME="What is LDAP">1.2. What is LDAP?</A></H2>
<P><TERM>LDAP</TERM> stands for <TERM>Lightweight Directory Access Protocol</TERM>. As the name suggests, it is a lightweight protocol for accessing directory services, specifically <TERM>X.500</TERM>-based directory services. LDAP runs over <TERM>TCP</TERM>/<TERM>IP</TERM> or other connection oriented transfer services. LDAP is an <A HREF="http://www.ietf.org/">IETF</A> Standard Track protocol and is specified in "Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) Technical Specification Road Map" <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4510.txt">RFC4510</A>.</P>
<P>This section gives an overview of LDAP from a user's perspective.</P>
<P><EM>What kind of information can be stored in the directory?</EM> The LDAP information model is based on <EM>entries</EM>. An entry is a collection of attributes that has a globally-unique <TERM>Distinguished Name</TERM> (DN). The DN is used to refer to the entry unambiguously. Each of the entry's attributes has a <EM>type</EM> and one or more <EM>values</EM>. The types are typically mnemonic strings, like "<TT>cn</TT>" for common name, or "<TT>mail</TT>" for email address. The syntax of values depend on the attribute type. For example, a <TT>cn</TT> attribute might contain the value <TT>Babs Jensen</TT>. A <TT>mail</TT> attribute might contain the value "<TT>babs@example.com</TT>". A <TT>jpegPhoto</TT> attribute would contain a photograph in the <TERM>JPEG</TERM> (binary) format.</P>
<P><EM>How is the information arranged?</EM> In LDAP, directory entries are arranged in a hierarchical tree-like structure. Traditionally, this structure reflected the geographic and/or organizational boundaries. Entries representing countries appear at the top of the tree. Below them are entries representing states and national organizations. Below them might be entries representing organizational units, people, printers, documents, or just about anything else you can think of. Figure 1.1 shows an example LDAP directory tree using traditional naming.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="intro_tree.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 1.1: LDAP directory tree (traditional naming)</P>
<P>The tree may also be arranged based upon Internet domain names. This naming approach is becoming increasing popular as it allows for directory services to be located using the <EM>DNS</EM>. Figure 1.2 shows an example LDAP directory tree using domain-based naming.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="intro_dctree.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 1.2: LDAP directory tree (Internet naming)</P>
<P>In addition, LDAP allows you to control which attributes are required and allowed in an entry through the use of a special attribute called <TT>objectClass</TT>. The values of the <TT>objectClass</TT> attribute determine the <EM>schema</EM> rules the entry must obey.</P>
<P><EM>How is the information referenced?</EM> An entry is referenced by its distinguished name, which is constructed by taking the name of the entry itself (called the <TERM>Relative Distinguished Name</TERM> or RDN) and concatenating the names of its ancestor entries. For example, the entry for Barbara Jensen in the Internet naming example above has an RDN of <TT>uid=babs</TT> and a DN of <TT>uid=babs,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com</TT>. The full DN format is described in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt">RFC4514</A>, "LDAP: String Representation of Distinguished Names."</P>
<P><EM>How is the information accessed?</EM> LDAP defines operations for interrogating and updating the directory. Operations are provided for adding and deleting an entry from the directory, changing an existing entry, and changing the name of an entry. Most of the time, though, LDAP is used to search for information in the directory. The LDAP search operation allows some portion of the directory to be searched for entries that match some criteria specified by a search filter. Information can be requested from each entry that matches the criteria.</P>
<P>For example, you might want to search the entire directory subtree at and below <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> for people with the name <TT>Barbara Jensen</TT>, retrieving the email address of each entry found. LDAP lets you do this easily. Or you might want to search the entries directly below the <TT>st=California,c=US</TT> entry for organizations with the string <TT>Acme</TT> in their name, and that have a fax number. LDAP lets you do this too. The next section describes in more detail what you can do with LDAP and how it might be useful to you.</P>
<P><EM>How is the information protected from unauthorized access?</EM> Some directory services provide no protection, allowing anyone to see the information. LDAP provides a mechanism for a client to authenticate, or prove its identity to a directory server, paving the way for rich access control to protect the information the server contains. LDAP also supports data security (integrity and confidentiality) services.</P>
<H2><A NAME="When should I use LDAP">1.3. When should I use LDAP?</A></H2>
<P>This is a very good question. In general, you should use a Directory server when you require data to be centrally managed, stored and accessible via standards based methods.</P>
<P>Some common examples found throughout the industry are, but not limited to:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Machine Authentication
<LI>User Authentication
<LI>User/System Groups
<LI>Address book
<LI>Organization Representation
<LI>Asset Tracking
<LI>Telephony Information Store
<LI>User resource management
<LI>E-mail address lookups
<LI>Application Configuration store
<LI>PBX Configuration store
<LI>etc.....</UL>
<P>There are various <A HREF="#Distributed Schema Files">Distributed Schema Files</A> that are standards based, but you can always create your own <A HREF="#Schema Specification">Schema Specification</A>.</P>
<P>There are always new ways to use a Directory and apply LDAP principles to address certain problems, therefore there is no simple answer to this question.</P>
<P>If in doubt, join the general LDAP forum for non-commercial discussions and information relating to LDAP at: <A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/mailinglist.html">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/mailinglist.html</A> and ask</P>
<H2><A NAME="When should I not use LDAP">1.4. When should I not use LDAP?</A></H2>
<P>When you start finding yourself bending the directory to do what you require, maybe a redesign is needed. Or if you only require one application to use and manipulate your data (for discussion of LDAP vs RDBMS, please read the <A HREF="#LDAP vs RDBMS">LDAP vs RDBMS</A> section).</P>
<P>It will become obvious when LDAP is the right tool for the job.</P>
<H2><A NAME="How does LDAP work">1.5. How does LDAP work?</A></H2>
<P>LDAP utilizes a <EM>client-server model</EM>. One or more LDAP servers contain the data making up the directory information tree (<TERM>DIT</TERM>). The client connects to servers and asks it a question. The server responds with an answer and/or with a pointer to where the client can get additional information (typically, another LDAP server). No matter which LDAP server a client connects to, it sees the same view of the directory; a name presented to one LDAP server references the same entry it would at another LDAP server. This is an important feature of a global directory service.</P>
<H2><A NAME="What about X.500">1.6. What about X.500?</A></H2>
<P>Technically, <TERM>LDAP</TERM> is a directory access protocol to an <TERM>X.500</TERM> directory service, the <TERM>OSI</TERM> directory service. Initially, LDAP clients accessed gateways to the X.500 directory service. This gateway ran LDAP between the client and gateway and X.500's <TERM>Directory Access Protocol</TERM> (<TERM>DAP</TERM>) between the gateway and the X.500 server. DAP is a heavyweight protocol that operates over a full OSI protocol stack and requires a significant amount of computing resources. LDAP is designed to operate over <TERM>TCP</TERM>/<TERM>IP</TERM> and provides most of the functionality of DAP at a much lower cost.</P>
<P>While LDAP is still used to access X.500 directory service via gateways, LDAP is now more commonly directly implemented in X.500 servers.</P>
<P>The Standalone LDAP Daemon, or <EM>slapd</EM>(8), can be viewed as a <EM>lightweight</EM> X.500 directory server. That is, it does not implement the X.500's DAP nor does it support the complete X.500 models.</P>
<P>If you are already running a X.500 DAP service and you want to continue to do so, you can probably stop reading this guide. This guide is all about running LDAP via <EM>slapd</EM>(8), without running X.500 DAP. If you are not running X.500 DAP, want to stop running X.500 DAP, or have no immediate plans to run X.500 DAP, read on.</P>
<P>It is possible to replicate data from an LDAP directory server to a X.500 DAP <TERM>DSA</TERM>. This requires an LDAP/DAP gateway. OpenLDAP Software does not include such a gateway.</P>
<H2><A NAME="What is the difference between LDAPv2 and LDAPv3">1.7. What is the difference between LDAPv2 and LDAPv3?</A></H2>
<P>LDAPv3 was developed in the late 1990's to replace LDAPv2. LDAPv3 adds the following features to LDAP:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Strong authentication and data security services via <TERM>SASL</TERM>
<LI>Certificate authentication and data security services via <TERM>TLS</TERM> (SSL)
<LI>Internationalization through the use of Unicode
<LI>Referrals and Continuations
<LI>Schema Discovery
<LI>Extensibility (controls, extended operations, and more)</UL>
<P>LDAPv2 is historic (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3494.txt">RFC3494</A>). As most <EM>so-called</EM> LDAPv2 implementations (including <EM>slapd</EM>(8)) do not conform to the LDAPv2 technical specification, interoperability amongst implementations claiming LDAPv2 support is limited. As LDAPv2 differs significantly from LDAPv3, deploying both LDAPv2 and LDAPv3 simultaneously is quite problematic. LDAPv2 should be avoided. LDAPv2 is disabled by default.</P>
<H2><A NAME="LDAP vs RDBMS">1.8. LDAP vs RDBMS</A></H2>
<P>This question is raised many times, in different forms. The most common, however, is: <EM>Why doesn't OpenLDAP drop Berkeley DB and use a relational database management system (RDBMS) instead?</EM> In general, expecting that the sophisticated algorithms implemented by commercial-grade RDBMS would make <EM>OpenLDAP</EM> be faster or somehow better and, at the same time, permitting sharing of data with other applications.</P>
<P>The short answer is that use of an embedded database and custom indexing system allows OpenLDAP to provide greater performance and scalability without loss of reliability. OpenLDAP uses Berkeley DB concurrent / transactional database software. This is the same software used by leading commercial directory software.</P>
<P>Now for the long answer. We are all confronted all the time with the choice RDBMSes vs. directories. It is a hard choice and no simple answer exists.</P>
<P>It is tempting to think that having a RDBMS backend to the directory solves all problems. However, it is a pig. This is because the data models are very different. Representing directory data with a relational database is going to require splitting data into multiple tables.</P>
<P>Think for a moment about the person objectclass. Its definition requires attribute types objectclass, sn and cn and allows attribute types userPassword, telephoneNumber, seeAlso and description. All of these attributes are multivalued, so a normalization requires putting each attribute type in a separate table.</P>
<P>Now you have to decide on appropriate keys for those tables. The primary key might be a combination of the DN, but this becomes rather inefficient on most database implementations.</P>
<P>The big problem now is that accessing data from one entry requires seeking on different disk areas. On some applications this may be OK but in many applications performance suffers.</P>
<P>The only attribute types that can be put in the main table entry are those that are mandatory and single-value. You may add also the optional single-valued attributes and set them to NULL or something if not present.</P>
<P>But wait, the entry can have multiple objectclasses and they are organized in an inheritance hierarchy. An entry of objectclass organizationalPerson now has the attributes from person plus a few others and some formerly optional attribute types are now mandatory.</P>
<P>What to do? Should we have different tables for the different objectclasses? This way the person would have an entry on the person table, another on organizationalPerson, etc. Or should we get rid of person and put everything on the second table?</P>
<P>But what do we do with a filter like (cn=*) where cn is an attribute type that appears in many, many objectclasses. Should we search all possible tables for matching entries? Not very attractive.</P>
<P>Once this point is reached, three approaches come to mind. One is to do full normalization so that each attribute type, no matter what, has its own separate table. The simplistic approach where the DN is part of the primary key is extremely wasteful, and calls for an approach where the entry has a unique numeric id that is used instead for the keys and a main table that maps DNs to ids. The approach, anyway, is very inefficient when several attribute types from one or more entries are requested. Such a database, though cumbersomely, can be managed from SQL applications.</P>
<P>The second approach is to put the whole entry as a blob in a table shared by all entries regardless of the objectclass and have additional tables that act as indices for the first table. Index tables are not database indices, but are fully managed by the LDAP server-side implementation. However, the database becomes unusable from SQL. And, thus, a fully fledged database system provides little or no advantage. The full generality of the database is unneeded. Much better to use something light and fast, like Berkeley DB.</P>
<P>A completely different way to see this is to give up any hopes of implementing the directory data model. In this case, LDAP is used as an access protocol to data that provides only superficially the directory data model. For instance, it may be read only or, where updates are allowed, restrictions are applied, such as making single-value attribute types that would allow for multiple values. Or the impossibility to add new objectclasses to an existing entry or remove one of those present. The restrictions span the range from allowed restrictions (that might be elsewhere the result of access control) to outright violations of the data model. It can be, however, a method to provide LDAP access to preexisting data that is used by other applications. But in the understanding that we don't really have a "directory".</P>
<P>Existing commercial LDAP server implementations that use a relational database are either from the first kind or the third. I don't know of any implementation that uses a relational database to do inefficiently what BDB does efficiently. For those who are interested in "third way" (exposing EXISTING data from RDBMS as LDAP tree, having some limitations compared to classic LDAP model, but making it possible to interoperate between LDAP and SQL applications):</P>
<P>OpenLDAP includes back-sql - the backend that makes it possible. It uses ODBC + additional metainformation about translating LDAP queries to SQL queries in your RDBMS schema, providing different levels of access - from read-only to full access depending on RDBMS you use, and your schema.</P>
<P>For more information on concept and limitations, see <EM>slapd-sql</EM>(5) man page, or the <A HREF="#Backends">Backends</A> section. There are also several examples for several RDBMSes in <TT>back-sql/rdbms_depend/*</TT> subdirectories.</P>
<H2><A NAME="What is slapd and what can it do">1.9. What is slapd and what can it do?</A></H2>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) is an LDAP directory server that runs on many different platforms. You can use it to provide a directory service of your very own. Your directory can contain pretty much anything you want to put in it. You can connect it to the global LDAP directory service, or run a service all by yourself. Some of slapd's more interesting features and capabilities include:</P>
<P><B>LDAPv3</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> implements version 3 of <TERM>Lightweight Directory Access Protocol</TERM>. <EM>slapd</EM> supports LDAP over both <TERM>IPv4</TERM> and <TERM>IPv6</TERM> and Unix <TERM>IPC</TERM>.</P>
<P><B><TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM></B>: <EM>slapd</EM> supports strong authentication and data security (integrity and confidentiality) services through the use of SASL. <EM>slapd</EM>'s SASL implementation utilizes <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A> software which supports a number of mechanisms including <TERM>DIGEST-MD5</TERM>, <TERM>EXTERNAL</TERM>, and <TERM>GSSAPI</TERM>.</P>
<P><B><TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM></B>: <EM>slapd</EM> supports certificate-based authentication and data security (integrity and confidentiality) services through the use of TLS (or SSL). <EM>slapd</EM>'s TLS implementation can utilize <A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A>, <A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">GnuTLS</A>, or <A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">MozNSS</A> software.</P>
<P><B>Topology control</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> can be configured to restrict access at the socket layer based upon network topology information. This feature utilizes <EM>TCP wrappers</EM>.</P>
<P><B>Access control</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> provides a rich and powerful access control facility, allowing you to control access to the information in your database(s). You can control access to entries based on LDAP authorization information, <TERM>IP</TERM> address, domain name and other criteria. <EM>slapd</EM> supports both <EM>static</EM> and <EM>dynamic</EM> access control information.</P>
<P><B>Internationalization</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> supports Unicode and language tags.</P>
<P><B>Choice of database backends</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> comes with a variety of different database backends you can choose from. They include <TERM>BDB</TERM>, a high-performance transactional database backend; <TERM>HDB</TERM>, a hierarchical high-performance transactional backend; <EM>SHELL</EM>, a backend interface to arbitrary shell scripts; and PASSWD, a simple backend interface to the <EM>passwd</EM>(5) file. The BDB and HDB backends utilize <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/">Oracle</A> <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A>.</P>
<P><B>Multiple database instances</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> can be configured to serve multiple databases at the same time. This means that a single <EM>slapd</EM> server can respond to requests for many logically different portions of the LDAP tree, using the same or different database backends.</P>
<P><B>Generic modules API</B>: If you require even more customization, <EM>slapd</EM> lets you write your own modules easily. <EM>slapd</EM> consists of two distinct parts: a front end that handles protocol communication with LDAP clients; and modules which handle specific tasks such as database operations. Because these two pieces communicate via a well-defined <TERM>C</TERM> <TERM>API</TERM>, you can write your own customized modules which extend <EM>slapd</EM> in numerous ways. Also, a number of <EM>programmable database</EM> modules are provided. These allow you to expose external data sources to <EM>slapd</EM> using popular programming languages (<A HREF="http://www.perl.org/">Perl</A>, <EM>shell</EM>, and <TERM>SQL</TERM>).</P>
<P><B>Threads</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> is threaded for high performance. A single multi-threaded <EM>slapd</EM> process handles all incoming requests using a pool of threads. This reduces the amount of system overhead required while providing high performance.</P>
<P><B>Replication</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> can be configured to maintain shadow copies of directory information. This <EM>single-master/multiple-slave</EM> replication scheme is vital in high-volume environments where a single <EM>slapd</EM> installation just doesn't provide the necessary availability or reliability. For extremely demanding environments where a single point of failure is not acceptable, <EM>multi-master</EM> replication is also available. <EM>slapd</EM> includes support for <EM>LDAP Sync</EM>-based replication.</P>
<P><B>Proxy Cache</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> can be configured as a caching LDAP proxy service.</P>
<P><B>Configuration</B>: <EM>slapd</EM> is highly configurable through a single configuration file which allows you to change just about everything you'd ever want to change. Configuration options have reasonable defaults, making your job much easier. Configuration can also be performed dynamically using LDAP itself, which greatly improves manageability.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="A Quick-Start Guide">2. A Quick-Start Guide</A></H1>
<P>The following is a quick start guide to OpenLDAP Software 2.4, including the Standalone <TERM>LDAP</TERM> Daemon, <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<P>It is meant to walk you through the basic steps needed to install and configure <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/">OpenLDAP Software</A>. It should be used in conjunction with the other chapters of this document, manual pages, and other materials provided with the distribution (e.g. the <TT>INSTALL</TT> document) or on the <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A> web site (<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org">http://www.OpenLDAP.org</A>), in particular the OpenLDAP Software <TERM>FAQ</TERM> (<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/faq/?file=2">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/faq/?file=2</A>).</P>
<P>If you intend to run OpenLDAP Software seriously, you should review all of this document before attempting to install the software.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>This quick start guide does not use strong authentication nor any integrity or confidential protection services. These services are described in other chapters of the OpenLDAP Administrator's Guide.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<UL>
</UL><OL>
<LI><B>Get the software</B>
<BR>
You can obtain a copy of the software by following the instructions on the OpenLDAP Software download page (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/download/">http://www.openldap.org/software/download/</A>). It is recommended that new users start with the latest <EM>release</EM>.
<BR>
<LI><B>Unpack the distribution</B>
<BR>
Pick a directory for the source to live under, change directory to there, and unpack the distribution using the following commands:<UL>
<TT>gunzip -c openldap-VERSION.tgz | tar xvfB -</TT></UL>
<BR>
then relocate yourself into the distribution directory:<UL>
<TT>cd openldap-VERSION</TT></UL>
<BR>
You'll have to replace <TT>VERSION</TT> with the version name of the release.
<BR>
<LI><B>Review documentation</B>
<BR>
You should now review the <TT>COPYRIGHT</TT>, <TT>LICENSE</TT>, <TT>README</TT> and <TT>INSTALL</TT> documents provided with the distribution. The <TT>COPYRIGHT</TT> and <TT>LICENSE</TT> provide information on acceptable use, copying, and limitation of warranty of OpenLDAP Software.
<BR>
<BR>
You should also review other chapters of this document. In particular, the <A HREF="#Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software">Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software</A> chapter of this document provides detailed information on prerequisite software and installation procedures.
<BR>
<LI><B>Run <TT>configure</TT></B>
<BR>
You will need to run the provided <TT>configure</TT> script to <EM>configure</EM> the distribution for building on your system. The <TT>configure</TT> script accepts many command line options that enable or disable optional software features. Usually the defaults are okay, but you may want to change them. To get a complete list of options that <TT>configure</TT> accepts, use the <TT>--help</TT> option:<UL>
<TT>./configure --help</TT></UL>
<BR>
However, given that you are using this guide, we'll assume you are brave enough to just let <TT>configure</TT> determine what's best:<UL>
<TT>./configure</TT></UL>
<BR>
Assuming <TT>configure</TT> doesn't dislike your system, you can proceed with building the software. If <TT>configure</TT> did complain, well, you'll likely need to go to the Software FAQ <EM>Installation</EM> section (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/?file=8">http://www.openldap.org/faq/?file=8</A>) and/or actually read the <A HREF="#Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software">Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software</A> chapter of this document.
<BR>
<LI><B>Build the software</B>.
<BR>
The next step is to build the software. This step has two parts, first we construct dependencies and then we compile the software:<UL>
<TT>make depend</TT>
<BR>
<TT>make</TT></UL>
<BR>
Both makes should complete without error.
<BR>
<LI><B>Test the build</B>.
<BR>
To ensure a correct build, you should run the test suite (it only takes a few minutes):<UL>
<TT>make test</TT></UL>
<BR>
Tests which apply to your configuration will run and they should pass. Some tests, such as the replication test, may be skipped.
<BR>
<LI><B>Install the software</B>.
<BR>
You are now ready to install the software; this usually requires <EM>super-user</EM> privileges:<UL>
<TT>su root -c 'make install'</TT></UL>
<BR>
Everything should now be installed under <TT>/usr/local</TT> (or whatever installation prefix was used by <TT>configure</TT>).
<BR>
<LI><B>Edit the configuration file</B>.
<BR>
Use your favorite editor to edit the provided <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) example (usually installed as <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.conf</TT>) to contain a BDB database definition of the form:<UL>
<TT>database bdb</TT>
<BR>
<TT>suffix "dc=<MY-DOMAIN>,dc=<COM>"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=<MY-DOMAIN>,dc=<COM>"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootpw secret</TT>
<BR>
<TT>directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data</TT></UL>
<BR>
Be sure to replace <TT><MY-DOMAIN></TT> and <TT><COM></TT> with the appropriate domain components of your domain name. For example, for <TT>example.com</TT>, use:<UL>
<TT>database bdb</TT>
<BR>
<TT>suffix "dc=example,dc=com"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootpw secret</TT>
<BR>
<TT>directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data</TT></UL>
<BR>
If your domain contains additional components, such as <TT>eng.uni.edu.eu</TT>, use:<UL>
<TT>database bdb</TT>
<BR>
<TT>suffix "dc=eng,dc=uni,dc=edu,dc=eu"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=eng,dc=uni,dc=edu,dc=eu"</TT>
<BR>
<TT>rootpw secret</TT>
<BR>
<TT>directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data</TT></UL>
<BR>
Details regarding configuring <EM>slapd</EM>(8) can be found in the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) manual page and the <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> chapter of this document. Note that the specified directory must exist prior to starting <EM>slapd</EM>(8).
<BR>
<LI><B>Start SLAPD</B>.
<BR>
You are now ready to start the Standalone LDAP Daemon, <EM>slapd</EM>(8), by running the command:<UL>
<TT>su root -c /usr/local/libexec/slapd</TT></UL>
<BR>
To check to see if the server is running and configured correctly, you can run a search against it with <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1). By default, <EM>ldapsearch</EM> is installed as <TT>/usr/local/bin/ldapsearch</TT>:<UL>
<TT>ldapsearch -x -b '' -s base '(objectclass=*)' namingContexts</TT></UL>
<BR>
Note the use of single quotes around command parameters to prevent special characters from being interpreted by the shell. This should return:<UL>
<TT>dn:</TT>
<BR>
<TT>namingContexts: dc=example,dc=com</TT></UL>
<BR>
Details regarding running <EM>slapd</EM>(8) can be found in the <EM>slapd</EM>(8) manual page and the <A HREF="#Running slapd">Running slapd</A> chapter of this document.
<BR>
<LI><B>Add initial entries to your directory</B>.
<BR>
You can use <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1) to add entries to your LDAP directory. <EM>ldapadd</EM> expects input in <TERM>LDIF</TERM> form. We'll do it in two steps:<OL>
<LI>create an LDIF file
<LI>run ldapadd</OL>
<BR>
Use your favorite editor and create an LDIF file that contains:<UL>
<TT>dn: dc=<MY-DOMAIN>,dc=<COM></TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: dcObject</TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: organization</TT>
<BR>
<TT>o: <MY ORGANIZATION></TT>
<BR>
<TT>dc: <MY-DOMAIN></TT>
<BR>
<TT></TT>
<BR>
<TT>dn: cn=Manager,dc=<MY-DOMAIN>,dc=<COM></TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: organizationalRole</TT>
<BR>
<TT>cn: Manager</TT></UL>
<BR>
Be sure to replace <TT><MY-DOMAIN></TT> and <TT><COM></TT> with the appropriate domain components of your domain name. <TT><MY ORGANIZATION></TT> should be replaced with the name of your organization. When you cut and paste, be sure to trim any leading and trailing whitespace from the example.<UL>
<TT>dn: dc=example,dc=com</TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: dcObject</TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: organization</TT>
<BR>
<TT>o: Example Company</TT>
<BR>
<TT>dc: example</TT>
<BR>
<TT></TT>
<BR>
<TT>dn: cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com</TT>
<BR>
<TT>objectclass: organizationalRole</TT>
<BR>
<TT>cn: Manager</TT></UL>
<BR>
Now, you may run <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1) to insert these entries into your directory.<UL>
<TT>ldapadd -x -D "cn=Manager,dc=<MY-DOMAIN>,dc=<COM>" -W -f example.ldif</TT></UL>
<BR>
Be sure to replace <TT><MY-DOMAIN></TT> and <TT><COM></TT> with the appropriate domain components of your domain name. You will be prompted for the "<TT>secret</TT>" specified in <TT>slapd.conf</TT>. For example, for <TT>example.com</TT>, use:<UL>
<TT>ldapadd -x -D "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com" -W -f example.ldif</TT></UL>
<BR>
where <TT>example.ldif</TT> is the file you created above.<UL>
<TT> </TT></UL>
<BR>
Additional information regarding directory creation can be found in the <A HREF="#Database Creation and Maintenance Tools">Database Creation and Maintenance Tools</A> chapter of this document.
<BR>
<LI><B>See if it works</B>.
<BR>
Now we're ready to verify the added entries are in your directory. You can use any LDAP client to do this, but our example uses the <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) tool. Remember to replace <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> with the correct values for your site:<UL>
<TT>ldapsearch -x -b 'dc=example,dc=com' '(objectclass=*)'</TT></UL>
<BR>
This command will search for and retrieve every entry in the database.</OL>
<P>You are now ready to add more entries using <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1) or another LDAP client, experiment with various configuration options, backend arrangements, etc..</P>
<P>Note that by default, the <EM>slapd</EM>(8) database grants <EM>read access to everybody</EM> excepting the <EM>super-user</EM> (as specified by the <TT>rootdn</TT> configuration directive). It is highly recommended that you establish controls to restrict access to authorized users. Access controls are discussed in the <A HREF="#Access Control">Access Control</A> chapter. You are also encouraged to read the <A HREF="#Security Considerations">Security Considerations</A>, <A HREF="#Using SASL">Using SASL</A> and <A HREF="#Using TLS">Using TLS</A> sections.</P>
<P>The following chapters provide more detailed information on making, installing, and running <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="The Big Picture - Configuration Choices">3. The Big Picture - Configuration Choices</A></H1>
<P>This section gives a brief overview of various <TERM>LDAP</TERM> directory configurations, and how your Standalone LDAP Daemon <EM>slapd</EM>(8) fits in with the rest of the world.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Local Directory Service">3.1. Local Directory Service</A></H2>
<P>In this configuration, you run a <EM>slapd</EM>(8) instance which provides directory service for your local domain only. It does not interact with other directory servers in any way. This configuration is shown in Figure 3.1.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="config_local.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 3.1: Local service configuration.</P>
<P>Use this configuration if you are just starting out (it's the one the quick-start guide makes for you) or if you want to provide a local service and are not interested in connecting to the rest of the world. It's easy to upgrade to another configuration later if you want.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Local Directory Service with Referrals">3.2. Local Directory Service with Referrals</A></H2>
<P>In this configuration, you run a <EM>slapd</EM>(8) instance which provides directory service for your local domain and configure it to return referrals to other servers capable of handling requests. You may run this service (or services) yourself or use one provided to you. This configuration is shown in Figure 3.2.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="config_ref.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 3.2: Local service with referrals</P>
<P>Use this configuration if you want to provide local service and participate in the Global Directory, or you want to delegate responsibility for <EM>subordinate</EM> entries to another server.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Replicated Directory Service">3.3. Replicated Directory Service</A></H2>
<P>slapd(8) includes support for <EM>LDAP Sync</EM>-based replication, called <EM>syncrepl</EM>, which may be used to maintain shadow copies of directory information on multiple directory servers. In its most basic configuration, the <EM>master</EM> is a syncrepl provider and one or more <EM>slave</EM> (or <EM>shadow</EM>) are syncrepl consumers. An example master-slave configuration is shown in figure 3.3. Multi-Master configurations are also supported.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="config_repl.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 3.3: Replicated Directory Services</P>
<P>This configuration can be used in conjunction with either of the first two configurations in situations where a single <EM>slapd</EM>(8) instance does not provide the required reliability or availability.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Distributed Local Directory Service">3.4. Distributed Local Directory Service</A></H2>
<P>In this configuration, the local service is partitioned into smaller services, each of which may be replicated, and <EM>glued</EM> together with <EM>superior</EM> and <EM>subordinate</EM> referrals.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software">4. Building and Installing OpenLDAP Software</A></H1>
<P>This chapter details how to build and install the <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A> Software package including <EM>slapd</EM>(8), the Standalone <TERM>LDAP</TERM> Daemon. Building and installing OpenLDAP Software requires several steps: installing prerequisite software, configuring OpenLDAP Software itself, making, and finally installing. The following sections describe this process in detail.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Obtaining and Extracting the Software">4.1. Obtaining and Extracting the Software</A></H2>
<P>You can obtain OpenLDAP Software from the project's download page at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/download/">http://www.openldap.org/software/download/</A> or directly from the project's <TERM>FTP</TERM> service at <A HREF="ftp://ftp.openldap.org/pub/OpenLDAP/">ftp://ftp.openldap.org/pub/OpenLDAP/</A>.</P>
<P>The project makes available two series of packages for <EM>general use</EM>. The project makes <EM>releases</EM> as new features and bug fixes come available. Though the project takes steps to improve stability of these releases, it is common for problems to arise only after <EM>release</EM>. The <EM>stable</EM> release is the latest <EM>release</EM> which has demonstrated stability through general use.</P>
<P>Users of OpenLDAP Software can choose, depending on their desire for the <EM>latest features</EM> versus <EM>demonstrated stability</EM>, the most appropriate series to install.</P>
<P>After downloading OpenLDAP Software, you need to extract the distribution from the compressed archive file and change your working directory to the top directory of the distribution:</P>
<UL>
<TT>gunzip -c openldap-VERSION.tgz | tar xf -</TT>
<BR>
<TT>cd openldap-VERSION</TT></UL>
<P>You'll have to replace <TT>VERSION</TT> with the version name of the release.</P>
<P>You should now review the <TT>COPYRIGHT</TT>, <TT>LICENSE</TT>, <TT>README</TT> and <TT>INSTALL</TT> documents provided with the distribution. The <TT>COPYRIGHT</TT> and <TT>LICENSE</TT> provide information on acceptable use, copying, and limitation of warranty of OpenLDAP Software. The <TT>README</TT> and <TT>INSTALL</TT> documents provide detailed information on prerequisite software and installation procedures.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Prerequisite software">4.2. Prerequisite software</A></H2>
<P>OpenLDAP Software relies upon a number of software packages distributed by third parties. Depending on the features you intend to use, you may have to download and install a number of additional software packages. This section details commonly needed third party software packages you might have to install. However, for an up-to-date prerequisite information, the <TT>README</TT> document should be consulted. Note that some of these third party packages may depend on additional software packages. Install each package per the installation instructions provided with it.</P>
<H3><A NAME="{{TERM[expand]TLS}}">4.2.1. <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM></A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP clients and servers require installation of <A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A>, <A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">GnuTLS</A>, or <A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">MozNSS</A> <TERM>TLS</TERM> libraries to provide <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> services. Though some operating systems may provide these libraries as part of the base system or as an optional software component, OpenSSL, GnuTLS, and Mozilla NSS often require separate installation.</P>
<P>OpenSSL is available from <A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">http://www.openssl.org/</A>. GnuTLS is available from <A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/</A>. Mozilla NSS is available from <A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS</A>.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP Software will not be fully LDAPv3 compliant unless OpenLDAP's <TT>configure</TT> detects a usable TLS library.</P>
<H3><A NAME="{{TERM[expand]SASL}}">4.2.2. <TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM></A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP clients and servers require installation of <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A> libraries to provide <TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM> services. Though some operating systems may provide this library as part of the base system or as an optional software component, Cyrus SASL often requires separate installation.</P>
<P>Cyrus SASL is available from <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html</A>. Cyrus SASL will make use of OpenSSL and Kerberos/GSSAPI libraries if preinstalled.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP Software will not be fully LDAPv3 compliant unless OpenLDAP's configure detects a usable Cyrus SASL installation.</P>
<H3><A NAME="{{TERM[expand]Kerberos}}">4.2.3. <TERM>Kerberos Authentication Service</TERM></A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP clients and servers support <TERM>Kerberos</TERM> authentication services. In particular, OpenLDAP supports the Kerberos V <TERM>GSS-API</TERM> <TERM>SASL</TERM> authentication mechanism known as the <TERM>GSSAPI</TERM> mechanism. This feature requires, in addition to Cyrus SASL libraries, either <A HREF="http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/">Heimdal</A> or <A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">MIT Kerberos</A> V libraries.</P>
<P>Heimdal Kerberos is available from <A HREF="http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/">http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/</A>. MIT Kerberos is available from <A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/</A>.</P>
<P>Use of strong authentication services, such as those provided by Kerberos, is highly recommended.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Database Software">4.2.4. Database Software</A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP's <EM>slapd</EM>(8) <TERM>MDB</TERM> primary database backend uses the <TERM>LMDB</TERM> software included with the OpenLDAP source. There is no need to download any additional software to have <EM>MDB</EM> support.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP's <EM>slapd</EM>(8) <TERM>BDB</TERM> and <TERM>HDB</TERM> deprecated database backends require <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/">Oracle Corporation</A> <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A>. If not available at configure time, you will not be able to build <EM>slapd</EM>(8) with these primary database backends.</P>
<P>Your operating system may provide a supported version of <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A> in the base system or as an optional software component. If not, you'll have to obtain and install it yourself.</P>
<P><A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A> is available from <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/">Oracle Corporation</A>'s Berkeley DB download page <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/software/products/berkeley-db/index.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/software/products/berkeley-db/index.html</A>.</P>
<P>There are several versions available. Generally, the most recent release (with published patches) is recommended. This package is required if you wish to use the deprecated <TERM>BDB</TERM> or <TERM>HDB</TERM> database backends.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Berkeley DB version 6.0.20 and later uses a software license that is incompatible with LDAP technology and should not be used with OpenLDAP.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Please see <A HREF="#Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions">Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions</A> for more information.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Threads">4.2.5. Threads</A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP is designed to take advantage of threads. OpenLDAP supports POSIX <EM>pthreads</EM>, Mach <EM>CThreads</EM>, and a number of other varieties. <TT>configure</TT> will complain if it cannot find a suitable thread subsystem. If this occurs, please consult the <TT>Software|Installation|Platform Hints</TT> section of the OpenLDAP FAQ <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/">http://www.openldap.org/faq/</A>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="TCP Wrappers">4.2.6. TCP Wrappers</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports TCP Wrappers (IP level access control filters) if preinstalled. Use of TCP Wrappers or other IP-level access filters (such as those provided by an IP-level firewall) is recommended for servers containing non-public information.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Running configure">4.3. Running configure</A></H2>
<P>Now you should probably run the <TT>configure</TT> script with the <TT>--help</TT> option. This will give you a list of options that you can change when building OpenLDAP. Many of the features of OpenLDAP can be enabled or disabled using this method.</P>
<PRE>
./configure --help
</PRE>
<P>The <TT>configure</TT> script also looks for certain variables on the command line and in the environment. These include:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 4.1: Variables</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Variable</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>CC</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Specify alternative C Compiler
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>CFLAGS</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Specify additional compiler flags
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>CPPFLAGS</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Specify C Preprocessor flags
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>LDFLAGS</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Specify linker flags
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>LIBS</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Specify additional libraries
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>Now run the configure script with any desired configuration options or variables.</P>
<PRE>
./configure [options] [variable=value ...]
</PRE>
<P>As an example, let's assume that we want to install OpenLDAP with BDB backend and TCP Wrappers support. By default, BDB is enabled and TCP Wrappers is not. So, we just need to specify <TT>--enable-wrappers</TT> to include TCP Wrappers support:</P>
<PRE>
./configure --enable-wrappers
</PRE>
<P>However, this will fail to locate dependent software not installed in system directories. For example, if TCP Wrappers headers and libraries are installed in <TT>/usr/local/include</TT> and <TT>/usr/local/lib</TT> respectively, the <TT>configure</TT> script should typically be called as follows:</P>
<PRE>
./configure --enable-wrappers \
CPPFLAGS="-I/usr/local/include" \
LDFLAGS="-L/usr/local/lib -Wl,-rpath,/usr/local/lib"
</PRE>
<P>The <TT>configure</TT> script will normally auto-detect appropriate settings. If you have problems at this stage, consult any platform specific hints and check your <TT>configure</TT> options, if any.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Building the Software">4.4. Building the Software</A></H2>
<P>Once you have run the <TT>configure</TT> script the last line of output should be:</P>
<PRE>
Please "make depend" to build dependencies
</PRE>
<P>If the last line of output does not match, <TT>configure</TT> has failed, and you will need to review its output to determine what went wrong. You should not proceed until <TT>configure</TT> completes successfully.</P>
<P>To build dependencies, run:</P>
<PRE>
make depend
</PRE>
<P>Now build the software, this step will actually compile OpenLDAP.</P>
<PRE>
make
</PRE>
<P>You should examine the output of this command carefully to make sure everything is built correctly. Note that this command builds the LDAP libraries and associated clients as well as <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<H2><A NAME="Testing the Software">4.5. Testing the Software</A></H2>
<P>Once the software has been properly configured and successfully made, you should run the test suite to verify the build.</P>
<PRE>
make test
</PRE>
<P>Tests which apply to your configuration will run and they should pass. Some tests, such as the replication test, may be skipped if not supported by your configuration.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Installing the Software">4.6. Installing the Software</A></H2>
<P>Once you have successfully tested the software, you are ready to install it. You will need to have write permission to the installation directories you specified when you ran configure. By default OpenLDAP Software is installed in <TT>/usr/local</TT>. If you changed this setting with the <TT>--prefix</TT> configure option, it will be installed in the location you provided.</P>
<P>Typically, the installation requires <EM>super-user</EM> privileges. From the top level OpenLDAP source directory, type:</P>
<PRE>
su root -c 'make install'
</PRE>
<P>and enter the appropriate password when requested.</P>
<P>You should examine the output of this command carefully to make sure everything is installed correctly. You will find the configuration files for <EM>slapd</EM>(8) in <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap</TT> by default. See the chapter <A HREF="#Configuring slapd">Configuring slapd</A> for additional information.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Configuring slapd">5. Configuring slapd</A></H1>
<P>Once the software has been built and installed, you are ready to configure <EM>slapd</EM>(8) for use at your site.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP 2.3 and later have transitioned to using a dynamic runtime configuration engine, <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5). <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5)</P>
<UL>
<LI>is fully LDAP-enabled
<LI>is managed using the standard LDAP operations
<LI>stores its configuration data in an <TERM>LDIF</TERM> database, generally in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.d</TT> directory.
<LI>allows all of slapd's configuration options to be changed on the fly, generally without requiring a server restart for the changes to take effect.</UL>
<P>This chapter describes the general format of the <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) configuration system, followed by a detailed description of commonly used settings.</P>
<P>The older style <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file is still supported, but its use is deprecated and support for it will be withdrawn in a future OpenLDAP release. Configuring <EM>slapd</EM>(8) via <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) is described in the next chapter.</P>
<P>Refer to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) for information on how to have slapd automatically convert from <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) to <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5).</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Although the <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) system stores its configuration as (text-based) LDIF files, you should <EM>never</EM> edit any of the LDIF files directly. Configuration changes should be performed via LDAP operations, e.g. <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1), <EM>ldapdelete</EM>(1), or <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You will need to continue to use the older <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) configuration system if your OpenLDAP installation requires the use of one or more backends or overlays that have not been updated to use the <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) system. As of OpenLDAP 2.4.33, all of the official backends have been updated. There may be additional contributed or experimental overlays that also have not been updated.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration Layout">5.1. Configuration Layout</A></H2>
<P>The slapd configuration is stored as a special LDAP directory with a predefined schema and DIT. There are specific objectClasses used to carry global configuration options, schema definitions, backend and database definitions, and assorted other items. A sample config tree is shown in Figure 5.1.</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="config_dit.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure 5.1: Sample configuration tree.</P>
<P>Other objects may be part of the configuration but were omitted from the illustration for clarity.</P>
<P>The <EM>slapd-config</EM> configuration tree has a very specific structure. The root of the tree is named <TT>cn=config</TT> and contains global configuration settings. Additional settings are contained in separate child entries:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Dynamically loaded modules<UL>
These may only be used if the <TT>--enable-modules</TT> option was used to configure the software.</UL>
<LI>Schema definitions<UL>
The <TT>cn=schema,cn=config</TT> entry contains the system schema (all the schema that is hard-coded in slapd).
<BR>
Child entries of <TT>cn=schema,cn=config</TT> contain user schema as loaded from config files or added at runtime.</UL>
<LI>Backend-specific configuration
<LI>Database-specific configuration<UL>
Overlays are defined in children of the Database entry.
<BR>
Databases and Overlays may also have other miscellaneous children.</UL></UL>
<P>The usual rules for LDIF files apply to the configuration information: Comment lines beginning with a '<TT>#</TT>' character are ignored. If a line begins with a single space, it is considered a continuation of the previous line (even if the previous line is a comment) and the single leading space is removed. Entries are separated by blank lines.</P>
<P>The general layout of the config LDIF is as follows:</P>
<PRE>
# global configuration settings
dn: cn=config
objectClass: olcGlobal
cn: config
<global config settings>
# schema definitions
dn: cn=schema,cn=config
objectClass: olcSchemaConfig
cn: schema
<system schema>
dn: cn={X}core,cn=schema,cn=config
objectClass: olcSchemaConfig
cn: {X}core
<core schema>
# additional user-specified schema
...
# backend definitions
dn: olcBackend=<typeA>,cn=config
objectClass: olcBackendConfig
olcBackend: <typeA>
<backend-specific settings>
# database definitions
dn: olcDatabase={X}<typeA>,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
olcDatabase: {X}<typeA>
<database-specific settings>
# subsequent definitions and settings
...
</PRE>
<P>Some of the entries listed above have a numeric index <TT>"{X}"</TT> in their names. While most configuration settings have an inherent ordering dependency (i.e., one setting must take effect before a subsequent one may be set), LDAP databases are inherently unordered. The numeric index is used to enforce a consistent ordering in the configuration database, so that all ordering dependencies are preserved. In most cases the index does not have to be provided; it will be automatically generated based on the order in which entries are created.</P>
<P>Configuration directives are specified as values of individual attributes. Most of the attributes and objectClasses used in the slapd configuration have a prefix of <TT>"olc"</TT> (OpenLDAP Configuration) in their names. Generally there is a one-to-one correspondence between the attributes and the old-style <TT>slapd.conf</TT> configuration keywords, using the keyword as the attribute name, with the "olc" prefix attached.</P>
<P>A configuration directive may take arguments. If so, the arguments are separated by whitespace. If an argument contains whitespace, the argument should be enclosed in double quotes <TT>"like this"</TT>. In the descriptions that follow, arguments that should be replaced by actual text are shown in brackets <TT><></TT>.</P>
<P>The distribution contains an example configuration file that will be installed in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap</TT> directory. A number of files containing schema definitions (attribute types and object classes) are also provided in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/schema</TT> directory.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration Directives">5.2. Configuration Directives</A></H2>
<P>This section details commonly used configuration directives. For a complete list, see the <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) manual page. This section will treat the configuration directives in a top-down order, starting with the global directives in the <TT>cn=config</TT> entry. Each directive will be described along with its default value (if any) and an example of its use.</P>
<H3><A NAME="cn=config">5.2.1. cn=config</A></H3>
<P>Directives contained in this entry generally apply to the server as a whole. Most of them are system or connection oriented, not database related. This entry must have the <TT>olcGlobal</TT> objectClass.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcIdleTimeout: <integer>">5.2.1.1. olcIdleTimeout: <integer></A></H4>
<P>Specify the number of seconds to wait before forcibly closing an idle client connection. A value of 0, the default, disables this feature.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcLogLevel: <level>">5.2.1.2. olcLogLevel: <level></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the level at which debugging statements and operation statistics should be syslogged (currently logged to the <EM>syslogd</EM>(8) <TT>LOG_LOCAL4</TT> facility). You must have configured OpenLDAP <TT>--enable-debug</TT> (the default) for this to work (except for the two statistics levels, which are always enabled). Log levels may be specified as integers or by keyword. Multiple log levels may be used and the levels are additive. To display what levels correspond to what kind of debugging, invoke slapd with <TT>-d?</TT> or consult the table below. The possible values for <level> are:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 5.1: Debugging Levels</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Level</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Keyword</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
-1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
any
</TD>
<TD>
enable all debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
0
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
</TD>
<TD>
no debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x1 trace)
</TD>
<TD>
trace function calls
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x2 packets)
</TD>
<TD>
debug packet handling
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
4
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4 args)
</TD>
<TD>
heavy trace debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
8
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8 conns)
</TD>
<TD>
connection management
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x10 BER)
</TD>
<TD>
print out packets sent and received
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x20 filter)
</TD>
<TD>
search filter processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
64
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x40 config)
</TD>
<TD>
configuration processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
128
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x80 ACL)
</TD>
<TD>
access control list processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
256
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x100 stats)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log connections/operations/results
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
512
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x200 stats2)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log entries sent
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1024
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x400 shell)
</TD>
<TD>
print communication with shell backends
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2048
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x800 parse)
</TD>
<TD>
print entry parsing debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16384
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4000 sync)
</TD>
<TD>
syncrepl consumer processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32768
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8000 none)
</TD>
<TD>
only messages that get logged whatever log level is set
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The desired log level can be input as a single integer that combines the (ORed) desired levels, both in decimal or in hexadecimal notation, as a list of integers (that are ORed internally), or as a list of the names that are shown between brackets, such that</P>
<PRE>
olcLogLevel 129
olcLogLevel 0x81
olcLogLevel 128 1
olcLogLevel 0x80 0x1
olcLogLevel acl trace
</PRE>
<P>are equivalent.</P>
<P>Examples:</P>
<PRE>
olcLogLevel -1
</PRE>
<P>This will cause lots and lots of debugging information to be logged.</P>
<PRE>
olcLogLevel conns filter
</PRE>
<P>Just log the connection and search filter processing.</P>
<PRE>
olcLogLevel none
</PRE>
<P>Log those messages that are logged regardless of the configured loglevel. This differs from setting the log level to 0, when no logging occurs. At least the <TT>None</TT> level is required to have high priority messages logged.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcLogLevel stats
</PRE>
<P>Basic stats logging is configured by default. However, if no olcLogLevel is defined, no logging occurs (equivalent to a 0 level).</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcReferral <URI>">5.2.1.3. olcReferral <URI></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the referral to pass back when slapd cannot find a local database to handle a request.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcReferral: ldap://root.openldap.org
</PRE>
<P>This will refer non-local queries to the global root LDAP server at the OpenLDAP Project. Smart LDAP clients can re-ask their query at that server, but note that most of these clients are only going to know how to handle simple LDAP URLs that contain a host part and optionally a distinguished name part.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entry">5.2.1.4. Sample Entry</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: cn=config
objectClass: olcGlobal
cn: config
olcIdleTimeout: 30
olcLogLevel: Stats
olcReferral: ldap://root.openldap.org
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="cn=module">5.2.2. cn=module</A></H3>
<P>If support for dynamically loaded modules was enabled when configuring slapd, <TT>cn=module</TT> entries may be used to specify sets of modules to load. Module entries must have the <TT>olcModuleList</TT> objectClass.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcModuleLoad: <filename>">5.2.2.1. olcModuleLoad: <filename></A></H4>
<P>Specify the name of a dynamically loadable module to load. The filename may be an absolute path name or a simple filename. Non-absolute names are searched for in the directories specified by the <TT>olcModulePath</TT> directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcModulePath: <pathspec>">5.2.2.2. olcModulePath: <pathspec></A></H4>
<P>Specify a list of directories to search for loadable modules. Typically the path is colon-separated but this depends on the operating system.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entries">5.2.2.3. Sample Entries</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: cn=module{0},cn=config
objectClass: olcModuleList
cn: module{0}
olcModuleLoad: /usr/local/lib/smbk5pwd.la
dn: cn=module{1},cn=config
objectClass: olcModuleList
cn: module{1}
olcModulePath: /usr/local/lib:/usr/local/lib/slapd
olcModuleLoad: accesslog.la
olcModuleLoad: pcache.la
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="cn=schema">5.2.3. cn=schema</A></H3>
<P>The cn=schema entry holds all of the schema definitions that are hard-coded in slapd. As such, the values in this entry are generated by slapd so no schema values need to be provided in the config file. The entry must still be defined though, to serve as a base for the user-defined schema to add in underneath. Schema entries must have the <TT>olcSchemaConfig</TT> objectClass.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcAttributeTypes: <{{REF:RFC4512}} Attribute Type Description>"> </A>5.2.3.1. olcAttributeTypes: <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Attribute Type Description></H4>
<P>This directive defines an attribute type. Please see the <A HREF="#Schema Specification">Schema Specification</A> chapter for information regarding how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcObjectClasses: <{{REF:RFC4512}} Object Class Description>"> </A>5.2.3.2. olcObjectClasses: <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Object Class Description></H4>
<P>This directive defines an object class. Please see the <A HREF="#Schema Specification">Schema Specification</A> chapter for information regarding how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entries">5.2.3.3. Sample Entries</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: cn=schema,cn=config
objectClass: olcSchemaConfig
cn: schema
dn: cn=test,cn=schema,cn=config
objectClass: olcSchemaConfig
cn: test
olcAttributeTypes: ( 1.1.1
NAME 'testAttr'
EQUALITY integerMatch
SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.27 )
olcAttributeTypes: ( 1.1.2 NAME 'testTwo' EQUALITY caseIgnoreMatch
SUBSTR caseIgnoreSubstringsMatch SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.44 )
olcObjectClasses: ( 1.1.3 NAME 'testObject'
MAY ( testAttr $ testTwo ) AUXILIARY )
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Backend-specific Directives">5.2.4. Backend-specific Directives</A></H3>
<P>Backend directives apply to all database instances of the same type and, depending on the directive, may be overridden by database directives. Backend entries must have the <TT>olcBackendConfig</TT> objectClass.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcBackend: <type>">5.2.4.1. olcBackend: <type></A></H4>
<P>This directive names a backend-specific configuration entry. <TT><type></TT> should be one of the supported backend types listed in Table 5.2.</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 5.2: Database Backends</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Types</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>bdb</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Berkeley DB transactional backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>config</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Slapd configuration backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dnssrv</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
DNS SRV backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>hdb</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Hierarchical variant of bdb backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>ldap</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (Proxy) backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>ldif</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Data Interchange Format backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>meta</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Meta Directory backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>monitor</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Monitor backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>passwd</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Provides read-only access to <EM>passwd</EM>(5)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>perl</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Perl Programmable backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>shell</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Shell (extern program) backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>sql</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
SQL Programmable backend
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcBackend: bdb
</PRE>
<P>There are no other directives defined for this entry. Specific backend types may define additional attributes for their particular use but so far none have ever been defined. As such, these directives usually do not appear in any actual configurations.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entry">5.2.4.2. Sample Entry</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: olcBackend=bdb,cn=config
objectClass: olcBackendConfig
olcBackend: bdb
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Database-specific Directives">5.2.5. Database-specific Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives in this section are supported by every type of database. Database entries must have the <TT>olcDatabaseConfig</TT> objectClass.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcDatabase: [{<index>}]<type>">5.2.5.1. olcDatabase: [{<index>}]<type></A></H4>
<P>This directive names a specific database instance. The numeric {<index>} may be provided to distinguish multiple databases of the same type. Usually the index can be omitted, and slapd will generate it automatically. <TT><type></TT> should be one of the supported backend types listed in Table 5.2 or the <TT>frontend</TT> type.</P>
<P>The <TT>frontend</TT> is a special database that is used to hold database-level options that should be applied to all the other databases. Subsequent database definitions may also override some frontend settings.</P>
<P>The <TT>config</TT> database is also special; both the <TT>config</TT> and the <TT>frontend</TT> databases are always created implicitly even if they are not explicitly configured, and they are created before any other databases.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDatabase: bdb
</PRE>
<P>This marks the beginning of a new <TERM>BDB</TERM> database instance.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcAccess: to <what> [ by <who> [<accesslevel>] [<control>] ]+">5.2.5.2. olcAccess: to <what> [ by <who> [<accesslevel>] [<control>] ]+</A></H4>
<P>This directive grants access (specified by <accesslevel>) to a set of entries and/or attributes (specified by <what>) by one or more requestors (specified by <who>). See the <A HREF="#Access Control">Access Control</A> section of this guide for basic usage.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>If no <TT>olcAccess</TT> directives are specified, the default access control policy, <TT>to * by * read</TT>, allows all users (both authenticated and anonymous) read access.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Access controls defined in the frontend are appended to all other databases' controls.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="olcReadonly { TRUE | FALSE }">5.2.5.3. olcReadonly { TRUE | FALSE }</A></H4>
<P>This directive puts the database into "read-only" mode. Any attempts to modify the database will return an "unwilling to perform" error.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcReadonly: FALSE
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcRootDN: <DN>">5.2.5.4. olcRootDN: <DN></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the DN that is not subject to access control or administrative limit restrictions for operations on this database. The DN need not refer to an entry in this database or even in the directory. The DN may refer to a SASL identity.</P>
<P>Entry-based Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcRootDN: "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>SASL-based Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcRootDN: "uid=root,cn=example.com,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth"
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#SASL Authentication">SASL Authentication</A> section for information on SASL authentication identities.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcRootPW: <password>">5.2.5.5. olcRootPW: <password></A></H4>
<P>This directive can be used to specify a password for the DN for the rootdn (when the rootdn is set to a DN within the database).</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcRootPW: secret
</PRE>
<P>It is also permissible to provide a hash of the password in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2307.txt">RFC2307</A> form. <EM>slappasswd</EM>(8) may be used to generate the password hash.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcRootPW: {SSHA}ZKKuqbEKJfKSXhUbHG3fG8MDn9j1v4QN
</PRE>
<P>The hash was generated using the command <TT>slappasswd -s secret</TT>.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcSizeLimit: <integer>">5.2.5.6. olcSizeLimit: <integer></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the maximum number of entries to return from a search operation.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcSizeLimit: 500
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Limits">Limits</A> section of this guide and slapd-config(5) for more details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcSuffix: <dn suffix>">5.2.5.7. olcSuffix: <dn suffix></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the DN suffix of queries that will be passed to this backend database. Multiple suffix lines can be given, and usually at least one is required for each database definition. (Some backend types, such as <TT>frontend</TT> and <TT>monitor</TT> use a hard-coded suffix which may not be overridden in the configuration.)</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcSuffix: "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>Queries with a DN ending in "dc=example,dc=com" will be passed to this backend.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>When the backend to pass a query to is selected, slapd looks at the suffix value(s) in each database definition in the order in which they were configured. Thus, if one database suffix is a prefix of another, it must appear after it in the configuration.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="olcSyncrepl">5.2.5.8. olcSyncrepl</A></H4>
<PRE>
olcSyncrepl: rid=<replica ID>
provider=ldap[s]://<hostname>[:port]
[type=refreshOnly|refreshAndPersist]
[interval=dd:hh:mm:ss]
[retry=[<retry interval> <# of retries>]+]
searchbase=<base DN>
[filter=<filter str>]
[scope=sub|one|base]
[attrs=<attr list>]
[attrsonly]
[sizelimit=<limit>]
[timelimit=<limit>]
[schemachecking=on|off]
[bindmethod=simple|sasl]
[binddn=<DN>]
[saslmech=<mech>]
[authcid=<identity>]
[authzid=<identity>]
[credentials=<passwd>]
[realm=<realm>]
[secprops=<properties>]
[starttls=yes|critical]
[tls_cert=<file>]
[tls_key=<file>]
[tls_cacert=<file>]
[tls_cacertdir=<path>]
[tls_reqcert=never|allow|try|demand]
[tls_ciphersuite=<ciphers>]
[tls_crlcheck=none|peer|all]
[logbase=<base DN>]
[logfilter=<filter str>]
[syncdata=default|accesslog|changelog]
</PRE>
<P>This directive specifies the current database as a replica of the master content by establishing the current <EM>slapd</EM>(8) as a replication consumer site running a syncrepl replication engine. The master database is located at the replication provider site specified by the <TT>provider</TT> parameter. The replica database is kept up-to-date with the master content using the LDAP Content Synchronization protocol. See <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">RFC4533</A> for more information on the protocol.</P>
<P>The <TT>rid</TT> parameter is used for identification of the current <TT>syncrepl</TT> directive within the replication consumer server, where <TT><replica ID></TT> uniquely identifies the syncrepl specification described by the current <TT>syncrepl</TT> directive. <TT><replica ID></TT> is non-negative and is no more than three decimal digits in length.</P>
<P>The <TT>provider</TT> parameter specifies the replication provider site containing the master content as an LDAP URI. The <TT>provider</TT> parameter specifies a scheme, a host and optionally a port where the provider slapd instance can be found. Either a domain name or IP address may be used for <hostname>. Examples are <TT>ldap://provider.example.com:389</TT> or <TT>ldaps://192.168.1.1:636</TT>. If <port> is not given, the standard LDAP port number (389 or 636) is used. Note that the syncrepl uses a consumer-initiated protocol, and hence its specification is located at the consumer site, whereas the <TT>replica</TT> specification is located at the provider site. <TT>syncrepl</TT> and <TT>replica</TT> directives define two independent replication mechanisms. They do not represent the replication peers of each other.</P>
<P>The content of the syncrepl replica is defined using a search specification as its result set. The consumer slapd will send search requests to the provider slapd according to the search specification. The search specification includes <TT>searchbase</TT>, <TT>scope</TT>, <TT>filter</TT>, <TT>attrs</TT>, <TT>attrsonly</TT>, <TT>sizelimit</TT>, and <TT>timelimit</TT> parameters as in the normal search specification. The <TT>searchbase</TT> parameter has no default value and must always be specified. The <TT>scope</TT> defaults to <TT>sub</TT>, the <TT>filter</TT> defaults to <TT>(objectclass=*)</TT>, <TT>attrs</TT> defaults to <TT>"*,+"</TT> to replicate all user and operational attributes, and <TT>attrsonly</TT> is unset by default. Both <TT>sizelimit</TT> and <TT>timelimit</TT> default to "unlimited", and only positive integers or "unlimited" may be specified.</P>
<P>The <TERM>LDAP Content Synchronization</TERM> protocol has two operation types: <TT>refreshOnly</TT> and <TT>refreshAndPersist</TT>. The operation type is specified by the <TT>type</TT> parameter. In the <TT>refreshOnly</TT> operation, the next synchronization search operation is periodically rescheduled at an interval time after each synchronization operation finishes. The interval is specified by the <TT>interval</TT> parameter. It is set to one day by default. In the <TT>refreshAndPersist</TT> operation, a synchronization search remains persistent in the provider <EM>slapd</EM> instance. Further updates to the master replica will generate <TT>searchResultEntry</TT> to the consumer slapd as the search responses to the persistent synchronization search.</P>
<P>If an error occurs during replication, the consumer will attempt to reconnect according to the retry parameter which is a list of the <retry interval> and <# of retries> pairs. For example, retry="60 10 300 3" lets the consumer retry every 60 seconds for the first 10 times and then retry every 300 seconds for the next three times before stop retrying. + in <# of retries> means indefinite number of retries until success.</P>
<P>The schema checking can be enforced at the LDAP Sync consumer site by turning on the <TT>schemachecking</TT> parameter. If it is turned on, every replicated entry will be checked for its schema as the entry is stored into the replica content. Every entry in the replica should contain those attributes required by the schema definition. If it is turned off, entries will be stored without checking schema conformance. The default is off.</P>
<P>The <TT>binddn</TT> parameter gives the DN to bind as for the syncrepl searches to the provider slapd. It should be a DN which has read access to the replication content in the master database.</P>
<P>The <TT>bindmethod</TT> is <TT>simple</TT> or <TT>sasl</TT>, depending on whether simple password-based authentication or <TERM>SASL</TERM> authentication is to be used when connecting to the provider <EM>slapd</EM> instance.</P>
<P>Simple authentication should not be used unless adequate data integrity and confidentiality protections are in place (e.g. TLS or IPsec). Simple authentication requires specification of <TT>binddn</TT> and <TT>credentials</TT> parameters.</P>
<P>SASL authentication is generally recommended. SASL authentication requires specification of a mechanism using the <TT>saslmech</TT> parameter. Depending on the mechanism, an authentication identity and/or credentials can be specified using <TT>authcid</TT> and <TT>credentials</TT>, respectively. The <TT>authzid</TT> parameter may be used to specify an authorization identity.</P>
<P>The <TT>realm</TT> parameter specifies a realm which a certain mechanisms authenticate the identity within. The <TT>secprops</TT> parameter specifies Cyrus SASL security properties.</P>
<P>The <TT>starttls</TT> parameter specifies use of the StartTLS extended operation to establish a TLS session before authenticating to the provider. If the <TT>critical</TT> argument is supplied, the session will be aborted if the StartTLS request fails. Otherwise the syncrepl session continues without TLS. Note that the main slapd TLS settings are not used by the syncrepl engine; by default the TLS parameters from a <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) configuration file will be used. TLS settings may be specified here, in which case any <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) settings will be completely ignored.</P>
<P>Rather than replicating whole entries, the consumer can query logs of data modifications. This mode of operation is referred to as <EM>delta syncrepl</EM>. In addition to the above parameters, the <TT>logbase</TT> and <TT>logfilter</TT> parameters must be set appropriately for the log that will be used. The <TT>syncdata</TT> parameter must be set to either <TT>"accesslog"</TT> if the log conforms to the <EM>slapo-accesslog</EM>(5) log format, or <TT>"changelog"</TT> if the log conforms to the obsolete <EM>changelog</EM> format. If the <TT>syncdata</TT> parameter is omitted or set to <TT>"default"</TT> then the log parameters are ignored.</P>
<P>The <EM>syncrepl</EM> replication mechanism is supported by the <EM>bdb</EM> and <EM>hdb</EM> backends.</P>
<P>See the <A HREF="#LDAP Sync Replication">LDAP Sync Replication</A> chapter of this guide for more information on how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcTimeLimit: <integer>">5.2.5.9. olcTimeLimit: <integer></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the maximum number of seconds (in real time) slapd will spend answering a search request. If a request is not finished in this time, a result indicating an exceeded timelimit will be returned.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcTimeLimit: 3600
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Limits">Limits</A> section of this guide and slapd-config(5) for more details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcUpdateref: <URL>">5.2.5.10. olcUpdateref: <URL></A></H4>
<P>This directive is only applicable in a slave slapd. It specifies the URL to return to clients which submit update requests upon the replica. If specified multiple times, each <TERM>URL</TERM> is provided.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcUpdateref: ldap://master.example.net
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entries">5.2.5.11. Sample Entries</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: olcDatabase=frontend,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
objectClass: olcFrontendConfig
olcDatabase: frontend
olcReadOnly: FALSE
dn: olcDatabase=config,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
olcDatabase: config
olcRootDN: cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="BDB and HDB Database Directives">5.2.6. BDB and HDB Database Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives in this category apply to both the <TERM>BDB</TERM> and the <TERM>HDB</TERM> database. They are used in an olcDatabase entry in addition to the generic database directives defined above. For a complete reference of BDB/HDB configuration directives, see <EM>slapd-bdb</EM>(5). In addition to the <TT>olcDatabaseConfig</TT> objectClass, BDB and HDB database entries must have the <TT>olcBdbConfig</TT> and <TT>olcHdbConfig</TT> objectClass, respectively.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbDirectory: <directory>">5.2.6.1. olcDbDirectory: <directory></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the directory where the BDB files containing the database and associated indices live.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbDirectory: /usr/local/var/openldap-data
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbCachesize: <integer>">5.2.6.2. olcDbCachesize: <integer></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the size in entries of the in-memory cache maintained by the BDB backend database instance.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbCachesize: 1000
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbCheckpoint: <kbyte> <min>">5.2.6.3. olcDbCheckpoint: <kbyte> <min></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies how often to checkpoint the BDB transaction log. A checkpoint operation flushes the database buffers to disk and writes a checkpoint record in the log. The checkpoint will occur if either <kbyte> data has been written or <min> minutes have passed since the last checkpoint. Both arguments default to zero, in which case they are ignored. When the <min> argument is non-zero, an internal task will run every <min> minutes to perform the checkpoint. See the Berkeley DB reference guide for more details.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbCheckpoint: 1024 10
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbConfig: <DB_CONFIG setting>">5.2.6.4. olcDbConfig: <DB_CONFIG setting></A></H4>
<P>This attribute specifies a configuration directive to be placed in the <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> file of the database directory. At server startup time, if no such file exists yet, the <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> file will be created and the settings in this attribute will be written to it. If the file exists, its contents will be read and displayed in this attribute. The attribute is multi-valued, to accommodate multiple configuration directives. No default is provided, but it is essential to use proper settings here to get the best server performance.</P>
<P>Any changes made to this attribute will be written to the <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> file and will cause the database environment to be reset so the changes can take immediate effect. If the environment cache is large and has not been recently checkpointed, this reset operation may take a long time. It may be advisable to manually perform a single checkpoint using the Berkeley DB <EM>db_checkpoint</EM> utility before using LDAP Modify to change this attribute.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbConfig: set_cachesize 0 10485760 0
olcDbConfig: set_lg_bsize 2097512
olcDbConfig: set_lg_dir /var/tmp/bdb-log
olcDbConfig: set_flags DB_LOG_AUTOREMOVE
</PRE>
<P>In this example, the BDB cache is set to 10MB, the BDB transaction log buffer size is set to 2MB, and the transaction log files are to be stored in the /var/tmp/bdb-log directory. Also a flag is set to tell BDB to delete transaction log files as soon as their contents have been checkpointed and they are no longer needed. Without this setting the transaction log files will continue to accumulate until some other cleanup procedure removes them. See the Berkeley DB documentation for the <TT>db_archive</TT> command for details. For a complete list of Berkeley DB flags please see - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/api_c/env_set_flags.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/api_c/env_set_flags.html</A></P>
<P>Ideally the BDB cache must be at least as large as the working set of the database, the log buffer size should be large enough to accommodate most transactions without overflowing, and the log directory must be on a separate physical disk from the main database files. And both the database directory and the log directory should be separate from disks used for regular system activities such as the root, boot, or swap filesystems. See the FAQ-o-Matic and the Berkeley DB documentation for more details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbNosync: { TRUE | FALSE }">5.2.6.5. olcDbNosync: { TRUE | FALSE }</A></H4>
<P>This option causes on-disk database contents to not be immediately synchronized with in memory changes upon change. Setting this option to <TT>TRUE</TT> may improve performance at the expense of data integrity. This directive has the same effect as using</P>
<PRE>
olcDbConfig: set_flags DB_TXN_NOSYNC
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbIDLcacheSize: <integer>">5.2.6.6. olcDbIDLcacheSize: <integer></A></H4>
<P>Specify the size of the in-memory index cache, in index slots. The default is zero. A larger value will speed up frequent searches of indexed entries. The optimal size will depend on the data and search characteristics of the database, but using a number three times the entry cache size is a good starting point.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbIDLcacheSize: 3000
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbIndex: {<attrlist> | default} [pres,eq,approx,sub,none]">5.2.6.7. olcDbIndex: {<attrlist> | default} [pres,eq,approx,sub,none]</A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the indices to maintain for the given attribute. If only an <TT><attrlist></TT> is given, the default indices are maintained. The index keywords correspond to the common types of matches that may be used in an LDAP search filter.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbIndex: default pres,eq
olcDbIndex: uid
olcDbIndex: cn,sn pres,eq,sub
olcDbIndex: objectClass eq
</PRE>
<P>The first line sets the default set of indices to maintain to present and equality. The second line causes the default (pres,eq) set of indices to be maintained for the <TT>uid</TT> attribute type. The third line causes present, equality, and substring indices to be maintained for <TT>cn</TT> and <TT>sn</TT> attribute types. The fourth line causes an equality index for the <TT>objectClass</TT> attribute type.</P>
<P>There is no index keyword for inequality matches. Generally these matches do not use an index. However, some attributes do support indexing for inequality matches, based on the equality index.</P>
<P>A substring index can be more explicitly specified as <TT>subinitial</TT>, <TT>subany</TT>, or <TT>subfinal</TT>, corresponding to the three possible components of a substring match filter. A subinitial index only indexes substrings that appear at the beginning of an attribute value. A subfinal index only indexes substrings that appear at the end of an attribute value, while subany indexes substrings that occur anywhere in a value.</P>
<P>Note that by default, setting an index for an attribute also affects every subtype of that attribute. E.g., setting an equality index on the <TT>name</TT> attribute causes <TT>cn</TT>, <TT>sn</TT>, and every other attribute that inherits from <TT>name</TT> to be indexed.</P>
<P>By default, no indices are maintained. It is generally advised that minimally an equality index upon objectClass be maintained.</P>
<PRE>
olcDbindex: objectClass eq
</PRE>
<P>Additional indices should be configured corresponding to the most common searches that are used on the database. Presence indexing should not be configured for an attribute unless the attribute occurs very rarely in the database, and presence searches on the attribute occur very frequently during normal use of the directory. Most applications don't use presence searches, so usually presence indexing is not very useful.</P>
<P>If this setting is changed while slapd is running, an internal task will be run to generate the changed index data. All server operations can continue as normal while the indexer does its work. If slapd is stopped before the index task completes, indexing will have to be manually completed using the slapindex tool.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbLinearIndex: { TRUE | FALSE }">5.2.6.8. olcDbLinearIndex: { TRUE | FALSE }</A></H4>
<P>If this setting is <TT>TRUE</TT> slapindex will index one attribute at a time. The default settings is <TT>FALSE</TT> in which case all indexed attributes of an entry are processed at the same time. When enabled, each indexed attribute is processed individually, using multiple passes through the entire database. This option improves slapindex performance when the database size exceeds the BDB cache size. When the BDB cache is large enough, this option is not needed and will decrease performance. Also by default, slapadd performs full indexing and so a separate slapindex run is not needed. With this option, slapadd does no indexing and slapindex must be used.</P>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbMode: { <octal> | <symbolic> }">5.2.6.9. olcDbMode: { <octal> | <symbolic> }</A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file protection mode that newly created database index files should have. This can be in the form <TT>0600</TT> or <TT>-rw-------</TT></P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbMode: 0600
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbSearchStack: <integer>">5.2.6.10. olcDbSearchStack: <integer></A></H4>
<P>Specify the depth of the stack used for search filter evaluation. Search filters are evaluated on a stack to accommodate nested <TT>AND</TT> / <TT>OR</TT> clauses. An individual stack is allocated for each server thread. The depth of the stack determines how complex a filter can be evaluated without requiring any additional memory allocation. Filters that are nested deeper than the search stack depth will cause a separate stack to be allocated for that particular search operation. These separate allocations can have a major negative impact on server performance, but specifying too much stack will also consume a great deal of memory. Each search uses 512K bytes per level on a 32-bit machine, or 1024K bytes per level on a 64-bit machine. The default stack depth is 16, thus 8MB or 16MB per thread is used on 32 and 64 bit machines, respectively. Also the 512KB size of a single stack slot is set by a compile-time constant which may be changed if needed; the code must be recompiled for the change to take effect.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbSearchStack: 16
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="olcDbShmKey: <integer>">5.2.6.11. olcDbShmKey: <integer></A></H4>
<P>Specify a key for a shared memory BDB environment. By default the BDB environment uses memory mapped files. If a non-zero value is specified, it will be used as the key to identify a shared memory region that will house the environment.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
olcDbShmKey: 42
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="Sample Entry">5.2.6.12. Sample Entry</A></H4>
<PRE>
dn: olcDatabase=hdb,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
objectClass: olcHdbConfig
olcDatabase: hdb
olcSuffix: "dc=example,dc=com"
olcDbDirectory: /usr/local/var/openldap-data
olcDbCacheSize: 1000
olcDbCheckpoint: 1024 10
olcDbConfig: set_cachesize 0 10485760 0
olcDbConfig: set_lg_bsize 2097152
olcDbConfig: set_lg_dir /var/tmp/bdb-log
olcDbConfig: set_flags DB_LOG_AUTOREMOVE
olcDbIDLcacheSize: 3000
olcDbIndex: objectClass eq
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration Example">5.3. Configuration Example</A></H2>
<P>The following is an example configuration, interspersed with explanatory text. It defines two databases to handle different parts of the <TERM>X.500</TERM> tree; both are <TERM>BDB</TERM> database instances. The line numbers shown are provided for reference only and are not included in the actual file. First, the global configuration section:</P>
<PRE>
1. # example config file - global configuration entry
2. dn: cn=config
3. objectClass: olcGlobal
4. cn: config
5. olcReferral: ldap://root.openldap.org
6.
</PRE>
<P>Line 1 is a comment. Lines 2-4 identify this as the global configuration entry. The <TT>olcReferral:</TT> directive on line 5 means that queries not local to one of the databases defined below will be referred to the LDAP server running on the standard port (389) at the host <TT>root.openldap.org</TT>. Line 6 is a blank line, indicating the end of this entry.</P>
<PRE>
7. # internal schema
8. dn: cn=schema,cn=config
9. objectClass: olcSchemaConfig
10. cn: schema
11.
</PRE>
<P>Line 7 is a comment. Lines 8-10 identify this as the root of the schema subtree. The actual schema definitions in this entry are hardcoded into slapd so no additional attributes are specified here. Line 11 is a blank line, indicating the end of this entry.</P>
<PRE>
12. # include the core schema
13. include: file:///usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.ldif
14.
</PRE>
<P>Line 12 is a comment. Line 13 is an LDIF include directive which accesses the <EM>core</EM> schema definitions in LDIF format. Line 14 is a blank line.</P>
<P>Next comes the database definitions. The first database is the special <TT>frontend</TT> database whose settings are applied globally to all the other databases.</P>
<PRE>
15. # global database parameters
16. dn: olcDatabase=frontend,cn=config
17. objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
18. olcDatabase: frontend
19. olcAccess: to * by * read
20.
</PRE>
<P>Line 15 is a comment. Lines 16-18 identify this entry as the global database entry. Line 19 is a global access control. It applies to all entries (after any applicable database-specific access controls). Line 20 is a blank line.</P>
<P>The next entry defines the config backend.</P>
<PRE>
21. # set a rootpw for the config database so we can bind.
22. # deny access to everyone else.
23. dn: olcDatabase=config,cn=config
24. objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
25. olcDatabase: config
26. olcRootPW: {SSHA}XKYnrjvGT3wZFQrDD5040US592LxsdLy
27. olcAccess: to * by * none
28.
</PRE>
<P>Lines 21-22 are comments. Lines 23-25 identify this entry as the config database entry. Line 26 defines the <EM>super-user</EM> password for this database. (The DN defaults to <EM>"cn=config"</EM>.) Line 27 denies all access to this database, so only the super-user will be able to access it. (This is already the default access on the config database. It is just listed here for illustration, and to reiterate that unless a means to authenticate as the super-user is explicitly configured, the config database will be inaccessible.)</P>
<P>Line 28 is a blank line.</P>
<P>The next entry defines a BDB backend that will handle queries for things in the "dc=example,dc=com" portion of the tree. Indices are to be maintained for several attributes, and the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute is to be protected from unauthorized access.</P>
<PRE>
29. # BDB definition for example.com
30. dn: olcDatabase=bdb,cn=config
31. objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
32. objectClass: olcBdbConfig
33. olcDatabase: bdb
34. olcSuffix: dc=example,dc=com
35. olcDbDirectory: /usr/local/var/openldap-data
36. olcRootDN: cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com
37. olcRootPW: secret
38. olcDbIndex: uid pres,eq
39. olcDbIndex: cn,sn pres,eq,approx,sub
40. olcDbIndex: objectClass eq
41. olcAccess: to attrs=userPassword
42. by self write
43. by anonymous auth
44. by dn.base="cn=Admin,dc=example,dc=com" write
45. by * none
46. olcAccess: to *
47. by self write
48. by dn.base="cn=Admin,dc=example,dc=com" write
49. by * read
50.
</PRE>
<P>Line 29 is a comment. Lines 30-33 identify this entry as a BDB database configuration entry. Line 34 specifies the DN suffix for queries to pass to this database. Line 35 specifies the directory in which the database files will live.</P>
<P>Lines 36 and 37 identify the database <EM>super-user</EM> entry and associated password. This entry is not subject to access control or size or time limit restrictions.</P>
<P>Lines 38 through 40 indicate the indices to maintain for various attributes.</P>
<P>Lines 41 through 49 specify access control for entries in this database. For all applicable entries, the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute is writable by the entry itself and by the "admin" entry. It may be used for authentication/authorization purposes, but is otherwise not readable. All other attributes are writable by the entry and the "admin" entry, but may be read by all users (authenticated or not).</P>
<P>Line 50 is a blank line, indicating the end of this entry.</P>
<P>The next entry defines another BDB database. This one handles queries involving the <TT>dc=example,dc=net</TT> subtree but is managed by the same entity as the first database. Note that without line 60, the read access would be allowed due to the global access rule at line 19.</P>
<PRE>
51. # BDB definition for example.net
52. dn: olcDatabase=bdb,cn=config
53. objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
54. objectClass: olcBdbConfig
55. olcDatabase: bdb
56. olcSuffix: "dc=example,dc=net"
57. olcDbDirectory: /usr/local/var/openldap-data-net
58. olcRootDN: "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
59. olcDbIndex: objectClass eq
60. olcAccess: to * by users read
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="Converting old style {{slapd.conf}}(5) file to {{cn=config}} format">5.4. Converting old style <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file to <EM>cn=config</EM> format</A></H2>
<P>Before converting to the <EM>cn=config</EM> format you should make sure that the config backend is properly configured in your existing config file. While the config backend is always present inside slapd, by default it is only accessible by its rootDN, and there are no default credentials assigned so unless you explicitly configure a means to authenticate to it, it will be unusable.</P>
<P>If you do not already have a <TT>database config</TT> section, add something like this to the end of <TT>slapd.conf</TT></P>
<PRE>
database config
rootpw VerySecret
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Since the config backend can be used to load arbitrary code into the slapd process, it is extremely important to carefully guard whatever credentials are used to access it. Since simple passwords are vulnerable to password guessing attacks, it is usually better to omit the rootpw and only use SASL authentication for the config rootDN.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>An existing <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file can be converted to the new format using <EM>slaptest</EM>(8) or any of the slap tools:</P>
<PRE>
slaptest -f /usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.conf -F /usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.d
</PRE>
<P>Test that you can access entries under <TT>cn=config</TT> using the default <EM>rootdn</EM> and the <EM>rootpw</EM> configured above:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -D cn=config -w VerySecret -b cn=config
</PRE>
<P>You can then discard the old <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file. Make sure to launch <EM>slapd</EM>(8) with the <EM>-F</EM> option to specify the configuration directory if you are not using the default directory path.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>When converting from the slapd.conf format to slapd.d format, any included files will also be integrated into the resulting configuration database.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="The slapd Configuration File">6. The slapd Configuration File</A></H1>
<P>This chapter describes configuring <EM>slapd</EM>(8) via the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) configuration file. <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) has been deprecated and should only be used if your site requires one of the backends that hasn't yet been updated to work with the newer <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) system. Configuring <EM>slapd</EM>(8) via <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) is described in the previous chapter.</P>
<P>The <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file is normally installed in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap</TT> directory. An alternate configuration file location can be specified via a command-line option to <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration File Format">6.1. Configuration File Format</A></H2>
<P>The <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file consists of three types of configuration information: global, backend specific, and database specific. Global information is specified first, followed by information associated with a particular backend type, which is then followed by information associated with a particular database instance. Global directives can be overridden in backend and/or database directives, and backend directives can be overridden by database directives.</P>
<P>Blank lines and comment lines beginning with a '<TT>#</TT>' character are ignored. If a line begins with whitespace, it is considered a continuation of the previous line (even if the previous line is a comment).</P>
<P>The general format of slapd.conf is as follows:</P>
<PRE>
# global configuration directives
<global config directives>
# backend definition
backend <typeA>
<backend-specific directives>
# first database definition & config directives
database <typeA>
<database-specific directives>
# second database definition & config directives
database <typeB>
<database-specific directives>
# second database definition & config directives
database <typeA>
<database-specific directives>
# subsequent backend & database definitions & config directives
...
</PRE>
<P>A configuration directive may take arguments. If so, they are separated by whitespace. If an argument contains whitespace, the argument should be enclosed in double quotes <TT>"like this"</TT>. If an argument contains a double quote or a backslash character `<TT>\</TT>', the character should be preceded by a backslash character `<TT>\</TT>'.</P>
<P>The distribution contains an example configuration file that will be installed in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap</TT> directory. A number of files containing schema definitions (attribute types and object classes) are also provided in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/schema</TT> directory.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration File Directives">6.2. Configuration File Directives</A></H2>
<P>This section details commonly used configuration directives. For a complete list, see the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) manual page. This section separates the configuration file directives into global, backend-specific and data-specific categories, describing each directive and its default value (if any), and giving an example of its use.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Global Directives">6.2.1. Global Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives described in this section apply to all backends and databases unless specifically overridden in a backend or database definition. Arguments that should be replaced by actual text are shown in brackets <TT><></TT>.</P>
<H4><A NAME="access to <what> [ by <who> [<accesslevel>] [<control>] ]+">6.2.1.1. access to <what> [ by <who> [<accesslevel>] [<control>] ]+</A></H4>
<P>This directive grants access (specified by <accesslevel>) to a set of entries and/or attributes (specified by <what>) by one or more requestors (specified by <who>). See the <A HREF="#Access Control">Access Control</A> section of this guide for basic usage.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>If no <TT>access</TT> directives are specified, the default access control policy, <TT>access to * by * read</TT>, allows all both authenticated and anonymous users read access.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="attributetype <{{REF:RFC4512}} Attribute Type Description>"> </A>6.2.1.2. attributetype <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Attribute Type Description></H4>
<P>This directive defines an attribute type. Please see the <A HREF="#Schema Specification">Schema Specification</A> chapter for information regarding how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="idletimeout <integer>">6.2.1.3. idletimeout <integer></A></H4>
<P>Specify the number of seconds to wait before forcibly closing an idle client connection. An idletimeout of 0, the default, disables this feature.</P>
<H4><A NAME="include <filename>">6.2.1.4. include <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies that slapd should read additional configuration information from the given file before continuing with the next line of the current file. The included file should follow the normal slapd config file format. The file is commonly used to include files containing schema specifications.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You should be careful when using this directive - there is no small limit on the number of nested include directives, and no loop detection is done.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="loglevel <level>">6.2.1.5. loglevel <level></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the level at which debugging statements and operation statistics should be syslogged (currently logged to the <EM>syslogd</EM>(8) <TT>LOG_LOCAL4</TT> facility). You must have configured OpenLDAP <TT>--enable-debug</TT> (the default) for this to work (except for the two statistics levels, which are always enabled). Log levels may be specified as integers or by keyword. Multiple log levels may be used and the levels are additive. To display what numbers correspond to what kind of debugging, invoke slapd with <TT>-d?</TT> or consult the table below. The possible values for <integer> are:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 6.1: Debugging Levels</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Level</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Keyword</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
-1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
any
</TD>
<TD>
enable all debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
0
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
</TD>
<TD>
no debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x1 trace)
</TD>
<TD>
trace function calls
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x2 packets)
</TD>
<TD>
debug packet handling
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
4
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4 args)
</TD>
<TD>
heavy trace debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
8
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8 conns)
</TD>
<TD>
connection management
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x10 BER)
</TD>
<TD>
print out packets sent and received
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x20 filter)
</TD>
<TD>
search filter processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
64
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x40 config)
</TD>
<TD>
configuration processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
128
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x80 ACL)
</TD>
<TD>
access control list processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
256
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x100 stats)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log connections/operations/results
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
512
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x200 stats2)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log entries sent
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1024
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x400 shell)
</TD>
<TD>
print communication with shell backends
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2048
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x800 parse)
</TD>
<TD>
print entry parsing debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16384
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4000 sync)
</TD>
<TD>
syncrepl consumer processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32768
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8000 none)
</TD>
<TD>
only messages that get logged whatever log level is set
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The desired log level can be input as a single integer that combines the (ORed) desired levels, both in decimal or in hexadecimal notation, as a list of integers (that are ORed internally), or as a list of the names that are shown between brackets, such that</P>
<PRE>
loglevel 129
loglevel 0x81
loglevel 128 1
loglevel 0x80 0x1
loglevel acl trace
</PRE>
<P>are equivalent.</P>
<P>Examples:</P>
<PRE>
loglevel -1
</PRE>
<P>This will cause lots and lots of debugging information to be logged.</P>
<PRE>
loglevel conns filter
</PRE>
<P>Just log the connection and search filter processing.</P>
<PRE>
loglevel none
</PRE>
<P>Log those messages that are logged regardless of the configured loglevel. This differs from setting the log level to 0, when no logging occurs. At least the <TT>None</TT> level is required to have high priority messages logged.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
loglevel stats
</PRE>
<P>Basic stats logging is configured by default. However, if no loglevel is defined, no logging occurs (equivalent to a 0 level).</P>
<H4><A NAME="objectclass <{{REF:RFC4512}} Object Class Description>"> </A>6.2.1.6. objectclass <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Object Class Description></H4>
<P>This directive defines an object class. Please see the <A HREF="#Schema Specification">Schema Specification</A> chapter for information regarding how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="referral <URI>">6.2.1.7. referral <URI></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the referral to pass back when slapd cannot find a local database to handle a request.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
referral ldap://root.openldap.org
</PRE>
<P>This will refer non-local queries to the global root LDAP server at the OpenLDAP Project. Smart LDAP clients can re-ask their query at that server, but note that most of these clients are only going to know how to handle simple LDAP URLs that contain a host part and optionally a distinguished name part.</P>
<H4><A NAME="sizelimit <integer>">6.2.1.8. sizelimit <integer></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the maximum number of entries to return from a search operation.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit 500
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Limits">Limits</A> section of this guide and slapd.conf(5) for more details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="timelimit <integer>">6.2.1.9. timelimit <integer></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the maximum number of seconds (in real time) slapd will spend answering a search request. If a request is not finished in this time, a result indicating an exceeded timelimit will be returned.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
timelimit 3600
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Limits">Limits</A> section of this guide and slapd.conf(5) for more details.</P>
<H3><A NAME="General Backend Directives">6.2.2. General Backend Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives in this section apply only to the backend in which they are defined. They are supported by every type of backend. Backend directives apply to all databases instances of the same type and, depending on the directive, may be overridden by database directives.</P>
<H4><A NAME="backend <type>">6.2.2.1. backend <type></A></H4>
<P>This directive marks the beginning of a backend declaration. <TT><type></TT> should be one of the supported backend types listed in Table 6.2.</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 6.2: Database Backends</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Types</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>bdb</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Berkeley DB transactional backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dnssrv</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
DNS SRV backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>hdb</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Hierarchical variant of bdb backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>ldap</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (Proxy) backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>meta</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Meta Directory backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>monitor</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Monitor backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>passwd</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Provides read-only access to <EM>passwd</EM>(5)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>perl</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Perl Programmable backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>shell</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Shell (extern program) backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>sql</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
SQL Programmable backend
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
backend bdb
</PRE>
<P>This marks the beginning of a new <TERM>BDB</TERM> backend definition.</P>
<H3><A NAME="General Database Directives">6.2.3. General Database Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives in this section apply only to the database in which they are defined. They are supported by every type of database.</P>
<H4><A NAME="database <type>">6.2.3.1. database <type></A></H4>
<P>This directive marks the beginning of a database instance declaration. <TT><type></TT> should be one of the supported backend types listed in Table 6.2.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
database bdb
</PRE>
<P>This marks the beginning of a new <TERM>BDB</TERM> database instance declaration.</P>
<H4><A NAME="limits <who> <limit> [<limit> [...]]">6.2.3.2. limits <who> <limit> [<limit> [...]]</A></H4>
<P>Specify time and size limits based on who initiated an operation.</P>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Limits">Limits</A> section of this guide and slapd.conf(5) for more details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="readonly { on | off }">6.2.3.3. readonly { on | off }</A></H4>
<P>This directive puts the database into "read-only" mode. Any attempts to modify the database will return an "unwilling to perform" error.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
readonly off
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="rootdn <DN>">6.2.3.4. rootdn <DN></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the DN that is not subject to access control or administrative limit restrictions for operations on this database. The DN need not refer to an entry in this database or even in the directory. The DN may refer to a SASL identity.</P>
<P>Entry-based Example:</P>
<PRE>
rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>SASL-based Example:</P>
<PRE>
rootdn "uid=root,cn=example.com,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth"
</PRE>
<P>See the <A HREF="#SASL Authentication">SASL Authentication</A> section for information on SASL authentication identities.</P>
<H4><A NAME="rootpw <password>">6.2.3.5. rootpw <password></A></H4>
<P>This directive can be used to specifies a password for the DN for the rootdn (when the rootdn is set to a DN within the database).</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
rootpw secret
</PRE>
<P>It is also permissible to provide hash of the password in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2307.txt">RFC2307</A> form. <EM>slappasswd</EM>(8) may be used to generate the password hash.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
rootpw {SSHA}ZKKuqbEKJfKSXhUbHG3fG8MDn9j1v4QN
</PRE>
<P>The hash was generated using the command <TT>slappasswd -s secret</TT>.</P>
<H4><A NAME="suffix <dn suffix>">6.2.3.6. suffix <dn suffix></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the DN suffix of queries that will be passed to this backend database. Multiple suffix lines can be given, and at least one is required for each database definition.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>Queries with a DN ending in "dc=example,dc=com" will be passed to this backend.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>When the backend to pass a query to is selected, slapd looks at the suffix line(s) in each database definition in the order they appear in the file. Thus, if one database suffix is a prefix of another, it must appear after it in the config file.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="syncrepl">6.2.3.7. syncrepl</A></H4>
<PRE>
syncrepl rid=<replica ID>
provider=ldap[s]://<hostname>[:port]
[type=refreshOnly|refreshAndPersist]
[interval=dd:hh:mm:ss]
[retry=[<retry interval> <# of retries>]+]
searchbase=<base DN>
[filter=<filter str>]
[scope=sub|one|base]
[attrs=<attr list>]
[attrsonly]
[sizelimit=<limit>]
[timelimit=<limit>]
[schemachecking=on|off]
[bindmethod=simple|sasl]
[binddn=<DN>]
[saslmech=<mech>]
[authcid=<identity>]
[authzid=<identity>]
[credentials=<passwd>]
[realm=<realm>]
[secprops=<properties>]
[starttls=yes|critical]
[tls_cert=<file>]
[tls_key=<file>]
[tls_cacert=<file>]
[tls_cacertdir=<path>]
[tls_reqcert=never|allow|try|demand]
[tls_ciphersuite=<ciphers>]
[tls_crlcheck=none|peer|all]
[logbase=<base DN>]
[logfilter=<filter str>]
[syncdata=default|accesslog|changelog]
</PRE>
<P>This directive specifies the current database as a replica of the master content by establishing the current <EM>slapd</EM>(8) as a replication consumer site running a syncrepl replication engine. The master database is located at the replication provider site specified by the <TT>provider</TT> parameter. The replica database is kept up-to-date with the master content using the LDAP Content Synchronization protocol. See <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">RFC4533</A> for more information on the protocol.</P>
<P>The <TT>rid</TT> parameter is used for identification of the current <TT>syncrepl</TT> directive within the replication consumer server, where <TT><replica ID></TT> uniquely identifies the syncrepl specification described by the current <TT>syncrepl</TT> directive. <TT><replica ID></TT> is non-negative and is no more than three decimal digits in length.</P>
<P>The <TT>provider</TT> parameter specifies the replication provider site containing the master content as an LDAP URI. The <TT>provider</TT> parameter specifies a scheme, a host and optionally a port where the provider slapd instance can be found. Either a domain name or IP address may be used for <hostname>. Examples are <TT>ldap://provider.example.com:389</TT> or <TT>ldaps://192.168.1.1:636</TT>. If <port> is not given, the standard LDAP port number (389 or 636) is used. Note that the syncrepl uses a consumer-initiated protocol, and hence its specification is located at the consumer site, whereas the <TT>replica</TT> specification is located at the provider site. <TT>syncrepl</TT> and <TT>replica</TT> directives define two independent replication mechanisms. They do not represent the replication peers of each other.</P>
<P>The content of the syncrepl replica is defined using a search specification as its result set. The consumer slapd will send search requests to the provider slapd according to the search specification. The search specification includes <TT>searchbase</TT>, <TT>scope</TT>, <TT>filter</TT>, <TT>attrs</TT>, <TT>attrsonly</TT>, <TT>sizelimit</TT>, and <TT>timelimit</TT> parameters as in the normal search specification. The <TT>searchbase</TT> parameter has no default value and must always be specified. The <TT>scope</TT> defaults to <TT>sub</TT>, the <TT>filter</TT> defaults to <TT>(objectclass=*)</TT>, <TT>attrs</TT> defaults to <TT>"*,+"</TT> to replicate all user and operational attributes, and <TT>attrsonly</TT> is unset by default. Both <TT>sizelimit</TT> and <TT>timelimit</TT> default to "unlimited", and only positive integers or "unlimited" may be specified.</P>
<P>The <TERM>LDAP Content Synchronization</TERM> protocol has two operation types: <TT>refreshOnly</TT> and <TT>refreshAndPersist</TT>. The operation type is specified by the <TT>type</TT> parameter. In the <TT>refreshOnly</TT> operation, the next synchronization search operation is periodically rescheduled at an interval time after each synchronization operation finishes. The interval is specified by the <TT>interval</TT> parameter. It is set to one day by default. In the <TT>refreshAndPersist</TT> operation, a synchronization search remains persistent in the provider <EM>slapd</EM> instance. Further updates to the master replica will generate <TT>searchResultEntry</TT> to the consumer slapd as the search responses to the persistent synchronization search.</P>
<P>If an error occurs during replication, the consumer will attempt to reconnect according to the retry parameter which is a list of the <retry interval> and <# of retries> pairs. For example, retry="60 10 300 3" lets the consumer retry every 60 seconds for the first 10 times and then retry every 300 seconds for the next three times before stop retrying. + in <# of retries> means indefinite number of retries until success.</P>
<P>The schema checking can be enforced at the LDAP Sync consumer site by turning on the <TT>schemachecking</TT> parameter. If it is turned on, every replicated entry will be checked for its schema as the entry is stored into the replica content. Every entry in the replica should contain those attributes required by the schema definition. If it is turned off, entries will be stored without checking schema conformance. The default is off.</P>
<P>The <TT>binddn</TT> parameter gives the DN to bind as for the syncrepl searches to the provider slapd. It should be a DN which has read access to the replication content in the master database.</P>
<P>The <TT>bindmethod</TT> is <TT>simple</TT> or <TT>sasl</TT>, depending on whether simple password-based authentication or <TERM>SASL</TERM> authentication is to be used when connecting to the provider <EM>slapd</EM> instance.</P>
<P>Simple authentication should not be used unless adequate data integrity and confidentiality protections are in place (e.g. TLS or IPsec). Simple authentication requires specification of <TT>binddn</TT> and <TT>credentials</TT> parameters.</P>
<P>SASL authentication is generally recommended. SASL authentication requires specification of a mechanism using the <TT>saslmech</TT> parameter. Depending on the mechanism, an authentication identity and/or credentials can be specified using <TT>authcid</TT> and <TT>credentials</TT>, respectively. The <TT>authzid</TT> parameter may be used to specify an authorization identity.</P>
<P>The <TT>realm</TT> parameter specifies a realm which a certain mechanisms authenticate the identity within. The <TT>secprops</TT> parameter specifies Cyrus SASL security properties.</P>
<P>The <TT>starttls</TT> parameter specifies use of the StartTLS extended operation to establish a TLS session before authenticating to the provider. If the <TT>critical</TT> argument is supplied, the session will be aborted if the StartTLS request fails. Otherwise the syncrepl session continues without TLS. Note that the main slapd TLS settings are not used by the syncrepl engine; by default the TLS parameters from a <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) configuration file will be used. TLS settings may be specified here, in which case any <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) settings will be completely ignored.</P>
<P>Rather than replicating whole entries, the consumer can query logs of data modifications. This mode of operation is referred to as <EM>delta syncrepl</EM>. In addition to the above parameters, the <TT>logbase</TT> and <TT>logfilter</TT> parameters must be set appropriately for the log that will be used. The <TT>syncdata</TT> parameter must be set to either <TT>"accesslog"</TT> if the log conforms to the <EM>slapo-accesslog</EM>(5) log format, or <TT>"changelog"</TT> if the log conforms to the obsolete <EM>changelog</EM> format. If the <TT>syncdata</TT> parameter is omitted or set to <TT>"default"</TT> then the log parameters are ignored.</P>
<P>The <EM>syncrepl</EM> replication mechanism is supported by the <EM>bdb</EM> and <EM>hdb</EM> backends.</P>
<P>See the <A HREF="#LDAP Sync Replication">LDAP Sync Replication</A> chapter of this guide for more information on how to use this directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="updateref <URL>">6.2.3.8. updateref <URL></A></H4>
<P>This directive is only applicable in a <EM>slave</EM> (or <EM>shadow</EM>) <EM>slapd</EM>(8) instance. It specifies the URL to return to clients which submit update requests upon the replica. If specified multiple times, each <TERM>URL</TERM> is provided.</P>
<P>Example:</P>
<PRE>
updateref ldap://master.example.net
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="BDB and HDB Database Directives">6.2.4. BDB and HDB Database Directives</A></H3>
<P>Directives in this category only apply to both the <TERM>BDB</TERM> and the <TERM>HDB</TERM> database. That is, they must follow a "database bdb" or "database hdb" line and come before any subsequent "backend" or "database" line. For a complete reference of BDB/HDB configuration directives, see <EM>slapd-bdb</EM>(5).</P>
<H4><A NAME="directory <directory>">6.2.4.1. directory <directory></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the directory where the BDB files containing the database and associated indices live.</P>
<P>Default:</P>
<PRE>
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="Configuration File Example">6.3. Configuration File Example</A></H2>
<P>The following is an example configuration file, interspersed with explanatory text. It defines two databases to handle different parts of the <TERM>X.500</TERM> tree; both are <TERM>BDB</TERM> database instances. The line numbers shown are provided for reference only and are not included in the actual file. First, the global configuration section:</P>
<PRE>
1. # example config file - global configuration section
2. include /usr/local/etc/schema/core.schema
3. referral ldap://root.openldap.org
4. access to * by * read
</PRE>
<P>Line 1 is a comment. Line 2 includes another config file which contains <EM>core</EM> schema definitions. The <TT>referral</TT> directive on line 3 means that queries not local to one of the databases defined below will be referred to the LDAP server running on the standard port (389) at the host <TT>root.openldap.org</TT>.</P>
<P>Line 4 is a global access control. It applies to all entries (after any applicable database-specific access controls).</P>
<P>The next section of the configuration file defines a BDB backend that will handle queries for things in the "dc=example,dc=com" portion of the tree. The database is to be replicated to two slave slapds, one on truelies, the other on judgmentday. Indices are to be maintained for several attributes, and the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute is to be protected from unauthorized access.</P>
<PRE>
5. # BDB definition for the example.com
6. database bdb
7. suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
8. directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
9. rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
10. rootpw secret
11. # indexed attribute definitions
12. index uid pres,eq
13. index cn,sn pres,eq,approx,sub
14. index objectClass eq
15. # database access control definitions
16. access to attrs=userPassword
17. by self write
18. by anonymous auth
19. by dn.base="cn=Admin,dc=example,dc=com" write
20. by * none
21. access to *
22. by self write
23. by dn.base="cn=Admin,dc=example,dc=com" write
24. by * read
</PRE>
<P>Line 5 is a comment. The start of the database definition is marked by the database keyword on line 6. Line 7 specifies the DN suffix for queries to pass to this database. Line 8 specifies the directory in which the database files will live.</P>
<P>Lines 9 and 10 identify the database <EM>super-user</EM> entry and associated password. This entry is not subject to access control or size or time limit restrictions.</P>
<P>Lines 12 through 14 indicate the indices to maintain for various attributes.</P>
<P>Lines 16 through 24 specify access control for entries in this database. For all applicable entries, the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute is writable by the entry itself and by the "admin" entry. It may be used for authentication/authorization purposes, but is otherwise not readable. All other attributes are writable by the entry and the "admin" entry, but may be read by all users (authenticated or not).</P>
<P>The next section of the example configuration file defines another BDB database. This one handles queries involving the <TT>dc=example,dc=net</TT> subtree but is managed by the same entity as the first database. Note that without line 39, the read access would be allowed due to the global access rule at line 4.</P>
<PRE>
33. # BDB definition for example.net
34. database bdb
35. suffix "dc=example,dc=net"
36. directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data-net
37. rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
38. index objectClass eq
39. access to * by users read
</PRE>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Running slapd">7. Running slapd</A></H1>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) is designed to be run as a standalone service. This allows the server to take advantage of caching, manage concurrency issues with underlying databases, and conserve system resources. Running from <EM>inetd</EM>(8) is <EM>NOT</EM> an option.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Command-Line Options">7.1. Command-Line Options</A></H2>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports a number of command-line options as detailed in the manual page. This section details a few commonly used options.</P>
<PRE>
-f <filename>
</PRE>
<P>This option specifies an alternate configuration file for slapd. The default is normally <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.conf</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
-F <slapd-config-directory>
</PRE>
<P>Specifies the slapd configuration directory. The default is <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.d</TT>.</P>
<P>If both <TT>-f</TT> and <TT>-F</TT> are specified, the config file will be read and converted to config directory format and written to the specified directory. If neither option is specified, slapd will attempt to read the default config directory before trying to use the default config file. If a valid config directory exists then the default config file is ignored. All of the slap tools that use the config options observe this same behavior.</P>
<PRE>
-h <URLs>
</PRE>
<P>This option specifies alternative listener configurations. The default is <TT>ldap:///</TT> which implies <TERM>LDAP</TERM> over <TERM>TCP</TERM> on all interfaces on the default LDAP port 389. You can specify specific host-port pairs or other protocol schemes (such as <TT>ldaps://</TT> or <TT>ldapi://</TT>).</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>URL</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Protocol</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Transport</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ldap:///
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
TCP port 389
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ldaps:///
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP over SSL
</TD>
<TD>
TCP port 636
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ldapi:///
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
IPC (Unix-domain socket)
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>For example, <TT>-h "ldaps:// ldap://127.0.0.1:666"</TT> will create two listeners: one for the (non-standard) <TT>ldaps://</TT> scheme on all interfaces on the default <TT>ldaps://</TT> port 636, and one for the standard <TT>ldap://</TT> scheme on the <TT>localhost</TT> (<EM>loopback</EM>) interface on port 666. Hosts may be specified using using hostnames or <TERM>IPv4</TERM> or <TERM>IPv6</TERM> addresses. Port values must be numeric.</P>
<P>For LDAP over IPC, the pathname of the Unix-domain socket can be encoded in the URL. Note that directory separators must be URL-encoded, like any other characters that are special to URLs. Thus the socket <TT>/usr/local/var/ldapi</TT> must be encoded as</P>
<PRE>
ldapi://%2Fusr%2Flocal%2Fvar%2Fldapi
</PRE>
<P>ldapi: is described in detail in <EM>Using LDAP Over IPC Mechanisms</EM> [<A HREF="http://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-chu-ldap-ldapi-00">Chu-LDAPI</A>]</P>
<P>Note that the ldapi:/// transport is not widely implemented: non-OpenLDAP clients may not be able to use it.</P>
<PRE>
-n <service-name>
</PRE>
<P>This option specifies the service name used for logging and other purposes. The default service name is <TT>slapd</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
-l <syslog-local-user>
</PRE>
<P>This option specifies the local user for the <EM>syslog</EM>(8) facility. Values can be <TT>LOCAL0</TT>, <TT>LOCAL1</TT>, <TT>LOCAL2</TT>, ..., and <TT>LOCAL7</TT>. The default is <TT>LOCAL4</TT>. This option may not be supported on all systems.</P>
<PRE>
-u user -g group
</PRE>
<P>These options specify the user and group, respectively, to run as. <TT>user</TT> can be either a user name or uid. <TT>group</TT> can be either a group name or gid.</P>
<PRE>
-r directory
</PRE>
<P>This option specifies a run-time directory. slapd will <EM>chroot</EM>(2) to this directory after opening listeners but before reading any configuration files or initializing any backends.</P>
<UL>
</UL>
<PRE>
-d <level> | ?
</PRE>
<P>This option sets the slapd debug level to <level>. When level is a `?' character, the various debugging levels are printed and slapd exits, regardless of any other options you give it. Current debugging levels are</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 7.1: Debugging Levels</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Level</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Keyword</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
-1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
any
</TD>
<TD>
enable all debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
0
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
</TD>
<TD>
no debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x1 trace)
</TD>
<TD>
trace function calls
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x2 packets)
</TD>
<TD>
debug packet handling
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
4
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4 args)
</TD>
<TD>
heavy trace debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
8
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8 conns)
</TD>
<TD>
connection management
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x10 BER)
</TD>
<TD>
print out packets sent and received
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x20 filter)
</TD>
<TD>
search filter processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
64
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x40 config)
</TD>
<TD>
configuration processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
128
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x80 ACL)
</TD>
<TD>
access control list processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
256
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x100 stats)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log connections/operations/results
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
512
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x200 stats2)
</TD>
<TD>
stats log entries sent
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
1024
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x400 shell)
</TD>
<TD>
print communication with shell backends
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
2048
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x800 parse)
</TD>
<TD>
print entry parsing debugging
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
16384
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x4000 sync)
</TD>
<TD>
syncrepl consumer processing
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
32768
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
(0x8000 none)
</TD>
<TD>
only messages that get logged whatever log level is set
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>You may enable multiple levels by specifying the debug option once for each desired level. Or, since debugging levels are additive, you can do the math yourself. That is, if you want to trace function calls and watch the config file being processed, you could set level to the sum of those two levels (in this case, <TT> -d 65</TT>). Or, you can let slapd do the math, (e.g. <TT> -d 1 -d 64</TT>). Consult <TT><ldap_log.h></TT> for more details.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>slapd must have been compiled with <TT>--enable-debug</TT> defined for any debugging information beyond the two stats levels to be available (the default).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="Starting slapd">7.2. Starting slapd</A></H2>
<P>In general, slapd is run like this:</P>
<PRE>
/usr/local/libexec/slapd [<option>]*
</PRE>
<P>where <TT>/usr/local/libexec</TT> is determined by <TT>configure</TT> and <option> is one of the options described above (or in <EM>slapd</EM>(8)). Unless you have specified a debugging level (including level <TT>0</TT>), slapd will automatically fork and detach itself from its controlling terminal and run in the background.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Stopping slapd">7.3. Stopping slapd</A></H2>
<P>To kill off <EM>slapd</EM>(8) safely, you should give a command like this</P>
<PRE>
kill -INT `cat /usr/local/var/slapd.pid`
</PRE>
<P>where <TT>/usr/local/var</TT> is determined by <TT>configure</TT>.</P>
<P>Killing slapd by a more drastic method may cause information loss or database corruption.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Access Control">8. Access Control</A></H1>
<H2><A NAME="Introduction">8.1. Introduction</A></H2>
<P>As the directory gets populated with more and more data of varying sensitivity, controlling the kinds of access granted to the directory becomes more and more critical. For instance, the directory may contain data of a confidential nature that you may need to protect by contract or by law. Or, if using the directory to control access to other services, inappropriate access to the directory may create avenues of attack to your sites security that result in devastating damage to your assets.</P>
<P>Access to your directory can be configured via two methods, the first using <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> and the second using the <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) format (<A HREF="#Configuring slapd">Configuring slapd</A>).</P>
<P>The default access control policy is allow read by all clients. Regardless of what access control policy is defined, the <EM>rootdn</EM> is always allowed full rights (i.e. auth, search, compare, read and write) on everything and anything.</P>
<P>As a consequence, it's useless (and results in a performance penalty) to explicitly list the <EM>rootdn</EM> among the <EM><by></EM> clauses.</P>
<P>The following sections will describe Access Control Lists in greater depth and follow with some examples and recommendations. See <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5) for complete details.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Access Control via Static Configuration">8.2. Access Control via Static Configuration</A></H2>
<P>Access to entries and attributes is controlled by the access configuration file directive. The general form of an access line is:</P>
<PRE>
<access directive> ::= access to <what>
[by <who> [<access>] [<control>] ]+
<what> ::= * |
[dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex> | dn.<scope-style>=<DN>]
[filter=<ldapfilter>] [attrs=<attrlist>]
<basic-style> ::= regex | exact
<scope-style> ::= base | one | subtree | children
<attrlist> ::= <attr> [val[.<basic-style>]=<regex>] | <attr> , <attrlist>
<attr> ::= <attrname> | entry | children
<who> ::= * | [anonymous | users | self
| dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex> | dn.<scope-style>=<DN>]
[dnattr=<attrname>]
[group[/<objectclass>[/<attrname>][.<basic-style>]]=<regex>]
[peername[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[sockname[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[domain[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[sockurl[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[set=<setspec>]
[aci=<attrname>]
<access> ::= [self]{<level>|<priv>}
<level> ::= none | disclose | auth | compare | search | read | write | manage
<priv> ::= {=|+|-}{m|w|r|s|c|x|d|0}+
<control> ::= [stop | continue | break]
</PRE>
<P>where the <what> part selects the entries and/or attributes to which the access applies, the <TT><who></TT> part specifies which entities are granted access, and the <TT><access></TT> part specifies the access granted. Multiple <TT><who> <access> <control></TT> triplets are supported, allowing many entities to be granted different access to the same set of entries and attributes. Not all of these access control options are described here; for more details see the <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5) man page.</P>
<H3><A NAME="What to control access to">8.2.1. What to control access to</A></H3>
<P>The <what> part of an access specification determines the entries and attributes to which the access control applies. Entries are commonly selected in two ways: by DN and by filter. The following qualifiers select entries by DN:</P>
<PRE>
to *
to dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex>
to dn.<scope-style>=<DN>
</PRE>
<P>The first form is used to select all entries. The second form may be used to select entries by matching a regular expression against the target entry's <EM>normalized DN</EM>. (The second form is not discussed further in this document.) The third form is used to select entries which are within the requested scope of DN. The <DN> is a string representation of the Distinguished Name, as described in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt">RFC4514</A>.</P>
<P>The scope can be either <TT>base</TT>, <TT>one</TT>, <TT>subtree</TT>, or <TT>children</TT>. Where <TT>base</TT> matches only the entry with provided DN, <TT>one</TT> matches the entries whose parent is the provided DN, <TT>subtree</TT> matches all entries in the subtree whose root is the provided DN, and <TT>children</TT> matches all entries under the DN (but not the entry named by the DN).</P>
<P>For example, if the directory contained entries named:</P>
<PRE>
0: o=suffix
1: cn=Manager,o=suffix
2: ou=people,o=suffix
3: uid=kdz,ou=people,o=suffix
4: cn=addresses,uid=kdz,ou=people,o=suffix
5: uid=hyc,ou=people,o=suffix
</PRE>
<P>Then:</P>
<UL>
<TT>dn.base="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 2;
<BR>
<TT>dn.one="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 3, and 5;
<BR>
<TT>dn.subtree="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 2, 3, 4, and 5; and
<BR>
<TT>dn.children="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 3, 4, and 5.</UL>
<P>Entries may also be selected using a filter:</P>
<PRE>
to filter=<ldap filter>
</PRE>
<P>where <ldap filter> is a string representation of an LDAP search filter, as described in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt">RFC4515</A>. For example:</P>
<PRE>
to filter=(objectClass=person)
</PRE>
<P>Note that entries may be selected by both DN and filter by including both qualifiers in the <what> clause.</P>
<PRE>
to dn.one="ou=people,o=suffix" filter=(objectClass=person)
</PRE>
<P>Attributes within an entry are selected by including a comma-separated list of attribute names in the <what> selector:</P>
<PRE>
attrs=<attribute list>
</PRE>
<P>A specific value of an attribute is selected by using a single attribute name and also using a value selector:</P>
<PRE>
attrs=<attribute> val[.<style>]=<regex>
</PRE>
<P>There are two special <EM>pseudo</EM> attributes <TT>entry</TT> and <TT>children</TT>. To read (and hence return) a target entry, the subject must have <TT>read</TT> access to the target's <EM>entry</EM> attribute. To perform a search, the subject must have <TT>search</TT> access to the search base's <EM>entry</EM> attribute. To add or delete an entry, the subject must have <TT>write</TT> access to the entry's <TT>entry</TT> attribute AND must have <TT>write</TT> access to the entry's parent's <TT>children</TT> attribute. To rename an entry, the subject must have <TT>write</TT> access to entry's <TT>entry</TT> attribute AND have <TT>write</TT> access to both the old parent's and new parent's <TT>children</TT> attributes. The complete examples at the end of this section should help clear things up.</P>
<P>Lastly, there is a special entry selector <TT>"*"</TT> that is used to select any entry. It is used when no other <TT><what></TT> selector has been provided. It's equivalent to "<TT>dn=.*</TT>"</P>
<H3><A NAME="Who to grant access to">8.2.2. Who to grant access to</A></H3>
<P>The <who> part identifies the entity or entities being granted access. Note that access is granted to "entities" not "entries." The following table summarizes entity specifiers:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 6.3: Access Entity Specifiers</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Specifier</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Entities</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>*</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
All, including anonymous and authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>anonymous</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Anonymous (non-authenticated) users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>users</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>self</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
User associated with target entry
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users matching a regular expression
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn.<scope-style>=<DN></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users within scope of a DN
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The DN specifier behaves much like <what> clause DN specifiers.</P>
<P>Other control factors are also supported. For example, a <TT><who></TT> can be restricted by an entry listed in a DN-valued attribute in the entry to which the access applies:</P>
<PRE>
dnattr=<dn-valued attribute name>
</PRE>
<P>The dnattr specification is used to give access to an entry whose DN is listed in an attribute of the entry (e.g., give access to a group entry to whoever is listed as the owner of the group entry).</P>
<P>Some factors may not be appropriate in all environments (or any). For example, the domain factor relies on IP to domain name lookups. As these can easily be spoofed, the domain factor should be avoided.</P>
<H3><A NAME="The access to grant">8.2.3. The access to grant</A></H3>
<P>The kind of <access> granted can be one of the following:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 6.4: Access Levels</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Level</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Privileges</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>none =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>0</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
no access
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>disclose =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>d</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed for information disclosure on error
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>auth =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>dx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to authenticate (bind)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>compare =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>cdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to compare
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>search =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>scdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to apply search filters
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>read =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>rscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to read search results
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>write =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>wrscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to modify/rename
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>manage =</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>mwrscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to manage
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>Each level implies all lower levels of access. So, for example, granting someone <TT>write</TT> access to an entry also grants them <TT>read</TT>, <TT>search</TT>, <TT>compare</TT>, <TT>auth</TT> and <TT>disclose</TT> access. However, one may use the privileges specifier to grant specific permissions.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Control Evaluation">8.2.4. Access Control Evaluation</A></H3>
<P>When evaluating whether some requester should be given access to an entry and/or attribute, slapd compares the entry and/or attribute to the <TT><what></TT> selectors given in the configuration file. For each entry, access controls provided in the database which holds the entry (or the global access directives if not held in any database) apply first, followed by the global access directives. However, when dealing with an access list, because the global access list is effectively appended to each per-database list, if the resulting list is non-empty then the access list will end with an implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT> directive. If there are no access directives applicable to a backend, then a default read is used.</P>
<P>Within this priority, access directives are examined in the order in which they appear in the config file. Slapd stops with the first <TT><what></TT> selector that matches the entry and/or attribute. The corresponding access directive is the one slapd will use to evaluate access.</P>
<P>Next, slapd compares the entity requesting access to the <TT><who></TT> selectors within the access directive selected above in the order in which they appear. It stops with the first <TT><who></TT> selector that matches the requester. This determines the access the entity requesting access has to the entry and/or attribute.</P>
<P>Finally, slapd compares the access granted in the selected <TT><access></TT> clause to the access requested by the client. If it allows greater or equal access, access is granted. Otherwise, access is denied.</P>
<P>The order of evaluation of access directives makes their placement in the configuration file important. If one access directive is more specific than another in terms of the entries it selects, it should appear first in the config file. Similarly, if one <TT><who></TT> selector is more specific than another it should come first in the access directive. The access control examples given below should help make this clear.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Control Examples">8.2.5. Access Control Examples</A></H3>
<P>The access control facility described above is quite powerful. This section shows some examples of its use for descriptive purposes.</P>
<P>A simple example:</P>
<PRE>
access to * by * read
</PRE>
<P>This access directive grants read access to everyone.</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by self write
by anonymous auth
by * read
</PRE>
<P>This directive allows the user to modify their entry, allows anonymous to authentication against these entries, and allows all others to read these entries. Note that only the first <TT>by <who></TT> clause which matches applies. Hence, the anonymous users are granted <TT>auth</TT>, not <TT>read</TT>. The last clause could just as well have been "<TT>by users read</TT>".</P>
<P>It is often desirable to restrict operations based upon the level of protection in place. The following shows how security strength factors (SSF) can be used.</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by ssf=128 self write
by ssf=64 anonymous auth
by ssf=64 users read
</PRE>
<P>This directive allows users to modify their own entries if security protections have of strength 128 or better have been established, allows authentication access to anonymous users, and read access when 64 or better security protections have been established. If client has not establish sufficient security protections, the implicit <TT>by * none</TT> clause would be applied.</P>
<P>The following example shows the use of a style specifiers to select the entries by DN in two access directives where ordering is significant.</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by * search
access to dn.children="dc=com"
by * read
</PRE>
<P>Read access is granted to entries under the <TT>dc=com</TT> subtree, except for those entries under the <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> subtree, to which search access is granted. No access is granted to <TT>dc=com</TT> as neither access directive matches this DN. If the order of these access directives was reversed, the trailing directive would never be reached, since all entries under <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> are also under <TT>dc=com</TT> entries.</P>
<P>Also note that if no <TT>access to</TT> directive matches or no <TT>by <who></TT> clause, <B>access is denied</B>. That is, every <TT>access to</TT> directive ends with an implicit <TT>by * none</TT> clause. When dealing with an access list, because the global access list is effectively appended to each per-database list, if the resulting list is non-empty then the access list will end with an implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT> directive. If there are no access directives applicable to a backend, then a default read is used.</P>
<P>The next example again shows the importance of ordering, both of the access directives and the <TT>by <who></TT> clauses. It also shows the use of an attribute selector to grant access to a specific attribute and various <TT><who></TT> selectors.</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.subtree="dc=example,dc=com" attrs=homePhone
by self write
by dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" search
by peername.regex=IP:10\..+ read
access to dn.subtree="dc=example,dc=com"
by self write
by dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" search
by anonymous auth
</PRE>
<P>This example applies to entries in the "<TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT>" subtree. To all attributes except <TT>homePhone</TT>, an entry can write to itself, entries under <TT>example.com</TT> entries can search by them, anybody else has no access (implicit <TT>by * none</TT>) excepting for authentication/authorization (which is always done anonymously). The <TT>homePhone</TT> attribute is writable by the entry, searchable by entries under <TT>example.com</TT>, readable by clients connecting from network 10, and otherwise not readable (implicit <TT>by * none</TT>). All other access is denied by the implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT>.</P>
<P>Sometimes it is useful to permit a particular DN to add or remove itself from an attribute. For example, if you would like to create a group and allow people to add and remove only their own DN from the member attribute, you could accomplish it with an access directive like this:</P>
<PRE>
access to attrs=member,entry
by dnattr=member selfwrite
</PRE>
<P>The dnattr <TT><who></TT> selector says that the access applies to entries listed in the <TT>member</TT> attribute. The <TT>selfwrite</TT> access selector says that such members can only add or delete their own DN from the attribute, not other values. The addition of the entry attribute is required because access to the entry is required to access any of the entry's attributes.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Access Control via Dynamic Configuration">8.3. Access Control via Dynamic Configuration</A></H2>
<P>Access to slapd entries and attributes is controlled by the olcAccess attribute, whose values are a sequence of access directives. The general form of the olcAccess configuration is:</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: <access directive>
<access directive> ::= to <what>
[by <who> [<access>] [<control>] ]+
<what> ::= * |
[dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex> | dn.<scope-style>=<DN>]
[filter=<ldapfilter>] [attrs=<attrlist>]
<basic-style> ::= regex | exact
<scope-style> ::= base | one | subtree | children
<attrlist> ::= <attr> [val[.<basic-style>]=<regex>] | <attr> , <attrlist>
<attr> ::= <attrname> | entry | children
<who> ::= * | [anonymous | users | self
| dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex> | dn.<scope-style>=<DN>]
[dnattr=<attrname>]
[group[/<objectclass>[/<attrname>][.<basic-style>]]=<regex>]
[peername[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[sockname[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[domain[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[sockurl[.<basic-style>]=<regex>]
[set=<setspec>]
[aci=<attrname>]
<access> ::= [self]{<level>|<priv>}
<level> ::= none | disclose | auth | compare | search | read | write | manage
<priv> ::= {=|+|-}{m|w|r|s|c|x|d|0}+
<control> ::= [stop | continue | break]
</PRE>
<P>where the <what> part selects the entries and/or attributes to which the access applies, the <TT><who></TT> part specifies which entities are granted access, and the <TT><access></TT> part specifies the access granted. Multiple <TT><who> <access> <control></TT> triplets are supported, allowing many entities to be granted different access to the same set of entries and attributes. Not all of these access control options are described here; for more details see the <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5) man page.</P>
<H3><A NAME="What to control access to">8.3.1. What to control access to</A></H3>
<P>The <what> part of an access specification determines the entries and attributes to which the access control applies. Entries are commonly selected in two ways: by DN and by filter. The following qualifiers select entries by DN:</P>
<PRE>
to *
to dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex>
to dn.<scope-style>=<DN>
</PRE>
<P>The first form is used to select all entries. The second form may be used to select entries by matching a regular expression against the target entry's <EM>normalized DN</EM>. (The second form is not discussed further in this document.) The third form is used to select entries which are within the requested scope of DN. The <DN> is a string representation of the Distinguished Name, as described in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt">RFC4514</A>.</P>
<P>The scope can be either <TT>base</TT>, <TT>one</TT>, <TT>subtree</TT>, or <TT>children</TT>. Where <TT>base</TT> matches only the entry with provided DN, <TT>one</TT> matches the entries whose parent is the provided DN, <TT>subtree</TT> matches all entries in the subtree whose root is the provided DN, and <TT>children</TT> matches all entries under the DN (but not the entry named by the DN).</P>
<P>For example, if the directory contained entries named:</P>
<PRE>
0: o=suffix
1: cn=Manager,o=suffix
2: ou=people,o=suffix
3: uid=kdz,ou=people,o=suffix
4: cn=addresses,uid=kdz,ou=people,o=suffix
5: uid=hyc,ou=people,o=suffix
</PRE>
<P>Then:</P>
<UL>
<TT>dn.base="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 2;
<BR>
<TT>dn.one="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 3, and 5;
<BR>
<TT>dn.subtree="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 2, 3, 4, and 5; and
<BR>
<TT>dn.children="ou=people,o=suffix"</TT> match 3, 4, and 5.</UL>
<P>Entries may also be selected using a filter:</P>
<PRE>
to filter=<ldap filter>
</PRE>
<P>where <ldap filter> is a string representation of an LDAP search filter, as described in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt">RFC4515</A>. For example:</P>
<PRE>
to filter=(objectClass=person)
</PRE>
<P>Note that entries may be selected by both DN and filter by including both qualifiers in the <what> clause.</P>
<PRE>
to dn.one="ou=people,o=suffix" filter=(objectClass=person)
</PRE>
<P>Attributes within an entry are selected by including a comma-separated list of attribute names in the <what> selector:</P>
<PRE>
attrs=<attribute list>
</PRE>
<P>A specific value of an attribute is selected by using a single attribute name and also using a value selector:</P>
<PRE>
attrs=<attribute> val[.<style>]=<regex>
</PRE>
<P>There are two special <EM>pseudo</EM> attributes <TT>entry</TT> and <TT>children</TT>. To read (and hence return) a target entry, the subject must have <TT>read</TT> access to the target's <EM>entry</EM> attribute. To perform a search, the subject must have <TT>search</TT> access to the search base's <EM>entry</EM> attribute. To add or delete an entry, the subject must have <TT>write</TT> access to the entry's <TT>entry</TT> attribute AND must have <TT>write</TT> access to the entry's parent's <TT>children</TT> attribute. To rename an entry, the subject must have <TT>write</TT> access to entry's <TT>entry</TT> attribute AND have <TT>write</TT> access to both the old parent's and new parent's <TT>children</TT> attributes. The complete examples at the end of this section should help clear things up.</P>
<P>Lastly, there is a special entry selector <TT>"*"</TT> that is used to select any entry. It is used when no other <TT><what></TT> selector has been provided. It's equivalent to "<TT>dn=.*</TT>"</P>
<H3><A NAME="Who to grant access to">8.3.2. Who to grant access to</A></H3>
<P>The <who> part identifies the entity or entities being granted access. Note that access is granted to "entities" not "entries." The following table summarizes entity specifiers:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 5.3: Access Entity Specifiers</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Specifier</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Entities</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>*</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
All, including anonymous and authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>anonymous</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Anonymous (non-authenticated) users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>users</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>self</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
User associated with target entry
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users matching a regular expression
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn.<scope-style>=<DN></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users within scope of a DN
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The DN specifier behaves much like <what> clause DN specifiers.</P>
<P>Other control factors are also supported. For example, a <TT><who></TT> can be restricted by an entry listed in a DN-valued attribute in the entry to which the access applies:</P>
<PRE>
dnattr=<dn-valued attribute name>
</PRE>
<P>The dnattr specification is used to give access to an entry whose DN is listed in an attribute of the entry (e.g., give access to a group entry to whoever is listed as the owner of the group entry).</P>
<P>Some factors may not be appropriate in all environments (or any). For example, the domain factor relies on IP to domain name lookups. As these can easily be spoofed, the domain factor should be avoided.</P>
<H3><A NAME="The access to grant">8.3.3. The access to grant</A></H3>
<P>The kind of <access> granted can be one of the following:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 5.4: Access Levels</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Level</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Privileges</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>none</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=0</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
no access
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>disclose</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=d</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed for information disclosure on error
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>auth</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=dx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to authenticate (bind)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>compare</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=cdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to compare
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>search</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=scdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to apply search filters
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>read</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=rscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to read search results
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>write</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=wrscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to modify/rename
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>manage</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<TT>=mwrscdx</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
needed to manage
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>Each level implies all lower levels of access. So, for example, granting someone <TT>write</TT> access to an entry also grants them <TT>read</TT>, <TT>search</TT>, <TT>compare</TT>, <TT>auth</TT> and <TT>disclose</TT> access. However, one may use the privileges specifier to grant specific permissions.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Control Evaluation">8.3.4. Access Control Evaluation</A></H3>
<P>When evaluating whether some requester should be given access to an entry and/or attribute, slapd compares the entry and/or attribute to the <TT><what></TT> selectors given in the configuration. For each entry, access controls provided in the database which holds the entry (or the global access directives if not held in any database) apply first, followed by the global access directives (which are held in the <TT>frontend</TT> database definition). However, when dealing with an access list, because the global access list is effectively appended to each per-database list, if the resulting list is non-empty then the access list will end with an implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT> directive. If there are no access directives applicable to a backend, then a default read is used.</P>
<P>Within this priority, access directives are examined in the order in which they appear in the configuration attribute. Slapd stops with the first <TT><what></TT> selector that matches the entry and/or attribute. The corresponding access directive is the one slapd will use to evaluate access.</P>
<P>Next, slapd compares the entity requesting access to the <TT><who></TT> selectors within the access directive selected above in the order in which they appear. It stops with the first <TT><who></TT> selector that matches the requester. This determines the access the entity requesting access has to the entry and/or attribute.</P>
<P>Finally, slapd compares the access granted in the selected <TT><access></TT> clause to the access requested by the client. If it allows greater or equal access, access is granted. Otherwise, access is denied.</P>
<P>The order of evaluation of access directives makes their placement in the configuration file important. If one access directive is more specific than another in terms of the entries it selects, it should appear first in the configuration. Similarly, if one <TT><who></TT> selector is more specific than another it should come first in the access directive. The access control examples given below should help make this clear.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Control Examples">8.3.5. Access Control Examples</A></H3>
<P>The access control facility described above is quite powerful. This section shows some examples of its use for descriptive purposes.</P>
<P>A simple example:</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to * by * read
</PRE>
<P>This access directive grants read access to everyone.</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to *
by self write
by anonymous auth
by * read
</PRE>
<P>This directive allows the user to modify their entry, allows anonymous to authenticate against these entries, and allows all others to read these entries. Note that only the first <TT>by <who></TT> clause which matches applies. Hence, the anonymous users are granted <TT>auth</TT>, not <TT>read</TT>. The last clause could just as well have been "<TT>by users read</TT>".</P>
<P>It is often desirable to restrict operations based upon the level of protection in place. The following shows how security strength factors (SSF) can be used.</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to *
by ssf=128 self write
by ssf=64 anonymous auth
by ssf=64 users read
</PRE>
<P>This directive allows users to modify their own entries if security protections of strength 128 or better have been established, allows authentication access to anonymous users, and read access when strength 64 or better security protections have been established. If the client has not establish sufficient security protections, the implicit <TT>by * none</TT> clause would be applied.</P>
<P>The following example shows the use of style specifiers to select the entries by DN in two access directives where ordering is significant.</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by * search
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=com"
by * read
</PRE>
<P>Read access is granted to entries under the <TT>dc=com</TT> subtree, except for those entries under the <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> subtree, to which search access is granted. No access is granted to <TT>dc=com</TT> as neither access directive matches this DN. If the order of these access directives was reversed, the trailing directive would never be reached, since all entries under <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> are also under <TT>dc=com</TT> entries.</P>
<P>Also note that if no <TT>olcAccess: to</TT> directive matches or no <TT>by <who></TT> clause, <B>access is denied</B>. When dealing with an access list, because the global access list is effectively appended to each per-database list, if the resulting list is non-empty then the access list will end with an implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT> directive. If there are no access directives applicable to a backend, then a default read is used.</P>
<P>The next example again shows the importance of ordering, both of the access directives and the <TT>by <who></TT> clauses. It also shows the use of an attribute selector to grant access to a specific attribute and various <TT><who></TT> selectors.</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to dn.subtree="dc=example,dc=com" attrs=homePhone
by self write
by dn.children=dc=example,dc=com" search
by peername.regex=IP:10\..+ read
olcAccess: to dn.subtree="dc=example,dc=com"
by self write
by dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" search
by anonymous auth
</PRE>
<P>This example applies to entries in the "<TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT>" subtree. To all attributes except <TT>homePhone</TT>, an entry can write to itself, entries under <TT>example.com</TT> entries can search by them, anybody else has no access (implicit <TT>by * none</TT>) excepting for authentication/authorization (which is always done anonymously). The <TT>homePhone</TT> attribute is writable by the entry, searchable by entries under <TT>example.com</TT>, readable by clients connecting from network 10, and otherwise not readable (implicit <TT>by * none</TT>). All other access is denied by the implicit <TT>access to * by * none</TT>.</P>
<P>Sometimes it is useful to permit a particular DN to add or remove itself from an attribute. For example, if you would like to create a group and allow people to add and remove only their own DN from the member attribute, you could accomplish it with an access directive like this:</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to attrs=member,entry
by dnattr=member selfwrite
</PRE>
<P>The dnattr <TT><who></TT> selector says that the access applies to entries listed in the <TT>member</TT> attribute. The <TT>selfwrite</TT> access selector says that such members can only add or delete their own DN from the attribute, not other values. The addition of the entry attribute is required because access to the entry is required to access any of the entry's attributes.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Control Ordering">8.3.6. Access Control Ordering</A></H3>
<P>Since the ordering of <TT>olcAccess</TT> directives is essential to their proper evaluation, but LDAP attributes normally do not preserve the ordering of their values, OpenLDAP uses a custom schema extension to maintain a fixed ordering of these values. This ordering is maintained by prepending a <TT>"{X}"</TT> numeric index to each value, similarly to the approach used for ordering the configuration entries. These index tags are maintained automatically by slapd and do not need to be specified when originally defining the values. For example, when you create the settings</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: to attrs=member,entry
by dnattr=member selfwrite
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by * search
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=com"
by * read
</PRE>
<P>when you read them back using slapcat or ldapsearch they will contain</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: {0}to attrs=member,entry
by dnattr=member selfwrite
olcAccess: {1}to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by * search
olcAccess: {2}to dn.children="dc=com"
by * read
</PRE>
<P>The numeric index may be used to specify a particular value to change when using ldapmodify to edit the access rules. This index can be used instead of (or in addition to) the actual access value. Using this numeric index is very helpful when multiple access rules are being managed.</P>
<P>For example, if we needed to change the second rule above to grant write access instead of search, we could try this LDIF:</P>
<PRE>
changetype: modify
delete: olcAccess
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" by * search
-
add: olcAccess
olcAccess: to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" by * write
-
</PRE>
<P>But this example <B>will not</B> guarantee that the existing values remain in their original order, so it will most likely yield a broken security configuration. Instead, the numeric index should be used:</P>
<PRE>
changetype: modify
delete: olcAccess
olcAccess: {1}
-
add: olcAccess
olcAccess: {1}to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com" by * write
-
</PRE>
<P>This example deletes whatever rule is in value #1 of the <TT>olcAccess</TT> attribute (regardless of its value) and adds a new value that is explicitly inserted as value #1. The result will be</P>
<PRE>
olcAccess: {0}to attrs=member,entry
by dnattr=member selfwrite
olcAccess: {1}to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by * write
olcAccess: {2}to dn.children="dc=com"
by * read
</PRE>
<P>which is exactly what was intended.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Access Control Common Examples">8.4. Access Control Common Examples</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Basic ACLs">8.4.1. Basic ACLs</A></H3>
<P>Generally one should start with some basic ACLs such as:</P>
<PRE>
access to attr=userPassword
by self =xw
by anonymous auth
by * none
access to *
by self write
by users read
by * none
</PRE>
<P>The first ACL allows users to update (but not read) their passwords, anonymous users to authenticate against this attribute, and (implicitly) denying all access to others.</P>
<P>The second ACL allows users full access to their entry, authenticated users read access to anything, and (implicitly) denying all access to others (in this case, anonymous users).</P>
<H3><A NAME="Matching Anonymous and Authenticated users">8.4.2. Matching Anonymous and Authenticated users</A></H3>
<P>An anonymous user has a empty DN. While the <EM>dn.exact=""</EM> or <EM>dn.regex="^$"</EM> could be used, <EM>slapd</EM>(8)) offers an anonymous shorthand which should be used instead.</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by anonymous none
by * read
</PRE>
<P>denies all access to anonymous users while granting others read.</P>
<P>Authenticated users have a subject DN. While <EM>dn.regex=".+"</EM> will match any authenticated user, OpenLDAP provides the users short hand which should be used instead.</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by users read
by * none
</PRE>
<P>This ACL grants read permissions to authenticated users while denying others (i.e.: anonymous users).</P>
<H3><A NAME="Controlling rootdn access">8.4.3. Controlling rootdn access</A></H3>
<P>You could specify the <EM>rootdn</EM> in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) or <EM>slapd.d</EM> without specifying a <EM>rootpw</EM>. Then you have to add an actual directory entry with the same dn, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Manager,o=MyOrganization
cn: Manager
sn: Manager
objectClass: person
objectClass: top
userPassword: {SSHA}someSSHAdata
</PRE>
<P>Then binding as the <EM>rootdn</EM> will require a regular bind to that DN, which in turn requires auth access to that entry's DN and <EM>userPassword</EM>, and this can be restricted via ACLs. E.g.:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.base="cn=Manager,o=MyOrganization"
by peername.regex=127\.0\.0\.1 auth
by peername.regex=192\.168\.0\..* auth
by users none
by * none
</PRE>
<P>The ACLs above will only allow binding using rootdn from localhost and 192.168.0.0/24.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Managing access with Groups">8.4.4. Managing access with Groups</A></H3>
<P>There are a few ways to do this. One approach is illustrated here. Consider the following DIT layout:</P>
<PRE>
+-dc=example,dc=com
+---cn=administrators,dc=example,dc=com
+---cn=fred blogs,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>and the following group object (in LDIF format):</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=administrators,dc=example,dc=com
cn: administrators of this region
objectclass: groupOfNames (important for the group acl feature)
member: cn=fred blogs,dc=example,dc=com
member: cn=somebody else,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>One can then grant access to the members of this this group by adding appropriate <EM>by group</EM> clause to an access directive in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5). For instance,</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
by self write
by group.exact="cn=Administrators,dc=example,dc=com" write
by * auth
</PRE>
<P>Like by <EM>dn</EM> clauses, one can also use <EM>expand</EM> to expand the group name based upon the regular expression matching of the target, that is, the to <EM>dn.regex</EM>). For instance,</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.regex="(.+,)?ou=People,(dc=[^,]+,dc=[^,]+)$"
attrs=children,entry,uid
by group.expand="cn=Managers,$2" write
by users read
by * auth
</PRE>
<P>The above illustration assumed that the group members are to be found in the <EM>member</EM> attribute type of the <EM>groupOfNames</EM> object class. If you need to use a different group object and/or a different attribute type then use the following <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) (abbreviated) syntax:</P>
<PRE>
access to <what>
by group/<objectclass>/<attributename>=<DN> <access>
</PRE>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by group/organizationalRole/roleOccupant="cn=Administrator,dc=example,dc=com" write
</PRE>
<P>In this case, we have an ObjectClass <EM>organizationalRole</EM> which contains the administrator DN's in the <EM>roleOccupant</EM> attribute. For instance:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Administrator,dc=example,dc=com
cn: Administrator
objectclass: organizationalRole
roleOccupant: cn=Jane Doe,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>the specified member attribute type MUST be of DN or <EM>NameAndOptionalUID</EM> syntax, and the specified object class SHOULD allow the attribute type.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Dynamic Groups are also supported in Access Control. Please see <EM>slapo-dynlist</EM>(5) and the <A HREF="#Dynamic Lists">Dynamic Lists</A> overlay section.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Granting access to a subset of attributes">8.4.5. Granting access to a subset of attributes</A></H3>
<P>You can grant access to a set of attributes by specifying a list of attribute names in the ACL <EM>to</EM> clause. To be useful, you also need to grant access to the <EM>entry</EM> itself. Also note how <EM>children</EM> controls the ability to add, delete, and rename entries.</P>
<PRE>
# mail: self may write, authenticated users may read
access to attrs=mail
by self write
by users read
by * none
# cn, sn: self my write, all may read
access to attrs=cn,sn
by self write
by * read
# immediate children: only self can add/delete entries under this entry
access to attrs=children
by self write
# entry itself: self may write, all may read
access to attrs=entry
by self write
by * read
# other attributes: self may write, others have no access
access to *
by self write
by * none
</PRE>
<P>ObjectClass names may also be specified in this list, which will affect all the attributes that are required and/or allowed by that <EM>objectClass</EM>. Actually, names in <EM>attrlist</EM> that are prefixed by <EM>@</EM> are directly treated as objectClass names. A name prefixed by <EM>!</EM> is also treated as an objectClass, but in this case the access rule affects the attributes that are not required nor allowed by that <EM>objectClass</EM>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Allowing a user write to all entries below theirs">8.4.6. Allowing a user write to all entries below theirs</A></H3>
<P>For a setup where a user can write to its own record and to all of its children:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.regex="(.+,)?(uid=[^,]+,o=Company)$"
by dn.exact,expand="$2" write
by anonymous auth
</PRE>
<P>(Add more examples for above)</P>
<H3><A NAME="Allowing entry creation">8.4.7. Allowing entry creation</A></H3>
<P>Let's say, you have it like this:</P>
<PRE>
o=<basedn>
ou=domains
associatedDomain=<somedomain>
ou=users
uid=<someuserid>
uid=<someotheruserid>
ou=addressbooks
uid=<someuserid>
cn=<someone>
cn=<someoneelse>
</PRE>
<P>and, for another domain <someotherdomain>:</P>
<PRE>
o=<basedn>
ou=domains
associatedDomain=<someotherdomain>
ou=users
uid=<someuserid>
uid=<someotheruserid>
ou=addressbooks
uid=<someotheruserid>
cn=<someone>
cn=<someoneelse>
</PRE>
<P>then, if you wanted user <EM>uid=<someuserid></EM> to <B>ONLY</B> create an entry for its own thing, you could write an ACL like this:</P>
<PRE>
# this rule lets users of "associatedDomain=<matcheddomain>"
# write under "ou=addressbook,associatedDomain=<matcheddomain>,ou=domains,o=<basedn>",
# i.e. a user can write ANY entry below its domain's address book;
# this permission is necessary, but not sufficient, the next
# will restrict this permission further
access to dn.regex="^ou=addressbook,associatedDomain=([^,]+),ou=domains,o=<basedn>$" attrs=children
by dn.regex="^uid=([^,]+),ou=users,associatedDomain=$1,ou=domains,o=<basedn>$$" write
by * none
# Note that above the "by" clause needs a "regex" style to make sure
# it expands to a DN that starts with a "uid=<someuserid>" pattern
# while substituting the associatedDomain submatch from the "what" clause.
# This rule lets a user with "uid=<matcheduid>" of "<associatedDomain=matcheddomain>"
# write (i.e. add, modify, delete) the entry whose DN is exactly
# "uid=<matcheduid>,ou=addressbook,associatedDomain=<matcheddomain>,ou=domains,o=<basedn>"
# and ANY entry as subtree of it
access to dn.regex="^(.+,)?uid=([^,]+),ou=addressbook,associatedDomain=([^,]+),ou=domains,o=<basedn>$"
by dn.exact,expand="uid=$2,ou=users,associatedDomain=$3,ou=domains,o=<basedn>" write
by * none
# Note that above the "by" clause uses the "exact" style with the "expand"
# modifier because now the whole pattern can be rebuilt by means of the
# submatches from the "what" clause, so a "regex" compilation and evaluation
# is no longer required.
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Tips for using regular expressions in Access Control">8.4.8. Tips for using regular expressions in Access Control</A></H3>
<P>Always use <EM>dn.regex=<pattern></EM> when you intend to use regular expression matching. <EM>dn=<pattern></EM> alone defaults to <EM>dn.exact<pattern></EM>.</P>
<P>Use <EM>(.+)</EM> instead of <EM>(.*)</EM> when you want at least one char to be matched. <EM>(.*)</EM> matches the empty string as well.</P>
<P>Don't use regular expressions for matches that can be done otherwise in a safer and cheaper manner. Examples:</P>
<PRE>
dn.regex=".*dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>is unsafe and expensive:</P>
<UL>
<LI>unsafe because any string containing <EM>dc=example,dc=com </EM>will match, not only those that end with the desired pattern; use <EM>.*dc=example,dc=com$</EM> instead.
<LI>unsafe also because it would allow any <EM>attributeType</EM> ending with <EM>dc</EM> as naming attribute for the first RDN in the string, e.g. a custom attributeType <EM>mydc</EM> would match as well. If you really need a regular expression that allows just <EM>dc=example,dc=com</EM> or any of its subtrees, use <EM>^(.+,)?dc=example,dc=com$</EM>, which means: anything to the left of dc=..., if any (the question mark after the pattern within brackets), must end with a comma;
<LI>expensive because if you don't need submatches, you could use scoping styles, e.g.</UL>
<PRE>
dn.subtree="dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>to include <EM>dc=example,dc=com</EM> in the matching patterns,</P>
<PRE>
dn.children="dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>to exclude <EM>dc=example,dc=com</EM> from the matching patterns, or</P>
<PRE>
dn.onelevel="dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>to allow exactly one sublevel matches only.</P>
<P>Always use <EM>^</EM> and <EM>$</EM> in regexes, whenever appropriate, because <EM>ou=(.+),ou=(.+),ou=addressbooks,o=basedn</EM> will match <EM>something=bla,ou=xxx,ou=yyy,ou=addressbooks,o=basedn,ou=addressbooks,o=basedn,dc=some,dc=org</EM></P>
<P>Always use <EM>([^,]+)</EM> to indicate exactly one RDN, because <EM>(.+)</EM> can include any number of RDNs; e.g. <EM>ou=(.+),dc=example,dc=com</EM> will match <EM>ou=My,o=Org,dc=example,dc=com</EM>, which might not be what you want.</P>
<P>Never add the rootdn to the by clauses. ACLs are not even processed for operations performed with rootdn identity (otherwise there would be no reason to define a rootdn at all).</P>
<P>Use shorthands. The user directive matches authenticated users and the anonymous directive matches anonymous users.</P>
<P>Don't use the <EM>dn.regex</EM> form for <by> clauses if all you need is scoping and/or substring replacement; use scoping styles (e.g. <EM>exact</EM>, <EM>onelevel</EM>, <EM>children</EM> or <EM>subtree</EM>) and the style modifier expand to cause substring expansion.</P>
<P>For instance,</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.regex=".+,dc=([^,]+),dc=([^,]+)$"
by dn.regex="^[^,],ou=Admin,dc=$1,dc=$2$$" write
</PRE>
<P>although correct, can be safely and efficiently replaced by</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.regex=".+,(dc=[^,]+,dc=[^,]+)$"
by dn.onelevel,expand="ou=Admin,$1" write
</PRE>
<P>where the regex in the <EM><what></EM> clause is more compact, and the one in the <EM><by></EM> clause is replaced by a much more efficient scoping style of onelevel with substring expansion.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Granting and Denying access based on security strength factors (ssf)">8.4.9. Granting and Denying access based on security strength factors (ssf)</A></H3>
<P>You can restrict access based on the security strength factor (SSF)</P>
<PRE>
access to dn="cn=example,cn=edu"
by * ssf=256 read
</PRE>
<P>0 (zero) implies no protection, 1 implies integrity protection only, 56 DES or other weak ciphers, 112 triple DES and other strong ciphers, 128 RC4, Blowfish and other modern strong ciphers.</P>
<P>Other possibilities:</P>
<PRE>
transport_ssf=<n>
tls_ssf=<n>
sasl_ssf=<n>
</PRE>
<P>256 is recommended.</P>
<P>See <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) for information on <EM>ssf</EM>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="When things aren\'t working as expected">8.4.10. When things aren't working as expected</A></H3>
<P>Consider this example:</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by anonymous auth
access to *
by self write
access to *
by users read
</PRE>
<P>You may think this will allow any user to login, to read everything and change his own data if he is logged in. But in this example only the login works and an ldapsearch returns no data. The Problem is that SLAPD goes through its access config line by line and stops as soon as it finds a match in the part of the access rule.(here: <EM>to *</EM>)</P>
<P>To get what we wanted the file has to read:</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by anonymous auth
by self write
by users read
</PRE>
<P>The general rule is: "special access rules first, generic access rules last"</P>
<P>See also <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5), loglevel 128 and <EM>slapacl</EM>(8) for debugging information.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Sets - Granting rights based on relationships">8.5. Sets - Granting rights based on relationships</A></H2>
<P>Sets are best illustrated via examples. The following sections will present a few set ACL examples in order to facilitate their understanding.</P>
<P>(Sets in Access Controls FAQ Entry: <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/1133.html">http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/1133.html</A>)</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Sets are considered experimental.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Groups of Groups">8.5.1. Groups of Groups</A></H3>
<P>The OpenLDAP ACL for groups doesn't expand groups within groups, which are groups that have another group as a member. For example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=sudoadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com
cn: sudoadm
objectClass: groupOfNames
member: uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
member: cn=accountadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com
dn: cn=accountadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com
cn: accountadm
objectClass: groupOfNames
member: uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>If we use standard group ACLs with the above entries and allow members of the <TT>sudoadm</TT> group to write somewhere, <TT>mary</TT> won't be included:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.subtree="ou=sudoers,dc=example,dc=com"
by group.exact="cn=sudoadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>With sets we can make the ACL be recursive and consider group within groups. So for each member that is a group, it is further expanded:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.subtree="ou=sudoers,dc=example,dc=com"
by set="[cn=sudoadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com]/member* & user" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>This set ACL means: take the <TT>cn=sudoadm</TT> DN, check its <TT>member</TT> attribute(s) (where the "<TT>*</TT>" means recursively) and intersect the result with the authenticated user's DN. If the result is non-empty, the ACL is considered a match and write access is granted.</P>
<P>The following drawing explains how this set is built:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="set-recursivegroup.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Populating a recursive group set</P>
<P>First we get the <TT>uid=john</TT> DN. This entry doesn't have a <TT>member</TT> attribute, so the expansion stops here. Now we get to <TT>cn=accountadm</TT>. This one does have a <TT>member</TT> attribute, which is <TT>uid=mary</TT>. The <TT>uid=mary</TT> entry, however, doesn't have member, so we stop here again. The end comparison is:</P>
<PRE>
{"uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com","uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"} & user
</PRE>
<P>If the authenticated user's DN is any one of those two, write access is granted. So this set will include <TT>mary</TT> in the <TT>sudoadm</TT> group and she will be allowed the write access.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Group ACLs without DN syntax">8.5.2. Group ACLs without DN syntax</A></H3>
<P>The traditional group ACLs, and even the previous example about recursive groups, require that the members are specified as DNs instead of just usernames.</P>
<P>With sets, however, it's also possible to use simple names in group ACLs, as this example will show.</P>
<P>Let's say we want to allow members of the <TT>sudoadm</TT> group to write to the <TT>ou=suders</TT> branch of our tree. But our group definition now is using <TT>memberUid</TT> for the group members:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=sudoadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com
cn: sudoadm
objectClass: posixGroup
gidNumber: 1000
memberUid: john
</PRE>
<P>With this type of group, we can't use group ACLs. But with a set ACL we can grant the desired access:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.subtree="ou=sudoers,dc=example,dc=com"
by set="[cn=sudoadm,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com]/memberUid & user/uid" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>We use a simple intersection where we compare the <TT>uid</TT> attribute of the connecting (and authenticated) user with the <TT>memberUid</TT> attributes of the group. If they match, the intersection is non-empty and the ACL will grant write access.</P>
<P>This drawing illustrates this set when the connecting user is authenticated as <TT>uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com</TT>:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="set-memberUid.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Sets with <TT>memberUid</TT></P>
<P>In this case, it's a match. If it were <TT>mary</TT> authenticating, however, she would be denied write access to <TT>ou=sudoers</TT> because her <TT>uid</TT> attribute is not listed in the group's <TT>memberUid</TT>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Following references">8.5.3. Following references</A></H3>
<P>We will now show a quite powerful example of what can be done with sets. This example tends to make OpenLDAP administrators smile after they have understood it and its implications.</P>
<P>Let's start with an user entry:</P>
<PRE>
dn: uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
uid: john
objectClass: inetOrgPerson
givenName: John
sn: Smith
cn: john
manager: uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>Writing an ACL to allow the manager to update some attributes is quite simple using sets:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.exact="uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=carLicense,homePhone,mobile,pager,telephoneNumber
by self write
by set="this/manager & user" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>In that set, <TT>this</TT> expands to the entry being accessed, so that <TT>this/manager</TT> expands to <TT>uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com</TT> when john's entry is accessed. If the manager herself is accessing John's entry, the ACL will match and write access to those attributes will be granted.</P>
<P>So far, this same behavior can be obtained with the <TT>dnattr</TT> keyword. With sets, however, we can further enhance this ACL. Let's say we want to allow the secretary of the manager to also update these attributes. This is how we do it:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.exact="uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=carLicense,homePhone,mobile,pager,telephoneNumber
by self write
by set="this/manager & user" write
by set="this/manager/secretary & user" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>Now we need a picture to help explain what is happening here (entries shortened for clarity):</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="set-following-references.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Sets jumping through entries</P>
<P>In this example, Jane is the secretary of Mary, which is the manager of John. This whole relationship is defined with the <TT>manager</TT> and <TT>secretary</TT> attributes, which are both of the distinguishedName syntax (i.e., full DNs). So, when the <TT>uid=john</TT> entry is being accessed, the <TT>this/manager/secretary</TT> set becomes <TT>{"uid=jane,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"</TT>} (follow the references in the picture):</P>
<PRE>
this = [uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com]
this/manager = \
[uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com]/manager = uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
this/manager/secretary = \
[uid=mary,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com]/secretary = uid=jane,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>The end result is that when Jane accesses John's entry, she will be granted write access to the specified attributes. Better yet, this will happen to any entry she accesses which has Mary as the manager.</P>
<P>This is all cool and nice, but perhaps gives too much power to secretaries. Maybe we need to further restrict it. For example, let's only allow executive secretaries to have this power:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.exact="uid=john,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=carLicense,homePhone,mobile,pager,telephoneNumber
by self write
by set="this/manager & user" write
by set="this/manager/secretary &
[cn=executive,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com]/member* &
user" write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>It's almost the same ACL as before, but we now also require that the connecting user be a member of the (possibly nested) <TT>cn=executive</TT> group.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Limits">9. Limits</A></H1>
<H2><A NAME="Introduction">9.1. Introduction</A></H2>
<P>It is usually desirable to limit the server resources that can be consumed by each LDAP client. OpenLDAP provides two sets of limits: a size limit, which can restrict the <EM>number</EM> of entries that a client can retrieve in a single operation, and a time limit which restricts the length of time that an operation may continue. Both types of limit can be given different values depending on who initiated the operation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Soft and Hard limits">9.2. Soft and Hard limits</A></H2>
<P>The server administrator can specify both <EM>soft limits</EM> and <EM>hard limits</EM>. Soft limits can be thought of as being the default limit value. Hard limits cannot be exceeded by ordinary LDAP users.</P>
<P>LDAP clients can specify their own size and time limits when issuing search operations. This feature has been present since the earliest version of X.500.</P>
<P>If the client specifies a limit then the lower of the requested value and the <EM>hard limit</EM> will become the limit for the operation.</P>
<P>If the client does not specify a limit then the server applies the <EM>soft limit</EM>.</P>
<P>Soft and Hard limits are often referred to together as <EM>administrative limits</EM>. Thus, if an LDAP client requests a search that would return more results than the limits allow it will get an <EM>adminLimitExceeded</EM> error. Note that the server will usually return some results even if the limit has been exceeded: this feature is useful to clients that just want to check for the existence of some entries without needing to see them all.</P>
<P>The <EM>rootdn</EM> is not subject to any limits.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Global Limits">9.3. Global Limits</A></H2>
<P>Limits specified in the global part of the server configuration act as defaults which are used if no database has more specific limits set.</P>
<P>In a <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) configuration the keywords are <TT>sizelimit</TT> and <TT>timelimit</TT>. When using the <EM>slapd config</EM> backend, the corresponding attributes are <TT>olcSizeLimit</TT> and <TT>olcTimeLimit</TT>. The syntax of these values are the same in both cases.</P>
<P>The simple form sets both soft and hard limits to the same value:</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit {<integer>|unlimited}
timelimit {<integer>|unlimited}
</PRE>
<P>The default sizelimit is 500 entries and the default timelimit is 3600 seconds.</P>
<P>An extended form allows soft and hard limits to be set separately:</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit size[.{soft|hard|unchecked}]=<integer> [...]
timelimit time[.{soft|hard}]=<integer> [...]
</PRE>
<P>Thus, to set a soft sizelimit of 10 entries and a hard limit of 75 entries:</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit size.soft=10 size.hard=75
</PRE>
<P>The <EM>unchecked</EM> keyword sets a limit on how many entries the server will examine once it has created an initial set of candidate results by using indices. This can be very important in a large directory, as a search that cannot be satisfied from an index might cause the server to examine millions of entries, therefore always make sure the correct indexes are configured.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Per-Database Limits">9.4. Per-Database Limits</A></H2>
<P>Each database can have its own set of limits that override the global ones. The syntax is more flexible, and it allows different limits to be applied to different entities. Note that an <EM>entity</EM> is different from an <EM>entry</EM>: the term <EM>entity</EM> is used here to indicate the ID of the person or process that has initiated the LDAP operation.</P>
<P>In a <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) configuration the keyword is <TT>limits</TT>. When using the <EM>slapd config</EM> backend, the corresponding attribute is <TT>olcLimits</TT>. The syntax of the values is the same in both cases.</P>
<PRE>
limits <who> <limit> [<limit> [...]]
</PRE>
<P>The <EM>limits</EM> clause can be specified multiple times to apply different limits to different initiators. The server examines each clause in turn until it finds one that matches the ID that requested the operation. If no match is found, the global limits will be used.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Specify who the limits apply to">9.4.1. Specify who the limits apply to</A></H3>
<P>The <TT><who></TT> part of the <EM>limits</EM> clause can take any of these values:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table ZZZ.ZZZ: Entity Specifiers</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Specifier</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Entities</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>*</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
All, including anonymous and authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>anonymous</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Anonymous (non-authenticated) users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>users</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Authenticated users
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>self</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
User associated with target entry
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn[.<basic-style>]=<regex></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users matching a regular expression
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>dn.<scope-style>=<DN></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Users within scope of a DN
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>group[/oc[/at]]=<pattern></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Members of a group
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The rules for specifying <TT><who></TT> are the same as those used in access-control rules.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Specify time limits">9.4.2. Specify time limits</A></H3>
<P>The syntax for time limits is</P>
<PRE>
time[.{soft|hard}]=<integer>
</PRE>
<P>where integer is the number of seconds slapd will spend answering a search request.</P>
<P>If neither <EM>soft</EM> nor <EM>hard</EM> is specified, the value is used for both, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
limits anonymous time=27
</PRE>
<P>The value <EM>unlimited</EM> may be used to remove the hard time limit entirely, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
limits dn.exact="cn=anyuser,dc=example,dc=org" time.hard=unlimited
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Specifying size limits">9.4.3. Specifying size limits</A></H3>
<P>The syntax for size limit is</P>
<PRE>
size[.{soft|hard|unchecked}]=<integer>
</PRE>
<P>where <TT><integer></TT> is the maximum number of entries slapd will return when answering a search request.</P>
<P>Soft, hard, and "unchecked" limits are available, with the same meanings described for the global limits configuration above.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Size limits and Paged Results">9.4.4. Size limits and Paged Results</A></H3>
<P>If the LDAP client adds the <EM>pagedResultsControl</EM> to the search operation, the hard size limit is used by default, because the request for a specific page size is considered an explicit request for a limitation on the number of entries to be returned. However, the size limit applies to the total count of entries returned within the search, and not to a single page.</P>
<P>Additional size limits may be enforced for paged searches.</P>
<P>The <TT>size.pr</TT> limit controls the maximum page size:</P>
<PRE>
size.pr={<integer>|noEstimate|unlimited}
</PRE>
<P><TT><integer></TT> is the maximum page size if no explicit size is set. <TT>noEstimate</TT> has no effect in the current implementation as the server does not return an estimate of the result size anyway. <TT>unlimited</TT> indicates that no limit is applied to the maximum page size.</P>
<P>The <TT>size.prtotal</TT> limit controls the total number of entries that can be returned by a paged search. By default the limit is the same as the normal <TT>size.hard</TT> limit.</P>
<PRE>
size.prtotal={<integer>|unlimited|disabled}
</PRE>
<P><TT>unlimited</TT> removes the limit on the number of entries that can be returned by a paged search. <TT>disabled</TT> can be used to selectively disable paged result searches.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Example Limit Configurations">9.5. Example Limit Configurations</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Simple Global Limits">9.5.1. Simple Global Limits</A></H3>
<P>This simple global configuration fragment applies size and time limits to all searches by all users except <EM>rootdn</EM>. It limits searches to 50 results and sets an overall time limit of 10 seconds.</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit 50
timelimit 10
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Global Hard and Soft Limits">9.5.2. Global Hard and Soft Limits</A></H3>
<P>It is sometimes useful to limit the size of result sets but to allow clients to request a higher limit where needed. This can be achieved by setting separate hard and soft limits.</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit size.soft=5 size.hard=100
</PRE>
<P>To prevent clients from doing very inefficient non-indexed searches, add the <EM>unchecked</EM> limit:</P>
<PRE>
sizelimit size.soft=5 size.hard=100 size.unchecked=100
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Giving specific users larger limits">9.5.3. Giving specific users larger limits</A></H3>
<P>Having set appropriate default limits in the global configuration, you may want to give certain users the ability to retrieve larger result sets. Here is a way to do that in the per-database configuration:</P>
<PRE>
limits dn.exact="cn=anyuser,dc=example,dc=org" size=100000
limits dn.exact="cn=personnel,dc=example,dc=org" size=100000
limits dn.exact="cn=dirsync,dc=example,dc=org" size=100000
</PRE>
<P>It is generally best to avoid mentioning specific users in the server configuration. A better way is to give the higher limits to a group:</P>
<PRE>
limits group/groupOfNames/member="cn=bigwigs,dc=example,dc=org" size=100000
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Limiting who can do paged searches">9.5.4. Limiting who can do paged searches</A></H3>
<P>It may be required that certain applications need very large result sets that they retrieve using paged searches, but that you do not want ordinary LDAP users to use the pagedResults control. The <EM>pr</EM> and <EM>prtotal</EM> limits can help:</P>
<PRE>
limits group/groupOfNames/member="cn=dirsync,dc=example,dc=org" size.prtotal=unlimited
limits users size.soft=5 size.hard=100 size.prtotal=disabled
limits anonymous size.soft=2 size.hard=5 size.prtotal=disabled
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="Further Information">9.6. Further Information</A></H2>
<P>For further information please see <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5), <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) and <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5)</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Database Creation and Maintenance Tools">10. Database Creation and Maintenance Tools</A></H1>
<P>This section tells you how to create a slapd database from scratch, and how to do trouble shooting if you run into problems. There are two ways to create a database. First, you can create the database on-line using <TERM>LDAP</TERM>. With this method, you simply start up slapd and add entries using the LDAP client of your choice. This method is fine for relatively small databases (a few hundred or thousand entries, depending on your requirements). This method works for database types which support updates.</P>
<P>The second method of database creation is to do it off-line using special utilities provided with <EM>slapd</EM>(8). This method is best if you have many thousands of entries to create, which would take an unacceptably long time using the LDAP method, or if you want to ensure the database is not accessed while it is being created. Note that not all database types support these utilities.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Creating a database over LDAP">10.1. Creating a database over LDAP</A></H2>
<P>With this method, you use the LDAP client of your choice (e.g., the <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1)) to add entries, just like you would once the database is created. You should be sure to set the following options in the configuration file before starting <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<PRE>
suffix <dn>
</PRE>
<P>As described in the <A HREF="#General Database Directives">General Database Directives</A> section, this option defines which entries are to be held by this database. You should set this to the DN of the root of the subtree you are trying to create. For example:</P>
<PRE>
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>You should be sure to specify a directory where the index files should be created:</P>
<PRE>
directory <directory>
</PRE>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
</PRE>
<P>You need to create this directory with appropriate permissions such that slapd can write to it.</P>
<P>You need to configure slapd so that you can connect to it as a directory user with permission to add entries. You can configure the directory to support a special <EM>super-user</EM> or <EM>root</EM> user just for this purpose. This is done through the following two options in the database definition:</P>
<PRE>
rootdn <dn>
rootpw <passwd>
</PRE>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
rootpw secret
</PRE>
<P>These options specify a DN and password that can be used to authenticate as the <EM>super-user</EM> entry of the database (i.e., the entry allowed to do anything). The DN and password specified here will always work, regardless of whether the entry named actually exists or has the password given. This solves the chicken-and-egg problem of how to authenticate and add entries before any entries yet exist.</P>
<P>Finally, you should make sure that the database definition contains the index definitions you want:</P>
<PRE>
index {<attrlist> | default} [pres,eq,approx,sub,none]
</PRE>
<P>For example, to index the <TT>cn</TT>, <TT>sn</TT>, <TT>uid</TT> and <TT>objectclass</TT> attributes, the following <TT>index</TT> directives could be used:</P>
<PRE>
index cn,sn,uid pres,eq,approx,sub
index objectClass eq
</PRE>
<P>This would create presence, equality, approximate, and substring indices for the <TT>cn</TT>, <TT>sn</TT>, and <TT>uid</TT> attributes and an equality index for the <TT>objectClass</TT> attribute. Note that not all index types are available with all attribute types. See <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> section for more information on this option.</P>
<P>Once you have configured things to your liking, start up slapd, connect with your LDAP client, and start adding entries. For example, to add an organization entry and an organizational role entry using the <I>ldapadd</I> tool, you could create an <TERM>LDIF</TERM> file called <TT>entries.ldif</TT> with the contents:</P>
<PRE>
# Organization for Example Corporation
dn: dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: dcObject
objectClass: organization
dc: example
o: Example Corporation
description: The Example Corporation
# Organizational Role for Directory Manager
dn: cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: organizationalRole
cn: Manager
description: Directory Manager
</PRE>
<P>and then use a command like this to actually create the entry:</P>
<PRE>
ldapadd -f entries.ldif -x -D "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com" -w secret
</PRE>
<P>The above command assumes settings provided in the above examples.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Creating a database off-line">10.2. Creating a database off-line</A></H2>
<P>The second method of database creation is to do it off-line, using the slapd database tools described below. This method is best if you have many thousands of entries to create, which would take an unacceptably long time to add using the LDAP method described above. These tools read the slapd configuration file and an input file containing a text representation of the entries to add. For database types which support the tools, they produce the database files directly (otherwise you must use the on-line method above). There are several important configuration options you will want to be sure and set in the config file database definition first:</P>
<PRE>
suffix <dn>
</PRE>
<P>As described in the <A HREF="#General Database Directives">General Database Directives</A> section, this option defines which entries are to be held by this database. You should set this to the DN of the root of the subtree you are trying to create. For example:</P>
<PRE>
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>You should be sure to specify a directory where the index files should be created:</P>
<PRE>
directory <directory>
</PRE>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
</PRE>
<P>Finally, you need to specify which indices you want to build. This is done by one or more index options.</P>
<PRE>
index {<attrlist> | default} [pres,eq,approx,sub,none]
</PRE>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
index cn,sn,uid pres,eq,approx,sub
index objectClass eq
</PRE>
<P>This would create presence, equality, approximate, and substring indices for the <TT>cn</TT>, <TT>sn</TT>, and <TT>uid</TT> attributes and an equality index for the <TT>objectClass</TT> attribute. Note that not all index types are available with all attribute types. See <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> section for more information on this option.</P>
<H3><A NAME="The {{EX:slapadd}} program">10.2.1. The <TT>slapadd</TT> program</A></H3>
<P>Once you've configured things to your liking, you create the primary database and associated indices by running the <EM>slapadd</EM>(8) program:</P>
<PRE>
slapadd -l <inputfile> -f <slapdconfigfile>
[-d <debuglevel>] [-n <integer>|-b <suffix>]
</PRE>
<P>The arguments have the following meanings:</P>
<PRE>
-l <inputfile>
</PRE>
<P>Specifies the <TERM>LDIF</TERM> input file containing the entries to add in text form (described below in the <A HREF="#The LDIF text entry format">The LDIF text entry format</A> section).</P>
<PRE>
-f <slapdconfigfile>
</PRE>
<P>Specifies the slapd configuration file that tells where to create the indices, what indices to create, etc.</P>
<PRE>
-F <slapdconfdirectory>
</PRE>
<P>Specifies a config directory. If both <TT>-f</TT> and <TT>-F</TT> are specified, the config file will be read and converted to config directory format and written to the specified directory. If neither option is specified, an attempt to read the default config directory will be made before trying to use the default config file. If a valid config directory exists then the default config file is ignored. If dryrun mode is also specified, no conversion will occur.</P>
<PRE>
-d <debuglevel>
</PRE>
<P>Turn on debugging, as specified by <TT><debuglevel></TT>. The debug levels are the same as for slapd. See the <A HREF="#Command-Line Options">Command-Line Options</A> section in <A HREF="#Running slapd">Running slapd</A>.</P>
<PRE>
-n <databasenumber>
</PRE>
<P>An optional argument that specifies which database to modify. The first database listed in the configuration file is <TT>1</TT>, the second <TT>2</TT>, etc. By default, the first database in the configuration file is used. Should not be used in conjunction with <TT>-b</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
-b <suffix>
</PRE>
<P>An optional argument that specifies which database to modify. The provided suffix is matched against a database <TT>suffix</TT> directive to determine the database number. Should not be used in conjunction with <TT>-n</TT>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="The {{EX:slapindex}} program">10.2.2. The <TT>slapindex</TT> program</A></H3>
<P>Sometimes it may be necessary to regenerate indices (such as after modifying <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5)). This is possible using the <EM>slapindex</EM>(8) program. <EM>slapindex</EM> is invoked like this</P>
<PRE>
slapindex -f <slapdconfigfile>
[-d <debuglevel>] [-n <databasenumber>|-b <suffix>]
</PRE>
<P>Where the <TT>-f</TT>, <TT>-d</TT>, <TT>-n</TT> and <TT>-b</TT> options are the same as for the <EM>slapadd</EM>(1) program. <EM>slapindex</EM> rebuilds all indices based upon the current database contents.</P>
<H3><A NAME="The {{EX:slapcat}} program">10.2.3. The <TT>slapcat</TT> program</A></H3>
<P>The <TT>slapcat</TT> program is used to dump the database to an <TERM>LDIF</TERM> file. This can be useful when you want to make a human-readable backup of your database or when you want to edit your database off-line. The program is invoked like this:</P>
<PRE>
slapcat -l <filename> -f <slapdconfigfile>
[-d <debuglevel>] [-n <databasenumber>|-b <suffix>]
</PRE>
<P>where <TT>-n</TT> or <TT>-b</TT> is used to select the database in the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) specified using <TT>-f</TT>. The corresponding <TERM>LDIF</TERM> output is written to standard output or to the file specified using the <TT>-l</TT> option.</P>
<H2><A NAME="The LDIF text entry format">10.3. The LDIF text entry format</A></H2>
<P>The <TERM>LDAP Data Interchange Format</TERM> (LDIF) is used to represent LDAP entries in a simple text format. This section provides a brief description of the LDIF entry format which complements <EM>ldif</EM>(5) and the technical specification <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2849.txt">RFC2849</A>.</P>
<P>The basic form of an entry is:</P>
<PRE>
# comment
dn: <distinguished name>
<attrdesc>: <attrvalue>
<attrdesc>: <attrvalue>
...
</PRE>
<P>Lines starting with a '<TT>#</TT>' character are comments. An attribute description may be a simple attribute type like <TT>cn</TT> or <TT>objectClass</TT> or <TT>1.2.3</TT> (an <TERM>OID</TERM> associated with an attribute type) or may include options such as <TT>cn;lang_en_US</TT> or <TT>userCertificate;binary</TT>.</P>
<P>A line may be continued by starting the next line with a <EM>single</EM> space or tab character. For example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Barbara J Jensen,dc=example,dc=
com
cn: Barbara J
Jensen
</PRE>
<P>is equivalent to:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Barbara J Jensen,dc=example,dc=com
cn: Barbara J Jensen
</PRE>
<P>Multiple attribute values are specified on separate lines. e.g.,</P>
<PRE>
cn: Barbara J Jensen
cn: Babs Jensen
</PRE>
<P>If an <TT><attrvalue></TT> contains non-printing characters or begins with a space, a colon ('<TT>:</TT>'), or a less than ('<TT><</TT>'), the <TT><attrdesc></TT> is followed by a double colon and the base64 encoding of the value. For example, the value "<TT> begins with a space</TT>" would be encoded like this:</P>
<PRE>
cn:: IGJlZ2lucyB3aXRoIGEgc3BhY2U=
</PRE>
<P>You can also specify a <TERM>URL</TERM> containing the attribute value. For example, the following specifies the <TT>jpegPhoto</TT> value should be obtained from the file <TT>/path/to/file.jpeg</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
cn:< file:///path/to/file.jpeg
</PRE>
<P>Multiple entries within the same LDIF file are separated by blank lines. Here's an example of an LDIF file containing three entries.</P>
<PRE>
# Barbara's Entry
dn: cn=Barbara J Jensen,dc=example,dc=com
cn: Barbara J Jensen
cn: Babs Jensen
objectClass: person
sn: Jensen
# Bjorn's Entry
dn: cn=Bjorn J Jensen,dc=example,dc=com
cn: Bjorn J Jensen
cn: Bjorn Jensen
objectClass: person
sn: Jensen
# Base64 encoded JPEG photo
jpegPhoto:: /9j/4AAQSkZJRgABAAAAAQABAAD/2wBDABALD
A4MChAODQ4SERATGCgaGBYWGDEjJR0oOjM9PDkzODdASFxOQ
ERXRTc4UG1RV19iZ2hnPk1xeXBkeFxlZ2P/2wBDARESEhgVG
# Jennifer's Entry
dn: cn=Jennifer J Jensen,dc=example,dc=com
cn: Jennifer J Jensen
cn: Jennifer Jensen
objectClass: person
sn: Jensen
# JPEG photo from file
jpegPhoto:< file:///path/to/file.jpeg
</PRE>
<P>Notice that the <TT>jpegPhoto</TT> in Bjorn's entry is base 64 encoded and the <TT>jpegPhoto</TT> in Jennifer's entry is obtained from the location indicated by the URL.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Trailing spaces are not trimmed from values in an LDIF file. Nor are multiple internal spaces compressed. If you don't want them in your data, don't put them there.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Backends">11. Backends</A></H1>
<P>Backends do the actual work of storing or retrieving data in response to LDAP requests. Backends may be compiled statically into <EM>slapd</EM>, or when module support is enabled, they may be dynamically loaded.</P>
<P>If your installation uses dynamic modules, you may need to add the relevant <EM>moduleload</EM> directives to the examples that follow. The name of the module for a backend is usually of the form:</P>
<PRE>
back_<backend name>.la
</PRE>
<P>So for example, if you need to load the <EM>hdb</EM> backend, you would configure</P>
<PRE>
moduleload back_hdb.la
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="Berkeley DB Backends">11.1. Berkeley DB Backends</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.1.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>hdb</EM> backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is the recommended primary backend for a normal <EM>slapd</EM> database. It uses the Oracle Berkeley DB (<TERM>BDB</TERM>) package to store data. It makes extensive use of indexing and caching (see the <A HREF="#Tuning">Tuning</A> section) to speed data access.</P>
<P><EM>hdb</EM> is a variant of the original <EM>bdb</EM> backend which was first written for use with BDB. <EM>hdb</EM> uses a hierarchical database layout which supports subtree renames. It is otherwise identical to the <EM>bdb</EM> behavior, and all the same configuration options apply.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>An <EM>hdb</EM> database needs a large <EM>idlcachesize</EM> for good search performance, typically three times the <EM>cachesize</EM> (entry cache size) or larger.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The <EM>hdb</EM> backend has superseded the <EM>bdb</EM> backend, and both will soon be deprecated in favor of the new <EM>mdb</EM> backend. See below.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="back-bdb/back-hdb Configuration">11.1.2. back-bdb/back-hdb Configuration</A></H3>
<P>MORE LATER</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.1.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-bdb</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="LDAP">11.2. LDAP</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.2.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The LDAP backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is not an actual database; instead it acts as a proxy to forward incoming requests to another LDAP server. While processing requests it will also chase referrals, so that referrals are fully processed instead of being returned to the <EM>slapd</EM> client.</P>
<P>Sessions that explicitly <EM>Bind</EM> to the <EM>back-ldap</EM> database always create their own private connection to the remote LDAP server. Anonymous sessions will share a single anonymous connection to the remote server. For sessions bound through other mechanisms, all sessions with the same DN will share the same connection. This connection pooling strategy can enhance the proxy's efficiency by reducing the overhead of repeatedly making/breaking multiple connections.</P>
<P>The ldap database can also act as an information service, i.e. the identity of locally authenticated clients is asserted to the remote server, possibly in some modified form. For this purpose, the proxy binds to the remote server with some administrative identity, and, if required, authorizes the asserted identity.</P>
<P>It is heavily used by a lot of other <A HREF="#Backends">Backends</A> and <A HREF="#Overlays">Overlays</A>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-ldap Configuration">11.2.2. back-ldap Configuration</A></H3>
<P>As previously mentioned, <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> is used behind the scenes by many other <A HREF="#Backends">Backends</A> and <A HREF="#Overlays">Overlays</A>. Some of them merely provide a few configuration directive themselves, but have available to the administrator the whole of the <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> options.</P>
<P>For example, the <A HREF="#Translucent Proxy">Translucent Proxy</A>, which retrieves entries from a remote LDAP server that can be partially overridden by the defined database, has only four specific <EM>translucent-</EM> directives, but can be configured using any of the normal <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> options. See {[slapo-translucent(5)}} for details.</P>
<P>Other <A HREF="#Overlays">Overlays</A> allow you to tag directives in front of a normal <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> directive. For example, the <EM>slapo-chain(5)</EM> overlay does this:</P>
<P><EM>"There are very few chain overlay specific directives; however, directives related to the instances of the ldap backend that may be implicitly instantiated by the overlay may assume a special meaning when used in conjunction with this overlay. They are described in slapd-ldap(5), and they also need to be prefixed by chain-."</EM></P>
<P>You may have also seen the <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> backend used and described in the <A HREF="#Push Based">Push Based</A> <A HREF="#Replication">Replication</A> section of the guide.</P>
<P>It should therefore be obvious that the <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> backend is extremely flexible and heavily used throughout the OpenLDAP Suite.</P>
<P>The following is a very simple example, but already the power of the <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM> backend is seen by use of a <EM>uri list</EM>:</P>
<PRE>
database ldap
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=slapd-ldap"
uri ldap://localhost/ ldap://remotehost ldap://remotehost2
</PRE>
<P>The URI list is space or comma-separated. Whenever the server that responds is not the first one in the list, the list is rearranged and the responsive server is moved to the head, so that it will be first contacted the next time a connection needs be created.</P>
<P>This feature can be used to provide a form of load balancing when using <A HREF="#MirrorMode replication">MirrorMode replication</A>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.2.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-ldap</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="LDIF">11.3. LDIF</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.3.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The LDIF backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is a basic storage backend that stores entries in text files in LDIF format, and exploits the filesystem to create the tree structure of the database. It is intended as a cheap, low performance easy to use backend.</P>
<P>When using the <EM>cn=config</EM> dynamic configuration database with persistent storage, the configuration data is stored using this backend. See <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5) for more information</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-ldif Configuration">11.3.2. back-ldif Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Like many other backends, the LDIF backend can be instantiated with very few configuration lines:</P>
<PRE>
include ./schema/core.schema
database ldif
directory ./ldif
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=LDIF,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootpw LDIF
</PRE>
<P>If we add the <EM>dcObject</EM> for <EM>dc=suretecsystems,dc=com</EM>, you can see how this is added behind the scenes on the file system:</P>
<PRE>
dn: dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: dcObject
objectClass: organization
dc: suretecsystems
o: Suretec Systems Ltd
</PRE>
<P>Now we add it to the directory:</P>
<PRE>
ldapadd -x -H ldap://localhost:9011 -f suretec.ldif -D "cn=LDIF,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" -w LDIF
adding new entry "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>And inside <TT>./ldif</TT> we have:</P>
<PRE>
ls ./ldif
dc=suretecsystems,dc=com.ldif
</PRE>
<P>which again contains:</P>
<PRE>
cat ldif/dc\=suretecsystems\,dc\=com.ldif
dn: dc=suretecsystems
objectClass: dcObject
objectClass: organization
dc: suretecsystems
o: Suretec Systems Ltd.
structuralObjectClass: organization
entryUUID: 2134b714-e3a1-102c-9a15-f96ee263886d
creatorsName: cn=LDIF,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
createTimestamp: 20080711142643Z
entryCSN: 20080711142643.661124Z#000000#000#000000
modifiersName: cn=LDIF,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
modifyTimestamp: 20080711142643Z
</PRE>
<P>This is the complete format you would get when exporting your directory using <TT>slapcat</TT> etc.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.3.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-ldif</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="LMDB">11.4. LMDB</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.4.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>mdb</EM> backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is the upcoming primary backend for a normal <EM>slapd</EM> database. It uses OpenLDAP's own Lightning Memory-Mapped Database (<TERM>LMDB</TERM>) library to store data and is intended to replace the Berkeley DB backends.</P>
<P>It supports indexing like the BDB backends, but it uses no caching and requires no tuning to deliver maximum search performance. Like <EM>hdb</EM>, it is also fully hierarchical and supports subtree renames in constant time.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-mdb Configuration">11.4.2. back-mdb Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Unlike the BDB backends, the <EM>mdb</EM> backend can be instantiated with very few configuration lines:</P>
<PRE>
include ./schema/core.schema
database mdb
directory ./mdb
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=mdb,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootpw mdb
maxsize 1073741824
</PRE>
<P>In addition to the usual parameters that a minimal configuration requires, the <EM>mdb</EM> backend requires a maximum size to be set. This should be the largest that the database is ever anticipated to grow (in bytes). The filesystem must also provide enough free space to accommodate this size.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.4.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-mdb</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Metadirectory">11.5. Metadirectory</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.5.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The meta backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) performs basic LDAP proxying with respect to a set of remote LDAP servers, called "targets". The information contained in these servers can be presented as belonging to a single Directory Information Tree (<TERM>DIT</TERM>).</P>
<P>A basic knowledge of the functionality of the <EM>slapd-ldap</EM>(5) backend is recommended. This backend has been designed as an enhancement of the ldap backend. The two backends share many features (actually they also share portions of code). While the ldap backend is intended to proxy operations directed to a single server, the meta backend is mainly intended for proxying of multiple servers and possibly naming context masquerading.</P>
<P>These features, although useful in many scenarios, may result in excessive overhead for some applications, so its use should be carefully considered.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-meta Configuration">11.5.2. back-meta Configuration</A></H3>
<P>LATER</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.5.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-meta</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Monitor">11.6. Monitor</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.6.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The monitor backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is not an actual database; if enabled, it is automatically generated and dynamically maintained by slapd with information about the running status of the daemon.</P>
<P>To inspect all monitor information, issue a subtree search with base <EM>cn=Monitor</EM>, requesting that attributes "+" and "*" are returned. The monitor backend produces mostly operational attributes, and LDAP only returns operational attributes that are explicitly requested. Requesting attribute "+" is an extension which requests all operational attributes.</P>
<P>See the <A HREF="#Monitoring">Monitoring</A> section.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-monitor Configuration">11.6.2. back-monitor Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The monitor database can be instantiated only once, i.e. only one occurrence of "database monitor" can occur in the <EM>slapd.conf(5)</EM> file. Also the suffix is automatically set to <EM>"cn=Monitor"</EM>.</P>
<P>You can however set a <EM>rootdn</EM> and <EM>rootpw</EM>. The following is all that is needed to instantiate a monitor backend:</P>
<PRE>
include ./schema/core.schema
database monitor
rootdn "cn=monitoring,cn=Monitor"
rootpw monitoring
</PRE>
<P>You can also apply Access Control to this database like any other database, for example:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.subtree="cn=Monitor"
by dn.exact="uid=Admin,dc=my,dc=org" write
by users read
by * none
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The <TT>core.schema</TT> must be loaded for the monitor database to work.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>A small example of the data returned via <EM>ldapsearch</EM> would be:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://localhost:9011 -b 'cn=Monitor'
# extended LDIF
#
# LDAPv3
# base <cn=Monitor> with scope subtree
# filter: (objectclass=*)
# requesting: ALL
#
# Monitor
dn: cn=Monitor
objectClass: monitorServer
cn: Monitor
description: This subtree contains monitoring/managing objects.
description: This object contains information about this server.
description: Most of the information is held in operational attributes, which
must be explicitly requested.
# Backends, Monitor
dn: cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
objectClass: monitorContainer
cn: Backends
description: This subsystem contains information about available backends.
</PRE>
<P>Please see the <A HREF="#Monitoring">Monitoring</A> section for complete examples of information available via this backend.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.6.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-monitor</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Null">11.7. Null</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.7.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The Null backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is surely the most useful part of slapd:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Searches return success but no entries.
<LI>Compares return compareFalse.
<LI>Updates return success (unless readonly is on) but do nothing.
<LI>Binds other than as the rootdn fail unless the database option "bind on" is given.
<LI>The slapadd(8) and slapcat(8) tools are equally exciting.</UL>
<P>Inspired by the <TT>/dev/null</TT> device.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-null Configuration">11.7.2. back-null Configuration</A></H3>
<P>This has to be one of the shortest configurations you'll ever do. In order to test this, your <TT>slapd.conf</TT> file would look like:</P>
<PRE>
database null
suffix "cn=Nothing"
bind on
</PRE>
<P><EM>bind on</EM> means:</P>
<P><EM>"Allow binds as any DN in this backend's suffix, with any password. The default is "off"."</EM></P>
<P>To test this backend with <EM>ldapsearch</EM>:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://localhost:9011 -D "uid=none,cn=Nothing" -w testing -b 'cn=Nothing'
# extended LDIF
#
# LDAPv3
# base <cn=Nothing> with scope subtree
# filter: (objectclass=*)
# requesting: ALL
#
# search result
search: 2
result: 0 Success
# numResponses: 1
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.7.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-null</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Passwd">11.8. Passwd</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.8.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The PASSWD backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) serves up the user account information listed in the system <EM>passwd</EM>(5) file (defaulting to <TT>/etc/passwd</TT>).</P>
<P>This backend is provided for demonstration purposes only. The DN of each entry is "uid=<username>,<suffix>".</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-passwd Configuration">11.8.2. back-passwd Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The configuration using <TT>slapd.conf</TT> a slightly longer, but not much. For example:</P>
<PRE>
include ./schema/core.schema
database passwd
suffix "cn=passwd"
</PRE>
<P>Again, testing this with <EM>ldapsearch</EM> would result in something like:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://localhost:9011 -b 'cn=passwd'
# extended LDIF
#
# LDAPv3
# base <cn=passwd> with scope subtree
# filter: (objectclass=*)
# requesting: ALL
#
# passwd
dn: cn=passwd
cn: passwd
objectClass: organizationalUnit
# root, passwd
dn: uid=root,cn=passwd
objectClass: person
objectClass: uidObject
uid: root
cn: root
sn: root
description: root
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.8.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-passwd</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Perl/Shell">11.9. Perl/Shell</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.9.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The Perl backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) works by embedding a <EM>perl</EM>(1) interpreter into <EM>slapd</EM>(8). Any perl database section of the configuration file <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) must then specify what Perl module to use. Slapd then creates a new Perl object that handles all the requests for that particular instance of the backend.</P>
<P>The Shell backend to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) executes external programs to implement operations, and is designed to make it easy to tie an existing database to the slapd front-end. This backend is is primarily intended to be used in prototypes.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-perl/back-shell Configuration">11.9.2. back-perl/back-shell Configuration</A></H3>
<P>LATER</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.9.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-shell</EM>(5) and <EM>slapd-perl</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="Relay">11.10. Relay</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.10.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The primary purpose of this <EM>slapd</EM>(8) backend is to map a naming context defined in a database running in the same <EM>slapd</EM>(8) instance into a virtual naming context, with attributeType and objectClass manipulation, if required. It requires the rwm overlay.</P>
<P>This backend and the above mentioned overlay are experimental.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-relay Configuration">11.10.2. back-relay Configuration</A></H3>
<P>LATER</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.10.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-relay</EM>(5)</P>
<H2><A NAME="SQL">11.11. SQL</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">11.11.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The primary purpose of this <EM>slapd</EM>(8) backend is to PRESENT information stored in some RDBMS as an LDAP subtree without any programming (some SQL and maybe stored procedures can't be considered programming, anyway ;).</P>
<P>That is, for example, when you (some ISP) have account information you use in an RDBMS, and want to use modern solutions that expect such information in LDAP (to authenticate users, make email lookups etc.). Or you want to synchronize or distribute information between different sites/applications that use RDBMSes and/or LDAP. Or whatever else...</P>
<P>It is <B>NOT</B> designed as a general-purpose backend that uses RDBMS instead of BerkeleyDB (as the standard BDB backend does), though it can be used as such with several limitations. Please see <A HREF="#LDAP vs RDBMS">LDAP vs RDBMS</A> for discussion.</P>
<P>The idea is to use some meta-information to translate LDAP queries to SQL queries, leaving relational schema untouched, so that old applications can continue using it without any modifications. This allows SQL and LDAP applications to interoperate without replication, and exchange data as needed.</P>
<P>The SQL backend is designed to be tunable to virtually any relational schema without having to change source (through that meta-information mentioned). Also, it uses ODBC to connect to RDBMSes, and is highly configurable for SQL dialects RDBMSes may use, so it may be used for integration and distribution of data on different RDBMSes, OSes, hosts etc., in other words, in highly heterogeneous environments.</P>
<P>This backend is experimental.</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-sql Configuration">11.11.2. back-sql Configuration</A></H3>
<P>This backend has to be one of the most abused and complex backends there is. Therefore, we will go through a simple, small example that comes with the OpenLDAP source and can be found in <TT>servers/slapd/back-sql/rdbms_depend/README</TT></P>
<P>For this example we will be using PostgreSQL.</P>
<P>First, we add to <TT>/etc/odbc.ini</TT> a block of the form:</P>
<PRE>
[example] <===
Description = Example for OpenLDAP's back-sql
Driver = PostgreSQL
Trace = No
Database = example <===
Servername = localhost
UserName = manager <===
Password = secret <===
Port = 5432
;Protocol = 6.4
ReadOnly = No
RowVersioning = No
ShowSystemTables = No
ShowOidColumn = No
FakeOidIndex = No
ConnSettings =
</PRE>
<P>The relevant information for our test setup is highlighted with '<===' on the right above.</P>
<P>Next, we add to <TT>/etc/odbcinst.ini</TT> a block of the form:</P>
<PRE>
[PostgreSQL]
Description = ODBC for PostgreSQL
Driver = /usr/lib/libodbcpsql.so
Setup = /usr/lib/libodbcpsqlS.so
FileUsage = 1
</PRE>
<P>We will presume you know how to create a database and user in PostgreSQL and how to set a password. Also, we'll presume you can populate the 'example' database you've just created with the following files, as found in <TT>servers/slapd/back-sql/rdbms_depend/pgsql </TT></P>
<PRE>
backsql_create.sql, testdb_create.sql, testdb_data.sql, testdb_metadata.sql
</PRE>
<P>Lastly, run the test:</P>
<PRE>
[root@localhost]# cd $SOURCES/tests
[root@localhost]# SLAPD_USE_SQL=pgsql ./run sql-test000
</PRE>
<P>Briefly, you should see something like (cut short for space):</P>
<PRE>
Cleaning up test run directory leftover from previous run.
Running ./scripts/sql-test000-read...
running defines.sh
Starting slapd on TCP/IP port 9011...
Testing SQL backend read operations...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
Testing correct bind... dn:cn=Mitya Kovalev,dc=example,dc=com
Testing incorrect bind (should fail)... ldap_bind: Invalid credentials (49)
......
Filtering original ldif...
Comparing filter output...
>>>>> Test succeeded
</PRE>
<P>The test is basically readonly; this can be performed by all RDBMSes (listed above).</P>
<P>There is another test, sql-test900-write, which is currently enabled only for PostgreSQL and IBM db2.</P>
<P>Using <TT>sql-test000</TT>, files in <TT>servers/slapd/back-sql/rdbms_depend/pgsql/</TT> and the man page, you should be set.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>This backend is experimental.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">11.11.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd-sql</EM>(5) and <TT>servers/slapd/back-sql/rdbms_depend/README</TT></P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Overlays">12. Overlays</A></H1>
<P>Overlays are software components that provide hooks to functions analogous to those provided by backends, which can be stacked on top of the backend calls and as callbacks on top of backend responses to alter their behavior.</P>
<P>Overlays may be compiled statically into <EM>slapd</EM>, or when module support is enabled, they may be dynamically loaded. Most of the overlays are only allowed to be configured on individual databases.</P>
<P>Some can be stacked on the <TT>frontend</TT> as well, for global use. This means that they can be executed after a request is parsed and validated, but right before the appropriate database is selected. The main purpose is to affect operations regardless of the database they will be handled by, and, in some cases, to influence the selection of the database by massaging the request DN.</P>
<P>Essentially, overlays represent a means to:</P>
<UL>
<LI>customize the behavior of existing backends without changing the backend code and without requiring one to write a new custom backend with complete functionality
<LI>write functionality of general usefulness that can be applied to different backend types</UL>
<P>When using <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5), overlays that are configured before any other databases are considered global, as mentioned above. In fact they are implicitly stacked on top of the <TT>frontend</TT> database. They can also be explicitly configured as such:</P>
<PRE>
database frontend
overlay <overlay name>
</PRE>
<P>Overlays are usually documented by separate specific man pages in section 5; the naming convention is</P>
<PRE>
slapo-<overlay name>
</PRE>
<P>All distributed core overlays have a man page. Feel free to contribute to any, if you think there is anything missing in describing the behavior of the component and the implications of all the related configuration directives.</P>
<P>Official overlays are located in</P>
<PRE>
servers/slapd/overlays/
</PRE>
<P>That directory also contains the file slapover.txt, which describes the rationale of the overlay implementation, and may serve as a guideline for the development of custom overlays.</P>
<P>Contribware overlays are located in</P>
<PRE>
contrib/slapd-modules/<overlay name>/
</PRE>
<P>along with other types of run-time loadable components; they are officially distributed, but not maintained by the project.</P>
<P>All the current overlays in OpenLDAP are listed and described in detail in the following sections.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Access Logging">12.1. Access Logging</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.1.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay can record accesses to a given backend database on another database.</P>
<P>This allows all of the activity on a given database to be reviewed using arbitrary LDAP queries, instead of just logging to local flat text files. Configuration options are available for selecting a subset of operation types to log, and to automatically prune older log records from the logging database. Log records are stored with audit schema to assure their readability whether viewed as LDIF or in raw form.</P>
<P>It is also used for <A HREF="#delta-syncrepl replication">delta-syncrepl replication</A></P>
<H3><A NAME="Access Logging Configuration">12.1.2. Access Logging Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The following is a basic example that implements Access Logging:</P>
<PRE>
database bdb
suffix dc=example,dc=com
...
overlay accesslog
logdb cn=log
logops writes reads
logold (objectclass=person)
database bdb
suffix cn=log
...
index reqStart eq
access to *
by dn.base="cn=admin,dc=example,dc=com" read
</PRE>
<P>The following is an example used for <A HREF="#delta-syncrepl replication">delta-syncrepl replication</A>:</P>
<PRE>
database hdb
suffix cn=accesslog
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-accesslog
rootdn cn=accesslog
index default eq
index entryCSN,objectClass,reqEnd,reqResult,reqStart
</PRE>
<P>Accesslog overlay definitions for the primary db</P>
<PRE>
database bdb
suffix dc=example,dc=com
...
overlay accesslog
logdb cn=accesslog
logops writes
logsuccess TRUE
# scan the accesslog DB every day, and purge entries older than 7 days
logpurge 07+00:00 01+00:00
</PRE>
<P>An example search result against <B>cn=accesslog</B> might look like:</P>
<PRE>
[ghenry@suretec ghenry]# ldapsearch -x -b cn=accesslog
# extended LDIF
#
# LDAPv3
# base <cn=accesslog> with scope subtree
# filter: (objectclass=*)
# requesting: ALL
#
# accesslog
dn: cn=accesslog
objectClass: auditContainer
cn: accesslog
# 20080110163829.000004Z, accesslog
dn: reqStart=20080110163829.000004Z,cn=accesslog
objectClass: auditModify
reqStart: 20080110163829.000004Z
reqEnd: 20080110163829.000005Z
reqType: modify
reqSession: 196696
reqAuthzID: cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
reqDN: uid=suretec-46022f8$,ou=Users,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
reqResult: 0
reqMod: sambaPwdCanChange:- ###CENSORED###
reqMod: sambaPwdCanChange:+ ###CENSORED###
reqMod: sambaNTPassword:- ###CENSORED###
reqMod: sambaNTPassword:+ ###CENSORED###
reqMod: sambaPwdLastSet:- ###CENSORED###
reqMod: sambaPwdLastSet:+ ###CENSORED###
reqMod: entryCSN:= 20080110163829.095157Z#000000#000#000000
reqMod: modifiersName:= cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
reqMod: modifyTimestamp:= 20080110163829Z
# search result
search: 2
result: 0 Success
# numResponses: 3
# numEntries: 2
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.1.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-accesslog(5)</EM> and the <A HREF="#delta-syncrepl replication">delta-syncrepl replication</A> section.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Audit Logging">12.2. Audit Logging</A></H2>
<P>The Audit Logging overlay can be used to record all changes on a given backend database to a specified log file.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.2.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>If the need arises whereby changes need to be logged as standard LDIF, then the auditlog overlay <B>slapo-auditlog (5)</B> can be used. Full examples are available in the man page <B>slapo-auditlog (5)</B></P>
<H3><A NAME="Audit Logging Configuration">12.2.2. Audit Logging Configuration</A></H3>
<P>If the directory is running vi <TT>slapd.d</TT>, then the following LDIF could be used to add the overlay to the overlay list in <B>cn=config</B> and set what file the <TERM>LDIF</TERM> gets logged to (adjust to suit)</P>
<PRE>
dn: olcOverlay=auditlog,olcDatabase={1}hdb,cn=config
changetype: add
objectClass: olcOverlayConfig
objectClass: olcAuditLogConfig
olcOverlay: auditlog
olcAuditlogFile: /tmp/auditlog.ldif
</PRE>
<P>In this example for testing, we are logging changes to <TT>/tmp/auditlog.ldif</TT></P>
<P>A typical <TERM>LDIF</TERM> file created by <B>slapo-auditlog(5)</B> would look like:</P>
<PRE>
# add 1196797576 dc=suretecsystems,dc=com cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
dn: dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
changetype: add
objectClass: dcObject
objectClass: organization
dc: suretecsystems
o: Suretec Systems Ltd.
structuralObjectClass: organization
entryUUID: 1606f8f8-f06e-1029-8289-f0cc9d81e81a
creatorsName: cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
modifiersName: cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
createTimestamp: 20051123130912Z
modifyTimestamp: 20051123130912Z
entryCSN: 20051123130912.000000Z#000001#000#000000
auditContext: cn=accesslog
# end add 1196797576
# add 1196797577 dc=suretecsystems,dc=com cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
dn: ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
changetype: add
objectClass: top
objectClass: organizationalUnit
ou: Groups
structuralObjectClass: organizationalUnit
entryUUID: 160aaa2a-f06e-1029-828a-f0cc9d81e81a
creatorsName: cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
modifiersName: cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
createTimestamp: 20051123130912Z
modifyTimestamp: 20051123130912Z
entryCSN: 20051123130912.000000Z#000002#000#000000
# end add 1196797577
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.2.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-auditlog(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Chaining">12.3. Chaining</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.3.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The chain overlay provides basic chaining capability to the underlying database.</P>
<P>What is chaining? It indicates the capability of a DSA to follow referrals on behalf of the client, so that distributed systems are viewed as a single virtual DSA by clients that are otherwise unable to "chase" (i.e. follow) referrals by themselves.</P>
<P>The chain overlay is built on top of the ldap backend; it is compiled by default when <B>--enable-ldap</B>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Chaining Configuration">12.3.2. Chaining Configuration</A></H3>
<P>In order to demonstrate how this overlay works, we shall discuss a typical scenario which might be one master server and three Syncrepl slaves.</P>
<P>On each replica, add this near the top of the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file (global), before any database definitions:</P>
<PRE>
overlay chain
chain-uri "ldap://ldapmaster.example.com"
chain-idassert-bind bindmethod="simple"
binddn="cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
credentials="<secret>"
mode="self"
chain-tls start
chain-return-error TRUE
</PRE>
<P>Add this below your <EM>syncrepl</EM> statement:</P>
<PRE>
updateref "ldap://ldapmaster.example.com/"
</PRE>
<P>The <B>chain-tls</B> statement enables TLS from the slave to the ldap master. The DITs are exactly the same between these machines, therefore whatever user bound to the slave will also exist on the master. If that DN does not have update privileges on the master, nothing will happen.</P>
<P>You will need to restart the slave after these <EM>slapd.conf</EM> changes. Then, if you are using <EM>loglevel stats</EM> (256), you can monitor an <EM>ldapmodify</EM> on the slave and the master. (If you're using <EM>cn=config</EM> no restart is required.)</P>
<P>Now start an <EM>ldapmodify</EM> on the slave and watch the logs. You should expect something like:</P>
<PRE>
Sep 6 09:27:25 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 fd=31 ACCEPT from IP=143.199.102.216:45181 (IP=143.199.102.216:389)
Sep 6 09:27:25 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=0 STARTTLS
Sep 6 09:27:25 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=0 RESULT oid= err=0 text=
Sep 6 09:27:25 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 fd=31 TLS established tls_ssf=256 ssf=256
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=1 BIND dn="uid=user1,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com" method=128
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=1 BIND dn="uid=user1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com" mech=SIMPLE ssf=0
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=1 RESULT tag=97 err=0 text=
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=2 MOD dn="uid=user1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com"
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=2 MOD attr=mail
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=2 RESULT tag=103 err=0 text=
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 op=3 UNBIND
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: conn=11 fd=31 closed
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: syncrepl_entry: LDAP_RES_SEARCH_ENTRY(LDAP_SYNC_MODIFY)
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: syncrepl_entry: be_search (0)
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: syncrepl_entry: uid=user1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
Sep 6 09:27:28 slave1 slapd[29274]: syncrepl_entry: be_modify (0)
</PRE>
<P>And on the master you will see this:</P>
<PRE>
Sep 6 09:23:57 ldapmaster slapd[2961]: conn=55902 op=3 PROXYAUTHZ dn="uid=user1,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com"
Sep 6 09:23:57 ldapmaster slapd[2961]: conn=55902 op=3 MOD dn="uid=user1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com"
Sep 6 09:23:57 ldapmaster slapd[2961]: conn=55902 op=3 MOD attr=mail
Sep 6 09:23:57 ldapmaster slapd[2961]: conn=55902 op=3 RESULT tag=103 err=0 text=
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You can clearly see the PROXYAUTHZ line on the master, indicating the proper identity assertion for the update on the master. Also note the slave immediately receiving the Syncrepl update from the master.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Handling Chaining Errors">12.3.3. Handling Chaining Errors</A></H3>
<P>By default, if chaining fails, the original referral is returned to the client under the assumption that the client might want to try and follow the referral.</P>
<P>With the following directive however, if the chaining fails at the provider side, the actual error is returned to the client.</P>
<PRE>
chain-return-error TRUE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Read-Back of Chained Modifications">12.3.4. Read-Back of Chained Modifications</A></H3>
<P>Occasionally, applications want to read back the data that they just wrote. If a modification requested to a shadow server was silently chained to its provider, an immediate read could result in receiving data not yet synchronized. In those cases, clients should use the <B>dontusecopy</B> control to ensure they are directed to the authoritative source for that piece of data.</P>
<P>This control usually causes a referral to the actual source of the data to be returned. However, when the <EM>slapo-chain(5)</EM> overlay is used, it intercepts the referral being returned in response to the <B>dontusecopy</B> control, and tries to fetch the requested data.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.3.5. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-chain(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Constraints">12.4. Constraints</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.4.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay enforces a regular expression constraint on all values of specified attributes during an LDAP modify request that contains add or modify commands. It is used to enforce a more rigorous syntax when the underlying attribute syntax is too general.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Constraint Configuration">12.4.2. Constraint Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Configuration via <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) would look like:</P>
<PRE>
overlay constraint
constraint_attribute mail regex ^[[:alnum:]]+@mydomain.com$
constraint_attribute title uri
ldap:///dc=catalog,dc=example,dc=com?title?sub?(objectClass=titleCatalog)
</PRE>
<P>A specification like the above would reject any <EM>mail</EM> attribute which did not look like <EM><alpha-numeric string>@mydomain.com</EM>.</P>
<P>It would also reject any title attribute whose values were not listed in the title attribute of any <EM>titleCatalog</EM> entries in the given scope.</P>
<P>An example for use with <EM>cn=config</EM>:</P>
<PRE>
dn: olcOverlay=constraint,olcDatabase={1}hdb,cn=config
changetype: add
objectClass: olcOverlayConfig
objectClass: olcConstraintConfig
olcOverlay: constraint
olcConstraintAttribute: mail regex ^[[:alnum:]]+@mydomain.com$
olcConstraintAttribute: title uri ldap:///dc=catalog,dc=example,dc=com?title?sub?(objectClass=titleCatalog)
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.4.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-constraint(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Dynamic Directory Services">12.5. Dynamic Directory Services</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.5.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>dds</EM> overlay to <EM>slapd</EM>(8) implements dynamic objects as per <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2589.txt">RFC2589</A>. The name <EM>dds</EM> stands for Dynamic Directory Services. It allows to define dynamic objects, characterized by the <EM>dynamicObject</EM> objectClass.</P>
<P>Dynamic objects have a limited lifetime, determined by a time-to-live (TTL) that can be refreshed by means of a specific refresh extended operation. This operation allows to set the Client Refresh Period (CRP), namely the period between refreshes that is required to preserve the dynamic object from expiration. The expiration time is computed by adding the requested TTL to the current time. When dynamic objects reach the end of their lifetime without being further refreshed, they are automatically <EM>deleted</EM>. There is no guarantee of immediate deletion, so clients should not count on it.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Dynamic Directory Service Configuration">12.5.2. Dynamic Directory Service Configuration</A></H3>
<P>A usage of dynamic objects might be to implement dynamic meetings; in this case, all the participants to the meeting are allowed to refresh the meeting object, but only the creator can delete it (otherwise it will be deleted when the TTL expires).</P>
<P>If we add the overlay to an example database, specifying a Max TTL of 1 day, a min of 10 seconds, with a default TTL of 1 hour. We'll also specify an interval of 120 (less than 60s might be too small) seconds between expiration checks and a tolerance of 5 second (lifetime of a dynamic object will be <EM>entryTtl + tolerance</EM>).</P>
<PRE>
overlay dds
dds-max-ttl 1d
dds-min-ttl 10s
dds-default-ttl 1h
dds-interval 120s
dds-tolerance 5s
</PRE>
<P>and add an index:</P>
<PRE>
entryExpireTimestamp
</PRE>
<P>Creating a meeting is as simple as adding the following:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=OpenLDAP Documentation Meeting,ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: groupOfNames
objectClass: dynamicObject
cn: OpenLDAP Documentation Meeting
member: uid=ghenry,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
member: uid=hyc,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="Dynamic Directory Service ACLs">12.5.2.1. Dynamic Directory Service ACLs</A></H4>
<P>Allow users to start a meeting and to join it; restrict refresh to the <EM>member</EM>; restrict delete to the creator:</P>
<PRE>
access to attrs=userPassword
by self write
by * read
access to dn.base="ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=children
by users write
access to dn.onelevel="ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=entry
by dnattr=creatorsName write
by * read
access to dn.onelevel="ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=participant
by dnattr=creatorsName write
by users selfwrite
by * read
access to dn.onelevel="ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com"
attrs=entryTtl
by dnattr=member manage
by * read
</PRE>
<P>In simple terms, the user who created the <EM>OpenLDAP Documentation Meeting</EM> can add new attendees, refresh the meeting using (basically complete control):</P>
<PRE>
ldapexop -x -H ldap://ldaphost "refresh" "cn=OpenLDAP Documentation Meeting,ou=Meetings,dc=example,dc=com" "120" -D "uid=ghenry,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com" -W
</PRE>
<P>Any user can join the meeting, but not add another attendee, but they can refresh the meeting. The ACLs above are quite straight forward to understand.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.5.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-dds(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Dynamic Groups">12.6. Dynamic Groups</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.6.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay extends the Compare operation to detect members of a dynamic group. This overlay is now deprecated as all of its functions are available using the <A HREF="#Dynamic Lists">Dynamic Lists</A> overlay.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Dynamic Group Configuration">12.6.2. Dynamic Group Configuration</A></H3>
<H2><A NAME="Dynamic Lists">12.7. Dynamic Lists</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.7.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay allows expansion of dynamic groups and lists. Instead of having the group members or list attributes hard coded, this overlay allows us to define an LDAP search whose results will make up the group or list.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Dynamic List Configuration">12.7.2. Dynamic List Configuration</A></H3>
<P>This module can behave both as a dynamic list and dynamic group, depending on the configuration. The syntax is as follows:</P>
<PRE>
overlay dynlist
dynlist-attrset <group-oc> <URL-ad> [member-ad]
</PRE>
<P>The parameters to the <TT>dynlist-attrset</TT> directive have the following meaning:</P>
<UL>
<LI><TT><group-oc></TT>: specifies which object class triggers the subsequent LDAP search. Whenever an entry with this object class is retrieved, the search is performed.
<LI><TT><URL-ad></TT>: is the name of the attribute which holds the search URI. It has to be a subtype of <TT>labeledURI</TT>. The attributes and values present in the search result are added to the entry unless <TT>member-ad</TT> is used (see below).
<LI><TT>member-ad</TT>: if present, changes the overlay behavior into a dynamic group. Instead of inserting the results of the search in the entry, the distinguished name of the results are added as values of this attribute.</UL>
<P>Here is an example which will allow us to have an email alias which automatically expands to all user's emails according to our LDAP filter:</P>
<P>In <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5):</P>
<PRE>
overlay dynlist
dynlist-attrset nisMailAlias labeledURI
</PRE>
<P>This means that whenever an entry which has the <TT>nisMailAlias</TT> object class is retrieved, the search specified in the <TT>labeledURI</TT> attribute is performed.</P>
<P>Let's say we have this entry in our directory:</P>
<PRE>
cn=all,ou=aliases,dc=example,dc=com
cn: all
objectClass: nisMailAlias
labeledURI: ldap:///ou=People,dc=example,dc=com?mail?one?(objectClass=inetOrgPerson)
</PRE>
<P>If this entry is retrieved, the search specified in <TT>labeledURI</TT> will be performed and the results will be added to the entry just as if they have always been there. In this case, the search filter selects all entries directly under <TT>ou=People</TT> that have the <TT>inetOrgPerson</TT> object class and retrieves the <TT>mail</TT> attribute, if it exists.</P>
<P>This is what gets added to the entry when we have two users under <TT>ou=People</TT> that match the filter:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="allmail-en.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Dynamic List for all emails</P>
<P>The configuration for a dynamic group is similar. Let's see an example which would automatically populate an <TT>allusers</TT> group with all the user accounts in the directory.</P>
<P>In <TT>slapd.conf</TT>(5):</P>
<PRE>
include /path/to/dyngroup.schema
...
overlay dynlist
dynlist-attrset groupOfURLs labeledURI member
</PRE>
<OL>
<LI>
<LI>Note: We must include the <TT>dyngroup.schema</TT> file that defines the
<LI><TT>groupOfURLs</TT> objectClass used in this example.</OL>
<P>Let's apply it to the following entry:</P>
<PRE>
cn=allusers,ou=group,dc=example,dc=com
cn: all
objectClass: groupOfURLs
labeledURI: ldap:///ou=people,dc=example,dc=com??one?(objectClass=inetOrgPerson)
</PRE>
<P>The behavior is similar to the dynamic list configuration we had before: whenever an entry with the <TT>groupOfURLs</TT> object class is retrieved, the search specified in the <TT>labeledURI</TT> attribute is performed. But this time, only the distinguished names of the results are added, and as values of the <TT>member</TT> attribute.</P>
<P>This is what we get:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="allusersgroup-en.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Dynamic Group for all users</P>
<P>Note that a side effect of this scheme of dynamic groups is that the members need to be specified as full DNs. So, if you are planning in using this for <TT>posixGroup</TT>s, be sure to use RFC2307bis and some attribute which can hold distinguished names. The <TT>memberUid</TT> attribute used in the <TT>posixGroup</TT> object class can hold only names, not DNs, and is therefore not suitable for dynamic groups.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.7.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-dynlist(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Reverse Group Membership Maintenance">12.8. Reverse Group Membership Maintenance</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.8.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>In some scenarios, it may be desirable for a client to be able to determine which groups an entry is a member of, without performing an additional search. Examples of this are applications using the <TERM>DIT</TERM> for access control based on group authorization.</P>
<P>The <B>memberof</B> overlay updates an attribute (by default <B>memberOf</B>) whenever changes occur to the membership attribute (by default <B>member</B>) of entries of the objectclass (by default <B>groupOfNames</B>) configured to trigger updates.</P>
<P>Thus, it provides maintenance of the list of groups an entry is a member of, when usual maintenance of groups is done by modifying the members on the group entry.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Member Of Configuration">12.8.2. Member Of Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The typical use of this overlay requires just enabling the overlay for a specific database. For example, with the following minimal slapd.conf:</P>
<PRE>
include /usr/share/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/share/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
authz-regexp "gidNumber=0\\\+uidNumber=0,cn=peercred,cn=external,cn=auth"
"cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
database bdb
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com"
rootpw secret
directory /var/lib/ldap2.4
checkpoint 256 5
index objectClass eq
index uid eq,sub
overlay memberof
</PRE>
<P>adding the following ldif:</P>
<PRE>
cat memberof.ldif
dn: dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: domain
dc: example
dn: ou=Group,dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: organizationalUnit
ou: Group
dn: ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: organizationalUnit
ou: People
dn: uid=test1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: account
uid: test1
dn: cn=testgroup,ou=Group,dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: groupOfNames
cn: testgroup
member: uid=test1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>Results in the following output from a search on the test1 user:</P>
<PRE>
# ldapsearch -LL -Y EXTERNAL -H ldapi:/// "(uid=test1)" -b dc=example,dc=com memberOf
SASL/EXTERNAL authentication started
SASL username: gidNumber=0+uidNumber=0,cn=peercred,cn=external,cn=auth
SASL SSF: 0
version: 1
dn: uid=test1,ou=People,dc=example,dc=com
memberOf: cn=testgroup,ou=Group,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>Note that the <B>memberOf</B> attribute is an operational attribute, so it must be requested explicitly.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.8.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-memberof(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="The Proxy Cache Engine">12.9. The Proxy Cache Engine</A></H2>
<P><TERM>LDAP</TERM> servers typically hold one or more subtrees of a <TERM>DIT</TERM>. Replica (or shadow) servers hold shadow copies of entries held by one or more master servers. Changes are propagated from the master server to replica (slave) servers using LDAP Sync replication. An LDAP cache is a special type of replica which holds entries corresponding to search filters instead of subtrees.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.9.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The proxy cache extension of slapd is designed to improve the responsiveness of the ldap and meta backends. It handles a search request (query) by first determining whether it is contained in any cached search filter. Contained requests are answered from the proxy cache's local database. Other requests are passed on to the underlying ldap or meta backend and processed as usual.</P>
<P>E.g. <TT>(shoesize>=9)</TT> is contained in <TT>(shoesize>=8)</TT> and <TT>(sn=Richardson)</TT> is contained in <TT>(sn=Richards*)</TT></P>
<P>Correct matching rules and syntaxes are used while comparing assertions for query containment. To simplify the query containment problem, a list of cacheable "templates" (defined below) is specified at configuration time. A query is cached or answered only if it belongs to one of these templates. The entries corresponding to cached queries are stored in the proxy cache local database while its associated meta information (filter, scope, base, attributes) is stored in main memory.</P>
<P>A template is a prototype for generating LDAP search requests. Templates are described by a prototype search filter and a list of attributes which are required in queries generated from the template. The representation for prototype filter is similar to <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt">RFC4515</A>, except that the assertion values are missing. Examples of prototype filters are: (sn=),(&(sn=)(givenname=)) which are instantiated by search filters (sn=Doe) and (&(sn=Doe)(givenname=John)) respectively.</P>
<P>The cache replacement policy removes the least recently used (LRU) query and entries belonging to only that query. Queries are allowed a maximum time to live (TTL) in the cache thus providing weak consistency. A background task periodically checks the cache for expired queries and removes them.</P>
<P>The Proxy Cache paper (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/pub/kapurva/proxycaching.pdf">http://www.openldap.org/pub/kapurva/proxycaching.pdf</A>) provides design and implementation details.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Proxy Cache Configuration">12.9.2. Proxy Cache Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The cache configuration specific directives described below must appear after a <TT>overlay pcache</TT> directive within a <TT>"database meta"</TT> or <TT>"database ldap"</TT> section of the server's <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Setting cache parameters">12.9.2.1. Setting cache parameters</A></H4>
<PRE>
pcache <DB> <maxentries> <nattrsets> <entrylimit> <period>
</PRE>
<P>This directive enables proxy caching and sets general cache parameters. The <DB> parameter specifies which underlying database is to be used to hold cached entries. It should be set to <TT>bdb</TT> or <TT>hdb</TT>. The <maxentries> parameter specifies the total number of entries which may be held in the cache. The <nattrsets> parameter specifies the total number of attribute sets (as specified by the <TT>pcacheAttrset</TT> directive) that may be defined. The <entrylimit> parameter specifies the maximum number of entries in a cacheable query. The <period> specifies the consistency check period (in seconds). In each period, queries with expired TTLs are removed.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Defining attribute sets">12.9.2.2. Defining attribute sets</A></H4>
<PRE>
pcacheAttrset <index> <attrs...>
</PRE>
<P>Used to associate a set of attributes to an index. Each attribute set is associated with an index number from 0 to <numattrsets>-1. These indices are used by the pcacheTemplate directive to define cacheable templates.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Specifying cacheable templates">12.9.2.3. Specifying cacheable templates</A></H4>
<PRE>
pcacheTemplate <prototype_string> <attrset_index> <TTL>
</PRE>
<P>Specifies a cacheable template and the "time to live" (in sec) <TTL> for queries belonging to the template. A template is described by its prototype filter string and set of required attributes identified by <attrset_index>.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Example for slapd.conf">12.9.2.4. Example for slapd.conf</A></H4>
<P>An example <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) database section for a caching server which proxies for the <TT>"dc=example,dc=com"</TT> subtree held at server <TT>ldap.example.com</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
database ldap
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
rootdn "dc=example,dc=com"
uri ldap://ldap.example.com/
overlay pcache
pcache hdb 100000 1 1000 100
pcacheAttrset 0 mail postaladdress telephonenumber
pcacheTemplate (sn=) 0 3600
pcacheTemplate (&(sn=)(givenName=)) 0 3600
pcacheTemplate (&(departmentNumber=)(secretary=*)) 0 3600
cachesize 20
directory ./testrun/db.2.a
index objectClass eq
index cn,sn,uid,mail pres,eq,sub
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="Example for slapd-config">12.9.2.5. Example for slapd-config</A></H4>
<P>The same example as a LDIF file for back-config for a caching server which proxies for the <TT>"dc=example,dc=com"</TT> subtree held at server <TT>ldap.example.com</TT>.</P>
<PRE>
dn: olcDatabase={2}ldap,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
objectClass: olcLDAPConfig
olcDatabase: {2}ldap
olcSuffix: dc=example,dc=com
olcRootDN: dc=example,dc=com
olcDbURI: "ldap://ldap.example.com"
dn: olcOverlay={0}pcache,olcDatabase={2}ldap,cn=config
objectClass: olcOverlayConfig
objectClass: olcPcacheConfig
olcOverlay: {0}pcache
olcPcache: hdb 100000 1 1000 100
olcPcacheAttrset: 0 mail postalAddress telephoneNumber
olcPcacheTemplate: "(sn=)" 0 3600 0 0 0
olcPcacheTemplate: "(&(sn=)(givenName=))" 0 3600 0 0 0
olcPcacheTemplate: "(&(departmentNumber=)(secretary=))" 0 3600
dn: olcDatabase={0}hdb,olcOverlay={0}pcache,olcDatabase={2}ldap,cn=config
objectClass: olcHdbConfig
objectClass: olcPcacheDatabase
olcDatabase: {0}hdb
olcDbDirectory: ./testrun/db.2.a
olcDbCacheSize: 20
olcDbIndex: objectClass eq
olcDbIndex: cn,sn,uid,mail pres,eq,sub
</PRE>
<H5><A NAME="Cacheable Queries">12.9.2.5.1. Cacheable Queries</A></H5>
<P>A LDAP search query is cacheable when its filter matches one of the templates as defined in the "pcacheTemplate" statements and when it references only the attributes specified in the corresponding attribute set. In the example above the attribute set number 0 defines that only the attributes: <TT>mail postaladdress telephonenumber</TT> are cached for the following pcacheTemplates.</P>
<H5><A NAME="Examples:">12.9.2.5.2. Examples:</A></H5>
<PRE>
Filter: (&(sn=Richard*)(givenName=jack))
Attrs: mail telephoneNumber
</PRE>
<P>is cacheable, because it matches the template <TT>(&(sn=)(givenName=))</TT> and its attributes are contained in pcacheAttrset 0.</P>
<PRE>
Filter: (&(sn=Richard*)(telephoneNumber))
Attrs: givenName
</PRE>
<P>is not cacheable, because the filter does not match the template, nor is the attribute givenName stored in the cache</P>
<PRE>
Filter: (|(sn=Richard*)(givenName=jack))
Attrs: mail telephoneNumber
</PRE>
<P>is not cacheable, because the filter does not match the template ( logical OR "|" condition instead of logical AND "&" )</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.9.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-pcache(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Password Policies">12.10. Password Policies</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.10.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay follows the specifications contained in the draft RFC titled draft-behera-ldap-password-policy-09. While the draft itself is expired, it has been implemented in several directory servers, including slapd. Nonetheless, it is important to note that it is a draft, meaning that it is subject to change and is a work-in-progress.</P>
<P>The key abilities of the password policy overlay are as follows:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Enforce a minimum length for new passwords
<LI>Make sure passwords are not changed too frequently
<LI>Cause passwords to expire, provide warnings before they need to be changed, and allow a fixed number of 'grace' logins to allow them to be changed after they have expired
<LI>Maintain a history of passwords to prevent password re-use
<LI>Prevent password guessing by locking a password for a specified period of time after repeated authentication failures
<LI>Force a password to be changed at the next authentication
<LI>Set an administrative lock on an account
<LI>Support multiple password policies on a default or a per-object basis.
<LI>Perform arbitrary quality checks using an external loadable module. This is a non-standard extension of the draft RFC.</UL>
<H3><A NAME="Password Policy Configuration">12.10.2. Password Policy Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Instantiate the module in the database where it will be used, after adding the new ppolicy schema and loading the ppolicy module. The following example shows the ppolicy module being added to the database that handles the naming context "dc=example,dc=com". In this example we are also specifying the DN of a policy object to use if none other is specified in a user's object.</P>
<PRE>
database bdb
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
[...additional database configuration directives go here...]
overlay ppolicy
ppolicy_default "cn=default,ou=policies,dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>Now we need a container for the policy objects. In our example the password policy objects are going to be placed in a section of the tree called "ou=policies,dc=example,dc=com":</P>
<PRE>
dn: ou=policies,dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: organizationalUnit
objectClass: top
ou: policies
</PRE>
<P>The default policy object that we are creating defines the following policies:</P>
<UL>
<LI>The user is allowed to change his own password. Note that the directory ACLs for this attribute can also affect this ability (pwdAllowUserChange: TRUE).
<LI>The name of the password attribute is "userPassword" (pwdAttribute: userPassword). Note that this is the only value that is accepted by OpenLDAP for this attribute.
<LI>The server will check the syntax of the password. If the server is unable to check the syntax (i.e., it was hashed or otherwise encoded by the client) it will return an error refusing the password (pwdCheckQuality: 2).
<LI>When a client includes the Password Policy Request control with a bind request, the server will respond with a password expiration warning if it is going to expire in ten minutes or less (pwdExpireWarning: 600). The warnings themselves are returned in a Password Policy Response control.
<LI>When the password for a DN has expired, the server will allow five additional "grace" logins (pwdGraceAuthNLimit: 5).
<LI>The server will maintain a history of the last five passwords that were used for a DN (pwdInHistory: 5).
<LI>The server will lock the account after the maximum number of failed bind attempts has been exceeded (pwdLockout: TRUE).
<LI>When the server has locked an account, the server will keep it locked until an administrator unlocks it (pwdLockoutDuration: 0)
<LI>The server will reset its failed bind count after a period of 30 seconds.
<LI>Passwords will not expire (pwdMaxAge: 0).
<LI>Passwords can be changed as often as desired (pwdMinAge: 0).
<LI>Passwords must be at least 5 characters in length (pwdMinLength: 5).
<LI>The password does not need to be changed at the first bind or when the administrator has reset the password (pwdMustChange: FALSE)
<LI>The current password does not need to be included with password change requests (pwdSafeModify: FALSE)
<LI>The server will only allow five failed binds in a row for a particular DN (pwdMaxFailure: 5).</UL>
<P>The actual policy would be:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=default,ou=policies,dc=example,dc=com
cn: default
objectClass: pwdPolicy
objectClass: person
objectClass: top
pwdAllowUserChange: TRUE
pwdAttribute: userPassword
pwdCheckQuality: 2
pwdExpireWarning: 600
pwdFailureCountInterval: 30
pwdGraceAuthNLimit: 5
pwdInHistory: 5
pwdLockout: TRUE
pwdLockoutDuration: 0
pwdMaxAge: 0
pwdMaxFailure: 5
pwdMinAge: 0
pwdMinLength: 5
pwdMustChange: FALSE
pwdSafeModify: FALSE
sn: dummy value
</PRE>
<P>You can create additional policy objects as needed.</P>
<P>There are two ways password policy can be applied to individual objects:</P>
<P>1. The pwdPolicySubentry in a user's object - If a user's object has a pwdPolicySubEntry attribute specifying the DN of a policy object, then the policy defined by that object is applied.</P>
<P>2. Default password policy - If there is no specific pwdPolicySubentry set for an object, and the password policy module was configured with the DN of a default policy object and if that object exists, then the policy defined in that object is applied.</P>
<P>Please see <EM>slapo-ppolicy(5)</EM> for complete explanations of features and discussion of "Password Management Issues" at <A HREF="http://www.symas.com/blog/?page_id=66">http://www.symas.com/blog/?page_id=66</A></P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.10.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-ppolicy(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Referential Integrity">12.11. Referential Integrity</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.11.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay can be used with a backend database such as slapd-bdb(5) to maintain the cohesiveness of a schema which utilizes reference attributes.</P>
<P>Whenever a <EM>modrdn</EM> or <EM>delete</EM> is performed, that is, when an entry's DN is renamed or an entry is removed, the server will search the directory for references to this DN (in selected attributes: see below) and update them accordingly. If it was a <EM>delete</EM> operation, the reference is deleted. If it was a <EM>modrdn</EM> operation, then the reference is updated with the new DN.</P>
<P>For example, a very common administration task is to maintain group membership lists, specially when users are removed from the directory. When an user account is deleted or renamed, all groups this user is a member of have to be updated. LDAP administrators usually have scripts for that. But we can use the <TT>refint</TT> overlay to automate this task. In this example, if the user is removed from the directory, the overlay will take care to remove the user from all the groups he/she was a member of. No more scripting for this.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Referential Integrity Configuration">12.11.2. Referential Integrity Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The configuration for this overlay is as follows:</P>
<PRE>
overlay refint
refint_attributes <attribute [attribute ...]>
refint_nothing <string>
</PRE>
<UL>
<LI><TT>refint_attributes</TT>: this parameter specifies a space separated list of attributes which will have the referential integrity maintained. When an entry is removed or has its DN renamed, the server will do an internal search for any of the <TT>refint_attributes</TT> that point to the affected DN and update them accordingly. IMPORTANT: the attributes listed here must have the <TT>distinguishedName</TT> syntax, that is, hold DNs as values.
<LI><TT>refint_nothing</TT>: some times, while trying to maintain the referential integrity, the server has to remove the last attribute of its kind from an entry. This may be prohibited by the schema: for example, the <TT>groupOfNames</TT> object class requires at least one member. In these cases, the server will add the attribute value specified in <TT>refint_nothing</TT> to the entry.</UL>
<P>To illustrate this overlay, we will use the group membership scenario.</P>
<P>In <TT>slapd.conf</TT>:</P>
<PRE>
overlay refint
refint_attributes member
refint_nothing "cn=admin,dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>This configuration tells the overlay to maintain the referential integrity of the <TT>member</TT> attribute. This attribute is used in the <TT>groupOfNames</TT> object class which always needs a member, so we add the <TT>refint_nothing</TT> directive to fill in the group with a standard member should all the members vanish.</P>
<P>If we have the following group membership, the refint overlay will automatically remove <TT>john</TT> from the group if his entry is removed from the directory:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="refint.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Maintaining referential integrity in groups</P>
<P>Notice that if we rename (<TT>modrdn</TT>) the <TT>john</TT> entry to, say, <TT>jsmith</TT>, the refint overlay will also rename the reference in the <TT>member</TT> attribute, so the group membership stays correct.</P>
<P>If we removed all users from the directory who are a member of this group, then the end result would be a single member in the group: <TT>cn=admin,dc=example,dc=com</TT>. This is the <TT>refint_nothing</TT> parameter kicking into action so that the schema is not violated.</P>
<P>The <EM>rootdn</EM> must be set for the database as refint runs as the <EM>rootdn</EM> to gain access to make its updates. The <EM>rootpw</EM> does not need to be set.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.11.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-refint(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Return Code">12.12. Return Code</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.12.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay is useful to test the behavior of clients when server-generated erroneous and/or unusual responses occur, for example; error codes, referrals, excessive response times and so on.</P>
<P>This would be classed as a debugging tool whilst developing client software or additional Overlays.</P>
<P>For detailed information, please see the <EM>slapo-retcode(5)</EM> man page.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Return Code Configuration">12.12.2. Return Code Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The retcode overlay utilizes the "return code" schema described in the man page. This schema is specifically designed for use with this overlay and is not intended to be used otherwise.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The necessary schema is loaded automatically by the overlay.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>An example configuration might be:</P>
<PRE>
overlay retcode
retcode-parent "ou=RetCodes,dc=example,dc=com"
include ./retcode.conf
retcode-item "cn=Unsolicited" 0x00 unsolicited="0"
retcode-item "cn=Notice of Disconnect" 0x00 unsolicited="1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.20036"
retcode-item "cn=Pre-disconnect" 0x34 flags="pre-disconnect"
retcode-item "cn=Post-disconnect" 0x34 flags="post-disconnect"
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG><EM>retcode.conf</EM> can be found in the openldap source at: <TT>tests/data/retcode.conf</TT>
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>An excerpt of a <TT>retcode.conf</TT> would be something like:</P>
<PRE>
retcode-item "cn=success" 0x00
retcode-item "cn=success w/ delay" 0x00 sleeptime=2
retcode-item "cn=operationsError" 0x01
retcode-item "cn=protocolError" 0x02
retcode-item "cn=timeLimitExceeded" 0x03 op=search
retcode-item "cn=sizeLimitExceeded" 0x04 op=search
retcode-item "cn=compareFalse" 0x05 op=compare
retcode-item "cn=compareTrue" 0x06 op=compare
retcode-item "cn=authMethodNotSupported" 0x07
retcode-item "cn=strongAuthNotSupported" 0x07 text="same as authMethodNotSupported"
retcode-item "cn=strongAuthRequired" 0x08
retcode-item "cn=strongerAuthRequired" 0x08 text="same as strongAuthRequired"
</PRE>
<P>Please see <TT>tests/data/retcode.conf</TT> for a complete <TT>retcode.conf</TT></P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.12.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-retcode(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Rewrite/Remap">12.13. Rewrite/Remap</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.13.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>It performs basic DN/data rewrite and objectClass/attributeType mapping. Its usage is mostly intended to provide virtual views of existing data either remotely, in conjunction with the proxy backend described in <EM>slapd-ldap(5)</EM>, or locally, in conjunction with the relay backend described in <EM>slapd-relay(5)</EM>.</P>
<P>This overlay is extremely configurable and advanced, therefore recommended reading is the <EM>slapo-rwm(5)</EM> man page.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Rewrite/Remap Configuration">12.13.2. Rewrite/Remap Configuration</A></H3>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.13.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-rwm(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Sync Provider">12.14. Sync Provider</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.14.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay implements the provider-side support for the LDAP Content Synchronization (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">RFC4533</A>) as well as syncrepl replication support, including persistent search functionality.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Sync Provider Configuration">12.14.2. Sync Provider Configuration</A></H3>
<P>There is very little configuration needed for this overlay, in fact for many situations merely loading the overlay will suffice.</P>
<P>However, because the overlay creates a contextCSN attribute in the root entry of the database which is updated for every write operation performed against the database and only updated in memory, it is recommended to configure a checkpoint so that the contextCSN is written into the underlying database to minimize recovery time after an unclean shutdown:</P>
<PRE>
overlay syncprov
syncprov-checkpoint 100 10
</PRE>
<P>For every 100 operations or 10 minutes, which ever is sooner, the contextCSN will be checkpointed.</P>
<P>The four configuration directives available are <B>syncprov-checkpoint</B>, <B>syncprov-sessionlog</B>, <B>syncprov-nopresent</B> and <B>syncprov-reloadhint</B> which are covered in the man page discussing various other scenarios where this overlay can be used.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.14.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>slapo-syncprov(5)</EM> man page and the <A HREF="#Configuring the different replication types">Configuring the different replication types</A> section</P>
<H2><A NAME="Translucent Proxy">12.15. Translucent Proxy</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.15.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay can be used with a backend database such as <EM>slapd-bdb</EM>(5) to create a "translucent proxy".</P>
<P>Entries retrieved from a remote LDAP server may have some or all attributes overridden, or new attributes added, by entries in the local database before being presented to the client.</P>
<P>A search operation is first populated with entries from the remote LDAP server, the attributes of which are then overridden with any attributes defined in the local database. Local overrides may be populated with the add, modify, and modrdn operations, the use of which is restricted to the root user of the translucent local database.</P>
<P>A compare operation will perform a comparison with attributes defined in the local database record (if any) before any comparison is made with data in the remote database.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Translucent Proxy Configuration">12.15.2. Translucent Proxy Configuration</A></H3>
<P>There are various options available with this overlay, but for this example we will demonstrate adding new attributes to a remote entry and also searching against these newly added local attributes. For more information about overriding remote entries and search configuration, please see <EM>slapo-translucent(5)</EM></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The Translucent Proxy overlay will disable schema checking in the local database, so that an entry consisting of overlay attributes need not adhere to the complete schema.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>First we configure the overlay in the normal manner:</P>
<PRE>
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
pidfile ./slapd.pid
argsfile ./slapd.args
database bdb
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=trans,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootpw secret
directory ./openldap-data
index objectClass eq
overlay translucent
translucent_local carLicense
uri ldap://192.168.X.X:389
lastmod off
acl-bind binddn="cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" credentials="blahblah"
</PRE>
<P>You will notice the overlay directive and a directive to say what attribute we want to be able to search against in the local database. We must also load the ldap backend which will connect to the remote directory server.</P>
<P>Now we take an example LDAP group:</P>
<PRE>
# itsupport, Groups, suretecsystems.com
dn: cn=itsupport,ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: posixGroup
objectClass: sambaGroupMapping
cn: itsupport
gidNumber: 1000
sambaSID: S-1-5-21-XXX
sambaGroupType: 2
displayName: itsupport
memberUid: ghenry
memberUid: joebloggs
</PRE>
<P>and create an LDIF file we can use to add our data to the local database, using some pretty strange choices of new attributes for demonstration purposes:</P>
<PRE>
[ghenry@suretec test_configs]$ cat test-translucent-add.ldif
dn: cn=itsupport,ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
businessCategory: frontend-override
carLicense: LIVID
employeeType: special
departmentNumber: 9999999
roomNumber: 41L-535
</PRE>
<P>Searching against the proxy gives:</P>
<PRE>
[ghenry@suretec test_configs]$ ldapsearch -x -H ldap://127.0.0.1:9001 "(cn=itsupport)"
# itsupport, Groups, OxObjects, suretecsystems.com
dn: cn=itsupport,ou=Groups,ou=OxObjects,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: posixGroup
objectClass: sambaGroupMapping
cn: itsupport
gidNumber: 1003
SAMBASID: S-1-5-21-XXX
SAMBAGROUPTYPE: 2
displayName: itsupport
memberUid: ghenry
memberUid: joebloggs
roomNumber: 41L-535
departmentNumber: 9999999
employeeType: special
carLicense: LIVID
businessCategory: frontend-override
</PRE>
<P>Here we can see that the 5 new attributes are added to the remote entry before being returned to the our client.</P>
<P>Because we have configured a local attribute to search against:</P>
<PRE>
overlay translucent
translucent_local carLicense
</PRE>
<P>we can also search for that to return the completely fabricated entry:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://127.0.0.1:9001 (carLicense=LIVID)
</PRE>
<P>This is an extremely feature because you can then extend a remote directory server locally and also search against the local entries.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Because the translucent overlay does not perform any DN rewrites, the local and remote database instances must have the same suffix. Other configurations will probably fail with No Such Object and other errors
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.15.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-translucent(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Attribute Uniqueness">12.16. Attribute Uniqueness</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.16.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>This overlay can be used with a backend database such as <EM>slapd-bdb(5)</EM> to enforce the uniqueness of some or all attributes within a subtree.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Attribute Uniqueness Configuration">12.16.2. Attribute Uniqueness Configuration</A></H3>
<P>This overlay is only effective on new data from the point the overlay is enabled. To check uniqueness for existing data, you can export and import your data again via the LDAP Add operation, which will not be suitable for large amounts of data, unlike <B>slapcat</B>.</P>
<P>For the following example, if uniqueness were enforced for the <B>mail</B> attribute, the subtree would be searched for any other records which also have a <B>mail</B> attribute containing the same value presented with an <B>add</B>, <B>modify</B> or <B>modrdn</B> operation which are unique within the configured scope. If any are found, the request is rejected.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>If no attributes are specified, for example <B>ldap:///??sub?</B>, then the URI applies to all non-operational attributes. However, the keyword <B>ignore</B> can be specified to exclude certain non-operational attributes.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>To search at the base dn of the current backend database ensuring uniqueness of the <B>mail</B> attribute, we simply add the following configuration:</P>
<PRE>
overlay unique
unique_uri ldap:///?mail?sub?
</PRE>
<P>For an existing entry of:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=gavin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: top
objectClass: inetorgperson
cn: gavin
sn: henry
mail: ghenry@suretecsystems.com
</PRE>
<P>and we then try to add a new entry of:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=robert,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: top
objectClass: inetorgperson
cn: robert
sn: jones
mail: ghenry@suretecsystems.com
</PRE>
<P>would result in an error like so:</P>
<PRE>
adding new entry "cn=robert,dc=example,dc=com"
ldap_add: Constraint violation (19)
additional info: some attributes not unique
</PRE>
<P>The overlay can have multiple URIs specified within a domain, allowing complex selections of objects and also have multiple <B>unique_uri</B> statements or <B>olcUniqueURI</B> attributes which will create independent domains.</P>
<P>For more information and details about the <B>strict</B> and <B>ignore</B> keywords, please see the <EM>slapo-unique(5)</EM> man page.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.16.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-unique(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Value Sorting">12.17. Value Sorting</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.17.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>The Value Sorting overlay can be used with a backend database to sort the values of specific multi-valued attributes within a subtree. The sorting occurs whenever the attributes are returned in a search response.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Value Sorting Configuration">12.17.2. Value Sorting Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Sorting can be specified in ascending or descending order, using either numeric or alphanumeric sort methods. Additionally, a "weighted" sort can be specified, which uses a numeric weight prepended to the attribute values.</P>
<P>The weighted sort is always performed in ascending order, but may be combined with the other methods for values that all have equal weights. The weight is specified by prepending an integer weight {<weight>} in front of each value of the attribute for which weighted sorting is desired. This weighting factor is stripped off and never returned in search results.</P>
<P>Here are a few examples:</P>
<PRE>
loglevel sync stats
database hdb
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
......
overlay valsort
valsort-attr memberUid ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com alpha-ascend
</PRE>
<P>For example, ascend:</P>
<PRE>
# sharedemail, Groups, suretecsystems.com
dn: cn=sharedemail,ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: posixGroup
objectClass: top
cn: sharedemail
gidNumber: 517
memberUid: admin
memberUid: dovecot
memberUid: laura
memberUid: suretec
</PRE>
<P>For weighted, we change our data to:</P>
<PRE>
# sharedemail, Groups, suretecsystems.com
dn: cn=sharedemail,ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: posixGroup
objectClass: top
cn: sharedemail
gidNumber: 517
memberUid: {4}admin
memberUid: {2}dovecot
memberUid: {1}laura
memberUid: {3}suretec
</PRE>
<P>and change the config to:</P>
<PRE>
overlay valsort
valsort-attr memberUid ou=Groups,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com weighted
</PRE>
<P>Searching now results in:</P>
<PRE>
# sharedemail, Groups, OxObjects, suretecsystems.com
dn: cn=sharedemail,ou=Groups,ou=OxObjects,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com
objectClass: posixGroup
objectClass: top
cn: sharedemail
gidNumber: 517
memberUid: laura
memberUid: dovecot
memberUid: suretec
memberUid: admin
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Further Information">12.17.3. Further Information</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapo-valsort(5)</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Overlay Stacking">12.18. Overlay Stacking</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Overview">12.18.1. Overview</A></H3>
<P>Overlays can be stacked, which means that more than one overlay can be instantiated for each database, or for the <TT>frontend</TT>. As a consequence, each overlays function is called, if defined, when overlay execution is invoked. Multiple overlays are executed in reverse order (as a stack) with respect to their definition in slapd.conf (5), or with respect to their ordering in the config database, as documented in slapd-config (5).</P>
<H3><A NAME="Example Scenarios">12.18.2. Example Scenarios</A></H3>
<H4><A NAME="Samba">12.18.2.1. Samba</A></H4>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Schema Specification">13. Schema Specification</A></H1>
<P>This chapter describes how to extend the user schema used by <EM>slapd</EM>(8). The chapter assumes the reader is familiar with the <TERM>LDAP</TERM>/<TERM>X.500</TERM> information model.</P>
<P>The first section, <A HREF="#Distributed Schema Files">Distributed Schema Files</A> details optional schema definitions provided in the distribution and where to obtain other definitions. The second section, <A HREF="#Extending Schema">Extending Schema</A>, details how to define new schema items.</P>
<P>This chapter does not discuss how to extend system schema used by <EM>slapd</EM>(8) as this requires source code modification. System schema includes all operational attribute types or any object class which allows or requires an operational attribute (directly or indirectly).</P>
<H2><A NAME="Distributed Schema Files">13.1. Distributed Schema Files</A></H2>
<P>OpenLDAP Software is distributed with a set of schema specifications for your use. Each set is defined in a file suitable for inclusion (using the <TT>include</TT> directive) in your <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file. These schema files are normally installed in the <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/schema</TT> directory.</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 8.1: Provided Schema Specifications</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>File</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>core.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
OpenLDAP <EM>core</EM> (required)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>cosine.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
Cosine and Internet X.500 (useful)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>inetorgperson.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
InetOrgPerson (useful)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>misc.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
Assorted (experimental)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>nis.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
Network Information Services (FYI)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>openldap.schema</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
OpenLDAP Project (experimental)
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>To use any of these schema files, you only need to include the desired file in the global definitions portion of your <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file. For example:</P>
<PRE>
# include schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
</PRE>
<P>Additional files may be available. Please consult the OpenLDAP <TERM>FAQ</TERM> (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/">http://www.openldap.org/faq/</A>).</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You should not modify any of the schema items defined in provided files.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="Extending Schema">13.2. Extending Schema</A></H2>
<P>Schema used by <EM>slapd</EM>(8) may be extended to support additional syntaxes, matching rules, attribute types, and object classes. This chapter details how to add user application attribute types and object classes using the syntaxes and matching rules already supported by slapd. slapd can also be extended to support additional syntaxes, matching rules and system schema, but this requires some programming and hence is not discussed here.</P>
<P>There are five steps to defining new schema:</P>
<OL>
<LI>obtain Object Identifier
<LI>choose a name prefix
<LI>create local schema file
<LI>define custom attribute types (if necessary)
<LI>define custom object classes</OL>
<H3><A NAME="Object Identifiers">13.2.1. Object Identifiers</A></H3>
<P>Each schema element is identified by a globally unique <TERM>Object Identifier</TERM> (OID). OIDs are also used to identify other objects. They are commonly found in protocols described by <TERM>ASN.1</TERM>. In particular, they are heavily used by the <TERM>Simple Network Management Protocol</TERM> (SNMP). As OIDs are hierarchical, your organization can obtain one OID and branch it as needed. For example, if your organization were assigned OID <TT>1.1</TT>, you could branch the tree as follows:</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 8.2: Example OID hierarchy</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<STRONG>OID</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
<STRONG>Assignment</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
Organization's OID
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.1</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
SNMP Elements
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.2</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
LDAP Elements
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.2.1</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
AttributeTypes
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.2.1.1</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
x-my-Attribute
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.2.2</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
ObjectClasses
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD ALIGN='Left'>
<TT>1.1.2.2.1</TT>
</TD>
<TD ALIGN='Right'>
x-my-ObjectClass
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>You are, of course, free to design a hierarchy suitable to your organizational needs under your organization's OID. No matter what hierarchy you choose, you should maintain a registry of assignments you make. This can be a simple flat file or something more sophisticated such as the <EM>OpenLDAP OID Registry</EM> (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/index.cgi?file=197">http://www.openldap.org/faq/index.cgi?file=197</A>).</P>
<P>For more information about Object Identifiers (and a listing service) see <A HREF="http://www.alvestrand.no/objectid/">http://www.alvestrand.no/objectid/</A>.</P>
<UL>
<EM>Under no circumstances should you hijack OID namespace!</EM></UL>
<P>To obtain a registered OID at <EM>no cost</EM>, apply for a OID under the <A HREF="http://www.iana.org/">Internet Assigned Numbers Authority</A> (ORG:IANA) maintained <EM>Private Enterprise</EM> arc. Any private enterprise (organization) may request a <TERM>Private Enterprise Number</TERM> (PEN) to be assigned under this arc. Just fill out the IANA form at <A HREF="http://pen.iana.org/pen/PenApplication.page">http://pen.iana.org/pen/PenApplication.page</A> and your official PEN will be sent to you usually within a few days. Your base OID will be something like <TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.X</TT> where <TT>X</TT> is an integer.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>PENs obtained using this form may be used for any purpose including identifying LDAP schema elements.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Alternatively, OID name space may be available from a national authority (e.g., <A HREF="http://www.ansi.org/">ANSI</A>, <A HREF="http://www.bsi-global.com/">BSI</A>).</P>
<H3><A NAME="Naming Elements">13.2.2. Naming Elements</A></H3>
<P>In addition to assigning a unique object identifier to each schema element, you should provide at least one textual name for each element. Names should be registered with the <A HREF="http://www.iana.org/">IANA</A> or prefixed with "x-" to place in the "private use" name space.</P>
<P>The name should be both descriptive and not likely to clash with names of other schema elements. In particular, any name you choose should not clash with present or future Standard Track names (this is assured if you registered names or use names beginning with "x-").</P>
<P>It is noted that you can obtain your own registered name prefix so as to avoid having to register your names individually. See <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4520.txt">RFC4520</A> for details.</P>
<P>In the examples below, we have used a short prefix '<TT>x-my-</TT>'. Such a short prefix would only be suitable for a very large, global organization. In general, we recommend something like '<TT>x-de-Firm-</TT>' (German company) or '<TT>x-com-Example</TT>' (elements associated with organization associated with <TT>example.com</TT>).</P>
<H3><A NAME="Local schema file">13.2.3. Local schema file</A></H3>
<P>The <TT>objectclass</TT> and <TT>attributeTypes</TT> configuration file directives can be used to define schema rules on entries in the directory. It is customary to create a file to contain definitions of your custom schema items. We recommend you create a file <TT>local.schema</TT> in <TT>/usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/local.schema</TT> and then include this file in your <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file immediately after other schema <TT>include</TT> directives.</P>
<PRE>
# include schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
# include local schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/local.schema
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Attribute Type Specification">13.2.4. Attribute Type Specification</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>attributetype</EM> directive is used to define a new attribute type. The directive uses the same Attribute Type Description (as defined in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A>) used by the attributeTypes attribute found in the subschema subentry, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
attributetype <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Attribute Type Description>
</PRE>
<P>where Attribute Type Description is defined by the following <TERM>ABNF</TERM>:</P>
<PRE>
AttributeTypeDescription = "(" whsp
numericoid whsp ; AttributeType identifier
[ "NAME" qdescrs ] ; name used in AttributeType
[ "DESC" qdstring ] ; description
[ "OBSOLETE" whsp ]
[ "SUP" woid ] ; derived from this other
; AttributeType
[ "EQUALITY" woid ; Matching Rule name
[ "ORDERING" woid ; Matching Rule name
[ "SUBSTR" woid ] ; Matching Rule name
[ "SYNTAX" whsp noidlen whsp ] ; Syntax OID
[ "SINGLE-VALUE" whsp ] ; default multi-valued
[ "COLLECTIVE" whsp ] ; default not collective
[ "NO-USER-MODIFICATION" whsp ]; default user modifiable
[ "USAGE" whsp AttributeUsage ]; default userApplications
whsp ")"
AttributeUsage =
"userApplications" /
"directoryOperation" /
"distributedOperation" / ; DSA-shared
"dSAOperation" ; DSA-specific, value depends on server
</PRE>
<P>where whsp is a space ('<TT> </TT>'), numericoid is a globally unique OID in dotted-decimal form (e.g. <TT>1.1.0</TT>), qdescrs is one or more names, woid is either the name or OID optionally followed by a length specifier (e.g <TT>{10</TT>}).</P>
<P>For example, the attribute types <TT>name</TT> and <TT>cn</TT> are defined in <TT>core.schema</TT> as:</P>
<PRE>
attributeType ( 2.5.4.41 NAME 'name'
DESC 'name(s) associated with the object'
EQUALITY caseIgnoreMatch
SUBSTR caseIgnoreSubstringsMatch
SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.15{32768} )
attributeType ( 2.5.4.3 NAME ( 'cn' 'commonName' )
DESC 'common name(s) assciated with the object'
SUP name )
</PRE>
<P>Notice that each defines the attribute's OID, provides a short name, and a brief description. Each name is an alias for the OID. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) returns the first listed name when returning results.</P>
<P>The first attribute, <TT>name</TT>, holds values of <TT>directoryString</TT> (<TERM>UTF-8</TERM> encoded Unicode) syntax. The syntax is specified by OID (1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.15 identifies the directoryString syntax). A length recommendation of 32768 is specified. Servers should support values of this length, but may support longer values. The field does NOT specify a size constraint, so is ignored on servers (such as slapd) which don't impose such size limits. In addition, the equality and substring matching uses case ignore rules. Below are tables listing commonly used syntax and matching rules (<EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports these and many more).</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 8.3: Commonly Used Syntaxes</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Name</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>OID</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>boolean</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.7</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
boolean value
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>directoryString</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.15</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
Unicode (UTF-8) string
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>distinguishedName</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.12</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP <TERM>DN</TERM>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>integer</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.27</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
integer
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>numericString</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.36</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
numeric string
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>OID</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.38</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
object identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>octetString</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.40</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
arbitrary octets
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<PRE>
</PRE>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 8.4: Commonly Used Matching Rules</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Name</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Type</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>booleanMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
boolean
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseIgnoreMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
case insensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseIgnoreOrderingMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
ordering
</TD>
<TD>
case insensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseIgnoreSubstringsMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
substrings
</TD>
<TD>
case insensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseExactMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
case sensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseExactOrderingMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
ordering
</TD>
<TD>
case sensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>caseExactSubstringsMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
substrings
</TD>
<TD>
case sensitive, space insensitive
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>distinguishedNameMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
distinguished name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>integerMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
integer
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>integerOrderingMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
ordering
</TD>
<TD>
integer
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>numericStringMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
numerical
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>numericStringOrderingMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
ordering
</TD>
<TD>
numerical
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>numericStringSubstringsMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
substrings
</TD>
<TD>
numerical
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>octetStringMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
octet string
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>octetStringOrderingMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
ordering
</TD>
<TD>
octet string
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>octetStringSubstringsMatch ordering</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
octet st
</TD>
<TD>
ring
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TT>objectIdentiferMatch</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
equality
</TD>
<TD>
object identifier
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P>The second attribute, <TT>cn</TT>, is a subtype of <TT>name</TT> hence it inherits the syntax, matching rules, and usage of <TT>name</TT>. <TT>commonName</TT> is an alternative name.</P>
<P>Neither attribute is restricted to a single value. Both are meant for usage by user applications. Neither is obsolete nor collective.</P>
<P>The following subsections provide a couple of examples.</P>
<H4><A NAME="x-my-UniqueName">13.2.4.1. x-my-UniqueName</A></H4>
<P>Many organizations maintain a single unique name for each user. Though one could use <TT>displayName</TT> (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt">RFC2798</A>), this attribute is really meant to be controlled by the user, not the organization. We could just copy the definition of <TT>displayName</TT> from <TT>inetorgperson.schema</TT> and replace the OID, name, and description, e.g:</P>
<PRE>
attributetype ( 1.1.2.1.1 NAME 'x-my-UniqueName'
DESC 'unique name with my organization'
EQUALITY caseIgnoreMatch
SUBSTR caseIgnoreSubstringsMatch
SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.15
SINGLE-VALUE )
</PRE>
<P>However, if we want this name to be used in <TT>name</TT> assertions, e.g. <TT>(name=*Jane*)</TT>, the attribute could alternatively be defined as a subtype of <TT>name</TT>, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
attributetype ( 1.1.2.1.1 NAME 'x-my-UniqueName'
DESC 'unique name with my organization'
SUP name )
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="x-my-Photo">13.2.4.2. x-my-Photo</A></H4>
<P>Many organizations maintain a photo of each each user. A <TT>x-my-Photo</TT> attribute type could be defined to hold a photo. Of course, one could use just use <TT>jpegPhoto</TT> (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt">RFC2798</A>) (or a subtype) to hold the photo. However, you can only do this if the photo is in <EM>JPEG File Interchange Format</EM>. Alternatively, an attribute type which uses the <EM>Octet String</EM> syntax can be defined, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
attributetype ( 1.1.2.1.2 NAME 'x-my-Photo'
DESC 'a photo (application defined format)'
SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.40
SINGLE-VALUE )
</PRE>
<P>In this case, the syntax doesn't specify the format of the photo. It's assumed (maybe incorrectly) that all applications accessing this attribute agree on the handling of values.</P>
<P>If you wanted to support multiple photo formats, you could define a separate attribute type for each format, prefix the photo with some typing information, or describe the value using <TERM>ASN.1</TERM> and use the <TT>;binary</TT> transfer option.</P>
<P>Another alternative is for the attribute to hold a <TERM>URI</TERM> pointing to the photo. You can model such an attribute after <TT>labeledURI</TT> (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2079.txt">RFC2079</A>) or simply create a subtype, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
attributetype ( 1.1.2.1.3 NAME 'x-my-PhotoURI'
DESC 'URI and optional label referring to a photo'
SUP labeledURI )
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Object Class Specification">13.2.5. Object Class Specification</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>objectclasses</EM> directive is used to define a new object class. The directive uses the same Object Class Description (as defined in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A>) used by the objectClasses attribute found in the subschema subentry, e.g.:</P>
<PRE>
objectclass <<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A> Object Class Description>
</PRE>
<P>where Object Class Description is defined by the following <TERM>ABNF</TERM>:</P>
<PRE>
ObjectClassDescription = "(" whsp
numericoid whsp ; ObjectClass identifier
[ "NAME" qdescrs ]
[ "DESC" qdstring ]
[ "OBSOLETE" whsp ]
[ "SUP" oids ] ; Superior ObjectClasses
[ ( "ABSTRACT" / "STRUCTURAL" / "AUXILIARY" ) whsp ]
; default structural
[ "MUST" oids ] ; AttributeTypes
[ "MAY" oids ] ; AttributeTypes
whsp ")"
</PRE>
<P>where whsp is a space ('<TT> </TT>'), numericoid is a globally unique OID in dotted-decimal form (e.g. <TT>1.1.0</TT>), qdescrs is one or more names, and oids is one or more names and/or OIDs.</P>
<H4><A NAME="x-my-PhotoObject">13.2.5.1. x-my-PhotoObject</A></H4>
<P>To define an <EM>auxiliary</EM> object class which allows x-my-Photo to be added to any existing entry.</P>
<PRE>
objectclass ( 1.1.2.2.1 NAME 'x-my-PhotoObject'
DESC 'mixin x-my-Photo'
AUXILIARY
MAY x-my-Photo )
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="x-my-Person">13.2.5.2. x-my-Person</A></H4>
<P>If your organization would like have a private <EM>structural</EM> object class to instantiate users, you can subclass one of the existing person classes, such as <TT>inetOrgPerson</TT> (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt">RFC2798</A>), and add any additional attributes which you desire.</P>
<PRE>
objectclass ( 1.1.2.2.2 NAME 'x-my-Person'
DESC 'my person'
SUP inetOrgPerson
MUST ( x-my-UniqueName $ givenName )
MAY x-my-Photo )
</PRE>
<P>The object class inherits the required/allowed attribute types of <TT>inetOrgPerson</TT> but requires <TT>x-my-UniqueName</TT> and <TT>givenName</TT> and allows <TT>x-my-Photo</TT>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="OID Macros">13.2.6. OID Macros</A></H3>
<P>To ease the management and use of OIDs, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports <EM>Object Identifier</EM> macros. The <TT>objectIdentifier</TT> directive is used to equate a macro (name) with a OID. The OID may possibly be derived from a previously defined OID macro. The <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) syntax is:</P>
<PRE>
objectIdentifier <name> { <oid> | <name>[:<suffix>] }
</PRE>
<P>The following demonstrates definition of a set of OID macros and their use in defining schema elements:</P>
<PRE>
objectIdentifier myOID 1.1
objectIdentifier mySNMP myOID:1
objectIdentifier myLDAP myOID:2
objectIdentifier myAttributeType myLDAP:1
objectIdentifier myObjectClass myLDAP:2
attributetype ( myAttributeType:3 NAME 'x-my-PhotoURI'
DESC 'URI and optional label referring to a photo'
SUP labeledURI )
objectclass ( myObjectClass:1 NAME 'x-my-PhotoObject'
DESC 'mixin x-my-Photo'
AUXILIARY
MAY x-my-Photo )
</PRE>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Security Considerations">14. Security Considerations</A></H1>
<P>OpenLDAP Software is designed to run in a wide variety of computing environments from tightly-controlled closed networks to the global Internet. Hence, OpenLDAP Software supports many different security mechanisms. This chapter describes these mechanisms and discusses security considerations for using OpenLDAP Software.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Network Security">14.1. Network Security</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Selective Listening">14.1.1. Selective Listening</A></H3>
<P>By default, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) will listen on both the IPv4 and IPv6 "any" addresses. It is often desirable to have <EM>slapd</EM> listen on select address/port pairs. For example, listening only on the IPv4 address <TT>127.0.0.1</TT> will disallow remote access to the directory server. E.g.:</P>
<PRE>
slapd -h ldap://127.0.0.1
</PRE>
<P>While the server can be configured to listen on a particular interface address, this doesn't necessarily restrict access to the server to only those networks accessible via that interface. To selective restrict remote access, it is recommend that an <A HREF="#IP Firewall">IP Firewall</A> be used to restrict access.</P>
<P>See <A HREF="#Command-line Options">Command-line Options</A> and <EM>slapd</EM>(8) for more information.</P>
<H3><A NAME="IP Firewall">14.1.2. IP Firewall</A></H3>
<P><TERM>IP</TERM> firewall capabilities of the server system can be used to restrict access based upon the client's IP address and/or network interface used to communicate with the client.</P>
<P>Generally, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) listens on port 389/tcp for <A HREF="ldap://">ldap://</A> sessions and port 636/tcp for <A HREF="ldaps://">ldaps://</A>) sessions. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) may be configured to listen on other ports.</P>
<P>As specifics of how to configure IP firewall are dependent on the particular kind of IP firewall used, no examples are provided here. See the document associated with your IP firewall.</P>
<H3><A NAME="TCP Wrappers">14.1.3. TCP Wrappers</A></H3>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports <TERM>TCP</TERM> Wrappers. TCP Wrappers provide a rule-based access control system for controlling TCP/IP access to the server. For example, the <EM>host_options</EM>(5) rule:</P>
<PRE>
slapd: 10.0.0.0/255.0.0.0 127.0.0.1 : ALLOW
slapd: ALL : DENY
</PRE>
<P>allows only incoming connections from the private network <TT>10.0.0.0</TT> and localhost (<TT>127.0.0.1</TT>) to access the directory service.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>IP addresses are used as <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is not normally configured to perform reverse lookups.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>It is noted that TCP wrappers require the connection to be accepted. As significant processing is required just to deny a connection, it is generally advised that IP firewall protection be used instead of TCP wrappers.</P>
<P>See <EM>hosts_access</EM>(5) for more information on TCP wrapper rules.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Data Integrity and Confidentiality Protection">14.2. Data Integrity and Confidentiality Protection</A></H2>
<P><TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> (TLS) can be used to provide data integrity and confidentiality protection. OpenLDAP supports negotiation of <TERM>TLS</TERM> (<TERM>SSL</TERM>) via both StartTLS and <A HREF="ldaps://">ldaps://</A>. See the <A HREF="#Using TLS">Using TLS</A> chapter for more information. StartTLS is the standard track mechanism.</P>
<P>A number of <TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM> (SASL) mechanisms, such as <TERM>DIGEST-MD5</TERM> and <TERM>GSSAPI</TERM>, also provide data integrity and confidentiality protection. See the <A HREF="#Using SASL">Using SASL</A> chapter for more information.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Security Strength Factors">14.2.1. Security Strength Factors</A></H3>
<P>The server uses <TERM>Security Strength Factor</TERM>s (SSF) to indicate the relative strength of protection. A SSF of zero (0) indicates no protections are in place. A SSF of one (1) indicates integrity protection are in place. A SSF greater than one (>1) roughly correlates to the effective encryption key length. For example, <TERM>DES</TERM> is 56, <TERM>3DES</TERM> is 112, and <TERM>AES</TERM> 128, 192, or 256.</P>
<P>A number of administrative controls rely on SSFs associated with TLS and SASL protection in place on an LDAP session.</P>
<P><TT>security</TT> controls disallow operations when appropriate protections are not in place. For example:</P>
<PRE>
security ssf=1 update_ssf=112
</PRE>
<P>requires integrity protection for all operations and encryption protection, 3DES equivalent, for update operations (e.g. add, delete, modify, etc.). See <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) for details.</P>
<P>For fine-grained control, SSFs may be used in access controls. See the <A HREF="#Access Control">Access Control</A> section for more information.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Authentication Methods">14.3. Authentication Methods</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME=""simple" method">14.3.1. "simple" method</A></H3>
<P>The LDAP "simple" method has three modes of operation:</P>
<UL>
<LI>anonymous,
<LI>unauthenticated, and
<LI>user/password authenticated.</UL>
<P>Anonymous access is requested by providing no name and no password to the "simple" bind operation. Unauthenticated access is requested by providing a name but no password. Authenticated access is requested by providing a valid name and password.</P>
<P>An anonymous bind results in an <EM>anonymous</EM> authorization association. Anonymous bind mechanism is enabled by default, but can be disabled by specifying "<TT>disallow bind_anon</TT>" in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5).</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Disabling the anonymous bind mechanism does not prevent anonymous access to the directory. To require authentication to access the directory, one should instead specify "<TT>require authc</TT>".
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>An unauthenticated bind also results in an <EM>anonymous</EM> authorization association. Unauthenticated bind mechanism is disabled by default, but can be enabled by specifying "<TT>allow bind_anon_cred</TT>" in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5). As a number of LDAP applications mistakenly generate unauthenticated bind request when authenticated access was intended (that is, they do not ensure a password was provided), this mechanism should generally remain disabled.</P>
<P>A successful user/password authenticated bind results in a user authorization identity, the provided name, being associated with the session. User/password authenticated bind is enabled by default. However, as this mechanism itself offers no eavesdropping protection (e.g., the password is set in the clear), it is recommended that it be used only in tightly controlled systems or when the LDAP session is protected by other means (e.g., TLS, <TERM>IPsec</TERM>). Where the administrator relies on TLS to protect the password, it is recommended that unprotected authentication be disabled. This is done using the <TT>security</TT> directive's <TT>simple_bind</TT> option, which provides fine grain control over the level of confidential protection to require for <EM>simple</EM> user/password authentication. E.g., using <TT>security simple_bind=56</TT> would require <EM>simple</EM> binds to use encryption of DES equivalent or better.</P>
<P>The user/password authenticated bind mechanism can be completely disabled by setting "<TT>disallow bind_simple</TT>".</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>An unsuccessful bind always results in the session having an <EM>anonymous</EM> authorization association.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="SASL method">14.3.2. SASL method</A></H3>
<P>The LDAP <TERM>SASL</TERM> method allows the use of any SASL authentication mechanism. The <A HREF="#Using SASL">Using SASL</A> section discusses the use of SASL.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Password Storage">14.4. Password Storage</A></H2>
<P>LDAP passwords are normally stored in the <EM>userPassword</EM> attribute. <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4519.txt">RFC4519</A> specifies that passwords are not stored in encrypted (or hashed) form. This allows a wide range of password-based authentication mechanisms, such as <TT>DIGEST-MD5</TT> to be used. This is also the most interoperable storage scheme.</P>
<P>However, it may be desirable to store a hash of password instead. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports a variety of storage schemes for the administrator to choose from.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Values of password attributes, regardless of storage scheme used, should be protected as if they were clear text. Hashed passwords are subject to <EM>dictionary attacks</EM> and <EM>brute-force attacks</EM>.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>The <EM>userPassword</EM> attribute is allowed to have more than one value, and it is possible for each value to be stored in a different form. During authentication, <EM>slapd</EM> will iterate through the values until it finds one that matches the offered password or until it runs out of values to inspect. The storage scheme is stored as a prefix on the value, so a hashed password using the Salted SHA1 (<TT>SSHA</TT>) scheme looks like:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SSHA}DkMTwBl+a/3DQTxCYEApdUtNXGgdUac3
</PRE>
<P>The advantage of hashed passwords is that an attacker which discovers the hash does not have direct access to the actual password. Unfortunately, as dictionary and brute force attacks are generally quite easy for attackers to successfully mount, this advantage is marginal at best (this is why all modern Unix systems use shadow password files).</P>
<P>The disadvantages of hashed storage is that they are non-standard, may cause interoperability problem, and generally preclude the use of stronger than Simple (or SASL/PLAIN) password-based authentication mechanisms such as <TT>DIGEST-MD5</TT>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="SSHA password storage scheme">14.4.1. SSHA password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>This is the salted version of the SHA scheme. It is believed to be the most secure password storage scheme supported by <EM>slapd</EM>.</P>
<P>These values represent the same password:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SSHA}DkMTwBl+a/3DQTxCYEApdUtNXGgdUac3
userPassword: {SSHA}d0Q0626PSH9VUld7yWpR0k6BlpQmtczb
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="CRYPT password storage scheme">14.4.2. CRYPT password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>This scheme uses the operating system's <EM>crypt(3)</EM> hash function. It normally produces the traditional Unix-style 13 character hash, but on systems with <TT>glibc2</TT> it can also generate the more secure 34-byte MD5 hash.</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {CRYPT}aUihad99hmev6
userPassword: {CRYPT}$1$czBJdDqS$TmkzUAb836oMxg/BmIwN.1
</PRE>
<P>The advantage of the CRYPT scheme is that passwords can be transferred to or from an existing Unix password file without having to know the cleartext form. Both forms of <EM>crypt</EM> include salt so they have some resistance to dictionary attacks.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Since this scheme uses the operating system's <EM>crypt(3)</EM> hash function, it is therefore operating system specific.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="MD5 password storage scheme">14.4.3. MD5 password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>This scheme simply takes the MD5 hash of the password and stores it in base64 encoded form:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {MD5}Xr4ilOzQ4PCOq3aQ0qbuaQ==
</PRE>
<P>Although safer than cleartext storage, this is not a very secure scheme. The MD5 algorithm is fast, and because there is no salt the scheme is vulnerable to a dictionary attack.</P>
<H3><A NAME="SMD5 password storage scheme">14.4.4. SMD5 password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>This improves on the basic MD5 scheme by adding salt (random data which means that there are many possible representations of a given plaintext password). For example, both of these values represent the same password:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SMD5}4QWGWZpj9GCmfuqEvm8HtZhZS6E=
userPassword: {SMD5}g2/J/7D5EO6+oPdklp5p8YtNFk4=
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="SHA password storage scheme">14.4.5. SHA password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>Like the MD5 scheme, this simply feeds the password through an SHA hash process. SHA is thought to be more secure than MD5, but the lack of salt leaves the scheme exposed to dictionary attacks.</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SHA}5en6G6MezRroT3XKqkdPOmY/BfQ=
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="SASL password storage scheme">14.4.6. SASL password storage scheme</A></H3>
<P>This is not really a password storage scheme at all. It uses the value of the <EM>userPassword</EM> attribute to delegate password verification to another process. See below for more information.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>This is not the same as using SASL to authenticate the LDAP session.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="Pass-Through authentication">14.5. Pass-Through authentication</A></H2>
<P>Since OpenLDAP 2.0 <EM>slapd</EM> has had the ability to delegate password verification to a separate process. This uses the <EM>sasl_checkpass(3)</EM> function so it can use any back-end server that Cyrus SASL supports for checking passwords. The choice is very wide, as one option is to use <EM>saslauthd(8)</EM> which in turn can use local files, Kerberos, an IMAP server, another LDAP server, or anything supported by the PAM mechanism.</P>
<P>The server must be built with the <TT>--enable-spasswd</TT> configuration option to enable pass-through authentication.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>This is not the same as using a SASL mechanism to authenticate the LDAP session.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Pass-Through authentication works only with plaintext passwords, as used in the "simple bind" and "SASL PLAIN" authentication mechanisms.}}</P>
<P>Pass-Through authentication is selective: it only affects users whose <EM>userPassword</EM> attribute has a value marked with the "{SASL}" scheme. The format of the attribute is:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SASL}username@realm
</PRE>
<P>The <EM>username</EM> and <EM>realm</EM> are passed to the SASL authentication mechanism and are used to identify the account whose password is to be verified. This allows arbitrary mapping between entries in OpenLDAP and accounts known to the backend authentication service.</P>
<P>It would be wise to use access control to prevent users from changing their passwords through LDAP where they have pass-through authentication enabled.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Configuring slapd to use an authentication provider">14.5.1. Configuring slapd to use an authentication provider</A></H3>
<P>Where an entry has a "{SASL}" password value, OpenLDAP delegates the whole process of validating that entry's password to Cyrus SASL. All the configuration is therefore done in SASL config files.</P>
<P>The first file to be considered is confusingly named <EM>slapd.conf</EM> and is typically found in the SASL library directory, often <TT>/usr/lib/sasl2/slapd.conf</TT> This file governs the use of SASL when talking LDAP to <EM>slapd</EM> as well as the use of SASL backends for pass-through authentication. See <TT>options.html</TT> in the <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A> docs for full details. Here is a simple example for a server that will use <EM>saslauthd</EM> to verify passwords:</P>
<PRE>
mech_list: plain
pwcheck_method: saslauthd
saslauthd_path: /var/run/sasl2/mux
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Configuring saslauthd">14.5.2. Configuring saslauthd</A></H3>
<P><EM>saslauthd</EM> is capable of using many different authentication services: see <EM>saslauthd(8)</EM> for details. A common requirement is to delegate some or all authentication to another LDAP server. Here is a sample <TT>saslauthd.conf</TT> that uses Microsoft Active Directory (AD):</P>
<PRE>
ldap_servers: ldap://dc1.example.com/ ldap://dc2.example.com/
ldap_search_base: cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com
ldap_filter: (userPrincipalName=%u)
ldap_bind_dn: cn=saslauthd,cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com
ldap_password: secret
</PRE>
<P>In this case, <EM>saslauthd</EM> is run with the <TT>ldap</TT> authentication mechanism and is set to combine the SASL realm with the login name:</P>
<PRE>
saslauthd -a ldap -r
</PRE>
<P>This means that the "username@realm" string from the <EM>userPassword</EM> attribute ends up being used to search AD for "userPrincipalName=username@realm" - the password is then verified by attempting to bind to AD using the entry found by the search and the password supplied by the LDAP client.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Testing pass-through authentication">14.5.3. Testing pass-through authentication</A></H3>
<P>It is usually best to start with the back-end authentication provider and work through <EM>saslauthd</EM> and <EM>slapd</EM> towards the LDAP client.</P>
<P>In the AD example above, first check that the DN and password that <EM>saslauthd</EM> will use when it connects to AD are valid:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://dc1.example.com/ \
-D cn=saslauthd,cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com \
-w secret \
-b '' \
-s base
</PRE>
<P>Next check that a sample AD user can be found:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://dc1.example.com/ \
-D cn=saslauthd,cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com \
-w secret \
-b cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com \
"(userPrincipalName=user@ad.example.com)"
</PRE>
<P>Check that the user can bind to AD:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -H ldap://dc1.example.com/ \
-D cn=user,cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com \
-w userpassword \
-b cn=user,cn=Users,DC=ad,DC=example,DC=com \
-s base \
"(objectclass=*)"
</PRE>
<P>If all that works then <EM>saslauthd</EM> should be able to do the same:</P>
<PRE>
testsaslauthd -u user@ad.example.com -p userpassword
testsaslauthd -u user@ad.example.com -p wrongpassword
</PRE>
<P>Now put the magic token into an entry in OpenLDAP:</P>
<PRE>
userPassword: {SASL}user@ad.example.com
</PRE>
<P>It should now be possible to bind to OpenLDAP using the DN of that entry and the password of the AD user.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Using SASL">15. Using SASL</A></H1>
<P>OpenLDAP clients and servers are capable of authenticating via the <TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM> (<TERM>SASL</TERM>) framework, which is detailed in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422.txt">RFC4422</A>. This chapter describes how to make use of SASL in OpenLDAP.</P>
<P>There are several industry standard authentication mechanisms that can be used with SASL, including <TERM>GSSAPI</TERM> for <TERM>Kerberos</TERM> V, <TERM>DIGEST-MD5</TERM>, and <TERM>PLAIN</TERM> and <TERM>EXTERNAL</TERM> for use with <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> (TLS).</P>
<P>The standard client tools provided with OpenLDAP Software, such as <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) and <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1), will by default attempt to authenticate the user to the <TERM>LDAP</TERM> directory server using SASL. Basic authentication service can be set up by the LDAP administrator with a few steps, allowing users to be authenticated to the slapd server as their LDAP entry. With a few extra steps, some users and services can be allowed to exploit SASL's proxy authorization feature, allowing them to authenticate themselves and then switch their identity to that of another user or service.</P>
<P>This chapter assumes you have read <EM>Cyrus SASL for System Administrators</EM>, provided with the <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A> package (in <TT>doc/sysadmin.html</TT>) and have a working Cyrus SASL installation. You should use the Cyrus SASL <TT>sample_client</TT> and <TT>sample_server</TT> to test your SASL installation before attempting to make use of it with OpenLDAP Software.</P>
<P>Note that in the following text the term <EM>user</EM> is used to describe a person or application entity who is connecting to the LDAP server via an LDAP client, such as <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1). That is, the term <EM>user</EM> not only applies to both an individual using an LDAP client, but to an application entity which issues LDAP client operations without direct user control. For example, an e-mail server which uses LDAP operations to access information held in an LDAP server is an application entity.</P>
<H2><A NAME="SASL Security Considerations">15.1. SASL Security Considerations</A></H2>
<P>SASL offers many different authentication mechanisms. This section briefly outlines security considerations.</P>
<P>Some mechanisms, such as PLAIN and LOGIN, offer no greater security over LDAP <EM>simple</EM> authentication. Like LDAP <EM>simple</EM> authentication, such mechanisms should not be used unless you have adequate security protections in place. It is recommended that these mechanisms be used only in conjunction with <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> (TLS). Use of PLAIN and LOGIN are not discussed further in this document.</P>
<P>The DIGEST-MD5 mechanism is the mandatory-to-implement authentication mechanism for LDAPv3. Though DIGEST-MD5 is not a strong authentication mechanism in comparison with trusted third party authentication systems (such as <TERM>Kerberos</TERM> or public key systems), it does offer significant protections against a number of attacks. Unlike the <TERM>CRAM-MD5</TERM> mechanism, it prevents chosen plaintext attacks. DIGEST-MD5 is favored over the use of plaintext password mechanisms. The CRAM-MD5 mechanism is deprecated in favor of DIGEST-MD5. Use of <A HREF="#DIGEST-MD5">DIGEST-MD5</A> is discussed below.</P>
<P>The GSSAPI mechanism utilizes <TERM>GSS-API</TERM> <TERM>Kerberos</TERM> V to provide secure authentication services. The KERBEROS_V4 mechanism is available for those using Kerberos IV. Kerberos is viewed as a secure, distributed authentication system suitable for both small and large enterprises. Use of <A HREF="#GSSAPI">GSSAPI</A> and <A HREF="#KERBEROS_V4">KERBEROS_V4</A> are discussed below.</P>
<P>The EXTERNAL mechanism utilizes authentication services provided by lower level network services such as <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> (<TERM>TLS</TERM>). When used in conjunction with <TERM>TLS</TERM> <TERM>X.509</TERM>-based public key technology, EXTERNAL offers strong authentication. TLS is discussed in the <A HREF="#Using TLS">Using TLS</A> chapter.</P>
<P>EXTERNAL can also be used with the <TT>ldapi:///</TT> transport, as Unix-domain sockets can report the UID and GID of the client process.</P>
<P>There are other strong authentication mechanisms to choose from, including <TERM>OTP</TERM> (one time passwords) and <TERM>SRP</TERM> (secure remote passwords). These mechanisms are not discussed in this document.</P>
<H2><A NAME="SASL Authentication">15.2. SASL Authentication</A></H2>
<P>Getting basic SASL authentication running involves a few steps. The first step configures your slapd server environment so that it can communicate with client programs using the security system in place at your site. This usually involves setting up a service key, a public key, or other form of secret. The second step concerns mapping authentication identities to LDAP <TERM>DN</TERM>'s, which depends on how entries are laid out in your directory. An explanation of the first step will be given in the next section using Kerberos V4 as an example mechanism. The steps necessary for your site's authentication mechanism will be similar, but a guide to every mechanism available under SASL is beyond the scope of this chapter. The second step is described in the section <A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">Mapping Authentication Identities</A>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="GSSAPI">15.2.1. GSSAPI</A></H3>
<P>This section describes the use of the SASL GSSAPI mechanism and Kerberos V with OpenLDAP. It will be assumed that you have Kerberos V deployed, you are familiar with the operation of the system, and that your users are trained in its use. This section also assumes you have familiarized yourself with the use of the GSSAPI mechanism by reading <EM>Configuring GSSAPI and Cyrus SASL</EM> (provided with Cyrus SASL in the <TT>doc/gssapi</TT> file) and successfully experimented with the Cyrus provided <TT>sample_server</TT> and <TT>sample_client</TT> applications. General information about Kerberos is available at <A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/</A>.</P>
<P>To use the GSSAPI mechanism with <EM>slapd</EM>(8) one must create a service key with a principal for <EM>ldap</EM> service within the realm for the host on which the service runs. For example, if you run <EM>slapd</EM> on <TT>directory.example.com</TT> and your realm is <TT>EXAMPLE.COM</TT>, you need to create a service key with the principal:</P>
<PRE>
ldap/directory.example.com@EXAMPLE.COM
</PRE>
<P>When <EM>slapd</EM>(8) runs, it must have access to this key. This is generally done by placing the key into a keytab file, <TT>/etc/krb5.keytab</TT>. See your Kerberos and Cyrus SASL documentation for information regarding keytab location settings.</P>
<P>To use the GSSAPI mechanism to authenticate to the directory, the user obtains a Ticket Granting Ticket (TGT) prior to running the LDAP client. When using OpenLDAP client tools, the user may mandate use of the GSSAPI mechanism by specifying <TT>-Y GSSAPI</TT> as a command option.</P>
<P>For the purposes of authentication and authorization, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) associates an authentication request DN of the form:</P>
<PRE>
uid=<primary[/instance]>,cn=<realm>,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>Continuing our example, a user with the Kerberos principal <TT>kurt@EXAMPLE.COM</TT> would have the associated DN:</P>
<PRE>
uid=kurt,cn=example.com,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>and the principal <TT>ursula/admin@FOREIGN.REALM</TT> would have the associated DN:</P>
<PRE>
uid=ursula/admin,cn=foreign.realm,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>The authentication request DN can be used directly ACLs and <TT>groupOfNames</TT> "member" attributes, since it is of legitimate LDAP DN format. Or alternatively, the authentication DN could be mapped before use. See the section <A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">Mapping Authentication Identities</A> for details.</P>
<H3><A NAME="KERBEROS_V4">15.2.2. KERBEROS_V4</A></H3>
<P>This section describes the use of the SASL KERBEROS_V4 mechanism with OpenLDAP. It will be assumed that you are familiar with the workings of the Kerberos IV security system, and that your site has Kerberos IV deployed. Your users should be familiar with authentication policy, how to receive credentials in a Kerberos ticket cache, and how to refresh expired credentials.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>KERBEROS_V4 and Kerberos IV are deprecated in favor of GSSAPI and Kerberos V.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Client programs will need to be able to obtain a session key for use when connecting to your LDAP server. This allows the LDAP server to know the identity of the user, and allows the client to know it is connecting to a legitimate server. If encryption layers are to be used, the session key can also be used to help negotiate that option.</P>
<P>The slapd server runs the service called "<EM>ldap</EM>", and the server will require a srvtab file with a service key. SASL aware client programs will be obtaining an "ldap" service ticket with the user's ticket granting ticket (TGT), with the instance of the ticket matching the hostname of the OpenLDAP server. For example, if your realm is named <TT>EXAMPLE.COM</TT> and the slapd server is running on the host named <TT>directory.example.com</TT>, the <TT>/etc/srvtab</TT> file on the server will have a service key</P>
<PRE>
ldap.directory@EXAMPLE.COM
</PRE>
<P>When an LDAP client is authenticating a user to the directory using the KERBEROS_IV mechanism, it will request a session key for that same principal, either from the ticket cache or by obtaining a new one from the Kerberos server. This will require the TGT to be available and valid in the cache as well. If it is not present or has expired, the client may print out the message:</P>
<PRE>
ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Local error
</PRE>
<P>When the service ticket is obtained, it will be passed to the LDAP server as proof of the user's identity. The server will extract the identity and realm out of the service ticket using SASL library calls, and convert them into an <EM>authentication request DN</EM> of the form</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=<realm>,cn=<mechanism>,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>So in our above example, if the user's name were "adamson", the authentication request DN would be:</P>
<PRE>
uid=adamsom,cn=example.com,cn=kerberos_v4,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>This authentication request DN can be used directly ACLs or, alternatively, mapped prior to use. See the section <A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">Mapping Authentication Identities</A> for details.</P>
<H3><A NAME="DIGEST-MD5">15.2.3. DIGEST-MD5</A></H3>
<P>This section describes the use of the SASL DIGEST-MD5 mechanism using secrets stored either in the directory itself or in Cyrus SASL's own database. DIGEST-MD5 relies on the client and the server sharing a "secret", usually a password. The server generates a challenge and the client a response proving that it knows the shared secret. This is much more secure than simply sending the secret over the wire.</P>
<P>Cyrus SASL supports several shared-secret mechanisms. To do this, it needs access to the plaintext password (unlike mechanisms which pass plaintext passwords over the wire, where the server can store a hashed version of the password).</P>
<P>The server's copy of the shared-secret may be stored in Cyrus SASL's own <EM>sasldb</EM> database, in an external system accessed via <EM>saslauthd</EM>, or in LDAP database itself. In either case it is very important to apply file access controls and LDAP access controls to prevent exposure of the passwords. The configuration and commands discussed in this section assume the use of Cyrus SASL 2.1.</P>
<P>To use secrets stored in <EM>sasldb</EM>, simply add users with the <EM>saslpasswd2</EM> command:</P>
<PRE>
saslpasswd2 -c <username>
</PRE>
<P>The passwords for such users must be managed with the <EM>saslpasswd2</EM> command.</P>
<P>To use secrets stored in the LDAP directory, place plaintext passwords in the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute. It will be necessary to add an option to <TT>slapd.conf</TT> to make sure that passwords set using the LDAP Password Modify Operation are stored in plaintext:</P>
<PRE>
password-hash {CLEARTEXT}
</PRE>
<P>Passwords stored in this way can be managed either with <EM>ldappasswd</EM>(1) or by simply modifying the <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute. Regardless of where the passwords are stored, a mapping will be needed from authentication request DN to user's DN.</P>
<P>The DIGEST-MD5 mechanism produces authentication IDs of the form:</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=<realm>,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>If the default realm is used, the realm name is omitted from the ID, giving:</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>See <A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">Mapping Authentication Identities</A> below for information on optional mapping of identities.</P>
<P>With suitable mappings in place, users can specify SASL IDs when performing LDAP operations, and the password stored in <EM>sasldb</EM> or in the directory itself will be used to verify the authentication. For example, the user identified by the directory entry:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Andrew Findlay+uid=u000997,dc=example,dc=com
objectclass: inetOrgPerson
objectclass: person
sn: Findlay
uid: u000997
userPassword: secret
</PRE>
<P>can issue commands of the form:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -Y DIGEST-MD5 -U u000997 ...
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>in each of the above cases, no authorization identity (e.g. <TT>-X</TT>) was provided. Unless you are attempting <A HREF="#SASL Proxy Authorization">SASL Proxy Authorization</A>, no authorization identity should be specified. The server will infer an authorization identity from authentication identity (as described below).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="EXTERNAL">15.2.4. EXTERNAL</A></H3>
<P>The SASL EXTERNAL mechanism makes use of an authentication performed by a lower-level protocol: usually <TERM>TLS</TERM> or Unix <TERM>IPC</TERM></P>
<P>Each transport protocol returns Authentication Identities in its own format:</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS Authentication Identity Format">15.2.4.1. TLS Authentication Identity Format</A></H4>
<P>This is the Subject DN from the client-side certificate. Note that DNs are displayed differently by LDAP and by X.509, so a certificate issued to</P>
<PRE>
C=gb, O=The Example Organisation, CN=A Person
</PRE>
<P>will produce an authentication identity of:</P>
<PRE>
cn=A Person,o=The Example Organisation,c=gb
</PRE>
<P>Note that you must set a suitable value for TLSVerifyClient to make the server request the use of a client-side certificate. Without this, the SASL EXTERNAL mechanism will not be offered. Refer to the <A HREF="#Using TLS">Using TLS</A> chapter for details.</P>
<H4><A NAME="IPC (ldapi:///) Identity Format">15.2.4.2. IPC (ldapi:///) Identity Format</A></H4>
<P>This is formed from the Unix UID and GID of the client process:</P>
<PRE>
gidNumber=<number>+uidNumber=<number>,cn=peercred,cn=external,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>Thus, a client process running as <TT>root</TT> will be:</P>
<PRE>
gidNumber=0+uidNumber=0,cn=peercred,cn=external,cn=auth
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Mapping Authentication Identities">15.2.5. Mapping Authentication Identities</A></H3>
<P>The authentication mechanism in the slapd server will use SASL library calls to obtain the authenticated user's "username", based on whatever underlying authentication mechanism was used. This username is in the namespace of the authentication mechanism, and not in the normal LDAP namespace. As stated in the sections above, that username is reformatted into an authentication request DN of the form</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=<realm>,cn=<mechanism>,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>or</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=<mechanism>,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>depending on whether or not <mechanism> employs the concept of "realms". Note also that the realm part will be omitted if the default realm was used in the authentication.</P>
<P>The <EM>ldapwhoami</EM>(1) command may be used to determine the identity associated with the user. It is very useful for determining proper function of mappings.</P>
<P>It is not intended that you should add LDAP entries of the above form to your LDAP database. Chances are you have an LDAP entry for each of the persons that will be authenticating to LDAP, laid out in your directory tree, and the tree does not start at cn=auth. But if your site has a clear mapping between the "username" and an LDAP entry for the person, you will be able to configure your LDAP server to automatically map a authentication request DN to the user's <EM>authentication DN</EM>.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>it is not required that the authentication request DN nor the user's authentication DN resulting from the mapping refer to an entry held in the directory. However, additional capabilities become available (see below).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>The LDAP administrator will need to tell the slapd server how to map an authentication request DN to a user's authentication DN. This is done by adding one or more <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directives to the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file. This directive takes two arguments:</P>
<PRE>
authz-regexp <search pattern> <replacement pattern>
</PRE>
<P>The authentication request DN is compared to the search pattern using the regular expression functions <EM>regcomp</EM>() and <EM>regexec</EM>(), and if it matches, it is rewritten as the replacement pattern. If there are multiple <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directives, only the first whose search pattern matches the authentication identity is used. The string that is output from the replacement pattern should be the authentication DN of the user or an LDAP URL. If replacement string produces a DN, the entry named by this DN need not be held by this server. If the replace string produces an LDAP URL, that LDAP URL must evaluate to one and only one entry held by this server.</P>
<P>The search pattern can contain any of the regular expression characters listed in <EM>regexec</EM>(3C). The main characters of note are dot ".", asterisk "*", and the open and close parenthesis "(" and ")". Essentially, the dot matches any character, the asterisk allows zero or more repeats of the immediately preceding character or pattern, and terms in parenthesis are remembered for the replacement pattern.</P>
<P>The replacement pattern will produce either a DN or URL referring to the user. Anything from the authentication request DN that matched a string in parenthesis in the search pattern is stored in the variable "$1". That variable "$1" can appear in the replacement pattern, and will be replaced by the string from the authentication request DN. If there were multiple sets of parentheses in the search pattern, the variables $2, $3, etc are used.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Direct Mapping">15.2.6. Direct Mapping</A></H3>
<P>Where possible, direct mapping of the authentication request DN to the user's DN is generally recommended. Aside from avoiding the expense of searching for the user's DN, it allows mapping to DNs which refer to entries not held by this server.</P>
<P>Suppose the authentication request DN is written as:</P>
<PRE>
uid=adamson,cn=example.com,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>and the user's actual LDAP entry is:</P>
<PRE>
uid=adamson,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>then the following <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directive in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) would provide for direct mapping.</P>
<PRE>
authz-regexp
uid=([^,]*),cn=example.com,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
uid=$1,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>An even more lenient rule could be written as</P>
<PRE>
authz-regexp
uid=([^,]*),cn=[^,]*,cn=auth
uid=$1,ou=people,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>Be careful about setting the search pattern too leniently, however, since it may mistakenly allow persons to become authenticated as a DN to which they should not have access. It is better to write several strict directives than one lenient directive which has security holes. If there is only one authentication mechanism in place at your site, and zero or one realms in use, you might be able to map between authentication identities and LDAP DN's with a single <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directive.</P>
<P>Don't forget to allow for the case where the realm is omitted as well as the case with an explicitly specified realm. This may well require a separate <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directive for each case, with the explicit-realm entry being listed first.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Search-based mappings">15.2.7. Search-based mappings</A></H3>
<P>There are a number of cases where mapping to a LDAP URL may be appropriate. For instance, some sites may have person objects located in multiple areas of the LDAP tree, such as if there were an <TT>ou=accounting</TT> tree and an <TT>ou=engineering</TT> tree, with persons interspersed between them. Or, maybe the desired mapping must be based upon information in the user's information. Consider the need to map the above authentication request DN to user whose entry is as follows:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Mark Adamson,ou=People,dc=Example,dc=COM
objectclass: person
cn: Mark Adamson
uid: adamson
</PRE>
<P>The information in the authentication request DN is insufficient to allow the user's DN to be directly derived, instead the user's DN must be searched for. For these situations, a replacement pattern which produces a LDAP URL can be used in the <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directives. This URL will then be used to perform an internal search of the LDAP database to find the person's authentication DN.</P>
<P>An LDAP URL, similar to other URL's, is of the form</P>
<PRE>
ldap://<host>/<base>?<attrs>?<scope>?<filter>
</PRE>
<P>This contains all of the elements necessary to perform an LDAP search: the name of the server <host>, the LDAP DN search base <base>, the LDAP attributes to retrieve <attrs>, the search scope <scope> which is one of the three options "base", "one", or "sub", and lastly an LDAP search filter <filter>. Since the search is for an LDAP DN within the current server, the <host> portion should be empty. The <attrs> field is also ignored since only the DN is of concern. These two elements are left in the format of the URL to maintain the clarity of what information goes where in the string.</P>
<P>Suppose that the person in the example from above did in fact have an authentication username of "adamson" and that information was kept in the attribute "uid" in their LDAP entry. The <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directive might be written as</P>
<PRE>
authz-regexp
uid=([^,]*),cn=example.com,cn=gssapi,cn=auth
ldap:///ou=people,dc=example,dc=com??one?(uid=$1)
</PRE>
<P>This will initiate an internal search of the LDAP database inside the slapd server. If the search returns exactly one entry, it is accepted as being the DN of the user. If there are more than one entries returned, or if there are zero entries returned, the authentication fails and the user's connection is left bound as the authentication request DN.</P>
<P>The attributes that are used in the search filter <filter> in the URL should be indexed to allow faster searching. If they are not, the authentication step alone can take uncomfortably long periods, and users may assume the server is down.</P>
<P>A more complex site might have several realms in use, each mapping to a different subtree in the directory. These can be handled with statements of the form:</P>
<PRE>
# Match Engineering realm
authz-regexp
uid=([^,]*),cn=engineering.example.com,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth
ldap:///dc=eng,dc=example,dc=com??one?(&(uid=$1)(objectClass=person))
# Match Accounting realm
authz-regexp
uid=([^,].*),cn=accounting.example.com,cn=digest-md5,cn=auth
ldap:///dc=accounting,dc=example,dc=com??one?(&(uid=$1)(objectClass=person))
# Default realm is customers.example.com
authz-regexp
uid=([^,]*),cn=digest-md5,cn=auth
ldap:///dc=customers,dc=example,dc=com??one?(&(uid=$1)(objectClass=person))
</PRE>
<P>Note that the explicitly-named realms are handled first, to avoid the realm name becoming part of the UID. Also note the use of scope and filters to limit matching to desirable entries.</P>
<P>Note as well that <TT>authz-regexp</TT> internal search are subject to access controls. Specifically, the authentication identity must have <TT>auth</TT> access.</P>
<P>See <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) for more detailed information.</P>
<H2><A NAME="SASL Proxy Authorization">15.3. SASL Proxy Authorization</A></H2>
<P>The SASL offers a feature known as <EM>proxy authorization</EM>, which allows an authenticated user to request that they act on the behalf of another user. This step occurs after the user has obtained an authentication DN, and involves sending an authorization identity to the server. The server will then make a decision on whether or not to allow the authorization to occur. If it is allowed, the user's LDAP connection is switched to have a binding DN derived from the authorization identity, and the LDAP session proceeds with the access of the new authorization DN.</P>
<P>The decision to allow an authorization to proceed depends on the rules and policies of the site where LDAP is running, and thus cannot be made by SASL alone. The SASL library leaves it up to the server to make the decision. The LDAP administrator sets the guidelines of who can authorize to what identity by adding information into the LDAP database entries. By default, the authorization features are disabled, and must be explicitly configured by the LDAP administrator before use.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Uses of Proxy Authorization">15.3.1. Uses of Proxy Authorization</A></H3>
<P>This sort of service is useful when one entity needs to act on the behalf of many other users. For example, users may be directed to a web page to make changes to their personal information in their LDAP entry. The users authenticate to the web server to establish their identity, but the web server CGI cannot authenticate to the LDAP server as that user to make changes for them. Instead, the web server authenticates itself to the LDAP server as a service identity, say,</P>
<PRE>
cn=WebUpdate,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>and then it will SASL authorize to the DN of the user. Once so authorized, the CGI makes changes to the LDAP entry of the user, and as far as the slapd server can tell for its ACLs, it is the user themself on the other end of the connection. The user could have connected to the LDAP server directly and authenticated as themself, but that would require the user to have more knowledge of LDAP clients, knowledge which the web page provides in an easier format.</P>
<P>Proxy authorization can also be used to limit access to an account that has greater access to the database. Such an account, perhaps even the root DN specified in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5), can have a strict list of people who can authorize to that DN. Changes to the LDAP database could then be only allowed by that DN, and in order to become that DN, users must first authenticate as one of the persons on the list. This allows for better auditing of who made changes to the LDAP database. If people were allowed to authenticate directly to the privileged account, possibly through the <TT>rootpw</TT> <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) directive or through a <TT>userPassword</TT> attribute, then auditing becomes more difficult.</P>
<P>Note that after a successful proxy authorization, the original authentication DN of the LDAP connection is overwritten by the new DN from the authorization request. If a service program is able to authenticate itself as its own authentication DN and then authorize to other DN's, and it is planning on switching to several different identities during one LDAP session, it will need to authenticate itself each time before authorizing to another DN (or use a different proxy authorization mechanism). The slapd server does not keep record of the service program's ability to switch to other DN's. On authentication mechanisms like Kerberos this will not require multiple connections being made to the Kerberos server, since the user's TGT and "ldap" session key are valid for multiple uses for the several hours of the ticket lifetime.</P>
<H3><A NAME="SASL Authorization Identities">15.3.2. SASL Authorization Identities</A></H3>
<P>The SASL authorization identity is sent to the LDAP server via the <TT>-X</TT> switch for <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) and other tools, or in the <TT>*authzid</TT> parameter to the <EM>lutil_sasl_defaults</EM>() call. The identity can be in one of two forms, either</P>
<PRE>
u:<username>
</PRE>
<P>or</P>
<PRE>
dn:<dn>
</PRE>
<P>In the first form, the <username> is from the same namespace as the authentication identities above. It is the user's username as it is referred to by the underlying authentication mechanism. Authorization identities of this form are converted into a DN format by the same function that the authentication process used, producing an <EM>authorization request DN</EM> of the form</P>
<PRE>
uid=<username>,cn=<realm>,cn=<mechanism>,cn=auth
</PRE>
<P>That authorization request DN is then run through the same <TT>authz-regexp</TT> process to convert it into a legitimate authorization DN from the database. If it cannot be converted due to a failed search from an LDAP URL, the authorization request fails with "inappropriate access". Otherwise, the DN string is now a legitimate authorization DN ready to undergo approval.</P>
<P>If the authorization identity was provided in the second form, with a <TT>"dn:"</TT> prefix, the string after the prefix is already in authorization DN form, ready to undergo approval.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Proxy Authorization Rules">15.3.3. Proxy Authorization Rules</A></H3>
<P>Once slapd has the authorization DN, the actual approval process begins. There are two attributes that the LDAP administrator can put into LDAP entries to allow authorization:</P>
<PRE>
authzTo
authzFrom
</PRE>
<P>Both can be multivalued. The <TT>authzTo</TT> attribute is a source rule, and it is placed into the entry associated with the authentication DN to tell what authorization DNs the authenticated DN is allowed to assume. The second attribute is a destination rule, and it is placed into the entry associated with the requested authorization DN to tell which authenticated DNs may assume it.</P>
<P>The choice of which authorization policy attribute to use is up to the administrator. Source rules are checked first in the person's authentication DN entry, and if none of the <TT>authzTo</TT> rules specify the authorization is permitted, the <TT>authzFrom</TT> rules in the authorization DN entry are then checked. If neither case specifies that the request be honored, the request is denied. Since the default behavior is to deny authorization requests, rules only specify that a request be allowed; there are no negative rules telling what authorizations to deny.</P>
<P>The value(s) in the two attributes are of the same form as the output of the replacement pattern of a <TT>authz-regexp</TT> directive: either a DN or an LDAP URL. For example, if a <TT>authzTo</TT> value is a DN, that DN is one the authenticated user can authorize to. On the other hand, if the <TT>authzTo</TT> value is an LDAP URL, the URL is used as an internal search of the LDAP database, and the authenticated user can become ANY DN returned by the search. If an LDAP entry looked like:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=WebUpdate,dc=example,dc=com
authzTo: ldap:///dc=example,dc=com??sub?(objectclass=person)
</PRE>
<P>then any user who authenticated as <TT>cn=WebUpdate,dc=example,dc=com</TT> could authorize to any other LDAP entry under the search base <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT> which has an objectClass of <TT>Person</TT>.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Notes on Proxy Authorization Rules">15.3.3.1. Notes on Proxy Authorization Rules</A></H4>
<P>An LDAP URL in a <TT>authzTo</TT> or <TT>authzFrom</TT> attribute will return a set of DNs. Each DN returned will be checked. Searches which return a large set can cause the authorization process to take an uncomfortably long time. Also, searches should be performed on attributes that have been indexed by slapd.</P>
<P>To help produce more sweeping rules for <TT>authzFrom</TT> and <TT>authzTo</TT>, the values of these attributes are allowed to be DNs with regular expression characters in them. This means a source rule like</P>
<PRE>
authzTo: dn.regex:^uid=[^,]*,dc=example,dc=com$
</PRE>
<P>would allow that authenticated user to authorize to any DN that matches the regular expression pattern given. This regular expression comparison can be evaluated much faster than an LDAP search for <TT>(uid=*)</TT>.</P>
<P>Also note that the values in an authorization rule must be one of the two forms: an LDAP URL or a DN (with or without regular expression characters). Anything that does not begin with "<TT>ldap://</TT>" is taken as a DN. It is not permissible to enter another authorization identity of the form "<TT>u:<username></TT>" as an authorization rule.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Policy Configuration">15.3.3.2. Policy Configuration</A></H4>
<P>The decision of which type of rules to use, <TT>authzFrom</TT> or <TT>authzTo</TT>, will depend on the site's situation. For example, if the set of people who may become a given identity can easily be written as a search filter, then a single destination rule could be written. If the set of people is not easily defined by a search filter, and the set of people is small, it may be better to write a source rule in the entries of each of those people who should be allowed to perform the proxy authorization.</P>
<P>By default, processing of proxy authorization rules is disabled. The <TT>authz-policy</TT> directive must be set in the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file to enable authorization. This directive can be set to <TT>none</TT> for no rules (the default), <TT>to</TT> for source rules, <TT>from</TT> for destination rules, or <TT>both</TT> for both source and destination rules.</P>
<P>Source rules are extremely powerful. If ordinary users have access to write the <TT>authzTo</TT> attribute in their own entries, then they can write rules that would allow them to authorize as anyone else. As such, when using source rules, the <TT>authzTo</TT> attribute should be protected with an ACL that only allows privileged users to set its values.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Using TLS">16. Using TLS</A></H1>
<P>OpenLDAP clients and servers are capable of using the <TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM> (<TERM>TLS</TERM>) framework to provide integrity and confidentiality protections and to support LDAP authentication using the <TERM>SASL</TERM> <TERM>EXTERNAL</TERM> mechanism. TLS is defined in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4346.txt">RFC4346</A>.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>For generating certifcates, please reference <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/185.html">http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/185.html</A>
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="TLS Certificates">16.1. TLS Certificates</A></H2>
<P>TLS uses <TERM>X.509</TERM> certificates to carry client and server identities. All servers are required to have valid certificates, whereas client certificates are optional. Clients must have a valid certificate in order to authenticate via SASL EXTERNAL. For more information on creating and managing certificates, see the <A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A>, <A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">GnuTLS</A>, or <A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">MozNSS</A> documentation, depending on which TLS implementation libraries you are using.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Server Certificates">16.1.1. Server Certificates</A></H3>
<P>The <TERM>DN</TERM> of a server certificate must use the <TT>CN</TT> attribute to name the server, and the <TT>CN</TT> must carry the server's fully qualified domain name. Additional alias names and wildcards may be present in the <TT>subjectAltName</TT> certificate extension. More details on server certificate names are in <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4513.txt">RFC4513</A>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Client Certificates">16.1.2. Client Certificates</A></H3>
<P>The DN of a client certificate can be used directly as an authentication DN. Since X.509 is a part of the <TERM>X.500</TERM> standard and LDAP is also based on X.500, both use the same DN formats and generally the DN in a user's X.509 certificate should be identical to the DN of their LDAP entry. However, sometimes the DNs may not be exactly the same, and so the mapping facility described in <A HREF="#Mapping Authentication Identities">Mapping Authentication Identities</A> can be applied to these DNs as well.</P>
<H2><A NAME="TLS Configuration">16.2. TLS Configuration</A></H2>
<P>After obtaining the required certificates, a number of options must be configured on both the client and the server to enable TLS and make use of the certificates. At a minimum, the clients must be configured with the name of the file containing all of the <TERM>Certificate Authority</TERM> (CA) certificates it will trust. The server must be configured with the <TERM>CA</TERM> certificates and also its own server certificate and private key.</P>
<P>Typically a single CA will have issued the server certificate and all of the trusted client certificates, so the server only needs to trust that one signing CA. However, a client may wish to connect to a variety of secure servers managed by different organizations, with server certificates generated by many different CAs. As such, a client is likely to need a list of many different trusted CAs in its configuration.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Server Configuration">16.2.1. Server Configuration</A></H3>
<P>The configuration directives for slapd belong in the global directives section of <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5).</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLSCACertificateFile <filename>">16.2.1.1. TLSCACertificateFile <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the <TERM>PEM</TERM>-format file containing certificates for the CA's that slapd will trust. The certificate for the CA that signed the server certificate must be included among these certificates. If the signing CA was not a top-level (root) CA, certificates for the entire sequence of CA's from the signing CA to the top-level CA should be present. Multiple certificates are simply appended to the file; the order is not significant.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLSCACertificatePath <path>">16.2.1.2. TLSCACertificatePath <path></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the path of a directory that contains individual <TERM>CA</TERM> certificates in separate files. In addition, this directory must be specially managed using the OpenSSL <EM>c_rehash</EM> utility. When using this feature, the OpenSSL library will attempt to locate certificate files based on a hash of their name and serial number. The <EM>c_rehash</EM> utility is used to generate symbolic links with the hashed names that point to the actual certificate files. As such, this option can only be used with a filesystem that actually supports symbolic links. In general, it is simpler to use the <TT>TLSCACertificateFile</TT> directive instead.</P>
<P>When using Mozilla NSS, this directive can be used to specify the path of the directory containing the NSS certificate and key database files. The <EM>certutil</EM> command can be used to add a <TERM>CA</TERM> certificate:</P>
<PRE>
certutil -d <path> -A -n "name of CA cert" -t CT,, -a -i /path/to/cacertfile.pem
</PRE>
<UL>
This command will add a CA certficate stored in the PEM (ASCII) formatted
<BR>
file named /path/to/cacertfile.pem. <TT>-t CT,,</TT> means that the certificate is
<BR>
trusted to be a CA issuing certs for use in TLS clients and servers.</UL>
<H4><A NAME="TLSCertificateFile <filename>">16.2.1.3. TLSCertificateFile <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file that contains the slapd server certificate. Certificates are generally public information and require no special protection.</P>
<P>When using Mozilla NSS, if using a cert/key database (specified with <TT>TLSCACertificatePath</TT>), this directive specifies the name of the certificate to use:</P>
<PRE>
TLSCertificateFile Server-Cert
</PRE>
<UL>
If using a token other than the internal built in token, specify the
<BR>
token name first, followed by a colon:</UL>
<PRE>
TLSCertificateFile my hardware device:Server-Cert
</PRE>
<UL>
Use <TT>certutil -L</TT> to list the certificates by name:</UL>
<PRE>
certutil -d /path/to/certdbdir -L
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="TLSCertificateKeyFile <filename>">16.2.1.4. TLSCertificateKeyFile <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file that contains the private key that matches the certificate stored in the <TT>TLSCertificateFile</TT> file. Private keys themselves are sensitive data and are usually password encrypted for protection. However, the current implementation doesn't support encrypted keys so the key must not be encrypted and the file itself must be protected carefully.</P>
<P>When using Mozilla NSS, this directive specifies the name of a file that contains the password for the key for the certificate specified with <TT>TLSCertificateFile</TT>. The modutil command can be used to turn off password protection for the cert/key database. For example, if <TT>TLSCACertificatePath</TT> specifes /etc/openldap/certdb as the location of the cert/key database, use modutil to change the password to the empty string:</P>
<PRE>
modutil -dbdir /etc/openldap/certdb -changepw 'NSS Certificate DB'
</PRE>
<UL>
You must have the old password, if any. Ignore the WARNING about the running
<BR>
browser. Press 'Enter' for the new password.</UL>
<H4><A NAME="TLSCipherSuite <cipher-suite-spec>">16.2.1.5. TLSCipherSuite <cipher-suite-spec></A></H4>
<P>This directive configures what ciphers will be accepted and the preference order. <TT><cipher-suite-spec></TT> should be a cipher specification for OpenSSL. You can use the command</P>
<PRE>
openssl ciphers -v ALL
</PRE>
<P>to obtain a verbose list of available cipher specifications.</P>
<P>Besides the individual cipher names, the specifiers <TT>HIGH</TT>, <TT>MEDIUM</TT>, <TT>LOW</TT>, <TT>EXPORT</TT>, and <TT>EXPORT40</TT> may be helpful, along with <TT>TLSv1</TT>, <TT>SSLv3</TT>, and <TT>SSLv2</TT>.</P>
<P>To obtain the list of ciphers in GnuTLS use:</P>
<PRE>
gnutls-cli -l
</PRE>
<P>When using Mozilla NSS, the OpenSSL cipher suite specifications are used and translated into the format used internally by Mozilla NSS. There isn't an easy way to list the cipher suites from the command line. The authoritative list is in the source code for Mozilla NSS in the file sslinfo.c in the structure</P>
<PRE>
static const SSLCipherSuiteInfo suiteInfo[]
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="TLSRandFile <filename>">16.2.1.6. TLSRandFile <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file to obtain random bits from when <TT>/dev/urandom</TT> is not available. If the system provides <TT>/dev/urandom</TT> then this option is not needed, otherwise a source of random data must be configured. Some systems (e.g. Linux) provide <TT>/dev/urandom</TT> by default, while others (e.g. Solaris) require the installation of a patch to provide it, and others may not support it at all. In the latter case, EGD or PRNGD should be installed, and this directive should specify the name of the EGD/PRNGD socket. The environment variable <TT>RANDFILE</TT> can also be used to specify the filename. Also, in the absence of these options, the <TT>.rnd</TT> file in the slapd user's home directory may be used if it exists. To use the <TT>.rnd</TT> file, just create the file and copy a few hundred bytes of arbitrary data into the file. The file is only used to provide a seed for the pseudo-random number generator, and it doesn't need very much data to work.</P>
<P>This directive is ignored with GnuTLS and Mozilla NSS.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLSEphemeralDHParamFile <filename>">16.2.1.7. TLSEphemeralDHParamFile <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file that contains parameters for Diffie-Hellman ephemeral key exchange. This is required in order to use a DSA certificate on the server side (i.e. <TT>TLSCertificateKeyFile</TT> points to a DSA key). Multiple sets of parameters can be included in the file; all of them will be processed. Parameters can be generated using the following command</P>
<PRE>
openssl dhparam [-dsaparam] -out <filename> <numbits>
</PRE>
<P>This directive is ignored with GnuTLS and Mozilla NSS.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLSVerifyClient { never | allow | try | demand }">16.2.1.8. TLSVerifyClient { never | allow | try | demand }</A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies what checks to perform on client certificates in an incoming TLS session, if any. This option is set to <TT>never</TT> by default, in which case the server never asks the client for a certificate. With a setting of <TT>allow</TT> the server will ask for a client certificate; if none is provided the session proceeds normally. If a certificate is provided but the server is unable to verify it, the certificate is ignored and the session proceeds normally, as if no certificate had been provided. With a setting of <TT>try</TT> the certificate is requested, and if none is provided, the session proceeds normally. If a certificate is provided and it cannot be verified, the session is immediately terminated. With a setting of <TT>demand</TT> the certificate is requested and a valid certificate must be provided, otherwise the session is immediately terminated.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The server must request a client certificate in order to use the SASL EXTERNAL authentication mechanism with a TLS session. As such, a non-default <TT>TLSVerifyClient</TT> setting must be configured before SASL EXTERNAL authentication may be attempted, and the SASL EXTERNAL mechanism will only be offered to the client if a valid client certificate was received.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Client Configuration">16.2.2. Client Configuration</A></H3>
<P>Most of the client configuration directives parallel the server directives. The names of the directives are different, and they go into <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) instead of <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5), but their functionality is mostly the same. Also, while most of these options may be configured on a system-wide basis, they may all be overridden by individual users in their <EM>.ldaprc</EM> files.</P>
<P>The LDAP Start TLS operation is used in LDAP to initiate TLS negotiation. All OpenLDAP command line tools support a <TT>-Z</TT> and <TT>-ZZ</TT> flag to indicate whether a Start TLS operation is to be issued. The latter flag indicates that the tool is to cease processing if TLS cannot be started while the former allows the command to continue.</P>
<P>In LDAPv2 environments, TLS is normally started using the LDAP Secure URI scheme (<TT>ldaps://</TT>) instead of the normal LDAP URI scheme (<TT>ldap://</TT>). OpenLDAP command line tools allow either scheme to used with the <TT>-H</TT> flag and with the <TT>URI</TT> <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) option.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_CACERT <filename>">16.2.2.1. TLS_CACERT <filename></A></H4>
<P>This is equivalent to the server's <TT>TLSCACertificateFile</TT> option. As noted in the <A HREF="#TLS Configuration">TLS Configuration</A> section, a client typically may need to know about more CAs than a server, but otherwise the same considerations apply.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_CACERTDIR <path>">16.2.2.2. TLS_CACERTDIR <path></A></H4>
<P>This is equivalent to the server's <TT>TLSCACertificatePath</TT> option. The specified directory must be managed with the OpenSSL <EM>c_rehash</EM> utility as well. If using Mozilla NSS, <path> may contain a cert/key database.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_CERT <filename>">16.2.2.3. TLS_CERT <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file that contains the client certificate. This is a user-only directive and can only be specified in a user's <EM>.ldaprc</EM> file.</P>
<P>When using Mozilla NSS, if using a cert/key database (specified with <TT>TLS_CACERTDIR</TT>), this directive specifies the name of the certificate to use:</P>
<PRE>
TLS_CERT Certificate for Sam Carter
</PRE>
<UL>
If using a token other than the internal built in token, specify the
<BR>
token name first, followed by a colon:</UL>
<PRE>
TLS_CERT my hardware device:Certificate for Sam Carter
</PRE>
<UL>
Use <TT>certutil -L</TT> to list the certificates by name:</UL>
<PRE>
certutil -d /path/to/certdbdir -L
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_KEY <filename>">16.2.2.4. TLS_KEY <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive specifies the file that contains the private key that matches the certificate stored in the <TT>TLS_CERT</TT> file. The same constraints mentioned for <TT>TLSCertificateKeyFile</TT> apply here. This is also a user-only directive.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_RANDFILE <filename>">16.2.2.5. TLS_RANDFILE <filename></A></H4>
<P>This directive is the same as the server's <TT>TLSRandFile</TT> option.</P>
<H4><A NAME="TLS_REQCERT { never | allow | try | demand }">16.2.2.6. TLS_REQCERT { never | allow | try | demand }</A></H4>
<P>This directive is equivalent to the server's <TT>TLSVerifyClient</TT> option. However, for clients the default value is <TT>demand</TT> and there generally is no good reason to change this setting.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Constructing a Distributed Directory Service">17. Constructing a Distributed Directory Service</A></H1>
<P>For many sites, running one or more <EM>slapd</EM>(8) that hold an entire subtree of data is sufficient. But often it is desirable to have one <EM>slapd</EM> refer to other directory services for a certain part of the tree (which may or may not be running <EM>slapd</EM>).</P>
<P><EM>slapd</EM> supports <EM>subordinate</EM> and <EM>superior</EM> knowledge information. Subordinate knowledge information is held in <TT>referral</TT> objects (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3296.txt">RFC3296</A>).</P>
<H2><A NAME="Subordinate Knowledge Information">17.1. Subordinate Knowledge Information</A></H2>
<P>Subordinate knowledge information may be provided to delegate a subtree. Subordinate knowledge information is maintained in the directory as a special <EM>referral</EM> object at the delegate point. The referral object acts as a delegation point, gluing two services together. This mechanism allows for hierarchical directory services to be constructed.</P>
<P>A referral object has a structural object class of <TT>referral</TT> and has the same <TERM>Distinguished Name</TERM> as the delegated subtree. Generally, the referral object will also provide the auxiliary object class <TT>extensibleObject</TT>. This allows the entry to contain appropriate <TERM>Relative Distinguished Name</TERM> values. This is best demonstrated by example.</P>
<P>If the server <TT>a.example.net</TT> holds <TT>dc=example,dc=net</TT> and wished to delegate the subtree <TT>ou=subtree,dc=example,dc=net</TT> to another server <TT>b.example.net</TT>, the following named referral object would be added to <TT>a.example.net</TT>:</P>
<PRE>
dn: dc=subtree,dc=example,dc=net
objectClass: referral
objectClass: extensibleObject
dc: subtree
ref: ldap://b.example.net/dc=subtree,dc=example,dc=net
</PRE>
<P>The server uses this information to generate referrals and search continuations to subordinate servers.</P>
<P>For those familiar with <TERM>X.500</TERM>, a <EM>named referral</EM> object is similar to an X.500 knowledge reference held in a <EM>subr</EM> <TERM>DSE</TERM>.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Superior Knowledge Information">17.2. Superior Knowledge Information</A></H2>
<P>Superior knowledge information may be specified using the <TT>referral</TT> directive. The value is a list of <TERM>URI</TERM>s referring to superior directory services. For servers without immediate superiors, such as for <TT>a.example.net</TT> in the example above, the server can be configured to use a directory service with <EM>global knowledge</EM>, such as the <EM>OpenLDAP Root Service</EM> (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/index.cgi?file=393">http://www.openldap.org/faq/index.cgi?file=393</A>).</P>
<PRE>
referral ldap://root.openldap.org/
</PRE>
<P>However, as <TT>a.example.net</TT> is the <EM>immediate superior</EM> to <TT>b.example.net</TT>, <EM>b.example.net</EM> would be configured as follows:</P>
<PRE>
referral ldap://a.example.net/
</PRE>
<P>The server uses this information to generate referrals for operations acting upon entries not within or subordinate to any of the naming contexts held by the server.</P>
<P>For those familiar with <TERM>X.500</TERM>, this use of the <TT>ref</TT> attribute is similar to an X.500 knowledge reference held in a <EM>Supr</EM> <TERM>DSE</TERM>.</P>
<H2><A NAME="The ManageDsaIT Control">17.3. The ManageDsaIT Control</A></H2>
<P>Adding, modifying, and deleting referral objects is generally done using <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1) or similar tools which support the ManageDsaIT control. The ManageDsaIT control informs the server that you intend to manage the referral object as a regular entry. This keeps the server from sending a referral result for requests which interrogate or update referral objects.</P>
<P>The ManageDsaIT control should not be specified when managing regular entries.</P>
<P>The <TT>-M</TT> option of <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1) (and other tools) enables ManageDsaIT. For example:</P>
<PRE>
ldapmodify -M -f referral.ldif -x -D "cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=net" -W
</PRE>
<P>or with <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1):</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -M -b "dc=example,dc=net" -x "(objectclass=referral)" '*' ref
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>the <TT>ref</TT> attribute is operational and must be explicitly requested when desired in search results.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>the use of referrals to construct a Distributed Directory Service is extremely clumsy and not well supported by common clients. If an existing installation has already been built using referrals, the use of the <EM>chain</EM> overlay to hide the referrals will greatly improve the usability of the Directory system. A better approach would be to use explicitly defined local and proxy databases in <EM>subordinate</EM> configurations to provide a seamless view of the Distributed Directory.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>LDAP operations, even subtree searches, normally access only one database. That can be changed by gluing databases together with the <B>subordinate</B>/<B>olcSubordinate</B> keyword. Please see <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) and <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Replication">18. Replication</A></H1>
<P>Replicated directories are a fundamental requirement for delivering a resilient enterprise deployment.</P>
<P><A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A> has various configuration options for creating a replicated directory. In previous releases, replication was discussed in terms of a <EM>master</EM> server and some number of <EM>slave</EM> servers. A master accepted directory updates from other clients, and a slave only accepted updates from a (single) master. The replication structure was rigidly defined and any particular database could only fulfill a single role, either master or slave.</P>
<P>As OpenLDAP now supports a wide variety of replication topologies, these terms have been deprecated in favor of <EM>provider</EM> and <EM>consumer</EM>: A provider replicates directory updates to consumers; consumers receive replication updates from providers. Unlike the rigidly defined master/slave relationships, provider/consumer roles are quite fluid: replication updates received in a consumer can be further propagated by that consumer to other servers, so a consumer can also act simultaneously as a provider. Also, a consumer need not be an actual LDAP server; it may be just an LDAP client.</P>
<P>The following sections will describe the replication technology and discuss the various replication options that are available.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Replication Technology">18.1. Replication Technology</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="LDAP Sync Replication">18.1.1. LDAP Sync Replication</A></H3>
<P>The <TERM>LDAP Sync</TERM> Replication engine, <TERM>syncrepl</TERM> for short, is a consumer-side replication engine that enables the consumer <TERM>LDAP</TERM> server to maintain a shadow copy of a <TERM>DIT</TERM> fragment. A syncrepl engine resides at the consumer and executes as one of the <EM>slapd</EM>(8) threads. It creates and maintains a consumer replica by connecting to the replication provider to perform the initial DIT content load followed either by periodic content polling or by timely updates upon content changes.</P>
<P>Syncrepl uses the LDAP Content Synchronization protocol (or LDAP Sync for short) as the replica synchronization protocol. LDAP Sync provides a stateful replication which supports both pull-based and push-based synchronization and does not mandate the use of a history store. In pull-based replication the consumer periodically polls the provider for updates. In push-based replication the consumer listens for updates that are sent by the provider in realtime. Since the protocol does not require a history store, the provider does not need to maintain any log of updates it has received (Note that the syncrepl engine is extensible and additional replication protocols may be supported in the future.).</P>
<P>Syncrepl keeps track of the status of the replication content by maintaining and exchanging synchronization cookies. Because the syncrepl consumer and provider maintain their content status, the consumer can poll the provider content to perform incremental synchronization by asking for the entries required to make the consumer replica up-to-date with the provider content. Syncrepl also enables convenient management of replicas by maintaining replica status. The consumer replica can be constructed from a consumer-side or a provider-side backup at any synchronization status. Syncrepl can automatically resynchronize the consumer replica up-to-date with the current provider content.</P>
<P>Syncrepl supports both pull-based and push-based synchronization. In its basic refreshOnly synchronization mode, the provider uses pull-based synchronization where the consumer servers need not be tracked and no history information is maintained. The information required for the provider to process periodic polling requests is contained in the synchronization cookie of the request itself. To optimize the pull-based synchronization, syncrepl utilizes the present phase of the LDAP Sync protocol as well as its delete phase, instead of falling back on frequent full reloads. To further optimize the pull-based synchronization, the provider can maintain a per-scope session log as a history store. In its refreshAndPersist mode of synchronization, the provider uses a push-based synchronization. The provider keeps track of the consumer servers that have requested a persistent search and sends them necessary updates as the provider replication content gets modified.</P>
<P>With syncrepl, a consumer server can create a replica without changing the provider's configurations and without restarting the provider server, if the consumer server has appropriate access privileges for the DIT fragment to be replicated. The consumer server can stop the replication also without the need for provider-side changes and restart.</P>
<P>Syncrepl supports partial, sparse, and fractional replications. The shadow DIT fragment is defined by a general search criteria consisting of base, scope, filter, and attribute list. The replica content is also subject to the access privileges of the bind identity of the syncrepl replication connection.</P>
<H4><A NAME="The LDAP Content Synchronization Protocol">18.1.1.1. The LDAP Content Synchronization Protocol</A></H4>
<P>The LDAP Sync protocol allows a client to maintain a synchronized copy of a DIT fragment. The LDAP Sync operation is defined as a set of controls and other protocol elements which extend the LDAP search operation. This section introduces the LDAP Content Sync protocol only briefly. For more information, refer to <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">RFC4533</A>.</P>
<P>The LDAP Sync protocol supports both polling and listening for changes by defining two respective synchronization operations: <EM>refreshOnly</EM> and <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM>. Polling is implemented by the <EM>refreshOnly</EM> operation. The consumer polls the provider using an LDAP Search request with an LDAP Sync control attached. The consumer copy is synchronized to the provider copy at the time of polling using the information returned in the search. The provider finishes the search operation by returning <EM>SearchResultDone</EM> at the end of the search operation as in the normal search. Listening is implemented by the <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> operation. As the name implies, it begins with a search, like refreshOnly. Instead of finishing the search after returning all entries currently matching the search criteria, the synchronization search remains persistent in the provider. Subsequent updates to the synchronization content in the provider cause additional entry updates to be sent to the consumer.</P>
<P>The <EM>refreshOnly</EM> operation and the refresh stage of the <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> operation can be performed with a present phase or a delete phase.</P>
<P>In the present phase, the provider sends the consumer the entries updated within the search scope since the last synchronization. The provider sends all requested attributes, be they changed or not, of the updated entries. For each unchanged entry which remains in the scope, the provider sends a present message consisting only of the name of the entry and the synchronization control representing state present. The present message does not contain any attributes of the entry. After the consumer receives all update and present entries, it can reliably determine the new consumer copy by adding the entries added to the provider, by replacing the entries modified at the provider, and by deleting entries in the consumer copy which have not been updated nor specified as being present at the provider.</P>
<P>The transmission of the updated entries in the delete phase is the same as in the present phase. The provider sends all the requested attributes of the entries updated within the search scope since the last synchronization to the consumer. In the delete phase, however, the provider sends a delete message for each entry deleted from the search scope, instead of sending present messages. The delete message consists only of the name of the entry and the synchronization control representing state delete. The new consumer copy can be determined by adding, modifying, and removing entries according to the synchronization control attached to the <EM>SearchResultEntry</EM> message.</P>
<P>In the case that the LDAP Sync provider maintains a history store and can determine which entries are scoped out of the consumer copy since the last synchronization time, the provider can use the delete phase. If the provider does not maintain any history store, cannot determine the scoped-out entries from the history store, or the history store does not cover the outdated synchronization state of the consumer, the provider should use the present phase. The use of the present phase is much more efficient than a full content reload in terms of the synchronization traffic. To reduce the synchronization traffic further, the LDAP Sync protocol also provides several optimizations such as the transmission of the normalized <TT>entryUUID</TT>s and the transmission of multiple <TT>entryUUIDs</TT> in a single <EM>syncIdSet</EM> message.</P>
<P>At the end of the <EM>refreshOnly</EM> synchronization, the provider sends a synchronization cookie to the consumer as a state indicator of the consumer copy after the synchronization is completed. The consumer will present the received cookie when it requests the next incremental synchronization to the provider.</P>
<P>When <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> synchronization is used, the provider sends a synchronization cookie at the end of the refresh stage by sending a Sync Info message with refreshDone=TRUE. It also sends a synchronization cookie by attaching it to <EM>SearchResultEntry</EM> messages generated in the persist stage of the synchronization search. During the persist stage, the provider can also send a Sync Info message containing the synchronization cookie at any time the provider wants to update the consumer-side state indicator.</P>
<P>In the LDAP Sync protocol, entries are uniquely identified by the <TT>entryUUID</TT> attribute value. It can function as a reliable identifier of the entry. The DN of the entry, on the other hand, can be changed over time and hence cannot be considered as the reliable identifier. The <TT>entryUUID</TT> is attached to each <EM>SearchResultEntry</EM> or <EM>SearchResultReference</EM> as a part of the synchronization control.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Syncrepl Details">18.1.1.2. Syncrepl Details</A></H4>
<P>The syncrepl engine utilizes both the <EM>refreshOnly</EM> and the <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> operations of the LDAP Sync protocol. If a syncrepl specification is included in a database definition, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) launches a syncrepl engine as a <EM>slapd</EM>(8) thread and schedules its execution. If the <EM>refreshOnly</EM> operation is specified, the syncrepl engine will be rescheduled at the interval time after a synchronization operation is completed. If the <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> operation is specified, the engine will remain active and process the persistent synchronization messages from the provider.</P>
<P>The syncrepl engine utilizes both the present phase and the delete phase of the refresh synchronization. It is possible to configure a session log in the provider which stores the <TT>entryUUID</TT>s of a finite number of entries deleted from a database. Multiple replicas share the same session log. The syncrepl engine uses the delete phase if the session log is present and the state of the consumer server is recent enough that no session log entries are truncated after the last synchronization of the client. The syncrepl engine uses the present phase if no session log is configured for the replication content or if the consumer replica is too outdated to be covered by the session log. The current design of the session log store is memory based, so the information contained in the session log is not persistent over multiple provider invocations. It is not currently supported to access the session log store by using LDAP operations. It is also not currently supported to impose access control to the session log.</P>
<P>As a further optimization, even in the case the synchronization search is not associated with any session log, no entries will be transmitted to the consumer server when there has been no update in the replication context.</P>
<P>The syncrepl engine, which is a consumer-side replication engine, can work with any backends. The LDAP Sync provider can be configured as an overlay on any backend, but works best with the <EM>back-bdb</EM> or <EM>back-hdb</EM> backend.</P>
<P>The LDAP Sync provider maintains a <TT>contextCSN</TT> for each database as the current synchronization state indicator of the provider content. It is the largest <TT>entryCSN</TT> in the provider context such that no transactions for an entry having smaller <TT>entryCSN</TT> value remains outstanding. The <TT>contextCSN</TT> could not just be set to the largest issued <TT>entryCSN</TT> because <TT>entryCSN</TT> is obtained before a transaction starts and transactions are not committed in the issue order.</P>
<P>The provider stores the <TT>contextCSN</TT> of a context in the <TT>contextCSN</TT> attribute of the context suffix entry. The attribute is not written to the database after every update operation though; instead it is maintained primarily in memory. At database start time the provider reads the last saved <TT>contextCSN</TT> into memory and uses the in-memory copy exclusively thereafter. By default, changes to the <TT>contextCSN</TT> as a result of database updates will not be written to the database until the server is cleanly shut down. A checkpoint facility exists to cause the <TT>contextCSN</TT> to be written out more frequently if desired.</P>
<P>Note that at startup time, if the provider is unable to read a <TT>contextCSN</TT> from the suffix entry, it will scan the entire database to determine the value, and this scan may take quite a long time on a large database. When a <TT>contextCSN</TT> value is read, the database will still be scanned for any <TT>entryCSN</TT> values greater than it, to make sure the <TT>contextCSN</TT> value truly reflects the greatest committed <TT>entryCSN</TT> in the database. On databases which support inequality indexing, setting an eq index on the <TT>entryCSN</TT> attribute and configuring <EM>contextCSN</EM> checkpoints will greatly speed up this scanning step.</P>
<P>If no <TT>contextCSN</TT> can be determined by reading and scanning the database, a new value will be generated. Also, if scanning the database yielded a greater <TT>entryCSN</TT> than was previously recorded in the suffix entry's <TT>contextCSN</TT> attribute, a checkpoint will be immediately written with the new value.</P>
<P>The consumer also stores its replica state, which is the provider's <TT>contextCSN</TT> received as a synchronization cookie, in the <TT>contextCSN</TT> attribute of the suffix entry. The replica state maintained by a consumer server is used as the synchronization state indicator when it performs subsequent incremental synchronization with the provider server. It is also used as a provider-side synchronization state indicator when it functions as a secondary provider server in a cascading replication configuration. Since the consumer and provider state information are maintained in the same location within their respective databases, any consumer can be promoted to a provider (and vice versa) without any special actions.</P>
<P>Because a general search filter can be used in the syncrepl specification, some entries in the context may be omitted from the synchronization content. The syncrepl engine creates a glue entry to fill in the holes in the replica context if any part of the replica content is subordinate to the holes. The glue entries will not be returned in the search result unless <EM>ManageDsaIT</EM> control is provided.</P>
<P>Also as a consequence of the search filter used in the syncrepl specification, it is possible for a modification to remove an entry from the replication scope even though the entry has not been deleted on the provider. Logically the entry must be deleted on the consumer but in <EM>refreshOnly</EM> mode the provider cannot detect and propagate this change without the use of the session log on the provider.</P>
<P>For configuration, please see the <A HREF="#Syncrepl">Syncrepl</A> section.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Deployment Alternatives">18.2. Deployment Alternatives</A></H2>
<P>While the LDAP Sync specification only defines a narrow scope for replication, the OpenLDAP implementation is extremely flexible and supports a variety of operating modes to handle other scenarios not explicitly addressed in the spec.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Delta-syncrepl replication">18.2.1. Delta-syncrepl replication</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>Disadvantages of LDAP Sync replication:</UL>
<P>LDAP Sync replication is an object-based replication mechanism. When any attribute value in a replicated object is changed on the provider, each consumer fetches and processes the complete changed object, including <B>both the changed and unchanged attribute values</B> during replication. One advantage of this approach is that when multiple changes occur to a single object, the precise sequence of those changes need not be preserved; only the final state of the entry is significant. But this approach may have drawbacks when the usage pattern involves single changes to multiple objects.</P>
<P>For example, suppose you have a database consisting of 102,400 objects of 1 KB each. Further, suppose you routinely run a batch job to change the value of a single two-byte attribute value that appears in each of the 102,400 objects on the master. Not counting LDAP and TCP/IP protocol overhead, each time you run this job each consumer will transfer and process <B>100 MB</B> of data to process <B>200KB of changes!</B></P>
<P>99.98% of the data that is transmitted and processed in a case like this will be redundant, since it represents values that did not change. This is a waste of valuable transmission and processing bandwidth and can cause an unacceptable replication backlog to develop. While this situation is extreme, it serves to demonstrate a very real problem that is encountered in some LDAP deployments.</P>
<UL>
<LI>Where Delta-syncrepl comes in:</UL>
<P>Delta-syncrepl, a changelog-based variant of syncrepl, is designed to address situations like the one described above. Delta-syncrepl works by maintaining a changelog of a selectable depth in a separate database on the provider. The replication consumer checks the changelog for the changes it needs and, as long as the changelog contains the needed changes, the consumer fetches the changes from the changelog and applies them to its database. If, however, a replica is too far out of sync (or completely empty), conventional syncrepl is used to bring it up to date and replication then switches back to the delta-syncrepl mode.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>since the database state is stored in both the changelog DB and the main DB on the provider, it is important to backup/restore both the changelog DB and the main DB using slapcat/slapadd when restoring a DB or copying it to another machine.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>For configuration, please see the <A HREF="#Delta-syncrepl">Delta-syncrepl</A> section.</P>
<H3><A NAME="N-Way Multi-Master replication">18.2.2. N-Way Multi-Master replication</A></H3>
<P>Multi-Master replication is a replication technique using Syncrepl to replicate data to multiple provider ("Master") Directory servers.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Valid Arguments for Multi-Master replication">18.2.2.1. Valid Arguments for Multi-Master replication</A></H4>
<UL>
<LI>If any provider fails, other providers will continue to accept updates
<LI>Avoids a single point of failure
<LI>Providers can be located in several physical sites i.e. distributed across the network/globe.
<LI>Good for Automatic failover/High Availability</UL>
<H4><A NAME="Invalid Arguments for Multi-Master replication">18.2.2.2. Invalid Arguments for Multi-Master replication</A></H4>
<P>(These are often claimed to be advantages of Multi-Master replication but those claims are false):</P>
<UL>
<LI>It has <B>NOTHING</B> to do with load balancing
<LI>Providers <B>must</B> propagate writes to <B>all</B> the other servers, which means the network traffic and write load spreads across all of the servers the same as for single-master.
<LI>Server utilization and performance are at best identical for Multi-Master and Single-Master replication; at worst Single-Master is superior because indexing can be tuned differently to optimize for the different usage patterns between the provider and the consumers.</UL>
<H4><A NAME="Arguments against Multi-Master replication">18.2.2.3. Arguments against Multi-Master replication</A></H4>
<UL>
<LI>Breaks the data consistency guarantees of the directory model
<LI><A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/1240.html">http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/1240.html</A>
<LI>If connectivity with a provider is lost because of a network partition, then "automatic failover" can just compound the problem
<LI>Typically, a particular machine cannot distinguish between losing contact with a peer because that peer crashed, or because the network link has failed
<LI>If a network is partitioned and multiple clients start writing to each of the "masters" then reconciliation will be a pain; it may be best to simply deny writes to the clients that are partitioned from the single provider</UL>
<P>For configuration, please see the <A HREF="#N-Way Multi-Master">N-Way Multi-Master</A> section below</P>
<H3><A NAME="MirrorMode replication">18.2.3. MirrorMode replication</A></H3>
<P>MirrorMode is a hybrid configuration that provides all of the consistency guarantees of single-master replication, while also providing the high availability of multi-master. In MirrorMode two providers are set up to replicate from each other (as a multi-master configuration), but an external frontend is employed to direct all writes to only one of the two servers. The second provider will only be used for writes if the first provider crashes, at which point the frontend will switch to directing all writes to the second provider. When a crashed provider is repaired and restarted it will automatically catch up to any changes on the running provider and resync.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Arguments for MirrorMode">18.2.3.1. Arguments for MirrorMode</A></H4>
<UL>
<LI>Provides a high-availability (HA) solution for directory writes (replicas handle reads)
<LI>As long as one provider is operational, writes can safely be accepted
<LI>Provider nodes replicate from each other, so they are always up to date and can be ready to take over (hot standby)
<LI>Syncrepl also allows the provider nodes to re-synchronize after any downtime</UL>
<H4><A NAME="Arguments against MirrorMode">18.2.3.2. Arguments against MirrorMode</A></H4>
<UL>
<LI>MirrorMode is not what is termed as a Multi-Master solution. This is because writes have to go to just one of the mirror nodes at a time
<LI>MirrorMode can be termed as Active-Active Hot-Standby, therefore an external server (slapd in proxy mode) or device (hardware load balancer) is needed to manage which provider is currently active
<LI>Backups are managed slightly differently<UL>
<LI>If backing up the Berkeley database itself and periodically backing up the transaction log files, then the same member of the mirror pair needs to be used to collect logfiles until the next database backup is taken</UL></UL>
<P>For configuration, please see the <A HREF="#MirrorMode">MirrorMode</A> section below</P>
<H3><A NAME="Syncrepl Proxy Mode">18.2.4. Syncrepl Proxy Mode</A></H3>
<P>While the LDAP Sync protocol supports both pull- and push-based replication, the push mode (refreshAndPersist) must still be initiated from the consumer before the provider can begin pushing changes. In some network configurations, particularly where firewalls restrict the direction in which connections can be made, a provider-initiated push mode may be needed.</P>
<P>This mode can be configured with the aid of the LDAP Backend (<A HREF="#Backends">Backends</A> and <EM>slapd-ldap(8)</EM>). Instead of running the syncrepl engine on the actual consumer, a slapd-ldap proxy is set up near (or collocated with) the provider that points to the consumer, and the syncrepl engine runs on the proxy.</P>
<P>For configuration, please see the <A HREF="#Syncrepl Proxy">Syncrepl Proxy</A> section.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Replacing Slurpd">18.2.4.1. Replacing Slurpd</A></H4>
<P>The old <EM>slurpd</EM> mechanism only operated in provider-initiated push mode. Slurpd replication was deprecated in favor of Syncrepl replication and has been completely removed from OpenLDAP 2.4.</P>
<P>The slurpd daemon was the original replication mechanism inherited from UMich's LDAP and operated in push mode: the master pushed changes to the slaves. It was replaced for many reasons, in brief:</P>
<UL>
<LI>It was not reliable<UL>
<LI>It was extremely sensitive to the ordering of records in the replog
<LI>It could easily go out of sync, at which point manual intervention was required to resync the slave database with the master directory
<LI>It wasn't very tolerant of unavailable servers. If a slave went down for a long time, the replog could grow to a size that was too large for slurpd to process</UL>
<LI>It only worked in push mode
<LI>It required stopping and restarting the master to add new slaves
<LI>It only supported single master replication</UL>
<P>Syncrepl has none of those weaknesses:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Syncrepl is self-synchronizing; you can start with a consumer database in any state from totally empty to fully synced and it will automatically do the right thing to achieve and maintain synchronization<UL>
<LI>It is completely insensitive to the order in which changes occur
<LI>It guarantees convergence between the consumer and the provider content without manual intervention
<LI>It can resynchronize regardless of how long a consumer stays out of contact with the provider</UL>
<LI>Syncrepl can operate in either direction
<LI>Consumers can be added at any time without touching anything on the provider
<LI>Multi-master replication is supported</UL>
<H2><A NAME="Configuring the different replication types">18.3. Configuring the different replication types</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Syncrepl">18.3.1. Syncrepl</A></H3>
<H4><A NAME="Syncrepl configuration">18.3.1.1. Syncrepl configuration</A></H4>
<P>Because syncrepl is a consumer-side replication engine, the syncrepl specification is defined in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) of the consumer server, not in the provider server's configuration file. The initial loading of the replica content can be performed either by starting the syncrepl engine with no synchronization cookie or by populating the consumer replica by loading an <TERM>LDIF</TERM> file dumped as a backup at the provider.</P>
<P>When loading from a backup, it is not required to perform the initial loading from the up-to-date backup of the provider content. The syncrepl engine will automatically synchronize the initial consumer replica to the current provider content. As a result, it is not required to stop the provider server in order to avoid the replica inconsistency caused by the updates to the provider content during the content backup and loading process.</P>
<P>When replicating a large scale directory, especially in a bandwidth constrained environment, it is advised to load the consumer replica from a backup instead of performing a full initial load using syncrepl.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Set up the provider slapd">18.3.1.2. Set up the provider slapd</A></H4>
<P>The provider is implemented as an overlay, so the overlay itself must first be configured in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) before it can be used. The provider has only two configuration directives, for setting checkpoints on the <TT>contextCSN</TT> and for configuring the session log. Because the LDAP Sync search is subject to access control, proper access control privileges should be set up for the replicated content.</P>
<P>The <TT>contextCSN</TT> checkpoint is configured by the</P>
<PRE>
syncprov-checkpoint <ops> <minutes>
</PRE>
<P>directive. Checkpoints are only tested after successful write operations. If <EM><ops></EM> operations or more than <EM><minutes></EM> time has passed since the last checkpoint, a new checkpoint is performed.</P>
<P>The session log is configured by the</P>
<PRE>
syncprov-sessionlog <size>
</PRE>
<P>directive, where <EM><size></EM> is the maximum number of session log entries the session log can record. When a session log is configured, it is automatically used for all LDAP Sync searches within the database.</P>
<P>Note that using the session log requires searching on the <EM>entryUUID</EM> attribute. Setting an eq index on this attribute will greatly benefit the performance of the session log on the provider.</P>
<P>A more complete example of the <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) content is thus:</P>
<PRE>
database bdb
suffix dc=Example,dc=com
rootdn dc=Example,dc=com
directory /var/ldap/db
index objectclass,entryCSN,entryUUID eq
overlay syncprov
syncprov-checkpoint 100 10
syncprov-sessionlog 100
</PRE>
<H4><A NAME="Set up the consumer slapd">18.3.1.3. Set up the consumer slapd</A></H4>
<P>The syncrepl replication is specified in the database section of <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) for the replica context. The syncrepl engine is backend independent and the directive can be defined with any database type.</P>
<PRE>
database hdb
suffix dc=Example,dc=com
rootdn dc=Example,dc=com
directory /var/ldap/db
index objectclass,entryCSN,entryUUID eq
syncrepl rid=123
provider=ldap://provider.example.com:389
type=refreshOnly
interval=01:00:00:00
searchbase="dc=example,dc=com"
filter="(objectClass=organizationalPerson)"
scope=sub
attrs="cn,sn,ou,telephoneNumber,title,l"
schemachecking=off
bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=syncuser,dc=example,dc=com"
credentials=secret
</PRE>
<P>In this example, the consumer will connect to the provider <EM>slapd</EM>(8) at port 389 of <A HREF="ldap://provider.example.com">ldap://provider.example.com</A> to perform a polling (<EM>refreshOnly</EM>) mode of synchronization once a day. It will bind as <TT>cn=syncuser,dc=example,dc=com</TT> using simple authentication with password "secret". Note that the access control privilege of <TT>cn=syncuser,dc=example,dc=com</TT> should be set appropriately in the provider to retrieve the desired replication content. Also the search limits must be high enough on the provider to allow the syncuser to retrieve a complete copy of the requested content. The consumer uses the rootdn to write to its database so it always has full permissions to write all content.</P>
<P>The synchronization search in the above example will search for the entries whose objectClass is organizationalPerson in the entire subtree rooted at <TT>dc=example,dc=com</TT>. The requested attributes are <TT>cn</TT>, <TT>sn</TT>, <TT>ou</TT>, <TT>telephoneNumber</TT>, <TT>title</TT>, and <TT>l</TT>. The schema checking is turned off, so that the consumer <EM>slapd</EM>(8) will not enforce entry schema checking when it processes updates from the provider <EM>slapd</EM>(8).</P>
<P>For more detailed information on the syncrepl directive, see the <A HREF="#syncrepl">syncrepl</A> section of <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> chapter of this admin guide.</P>
<H4><A NAME="Start the provider and the consumer slapd">18.3.1.4. Start the provider and the consumer slapd</A></H4>
<P>The provider <EM>slapd</EM>(8) is not required to be restarted. <EM>contextCSN</EM> is automatically generated as needed: it might be originally contained in the <TERM>LDIF</TERM> file, generated by <EM>slapadd</EM> (8), generated upon changes in the context, or generated when the first LDAP Sync search arrives at the provider. If an LDIF file is being loaded which did not previously contain the <EM>contextCSN</EM>, the <EM>-w</EM> option should be used with <EM>slapadd</EM> (8) to cause it to be generated. This will allow the server to startup a little quicker the first time it runs.</P>
<P>When starting a consumer <EM>slapd</EM>(8), it is possible to provide a synchronization cookie as the <EM>-c cookie</EM> command line option in order to start the synchronization from a specific state. The cookie is a comma separated list of name=value pairs. Currently supported syncrepl cookie fields are <EM>csn=<csn></EM> and <EM>rid=<rid></EM>. <EM><csn></EM> represents the current synchronization state of the consumer replica. <EM><rid></EM> identifies a consumer replica locally within the consumer server. It is used to relate the cookie to the syncrepl definition in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) which has the matching replica identifier. The <EM><rid></EM> must have no more than 3 decimal digits. The command line cookie overrides the synchronization cookie stored in the consumer replica database.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Delta-syncrepl">18.3.2. Delta-syncrepl</A></H3>
<H4><A NAME="Delta-syncrepl Provider configuration">18.3.2.1. Delta-syncrepl Provider configuration</A></H4>
<P>Setting up delta-syncrepl requires configuration changes on both the master and replica servers:</P>
<PRE>
# Give the replica DN unlimited read access. This ACL needs to be
# merged with other ACL statements, and/or moved within the scope
# of a database. The "by * break" portion causes evaluation of
# subsequent rules. See slapd.access(5) for details.
access to *
by dn.base="cn=replicator,dc=symas,dc=com" read
by * break
# Set the module path location
modulepath /opt/symas/lib/openldap
# Load the hdb backend
moduleload back_hdb.la
# Load the accesslog overlay
moduleload accesslog.la
#Load the syncprov overlay
moduleload syncprov.la
# Accesslog database definitions
database hdb
suffix cn=accesslog
directory /db/accesslog
rootdn cn=accesslog
index default eq
index entryCSN,objectClass,reqEnd,reqResult,reqStart
overlay syncprov
syncprov-nopresent TRUE
syncprov-reloadhint TRUE
# Let the replica DN have limitless searches
limits dn.exact="cn=replicator,dc=symas,dc=com" time.soft=unlimited time.hard=unlimited size.soft=unlimited size.hard=unlimited
# Primary database definitions
database hdb
suffix "dc=symas,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=manager,dc=symas,dc=com"
## Whatever other configuration options are desired
# syncprov specific indexing
index entryCSN eq
index entryUUID eq
# syncrepl Provider for primary db
overlay syncprov
syncprov-checkpoint 1000 60
# accesslog overlay definitions for primary db
overlay accesslog
logdb cn=accesslog
logops writes
logsuccess TRUE
# scan the accesslog DB every day, and purge entries older than 7 days
logpurge 07+00:00 01+00:00
# Let the replica DN have limitless searches
limits dn.exact="cn=replicator,dc=symas,dc=com" time.soft=unlimited time.hard=unlimited size.soft=unlimited size.hard=unlimited
</PRE>
<P>For more information, always consult the relevant man pages (<EM>slapo-accesslog</EM>(5) and <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5))</P>
<H4><A NAME="Delta-syncrepl Consumer configuration">18.3.2.2. Delta-syncrepl Consumer configuration</A></H4>
<PRE>
# Replica database configuration
database hdb
suffix "dc=symas,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=manager,dc=symas,dc=com"
## Whatever other configuration bits for the replica, like indexing
## that you want
# syncrepl specific indices
index entryUUID eq
# syncrepl directives
syncrepl rid=0
provider=ldap://ldapmaster.symas.com:389
bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=replicator,dc=symas,dc=com"
credentials=secret
searchbase="dc=symas,dc=com"
logbase="cn=accesslog"
logfilter="(&(objectClass=auditWriteObject)(reqResult=0))"
schemachecking=on
type=refreshAndPersist
retry="60 +"
syncdata=accesslog
# Refer updates to the master
updateref ldap://ldapmaster.symas.com
</PRE>
<P>The above configuration assumes that you have a replicator identity defined in your database that can be used to bind to the provider. In addition, all of the databases (primary, replica, and the accesslog storage database) should also have properly tuned <EM>DB_CONFIG</EM> files that meet your needs.</P>
<H3><A NAME="N-Way Multi-Master">18.3.3. N-Way Multi-Master</A></H3>
<P>For the following example we will be using 3 Master nodes. Keeping in line with <B>test050-syncrepl-multimaster</B> of the OpenLDAP test suite, we will be configuring <EM>slapd(8)</EM> via <B>cn=config</B></P>
<P>This sets up the config database:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=config
objectClass: olcGlobal
cn: config
olcServerID: 1
dn: olcDatabase={0}config,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
olcDatabase: {0}config
olcRootPW: secret
</PRE>
<P>second and third servers will have a different olcServerID obviously:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=config
objectClass: olcGlobal
cn: config
olcServerID: 2
dn: olcDatabase={0}config,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
olcDatabase: {0}config
olcRootPW: secret
</PRE>
<P>This sets up syncrepl as a provider (since these are all masters):</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=module,cn=config
objectClass: olcModuleList
cn: module
olcModulePath: /usr/local/libexec/openldap
olcModuleLoad: syncprov.la
</PRE>
<P>Now we setup the first Master Node (replace $URI1, $URI2 and $URI3 etc. with your actual ldap urls):</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=config
changetype: modify
replace: olcServerID
olcServerID: 1 $URI1
olcServerID: 2 $URI2
olcServerID: 3 $URI3
dn: olcOverlay=syncprov,olcDatabase={0}config,cn=config
changetype: add
objectClass: olcOverlayConfig
objectClass: olcSyncProvConfig
olcOverlay: syncprov
dn: olcDatabase={0}config,cn=config
changetype: modify
add: olcSyncRepl
olcSyncRepl: rid=001 provider=$URI1 binddn="cn=config" bindmethod=simple
credentials=secret searchbase="cn=config" type=refreshAndPersist
retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
olcSyncRepl: rid=002 provider=$URI2 binddn="cn=config" bindmethod=simple
credentials=secret searchbase="cn=config" type=refreshAndPersist
retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
olcSyncRepl: rid=003 provider=$URI3 binddn="cn=config" bindmethod=simple
credentials=secret searchbase="cn=config" type=refreshAndPersist
retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
-
add: olcMirrorMode
olcMirrorMode: TRUE
</PRE>
<P>Now start up the Master and a consumer/s, also add the above LDIF to the first consumer, second consumer etc. It will then replicate <B>cn=config</B>. You now have N-Way Multimaster on the config database.</P>
<P>We still have to replicate the actual data, not just the config, so add to the master (all active and configured consumers/masters will pull down this config, as they are all syncing). Also, replace all <EM>${</EM>} variables with whatever is applicable to your setup:</P>
<PRE>
dn: olcDatabase={1}$BACKEND,cn=config
objectClass: olcDatabaseConfig
objectClass: olc${BACKEND}Config
olcDatabase: {1}$BACKEND
olcSuffix: $BASEDN
olcDbDirectory: ./db
olcRootDN: $MANAGERDN
olcRootPW: $PASSWD
olcLimits: dn.exact="$MANAGERDN" time.soft=unlimited time.hard=unlimited size.soft=unlimited size.hard=unlimited
olcSyncRepl: rid=004 provider=$URI1 binddn="$MANAGERDN" bindmethod=simple
credentials=$PASSWD searchbase="$BASEDN" type=refreshOnly
interval=00:00:00:10 retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
olcSyncRepl: rid=005 provider=$URI2 binddn="$MANAGERDN" bindmethod=simple
credentials=$PASSWD searchbase="$BASEDN" type=refreshOnly
interval=00:00:00:10 retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
olcSyncRepl: rid=006 provider=$URI3 binddn="$MANAGERDN" bindmethod=simple
credentials=$PASSWD searchbase="$BASEDN" type=refreshOnly
interval=00:00:00:10 retry="5 5 300 5" timeout=1
olcMirrorMode: TRUE
dn: olcOverlay=syncprov,olcDatabase={1}${BACKEND},cn=config
changetype: add
objectClass: olcOverlayConfig
objectClass: olcSyncProvConfig
olcOverlay: syncprov
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>All of your servers' clocks must be tightly synchronized using e.g. NTP <A HREF="http://www.ntp.org/">http://www.ntp.org/</A>, atomic clock, or some other reliable time reference.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>As stated in <EM>slapd-config</EM>(5), URLs specified in <EM>olcSyncRepl</EM> directives are the URLs of the servers from which to replicate. These must exactly match the URLs <EM>slapd</EM> listens on (<EM>-h</EM> in <A HREF="#Command-Line Options">Command-Line Options</A>). Otherwise slapd may attempt to replicate from itself, causing a loop.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="MirrorMode">18.3.4. MirrorMode</A></H3>
<P>MirrorMode configuration is actually very easy. If you have ever setup a normal slapd syncrepl provider, then the only change is the following two directives:</P>
<PRE>
mirrormode on
serverID 1
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You need to make sure that the <EM>serverID</EM> of each mirror node is different and add it as a global configuration option.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H4><A NAME="Mirror Node Configuration">18.3.4.1. Mirror Node Configuration</A></H4>
<P>The first step is to configure the syncrepl provider the same as in the <A HREF="#Set up the provider slapd">Set up the provider slapd</A> section.</P>
<P>Here's a specific cut down example using <A HREF="#LDAP Sync Replication">LDAP Sync Replication</A> in <EM>refreshAndPersist</EM> mode:</P>
<P>MirrorMode node 1:</P>
<PRE>
# Global section
serverID 1
# database section
# syncrepl directive
syncrepl rid=001
provider=ldap://ldap-sid2.example.com
bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=mirrormode,dc=example,dc=com"
credentials=mirrormode
searchbase="dc=example,dc=com"
schemachecking=on
type=refreshAndPersist
retry="60 +"
mirrormode on
</PRE>
<P>MirrorMode node 2:</P>
<PRE>
# Global section
serverID 2
# database section
# syncrepl directive
syncrepl rid=001
provider=ldap://ldap-sid1.example.com
bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=mirrormode,dc=example,dc=com"
credentials=mirrormode
searchbase="dc=example,dc=com"
schemachecking=on
type=refreshAndPersist
retry="60 +"
mirrormode on
</PRE>
<P>It's simple really; each MirrorMode node is setup <B>exactly</B> the same, except that the <EM>serverID</EM> is unique, and each consumer is pointed to the other server.</P>
<H5><A NAME="Failover Configuration">18.3.4.1.1. Failover Configuration</A></H5>
<P>There are generally 2 choices for this; 1. Hardware proxies/load-balancing or dedicated proxy software, 2. using a Back-LDAP proxy as a syncrepl provider</P>
<P>A typical enterprise example might be:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="dual_dc.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: MirrorMode in a Dual Data Center Configuration</P>
<H5><A NAME="Normal Consumer Configuration">18.3.4.1.2. Normal Consumer Configuration</A></H5>
<P>This is exactly the same as the <A HREF="#Set up the consumer slapd">Set up the consumer slapd</A> section. It can either setup in normal <A HREF="#syncrepl replication">syncrepl replication</A> mode, or in <A HREF="#delta-syncrepl replication">delta-syncrepl replication</A> mode.</P>
<H4><A NAME="MirrorMode Summary">18.3.4.2. MirrorMode Summary</A></H4>
<P>You will now have a directory architecture that provides all of the consistency guarantees of single-master replication, while also providing the high availability of multi-master replication.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Syncrepl Proxy">18.3.5. Syncrepl Proxy</A></H3>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="push-based-complete.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Replacing slurpd</P>
<P>The following example is for a self-contained push-based replication solution:</P>
<PRE>
#######################################################################
# Standard OpenLDAP Master/Provider
#######################################################################
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.acl
modulepath /usr/local/libexec/openldap
moduleload back_hdb.la
moduleload syncprov.la
moduleload back_monitor.la
moduleload back_ldap.la
pidfile /usr/local/var/slapd.pid
argsfile /usr/local/var/slapd.args
loglevel sync stats
database hdb
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-data
checkpoint 1024 5
cachesize 10000
idlcachesize 10000
index objectClass eq
# rest of indexes
index default sub
rootdn "cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootpw testing
# syncprov specific indexing
index entryCSN eq
index entryUUID eq
# syncrepl Provider for primary db
overlay syncprov
syncprov-checkpoint 1000 60
# Let the replica DN have limitless searches
limits dn.exact="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" time.soft=unlimited time.hard=unlimited size.soft=unlimited size.hard=unlimited
database monitor
database config
rootpw testing
##############################################################################
# Consumer Proxy that pulls in data via Syncrepl and pushes out via slapd-ldap
##############################################################################
database ldap
# ignore conflicts with other databases, as we need to push out to same suffix
hidden on
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=slapd-ldap"
uri ldap://localhost:9012/
lastmod on
# We don't need any access to this DSA
restrict all
acl-bind bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
credentials=testing
syncrepl rid=001
provider=ldap://localhost:9011/
binddn="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
bindmethod=simple
credentials=testing
searchbase="dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
type=refreshAndPersist
retry="5 5 300 5"
overlay syncprov
</PRE>
<P>A replica configuration for this type of setup could be:</P>
<PRE>
#######################################################################
# Standard OpenLDAP Slave without Syncrepl
#######################################################################
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.acl
modulepath /usr/local/libexec/openldap
moduleload back_hdb.la
moduleload syncprov.la
moduleload back_monitor.la
moduleload back_ldap.la
pidfile /usr/local/var/slapd.pid
argsfile /usr/local/var/slapd.args
loglevel sync stats
database hdb
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
directory /usr/local/var/openldap-slave/data
checkpoint 1024 5
cachesize 10000
idlcachesize 10000
index objectClass eq
# rest of indexes
index default sub
rootdn "cn=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootpw testing
# Let the replica DN have limitless searches
limits dn.exact="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" time.soft=unlimited time.hard=unlimited size.soft=unlimited size.hard=unlimited
updatedn "cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
# Refer updates to the master
updateref ldap://localhost:9011
database monitor
database config
rootpw testing
</PRE>
<P>You can see we use the <EM>updatedn</EM> directive here and example ACLs (<TT>usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.acl</TT>) for this could be:</P>
<PRE>
# Give the replica DN unlimited read access. This ACL may need to be
# merged with other ACL statements.
access to *
by dn.base="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" write
by * break
access to dn.base=""
by * read
access to dn.base="cn=Subschema"
by * read
access to dn.subtree="cn=Monitor"
by dn.exact="uid=admin,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com" write
by users read
by * none
access to *
by self write
by * read
</PRE>
<P>In order to support more replicas, just add more <EM>database ldap</EM> sections and increment the <EM>syncrepl rid</EM> number accordingly.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>You must populate the Master and Slave directories with the same data, unlike when using normal Syncrepl
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>If you do not have access to modify the master directory configuration you can configure a standalone ldap proxy, which might look like:</P>
<P><CENTER><IMG SRC="push-based-standalone.png" ALIGN="center"></CENTER></P>
<P ALIGN="Center">Figure X.Y: Replacing slurpd with a standalone version</P>
<P>The following configuration is an example of a standalone LDAP Proxy:</P>
<PRE>
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/core.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema
include /usr/local/etc/openldap/slapd.acl
modulepath /usr/local/libexec/openldap
moduleload syncprov.la
moduleload back_ldap.la
##############################################################################
# Consumer Proxy that pulls in data via Syncrepl and pushes out via slapd-ldap
##############################################################################
database ldap
# ignore conflicts with other databases, as we need to push out to same suffix
hidden on
suffix "dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
rootdn "cn=slapd-ldap"
uri ldap://localhost:9012/
lastmod on
# We don't need any access to this DSA
restrict all
acl-bind bindmethod=simple
binddn="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
credentials=testing
syncrepl rid=001
provider=ldap://localhost:9011/
binddn="cn=replicator,dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
bindmethod=simple
credentials=testing
searchbase="dc=suretecsystems,dc=com"
type=refreshAndPersist
retry="5 5 300 5"
overlay syncprov
</PRE>
<P>As you can see, you can let your imagination go wild using Syncrepl and <EM>slapd-ldap(8)</EM> tailoring your replication to fit your specific network topology.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Maintenance">19. Maintenance</A></H1>
<P>System Administration is all about maintenance, so it is only fair that we discuss how to correctly maintain an OpenLDAP deployment.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Directory Backups">19.1. Directory Backups</A></H2>
<P>Backup strategies largely depend on the amount of change in the database and how much of that change an administrator might be willing to lose in a catastrophic failure. There are two basic methods that can be used:</P>
<P>1. Backup the Berkeley database itself and periodically back up the transaction log files:</P>
<P>Berkeley DB produces transaction logs that can be used to reconstruct changes from a given point in time. For example, if an administrator were willing to only lose one hour's worth of changes, they could take down the server in the middle of the night, copy the Berkeley database files offsite, and bring the server back online. Then, on an hourly basis, they could force a database checkpoint, capture the log files that have been generated in the past hour, and copy them offsite. The accumulated log files, in combination with the previous database backup, could be used with db_recover to reconstruct the database up to the time the last collection of log files was copied offsite. This method affords good protection, with minimal space overhead.</P>
<P>2. Periodically run slapcat and back up the LDIF file:</P>
<P>Slapcat can be run while slapd is active. However, one runs the risk of an inconsistent database- not from the point of slapd, but from the point of the applications using LDAP. For example, if a provisioning application performed tasks that consisted of several LDAP operations, and the slapcat took place concurrently with those operations, then there might be inconsistencies in the LDAP database from the point of view of that provisioning application and applications that depended on it. One must, therefore, be convinced something like that won't happen. One way to do that would be to put the database in read-only mode while performing the slapcat. The other disadvantage of this approach is that the generated LDIF files can be rather large and the accumulation of the day's backups could add up to a substantial amount of space.</P>
<P>You can use <EM>slapcat</EM>(8) to generate an LDIF file for each of your <EM>slapd</EM>(8) back-bdb or back-hdb databases.</P>
<PRE>
slapcat -f slapd.conf -b "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>For back-bdb and back-hdb, this command may be ran while slapd(8) is running.</P>
<P>MORE on actual Berkeley DB backups later covering db_recover etc.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Berkeley DB Logs">19.2. Berkeley DB Logs</A></H2>
<P>Berkeley DB log files grow, and the administrator has to deal with it. The procedure is known as log file archival or log file rotation.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The actual log file rotation is handled by the Berkeley DB engine.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>Logs of current transactions need to be stored into files so that the database can be recovered in the event of an application crash. Administrators can change the size limit of a single log file (by default 10MB), and have old log files removed automatically, by setting up DB environment (see below). The reason Berkeley DB never deletes any log files by default is that the administrator may wish to backup the log files before removal to make database recovery possible even after a catastrophic failure, such as file system corruption.</P>
<P>Log file names are <TT>log.XXXXXXXXXX</TT> (X is a digit). By default the log files are located in the BDB backend directory. The <TT>db_archive</TT> tool knows what log files are used in current transactions, and what are not. Administrators can move unused log files to a backup media, and delete them. To have them removed automatically, place set_flags <EM>DB_LOG_AUTOREMOVE</EM> directive in <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT>.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>If the log files are removed automatically, recovery after a catastrophic failure is likely to be impossible.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>The files with names <TT>__db.001</TT>, <TT>__db.002</TT>, etc are just shared memory regions (or whatever). These ARE NOT 'logs', they must be left alone. Don't be afraid of them, they do not grow like logs do.</P>
<P>To understand the <TT>db_archive</TT> interface, the reader should refer to chapter 9 of the Berkeley DB guide. In particular, the following chapters are recommended:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Database and log file archival - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/archival.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/archival.html</A>
<LI>Log file removal - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/logfile.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/logfile.html</A>
<LI>Recovery procedures - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/recovery.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/recovery.html</A>
<LI>Hot failover - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/hotfail.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/transapp/hotfail.html</A>
<LI>Complete list of Berkeley DB flags - <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/api_c/env_set_flags.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/api_c/env_set_flags.html</A></UL>
<P>Advanced installations can use special environment settings to fine-tune some Berkeley DB options (change the log file limit, etc). This can be done by using the <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> file. This magic file can be created in BDB backend directory set up by <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5). More information on this file can be found in File naming chapter. Specific directives can be found in C Interface, look for <EM>DB_ENV->set_XXXX</EM> calls.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>options set in <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> file override options set by OpenLDAP. Use them with extreme caution. Do not use them unless You know what You are doing.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>The advantages of <TT>DB_CONFIG</TT> usage can be the following:</P>
<UL>
<LI>to keep data files and log files on different mediums (i.e. disks) to improve performance and/or reliability;
<LI>to fine-tune some specific options (such as shared memory region sizes);
<LI>to set the log file limit (please read Log file limits before doing this).</UL>
<P>To figure out the best-practice BDB backup scenario, the reader is highly recommended to read the whole Chapter 9: Berkeley DB Transactional Data Store Applications. This chapter is a set of small pages with examples in C language. Non-programming people can skip these examples without loss of knowledge.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Checkpointing">19.3. Checkpointing</A></H2>
<P>MORE/TIDY</P>
<P>If you put "checkpoint 1024 5" in slapd.conf (to checkpoint after 1024kb or 5 minutes, for example), this does not checkpoint every 5 minutes as you may think. The explanation from Howard is:</P>
<P>'In OpenLDAP 2.1 and 2.2 the checkpoint directive acts as follows - *when there is a write operation*, and more than <check> minutes have occurred since the last checkpoint, perform the checkpoint. If more than <check> minutes pass after a write without any other write operations occurring, no checkpoint is performed, so it's possible to lose the last write that occurred.''</P>
<P>In other words, a write operation occurring less than "check" minutes after the last checkpoint will not be checkpointed until the next write occurs after "check" minutes have passed since the checkpoint.</P>
<P>This has been modified in 2.3 to indeed checkpoint every so often; in the meantime a workaround is to invoke "db_checkpoint" from a cron script every so often, say 5 minutes.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Migration">19.4. Migration</A></H2>
<P>The simplest steps needed to migrate between versions or upgrade, depending on your deployment type are:</P>
<UL>
</UL><OL>
<LI><B>Stop the current server when convenient</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>slapcat the current data out</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Clear out the current data directory (/usr/local/var/openldap-data/) leaving DB_CONFIG in place</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Perform the software upgrades</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>slapadd the exported data back into the directory</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Start the server</B></OL>
<P>Obviously this doesn't cater for any complicated deployments like <A HREF="#MirrorMode">MirrorMode</A> or <A HREF="#N-Way Multi-Master">N-Way Multi-Master</A>, but following the above sections and using either commercial support or community support should help. Also check the <A HREF="#Troubleshooting">Troubleshooting</A> section.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Monitoring">20. Monitoring</A></H1>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) supports an optional <TERM>LDAP</TERM> monitoring interface you can use to obtain information regarding the current state of your <EM>slapd</EM> instance. For instance, the interface allows you to determine how many clients are connected to the server currently. The monitoring information is provided by a specialized backend, the <EM>monitor</EM> backend. A manual page, <EM>slapd-monitor</EM>(5) is available.</P>
<P>When the monitoring interface is enabled, LDAP clients may be used to access information provided by the <EM>monitor</EM> backend, subject to access and other controls.</P>
<P>When enabled, the <EM>monitor</EM> backend dynamically generates and returns objects in response to search requests in the <EM>cn=Monitor</EM> subtree. Each object contains information about a particular aspect of the server. The information is held in a combination of user applications and operational attributes. This information can be access with <EM>ldapsearch(1)</EM>, with any general-purpose LDAP browser, or with specialized monitoring tools. The <A HREF="#Accessing Monitoring Information">Accessing Monitoring Information</A> section provides a brief tutorial on how to use <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) to access monitoring information, while the <A HREF="#Monitor information">Monitor information</A> section details monitoring information base and its organization.</P>
<P>While support for the monitor backend is included in default builds of slapd(8), this support requires some configuration to become active. This may be done using either <TT>cn=config</TT> or <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5). The former is discussed in the <A HREF="#Monitor configuration via cn=config">Monitor configuration via cn=config</A> section of this of this chapter. The latter is discussed in the <A HREF="#Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)">Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)</A> section of this chapter. These sections assume monitor backend is built into <EM>slapd</EM> (e.g., <TT>--enable-monitor=yes</TT>, the default). If the monitor backend was built as a module (e.g., <TT>--enable-monitor=mod</TT>, this module must loaded. Loading of modules is discussed in the <A HREF="#Configuring slapd">Configuring slapd</A> and <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> chapters.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Monitor configuration via cn=config(5)">20.1. Monitor configuration via cn=config(5)</A></H2>
<P><EM>This section has yet to be written.</EM></P>
<H2><A NAME="Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)">20.2. Monitor configuration via slapd.conf(5)</A></H2>
<P>Configuration of the slapd.conf(5) to support LDAP monitoring is quite simple.</P>
<P>First, ensure <EM>core.schema</EM> schema configuration file is included by your <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) file. The <EM>monitor</EM> backend requires it.</P>
<P>Second, instantiate the <EM>monitor backend</EM> by adding a <EM>database monitor</EM> directive below your existing database sections. For instance:</P>
<PRE>
database monitor
</PRE>
<P>Lastly, add additional global or database directives as needed.</P>
<P>Like most other database backends, the monitor backend does honor slapd(8) access and other administrative controls. As some monitor information may be sensitive, it is generally recommend access to cn=monitor be restricted to directory administrators and their monitoring agents. Adding an <EM>access</EM> directive immediately below the <EM>database monitor</EM> directive is a clear and effective approach for controlling access. For instance, the addition of the following <EM>access</EM> directive immediately below the <EM>database monitor</EM> directive restricts access to monitoring information to the specified directory manager.</P>
<PRE>
access to *
by dn.exact="cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com
by * none
</PRE>
<P>More information on <EM>slapd</EM>(8) access controls, see <EM>The access Control Directive</EM> section of the <A HREF="#The slapd Configuration File">The slapd Configuration File</A> chapter and <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5).</P>
<P>After restarting <EM>slapd</EM>(8), you are ready to start exploring the monitoring information provided in <TT>cn=config</TT> as discussed in the <A HREF="#Accessing Monitoring Information">Accessing Monitoring Information</A> section of this chapter.</P>
<P>One can verify slapd(8) is properly configured to provide monitoring information by attempting to read the <TT>cn=monitor</TT> object. For instance, if the following <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) command returns the cn=monitor object (with, as requested, no attributes), it's working.</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -D 'cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com' -W \
-b 'cn=Monitor' -s base 1.1
</PRE>
<P>Note that unlike general purpose database backends, the database suffix is hardcoded. It's always <TT>cn=Monitor</TT>. So no <EM>suffix</EM> directive should be provided. Also note that general purpose database backends, the monitor backend cannot be instantiated multiple times. That is, there can only be one (or zero) occurrences of <TT>database monitor</TT> in the server's configuration.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Accessing Monitoring Information">20.3. Accessing Monitoring Information</A></H2>
<P>As previously discussed, when enabled, the <EM>monitor</EM> backend dynamically generates and returns objects in response to search requests in the <EM>cn=Monitor</EM> subtree. Each object contains information about a particular aspect of the server. The information is held in a combination of user applications and operational attributes. This information can be access with <EM>ldapsearch(1)</EM>, with any general-purpose LDAP browser, or with specialized monitoring tools.</P>
<P>This section provides a provides a brief tutorial on how to use <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) to access monitoring information.</P>
<P>To inspect any particular monitor object, one performs search operation on the object with a baseObject scope and a <TT>(objectClass=*)</TT> filter. As the monitoring information is contained in a combination of user applications and operational attributes, the return all user applications attributes (e.g., <TT>'*'</TT>) and all operational attributes (e.g., <TT>'+'</TT>) should be requested. For instance, to read the <TT>cn=Monitor</TT> object itself, the <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1) command (modified to fit your configuration) can be used:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -D 'cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com' -W \
-b 'cn=Monitor' -s base '(objectClass=*)' '*' '+'
</PRE>
<P>When run against your server, this should produce output similar to:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Monitor
objectClass: monitorServer
structuralObjectClass: monitorServer
cn: Monitor
creatorsName:
modifiersName:
createTimestamp: 20061208223558Z
modifyTimestamp: 20061208223558Z
description: This subtree contains monitoring/managing objects.
description: This object contains information about this server.
description: Most of the information is held in operational attributes, which
must be explicitly requested.
monitoredInfo: OpenLDAP: slapd 2.4 (Dec 7 2006 17:30:29)
entryDN: cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: TRUE
</PRE>
<P>To reduce the number of uninteresting attributes returned, one can be more selective when requesting which attributes are to be returned. For instance, one could request the return of all attributes allowed by the <EM>monitorServer</EM> object class (e.g., <TT>@objectClass</TT>) instead of all user and all operational attributes:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -D 'cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com' -W \
-b 'cn=Monitor' -s base '(objectClass=*)' '@monitorServer'
</PRE>
<P>This limits the output as follows:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Monitor
objectClass: monitorServer
cn: Monitor
description: This subtree contains monitoring/managing objects.
description: This object contains information about this server.
description: Most of the information is held in operational attributes, which
must be explicitly requested.
monitoredInfo: OpenLDAP: slapd 2.X (Dec 7 2006 17:30:29)
</PRE>
<P>To return the names of all the monitoring objects, one performs a search of <TT>cn=Monitor</TT> with subtree scope and <TT>(objectClass=*)</TT> filter and requesting no attributes (e.g., <TT>1.1</TT>) be returned.</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -x -D 'cn=Manager,dc=example,dc=com' -W -b 'cn=Monitor' -s sub 1.1
</PRE>
<P>If you run this command you will discover that there are many objects in the <EM>cn=Monitor</EM> subtree. The following section describes some of the commonly available monitoring objects.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Monitor Information">20.4. Monitor Information</A></H2>
<P>The <EM>monitor</EM> backend provides a wealth of information useful for monitoring the slapd(8) contained in set of monitor objects. Each object contains information about a particular aspect of the server, such as a backends, a connection, or a thread. Some objects serve as containers for other objects and used to construct a hierarchy of objects.</P>
<P>In this hierarchy, the most superior object is {cn=Monitor}. While this object primarily serves as a container for other objects, most of which are containers, this object provides information about this server. In particular, it provides the slapd(8) version string. Example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: OpenLDAP: slapd 2.X (Dec 7 2006 17:30:29)
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Examples in this section (and its subsections) have been trimmed to show only key information.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="Backends">20.4.1. Backends</A></H3>
<P>The <TT>cn=Backends,cn=Monitor</TT> object, itself, provides a list of available backends. The list of available backends all builtin backends, as well as backends loaded by modules. For example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: config
monitoredInfo: ldif
monitoredInfo: monitor
monitoredInfo: bdb
monitoredInfo: hdb
</PRE>
<P>This indicates the <EM>config</EM>, <EM>ldif</EM>, <EM>monitor</EM>, <EM>bdb</EM>, and <EM>hdb</EM> backends are available.</P>
<P>The <TT>cn=Backends,cn=Monitor</TT> object is also a container for available backend objects. Each available backend object contains information about a particular backend. For example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Backend 0,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: config
monitorRuntimeConfig: TRUE
supportedControl: 2.16.840.1.113730.3.4.2
seeAlso: cn=Database 0,cn=Databases,cn=Monitor
dn: cn=Backend 1,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: ldif
monitorRuntimeConfig: TRUE
supportedControl: 2.16.840.1.113730.3.4.2
dn: cn=Backend 2,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: monitor
monitorRuntimeConfig: TRUE
supportedControl: 2.16.840.1.113730.3.4.2
seeAlso: cn=Database 2,cn=Databases,cn=Monitor
dn: cn=Backend 3,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: bdb
monitorRuntimeConfig: TRUE
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.12
supportedControl: 2.16.840.1.113730.3.4.2
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.666.5.2
supportedControl: 1.2.840.113556.1.4.319
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.13.1
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.13.2
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.1.10.1
supportedControl: 1.2.840.113556.1.4.1413
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.666.11.7.2
seeAlso: cn=Database 1,cn=Databases,cn=Monitor
dn: cn=Backend 4,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor
monitoredInfo: hdb
monitorRuntimeConfig: TRUE
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.12
supportedControl: 2.16.840.1.113730.3.4.2
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.666.5.2
supportedControl: 1.2.840.113556.1.4.319
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.13.1
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.1.13.2
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.1.10.1
supportedControl: 1.2.840.113556.1.4.1413
supportedControl: 1.3.6.1.4.1.4203.666.11.7.2
</PRE>
<P>For each of these objects, monitorInfo indicates which backend the information in the object is about. For instance, the <TT>cn=Backend 3,cn=Backends,cn=Monitor</TT> object contains (in the example) information about the <EM>bdb</EM> backend.</P>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Attribute</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Description</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
monitoredInfo
</TD>
<TD>
Name of backend
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
supportedControl
</TD>
<TD>
supported LDAP control extensions
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
seeAlso
</TD>
<TD>
Database objects of instances of this backend
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<H3><A NAME="Connections">20.4.2. Connections</A></H3>
<P>The main entry is empty; it should contain some statistics on the number of connections.</P>
<P>Dynamic child entries are created for each open connection, with stats on the activity on that connection (the format will be detailed later). There are two special child entries that show the number of total and current connections respectively.</P>
<P>For example:</P>
<P>Total Connections:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Total,cn=Connections,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorCounterObject
monitorCounter: 4
entryDN: cn=Total,cn=Connections,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<P>Current Connections:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Current,cn=Connections,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorCounterObject
monitorCounter: 2
entryDN: cn=Current,cn=Connections,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Databases">20.4.3. Databases</A></H3>
<P>The main entry contains the naming context of each configured database; the child entries contain, for each database, the type and the naming context.</P>
<P>For example:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Database 2,cn=Databases,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitoredObject
monitoredInfo: monitor
monitorIsShadow: FALSE
monitorContext: cn=Monitor
readOnly: FALSE
entryDN: cn=Database 2,cn=Databases,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Listener">20.4.4. Listener</A></H3>
<P>It contains the description of the devices the server is currently listening on:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Listener 0,cn=Listeners,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitoredObject
monitorConnectionLocalAddress: IP=0.0.0.0:389
entryDN: cn=Listener 0,cn=Listeners,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Log">20.4.5. Log</A></H3>
<P>It contains the currently active log items. The <EM>Log</EM> subsystem allows user modify operations on the <EM>description</EM> attribute, whose values <EM>MUST</EM> be in the list of admittable log switches:</P>
<PRE>
Trace
Packets
Args
Conns
BER
Filter
Config
ACL
Stats
Stats2
Shell
Parse
Sync
</PRE>
<P>These values can be added, replaced or deleted; they affect what messages are sent to the syslog device. Custom values could be added by custom modules.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Operations">20.4.6. Operations</A></H3>
<P>It shows some statistics on the operations performed by the server:</P>
<PRE>
Initiated
Completed
</PRE>
<P>and for each operation type, i.e.:</P>
<PRE>
Bind
Unbind
Add
Delete
Modrdn
Modify
Compare
Search
Abandon
Extended
</PRE>
<P>There are too many types to list example here, so please try for yourself using <A HREF="#Monitor search example">Monitor search example</A></P>
<H3><A NAME="Overlays">20.4.7. Overlays</A></H3>
<P>The main entry contains the type of overlays available at run-time; the child entries, for each overlay, contain the type of the overlay.</P>
<P>It should also contain the modules that have been loaded if dynamic overlays are enabled:</P>
<PRE>
# Overlays, Monitor
dn: cn=Overlays,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorContainer
monitoredInfo: syncprov
monitoredInfo: accesslog
monitoredInfo: glue
entryDN: cn=Overlays,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: TRUE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="SASL">20.4.8. SASL</A></H3>
<P>Currently empty.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Statistics">20.4.9. Statistics</A></H3>
<P>It shows some statistics on the data sent by the server:</P>
<PRE>
Bytes
PDU
Entries
Referrals
</PRE>
<P>e.g.</P>
<PRE>
# Entries, Statistics, Monitor
dn: cn=Entries,cn=Statistics,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorCounterObject
monitorCounter: 612248
entryDN: cn=Entries,cn=Statistics,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Threads">20.4.10. Threads</A></H3>
<P>It contains the maximum number of threads enabled at startup and the current backload.</P>
<P>e.g.</P>
<PRE>
# Max, Threads, Monitor
dn: cn=Max,cn=Threads,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitoredObject
monitoredInfo: 16
entryDN: cn=Max,cn=Threads,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Time">20.4.11. Time</A></H3>
<P>It contains two child entries with the start time and the current time of the server.</P>
<P>e.g.</P>
<P>Start time:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Start,cn=Time,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitoredObject
monitorTimestamp: 20061205124040Z
entryDN: cn=Start,cn=Time,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<P>Current time:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Current,cn=Time,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitoredObject
monitorTimestamp: 20061207120624Z
entryDN: cn=Current,cn=Time,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="TLS">20.4.12. TLS</A></H3>
<P>Currently empty.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Waiters">20.4.13. Waiters</A></H3>
<P>It contains the number of current read waiters.</P>
<P>e.g.</P>
<P>Read waiters:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Read,cn=Waiters,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorCounterObject
monitorCounter: 7
entryDN: cn=Read,cn=Waiters,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<P>Write waiters:</P>
<PRE>
dn: cn=Write,cn=Waiters,cn=Monitor
structuralObjectClass: monitorCounterObject
monitorCounter: 0
entryDN: cn=Write,cn=Waiters,cn=Monitor
subschemaSubentry: cn=Subschema
hasSubordinates: FALSE
</PRE>
<P>Add new monitored things here and discuss, referencing man pages and present examples</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Tuning">21. Tuning</A></H1>
<P>This is perhaps one of the most important chapters in the guide, because if you have not tuned <EM>slapd</EM>(8) correctly or grasped how to design your directory and environment, you can expect very poor performance.</P>
<P>Reading, understanding and experimenting using the instructions and information in the following sections, will enable you to fully understand how to tailor your directory server to your specific requirements.</P>
<P>It should be noted that the following information has been collected over time from our community based FAQ. So obviously the benefit of this real world experience and advice should be of great value to the reader.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Performance Factors">21.1. Performance Factors</A></H2>
<P>Various factors can play a part in how your directory performs on your chosen hardware and environment. We will attempt to discuss these here.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Memory">21.1.1. Memory</A></H3>
<P>Scale your cache to use available memory and increase system memory if you can.</P>
<P>See <A HREF="#Caching">Caching</A> for BDB cache tuning hints. Note that LMDB uses no cache of its own and has no tuning options, so the Caching section can be ignored when using LMDB.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Disks">21.1.2. Disks</A></H3>
<P>Use fast filesystems, and conduct your own testing to see which filesystem types perform best with your workload. (On our own Linux testing, EXT2 and JFS tend to provide better write performance than everything else, including newer filesystems like EXT4, BTRFS, etc.)</P>
<P>Use fast subsystems. Put each database and logs on separate disks (for BDB this is configurable via <EM>DB_CONFIG</EM>):</P>
<PRE>
# Data Directory
set_data_dir /data/db
# Transaction Log settings
set_lg_dir /logs
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Network Topology">21.1.3. Network Topology</A></H3>
<P>http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/363.html</P>
<P>Drawing here.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Directory Layout Design">21.1.4. Directory Layout Design</A></H3>
<P>Reference to other sections and good/bad drawing here.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Expected Usage">21.1.5. Expected Usage</A></H3>
<P>Discussion.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Indexes">21.2. Indexes</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Understanding how a search works">21.2.1. Understanding how a search works</A></H3>
<P>If you're searching on a filter that has been indexed, then the search reads the index and pulls exactly the entries that are referenced by the index. If the filter term has not been indexed, then the search must read every single entry in the target scope and test to see if each entry matches the filter. Obviously indexing can save a lot of work when it's used correctly.</P>
<H3><A NAME="What to index">21.2.2. What to index</A></H3>
<P>You should create indices to match the actual filter terms used in search queries.</P>
<PRE>
index cn,sn,givenname,mail eq
</PRE>
<P>Each attribute index can be tuned further by selecting the set of index types to generate. For example, substring and approximate search for organizations (o) may make little sense (and isn't like done very often). And searching for <EM>userPassword</EM> likely makes no sense what so ever.</P>
<P>General rule: don't go overboard with indexes. Unused indexes must be maintained and hence can only slow things down.</P>
<P>See <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(8) and <EM>slapdindex</EM>(8) for more information</P>
<H3><A NAME="Presence indexing">21.2.3. Presence indexing</A></H3>
<P>If your client application uses presence filters and if the target attribute exists on the majority of entries in your target scope, then all of those entries are going to be read anyway, because they are valid members of the result set. In a subtree where 100% of the entries are going to contain the same attributes, the presence index does absolutely NOTHING to benefit the search, because 100% of the entries match that presence filter.</P>
<P>So the resource cost of generating the index is a complete waste of CPU time, disk, and memory. Don't do it unless you know that it will be used, and that the attribute in question occurs very infrequently in the target data.</P>
<P>Almost no applications use presence filters in their search queries. Presence indexing is pointless when the target attribute exists on the majority of entries in the database. In most LDAP deployments, presence indexing should not be done, it's just wasted overhead.</P>
<P>See the <EM>Logging</EM> section below on what to watch our for if you have a frequently searched for attribute that is unindexed.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Logging">21.3. Logging</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="What log level to use">21.3.1. What log level to use</A></H3>
<P>The default of <EM>loglevel stats</EM> (256) is really the best bet. There's a corollary to this when problems *do* arise, don't try to trace them using syslog. Use the debug flag instead, and capture slapd's stderr output. syslog is too slow for debug tracing, and it's inherently lossy - it will throw away messages when it can't keep up.</P>
<P>Contrary to popular belief, <EM>loglevel 0</EM> is not ideal for production as you won't be able to track when problems first arise.</P>
<H3><A NAME="What to watch out for">21.3.2. What to watch out for</A></H3>
<P>The most common message you'll see that you should pay attention to is:</P>
<PRE>
"<= bdb_equality_candidates: (foo) index_param failed (18)"
</PRE>
<P>That means that some application tried to use an equality filter (<EM>foo=<somevalue></EM>) and attribute <EM>foo</EM> does not have an equality index. If you see a lot of these messages, you should add the index. If you see one every month or so, it may be acceptable to ignore it.</P>
<P>The default syslog level is stats (256) which logs the basic parameters of each request; it usually produces 1-3 lines of output. On Solaris and systems that only provide synchronous syslog, you may want to turn it off completely, but usually you want to leave it enabled so that you'll be able to see index messages whenever they arise. On Linux you can configure syslogd to run asynchronously, in which case the performance hit for moderate syslog traffic pretty much disappears.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Improving throughput">21.3.3. Improving throughput</A></H3>
<P>You can improve logging performance on some systems by configuring syslog not to sync the file system with every write (<EM>man syslogd/syslog.conf</EM>). In Linux, you can prepend the log file name with a "-" in <EM>syslog.conf</EM>. For example, if you are using the default LOCAL4 logging you could try:</P>
<PRE>
# LDAP logs
LOCAL4.* -/var/log/ldap
</PRE>
<P>For syslog-ng, add or modify the following line in <EM>syslog-ng.conf</EM>:</P>
<PRE>
options { sync(n); };
</PRE>
<P>where n is the number of lines which will be buffered before a write.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Caching">21.4. Caching</A></H2>
<P>We all know what caching is, don't we?</P>
<P>In brief, "A cache is a block of memory for temporary storage of data likely to be used again" - <A HREF="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Cache">http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Cache</A></P>
<P>There are 3 types of caches, BerkeleyDB's own cache, <EM>slapd</EM>(8) entry cache and <TERM>IDL</TERM> (IDL) cache.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Berkeley DB Cache">21.4.1. Berkeley DB Cache</A></H3>
<P>There are two ways to tune for the BDB cachesize:</P>
<P>(a) BDB cache size necessary to load the database via slapadd in optimal time</P>
<P>(b) BDB cache size necessary to have a high performing running slapd once the data is loaded</P>
<P>For (a), the optimal cachesize is the size of the entire database. If you already have the database loaded, this is simply a</P>
<PRE>
du -c -h *.bdb
</PRE>
<P>in the directory containing the OpenLDAP (<EM>/usr/local/var/openldap-data</EM>) data.</P>
<P>For (b), the optimal cachesize is just the size of the <EM>id2entry.bdb</EM> file, plus about 10% for growth.</P>
<P>The tuning of <EM>DB_CONFIG</EM> should be done for each BDB type database instantiated (back-bdb, back-hdb).</P>
<P>Note that while the <TERM>BDB</TERM> cache is just raw chunks of memory and configured as a memory size, the <EM>slapd</EM>(8) entry cache holds parsed entries, and the size of each entry is variable.</P>
<P>There is also an IDL cache which is used for Index Data Lookups. If you can fit all of your database into slapd's entry cache, and all of your index lookups fit in the IDL cache, that will provide the maximum throughput.</P>
<P>If not, but you can fit the entire database into the BDB cache, then you should do that and shrink the slapd entry cache as appropriate.</P>
<P>Failing that, you should balance the BDB cache against the entry cache.</P>
<P>It is worth noting that it is not absolutely necessary to configure a BerkeleyDB cache equal in size to your entire database. All that you need is a cache that's large enough for your "working set."</P>
<P>That means, large enough to hold all of the most frequently accessed data, plus a few less-frequently accessed items.</P>
<P>For more information, please see: <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/am_conf/cachesize.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/ref/am_conf/cachesize.html</A></P>
<H4><A NAME="Calculating Cachesize">21.4.1.1. Calculating Cachesize</A></H4>
<P>The back-bdb database lives in two main files, <TT>dn2id.bdb</TT> and <TT>id2entry.bdb</TT>. These are B-tree databases. We have never documented the back-bdb internal layout before, because it didn't seem like something anyone should have to worry about, nor was it necessarily cast in stone. But here's how it works today, in OpenLDAP 2.4.</P>
<P>A B-tree is a balanced tree; it stores data in its leaf nodes and bookkeeping data in its interior nodes (If you don't know what tree data structures look like in general, Google for some references, because that's getting far too elementary for the purposes of this discussion).</P>
<P>For decent performance, you need enough cache memory to contain all the nodes along the path from the root of the tree down to the particular data item you're accessing. That's enough cache for a single search. For the general case, you want enough cache to contain all the internal nodes in the database.</P>
<PRE>
db_stat -d
</PRE>
<P>will tell you how many internal pages are present in a database. You should check this number for both dn2id and id2entry.</P>
<P>Also note that <EM>id2entry</EM> always uses 16KB per "page", while <EM>dn2id</EM> uses whatever the underlying filesystem uses, typically 4 or 8KB. To avoid thrashing, your cache must be at least as large as the number of internal pages in both the <EM>dn2id</EM> and <EM>id2entry</EM> databases, plus some extra space to accommodate the actual leaf data pages.</P>
<P>For example, in my OpenLDAP 2.4 test database, I have an input LDIF file that's about 360MB. With the back-hdb backend this creates a <EM>dn2id.bdb</EM> that's 68MB, and an <EM>id2entry</EM> that's 800MB. db_stat tells me that <EM>dn2id</EM> uses 4KB pages, has 433 internal pages, and 6378 leaf pages. The id2entry uses 16KB pages, has 52 internal pages, and 45912 leaf pages. In order to efficiently retrieve any single entry in this database, the cache should be at least</P>
<PRE>
(433+1) * 4KB + (52+1) * 16KB in size: 1736KB + 848KB =~ 2.5MB.
</PRE>
<P>This doesn't take into account other library overhead, so this is even lower than the barest minimum. The default cache size, when nothing is configured, is only 256KB.</P>
<P>This 2.5MB number also doesn't take indexing into account. Each indexed attribute results in another database file. Earlier versions of OpenLDAP kept these index databases in Hash format, but from OpenLDAP 2.2 onward the index databases are in B-tree format so the same procedure can be used to calculate the necessary amount of cache for each index database.</P>
<P>For example, if your only index is for the objectClass attribute and db_stat reveals that <EM>objectClass.bdb</EM> has 339 internal pages and uses 4096 byte pages, the additional cache needed for just this attribute index is</P>
<PRE>
(339+1) * 4KB =~ 1.3MB.
</PRE>
<P>With only this index enabled, I'd figure at least a 4MB cache for this backend. (Of course you're using a single cache shared among all of the database files, so the cache pages will most likely get used for something other than what you accounted for, but this gives you a fighting chance.)</P>
<P>With this 4MB cache I can slapcat this entire database on my 1.3GHz PIII in 1 minute, 40 seconds. With the cache doubled to 8MB, it still takes the same 1:40s. Once you've got enough cache to fit the B-tree internal pages, increasing it further won't have any effect until the cache really is large enough to hold 100% of the data pages. I don't have enough free RAM to hold all the 800MB id2entry data, so 4MB is good enough.</P>
<P>With back-bdb and back-hdb you can use "db_stat -m" to check how well the database cache is performing.</P>
<P>For more information on <EM>db_stat</EM>: <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/utility/db_stat.html">http://www.oracle.com/technology/documentation/berkeley-db/db/utility/db_stat.html</A></P>
<H3><A NAME="{{slapd}}(8) Entry Cache (cachesize)">21.4.2. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) Entry Cache (cachesize)</A></H3>
<P>The <EM>slapd</EM>(8) entry cache operates on decoded entries. The rationale - entries in the entry cache can be used directly, giving the fastest response. If an entry isn't in the entry cache but can be extracted from the BDB page cache, that will avoid an I/O but it will still require parsing, so this will be slower.</P>
<P>If the entry is in neither cache then BDB will have to flush some of its current cached pages and bring in the needed pages, resulting in a couple of expensive I/Os as well as parsing.</P>
<P>The most optimal value is of course, the entire number of entries in the database. However, most directory servers don't consistently serve out their entire database, so setting this to a lesser number that more closely matches the believed working set of data is sufficient. This is the second most important parameter for the DB.</P>
<P>As far as balancing the entry cache vs the BDB cache - parsed entries in memory are generally about twice as large as they are on disk.</P>
<P>As we have already mentioned, not having a proper database cache size will cause performance issues. These issues are not an indication of corruption occurring in the database. It is merely the fact that the cache is thrashing itself that causes performance/response time to slowdown.</P>
<H3><A NAME="{{TERM:IDL}} Cache (idlcachesize)">21.4.3. <TERM>IDL</TERM> Cache (idlcachesize)</A></H3>
<P>Each IDL holds the search results from a given query, so the IDL cache will end up holding the most frequently requested search results. For back-bdb, it is generally recommended to match the "cachesize" setting. For back-hdb, it is generally recommended to be 3x"cachesize".</P>
<P>{NOTE: The idlcachesize setting directly affects search performance}</P>
<H2><A NAME="{{slapd}}(8) Threads">21.5. <EM>slapd</EM>(8) Threads</A></H2>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) can process requests via a configurable number of threads, which in turn affects the in/out rate of connections.</P>
<P>This value should generally be a function of the number of "real" cores on the system, for example on a server with 2 CPUs with one core each, set this to 8, or 4 threads per real core. This is a "read" maximized value. The more threads that are configured per core, the slower <EM>slapd</EM>(8) responds for "read" operations. On the flip side, it appears to handle write operations faster in a heavy write/low read scenario.</P>
<P>The upper bound for good read performance appears to be 16 threads (which also happens to be the default setting).</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Troubleshooting">22. Troubleshooting</A></H1>
<P>If you're having trouble using OpenLDAP, get onto the OpenLDAP-Software mailing list, or:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Browse the list archives at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/lists/#archives">http://www.openldap.org/lists/#archives</A>
<LI>Search the FAQ at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/">http://www.openldap.org/faq/</A>
<LI>Search the Issue Tracking System at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">http://www.openldap.org/its/</A></UL>
<P>Chances are the problem has been solved and explained in detail many times before.</P>
<H2><A NAME="User or Software errors">22.1. User or Software errors?</A></H2>
<P>More often than not, an error is caused by a configuration problem or a misunderstanding of what you are trying to implement and/or achieve.</P>
<P>We will now attempt to discuss common user errors.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Checklist">22.2. Checklist</A></H2>
<P>The following checklist can help track down your problem. Please try to use if <B>before</B> posting to the list, or in the rare circumstances of reporting a bug.</P>
<UL>
</UL><OL>
<LI><B>Use the <EM>slaptest</EM> tool to verify configurations before starting <EM>slapd</EM></B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Verify that <EM>slapd</EM> is listening to the specified port(s) (389 and 636, generally) before trying the <EM>ldapsearch</EM></B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Can you issue an <EM>ldapsearch</EM>?</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>If not, have you enabled complex ACLs without fully understanding them?</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Do you have a system wide LDAP setting pointing to the wrong LDAP Directory?</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Are you using TLS?</B>
<BR>
<LI><B>Have your certificates expired?</B></OL>
<H2><A NAME="OpenLDAP Bugs">22.3. OpenLDAP Bugs</A></H2>
<P>Sometimes you may encounter an actual OpenLDAP bug, in which case please visit our Issue Tracking system <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">http://www.openldap.org/its/</A> and report it. However, make sure it's not already a known bug or a common user problem.</P>
<UL>
<LI>bugs in historic versions of OpenLDAP will not be considered;
<LI>bugs in released versions that are no longer present in the Git master branch, either because they have been fixed or because they no longer apply, will not be considered as well;
<LI>bugs in distributions of OpenLDAP software that are not related to the software as provided by OpenLDAP will not be considered; in those cases please refer to the distributor.</UL>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>Our Issue Tracking system is <B>NOT</B> for OpenLDAP <B>Support</B>, please join our mailing Lists: <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/lists/">http://www.openldap.org/lists/</A> for that.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>The information you should provide in your bug report is discussed in our FAQ-O-MATIC at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/59.html">http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/59.html</A></P>
<H2><A NAME="3rd party software error">22.4. 3rd party software error</A></H2>
<P>The OpenLDAP Project only supports OpenLDAP software.</P>
<P>You may however seek commercial support (<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/support/">http://www.openldap.org/support/</A>) or join the general LDAP forum for non-commercial discussions and information relating to LDAP at: <A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/mailinglist.html">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/mailinglist.html</A></P>
<H2><A NAME="How to contact the OpenLDAP Project">22.5. How to contact the OpenLDAP Project</A></H2>
<UL>
<LI>Mailing Lists: <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/lists/">http://www.openldap.org/lists/</A>
<LI>Project: <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/project/">http://www.openldap.org/project/</A>
<LI>Issue Tracking: <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">http://www.openldap.org/its/</A></UL>
<H2><A NAME="How to present your problem">22.6. How to present your problem</A></H2>
<H2><A NAME="Debugging {{slapd}}(8)">22.7. Debugging <EM>slapd</EM>(8)</A></H2>
<P>After reading through the above sections and before e-mailing the OpenLDAP lists, you might want to try out some of the following to track down the cause of your problems:</P>
<UL>
<LI>Loglevel stats (256) is generally a good first loglevel to try for getting information useful to list members on issues
<LI>Running <EM>slapd -d -1</EM> can often track down fairly simple issues, such as missing schemas and incorrect file permissions for the <EM>slapd</EM> user to things like certs
<LI>Check your logs for errors, as discussed at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/358.html">http://www.openldap.org/faq/data/cache/358.html</A></UL>
<H2><A NAME="Commercial Support">22.8. Commercial Support</A></H2>
<P>The firms listed at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/support/">http://www.openldap.org/support/</A> offer technical support services catering to OpenLDAP community.</P>
<P>The listing of any given firm should not be viewed as an endorsement or recommendation of any kind, nor as otherwise indicating there exists a business relationship or an affiliation between any listed firm and the OpenLDAP Foundation or the OpenLDAP Project or its contributors.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Changes Since Previous Release">A. Changes Since Previous Release</A></H1>
<P>The following sections attempt to summarize the new features and changes in OpenLDAP software since the 2.3.x release and the OpenLDAP Admin Guide.</P>
<H2><A NAME="New Guide Sections">A.1. New Guide Sections</A></H2>
<P>In order to make the Admin Guide more thorough and cover the majority of questions asked on the OpenLDAP mailing lists and scenarios discussed there, we have added the following new sections:</P>
<UL>
<LI><A HREF="#When should I use LDAP">When should I use LDAP?</A>
<LI><A HREF="#When should I not use LDAP">When should I not use LDAP?</A>
<LI><A HREF="#LDAP vs RDBMS">LDAP vs RDBMS</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Access Control">Access Control</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Backends">Backends</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Overlays">Overlays</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Replication">Replication</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Maintenance">Maintenance</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Monitoring">Monitoring</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Tuning">Tuning</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Troubleshooting">Troubleshooting</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Changes Since Previous Release">Changes Since Previous Release</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Upgrading from 2.3.x">Upgrading from 2.3.x</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software">Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions">Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples">Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples</A>
<LI><A HREF="#OpenLDAP Software Contributions">OpenLDAP Software Contributions</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Configuration File Examples">Configuration File Examples</A>
<LI><A HREF="#LDAP Result Codes">LDAP Result Codes</A>
<LI><A HREF="#Glossary">Glossary</A></UL>
<P>Also, the table of contents is now 3 levels deep to ease navigation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="New Features and Enhancements in 2.4">A.2. New Features and Enhancements in 2.4</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="Better {{B:cn=config}} functionality">A.2.1. Better <B>cn=config</B> functionality</A></H3>
<P>There is a new slapd-config(5) manpage for the <B>cn=config</B> backend. The original design called for auto-renaming of config entries when you insert or delete entries with ordered names, but that was not implemented in 2.3. It is now in 2.4. This means, e.g., if you have</P>
<PRE>
olcDatabase={1}bdb,cn=config
olcSuffix: dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>and you want to add a new subordinate, now you can ldapadd:</P>
<PRE>
olcDatabase={1}bdb,cn=config
olcSuffix: dc=foo,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>This will insert a new BDB database in slot 1 and bump all following databases down one, so the original BDB database will now be named:</P>
<PRE>
olcDatabase={2}bdb,cn=config
olcSuffix: dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="Better {{B:cn=schema}} functionality">A.2.2. Better <B>cn=schema</B> functionality</A></H3>
<P>In 2.3 you were only able to add new schema elements, not delete or modify existing elements. In 2.4 you can modify schema at will. (Except for the hardcoded system schema, of course.)</P>
<H3><A NAME="More sophisticated Syncrepl configurations">A.2.3. More sophisticated Syncrepl configurations</A></H3>
<P>The original implementation of Syncrepl in OpenLDAP 2.2 was intended to support multiple consumers within the same database, but that feature never worked and was removed from OpenLDAP 2.3; you could only configure a single consumer in any database.</P>
<P>In 2.4 you can configure multiple consumers in a single database. The configuration possibilities here are quite complex and numerous. You can configure consumers over arbitrary subtrees of a database (disjoint or overlapping). Any portion of the database may in turn be provided to other consumers using the Syncprov overlay. The Syncprov overlay works with any number of consumers over a single database or over arbitrarily many glued databases.</P>
<H3><A NAME="N-Way Multimaster Replication">A.2.4. N-Way Multimaster Replication</A></H3>
<P>As a consequence of the work to support multiple consumer contexts, the syncrepl system now supports full N-Way multimaster replication with entry-level conflict resolution. There are some important constraints, of course: In order to maintain consistent results across all servers, you must maintain tightly synchronized clocks across all participating servers (e.g., you must use NTP on all servers).</P>
<P>The entryCSNs used for replication now record timestamps with microsecond resolution, instead of just seconds. The delta-syncrepl code has not been updated to support multimaster usage yet, that will come later in the 2.4 cycle.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Replicating {{slapd}} Configuration (syncrepl and {{B:cn=config}})">A.2.5. Replicating <EM>slapd</EM> Configuration (syncrepl and <B>cn=config</B>)</A></H3>
<P>Syncrepl was explicitly disabled on cn=config in 2.3. It is now fully supported in 2.4; you can use syncrepl to replicate an entire server configuration from one server to arbitrarily many other servers. It's possible to clone an entire running slapd using just a small (less than 10 lines) seed configuration, or you can just replicate the schema subtrees, etc. Tests 049 and 050 in the test suite provide working examples of these capabilities.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Push-Mode Replication">A.2.6. Push-Mode Replication</A></H3>
<P>In 2.3 you could configure syncrepl as a full push-mode replicator by using it in conjunction with a back-ldap pointed at the target server. But because the back-ldap database needs to have a suffix corresponding to the target's suffix, you could only configure one instance per slapd.</P>
<P>In 2.4 you can define a database to be "hidden", which means that its suffix is ignored when checking for name collisions, and the database will never be used to answer requests received by the frontend. Using this "hidden" database feature allows you to configure multiple databases with the same suffix, allowing you to set up multiple back-ldap instances for pushing replication of a single database to multiple targets. There may be other uses for hidden databases as well (e.g., using a syncrepl consumer to maintain a *local* mirror of a database on a separate filesystem).</P>
<H3><A NAME="More extensive TLS configuration control">A.2.7. More extensive TLS configuration control</A></H3>
<P>In 2.3, the TLS configuration in slapd was only used by the slapd listeners. For outbound connections used by e.g. back-ldap or syncrepl their TLS parameters came from the system's ldap.conf file.</P>
<P>In 2.4 all of these sessions inherit their settings from the main slapd configuration, but settings can be individually overridden on a per-config-item basis. This is particularly helpful if you use certificate-based authentication and need to use a different client certificate for different destinations.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Performance enhancements">A.2.8. Performance enhancements</A></H3>
<P>Too many to list. Some notable changes - ldapadd used to be a couple of orders of magnitude slower than "slapadd -q". It's now at worst only about half the speed of slapadd -q. Some comparisons of all the 2.x OpenLDAP releases are available at <A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/pub/hyc/scale2007.pdf">http://www.openldap.org/pub/hyc/scale2007.pdf</A></P>
<P>That compared 2.0.27, 2.1.30, 2.2.30, 2.3.33, and CVS HEAD). Toward the latter end of the "Cached Search Performance" chart it gets hard to see the difference because the run times are so small, but the new code is about 25% faster than 2.3, which was about 20% faster than 2.2, which was about 100% faster than 2.1, which was about 100% faster than 2.0, in that particular search scenario. That test basically searched a 1.3GB DB of 380836 entries (all in the slapd entry cache) in under 1 second. i.e., on a 2.4GHz CPU with DDR400 ECC/Registered RAM we can search over 500 thousand entries per second. The search was on an unindexed attribute using a filter that would not match any entry, forcing slapd to examine every entry in the DB, testing the filter for a match.</P>
<P>Essentially the slapd entry cache in back-bdb/back-hdb is so efficient the search processing time is almost invisible; the runtime is limited only by the memory bandwidth of the machine. (The search data rate corresponds to about 3.5GB/sec; the memory bandwidth on the machine is only about 4GB/sec due to ECC and register latency.)</P>
<H3><A NAME="New overlays">A.2.9. New overlays</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>slapo-constraint (Attribute value constraints)
<LI>slapo-dds (Dynamic Directory Services, RFC 2589)
<LI>slapo-memberof (reverse group membership maintenance)</UL>
<H3><A NAME="New features in existing Overlays">A.2.10. New features in existing Overlays</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>slapo-pcache<UL>
<LI>Inspection/Maintenance<UL>
<LI>the cache database can be directly accessed via LDAP by adding a specific control to each LDAP request; a specific extended operation allows to consistently remove cached entries and entire cached queries</UL>
<LI>Hot Restart<UL>
<LI>cached queries are saved on disk at shutdown, and reloaded if not expired yet at subsequent restart</UL></UL>
<LI>slapo-rwm can safely interoperate with other overlays
<LI>Dyngroup/Dynlist merge, plus security enhancements<UL>
<LI>added dgIdentity support (draft-haripriya-dynamicgroup)</UL></UL>
<H3><A NAME="New features in slapd">A.2.11. New features in slapd</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>monitoring of back-{b,h}db: cache fill-in, non-indexed searches,
<LI>session tracking control (draft-wahl-ldap-session)
<LI>subtree delete in back-sql (draft-armijo-ldap-treedelete)
<LI>sorted values in multivalued attributes for faster matching
<LI>lightweight dispatcher for greater throughput under heavy load and on multiprocessor machines. (33% faster than 2.3 on AMD quad-socket dual-core server.)</UL>
<H3><A NAME="New features in libldap">A.2.12. New features in libldap</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>ldap_sync client API (LDAP Content Sync Operation, RFC 4533)</UL>
<H3><A NAME="New clients, tools and tool enhancements">A.2.13. New clients, tools and tool enhancements</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>ldapexop for arbitrary extended operations
<LI>Complete support of controls in request/response for all clients
<LI>LDAP Client tools now honor SRV records</UL>
<H3><A NAME="New build options">A.2.14. New build options</A></H3>
<UL>
<LI>Support for building against GnuTLS</UL>
<H2><A NAME="Obsolete Features Removed From 2.4">A.3. Obsolete Features Removed From 2.4</A></H2>
<P>These features were strongly deprecated in 2.3 and removed in 2.4.</P>
<H3><A NAME="Slurpd">A.3.1. Slurpd</A></H3>
<P>Please read the <A HREF="#Replication">Replication</A> section as to why this is no longer in OpenLDAP</P>
<H3><A NAME="back-ldbm">A.3.2. back-ldbm</A></H3>
<P>back-ldbm was both slow and unreliable. Its byzantine indexing code was prone to spontaneous corruption, as were the underlying database libraries that were commonly used (e.g. GDBM or NDBM). back-bdb and back-hdb are superior in every aspect, with simplified indexing to avoid index corruption, fine-grained locking for greater concurrency, hierarchical caching for greater performance, streamlined on-disk format for greater efficiency and portability, and full transaction support for greater reliability.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Upgrading from 2.3.x">B. Upgrading from 2.3.x</A></H1>
<P>The following sections attempt to document the steps you will need to take in order to upgrade from the latest 2.3.x OpenLDAP version.</P>
<P>The normal upgrade procedure, as discussed in the <A HREF="#Maintenance">Maintenance</A> section, should of course still be followed prior to doing any of this.</P>
<H2><A NAME="{{B:cn=config}} olc* attributes">B.1. <B>cn=config</B> olc* attributes</A></H2>
<P>Quite a few <EM>olc*</EM> attributes have now become obsolete, if you see in your logs entries like below, just remove them from the relevant ldif file.</P>
<PRE>
olcReplicationInterval: value #0: <olcReplicationInterval> keyword is obsolete (ignored)
</PRE>
<H2><A NAME="ACLs: searches require privileges on the search base">B.2. ACLs: searches require privileges on the search base</A></H2>
<P>Search operations now require "search" privileges on the "entry" pseudo-attribute of the search base. While upgrading from 2.3.x, make sure your ACLs grant such privileges to all desired search bases.</P>
<P>For example, assuming you have the following ACL:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.sub="ou=people,dc=example,dc=com" by * search
</PRE>
<P>Searches using a base of "dc=example,dc=com" will only be allowed if you add the following ACL:</P>
<PRE>
access to dn.base="dc=example,dc=com" attrs=entry by * search
</PRE>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The <EM>slapd.access</EM>(5) man page states that this requirement was introduced with OpenLDAP 2.3. However, it is the default behavior only since 2.4.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>ADD MORE HERE</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software">C. Common errors encountered when using OpenLDAP Software</A></H1>
<P>The following sections attempt to summarize the most common causes of LDAP errors when using OpenLDAP</P>
<H2><A NAME="Common causes of LDAP errors">C.1. Common causes of LDAP errors</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Can\'t contact LDAP server">C.1.1. ldap_*: Can't contact LDAP server</A></H3>
<P>The <B>Can't contact LDAP server</B> error is usually returned when the LDAP server cannot be contacted. This may occur for many reasons:</P>
<UL>
<LI>the LDAP server is not running; this can be checked by running, for example,</UL>
<PRE>
telnet <host> <port>
</PRE>
<P>replacing <EM><host></EM> and <EM><port></EM> with the hostname and the port the server is supposed to listen on.</P>
<UL>
<LI>the client has not been instructed to contact a running server; with OpenLDAP command-line tools this is accomplished by providing the -H switch, whose argument is a valid LDAP url corresponding to the interface the server is supposed to be listening on.</UL>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: No such object">C.1.2. ldap_*: No such object</A></H3>
<P>The <B>no such object</B> error is generally returned when the target DN of the operation cannot be located. This section details reasons common to all operations. You should also look for answers specific to the operation (as indicated in the error message).</P>
<P>The most common reason for this error is non-existence of the named object. First, check for typos.</P>
<P>Also note that, by default, a new directory server holds no objects (except for a few system entries). So, if you are setting up a new directory server and get this message, it may simply be that you have yet to add the object you are trying to locate.</P>
<P>The error commonly occurs because a DN was not specified and a default was not properly configured.</P>
<P>If you have a suffix specified in slapd.conf eg.</P>
<PRE>
suffix "dc=example,dc=com"
</PRE>
<P>You should use</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -b 'dc=example,dc=com' '(cn=jane*)'
</PRE>
<P>to tell it where to start the search.</P>
<P>The <TT>-b</TT> should be specified for all LDAP commands unless you have an <EM>ldap.conf</EM>(5) default configured.</P>
<P>See <EM>ldapsearch</EM>(1), <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1)</P>
<P>Also, <EM>slapadd</EM>(8) and its ancillary programs are very strict about the syntax of the LDIF file.</P>
<P>Some liberties in the LDIF file may result in an apparently successful creation of the database, but accessing some parts of it may be difficult.</P>
<P>One known common error in database creation is putting a blank line before the first entry in the LDIF file. <B>There must be no leading blank lines in the LDIF file.</B></P>
<P>It is generally recommended that <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1) be used instead of <EM>slapadd</EM>(8) when adding new entries your directory. <EM>slapadd</EM>(8) should be used to bulk load entries known to be valid.</P>
<P>Another cause of this message is a referral ({SECT:Constructing a Distributed Directory Service}}) entry to an unpopulated directory.</P>
<P>Either remove the referral, or add a single record with the referral base DN to the empty directory.</P>
<P>This error may also occur when slapd is unable to access the contents of its database because of file permission problems. For instance, on a Red Hat Linux system, slapd runs as user 'ldap'. When slapadd is run as root to create a database from scratch, the contents of <TT>/var/lib/ldap</TT> are created with user and group root and with permission 600, making the contents inaccessible to the slapd server.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Can\'t chase referral">C.1.3. ldap_*: Can't chase referral</A></H3>
<P>This is caused by the line</P>
<PRE>
referral ldap://root.openldap.org
</PRE>
<P>In <TT>slapd.conf</TT>, it was provided as an example for how to use referrals in the original file. However if your machine is not permanently connected to the Internet, it will fail to find the server, and hence produce an error message.</P>
<P>To resolve, just place a # in front of line and restart slapd or point it to an available ldap server.</P>
<P>See also: <EM>ldapadd</EM>(1), <EM>ldapmodify</EM>(1) and <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5)</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: server is unwilling to perform">C.1.4. ldap_*: server is unwilling to perform</A></H3>
<P>slapd will return an unwilling to perform error if the backend holding the target entry does not support the given operation.</P>
<P>The password backend is only willing to perform searches. It will return an unwilling to perform error for all other operations.</P>
<P>The shell backend is configurable and may support a limited subset of operations. Check for other errors indicating a shortage of resources required by the directory server. i.e. you may have a full disk etc</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Insufficient access">C.1.5. ldap_*: Insufficient access</A></H3>
<P>This error occurs when server denies the operation due to insufficient access. This is usually caused by binding to a DN with insufficient privileges (or binding anonymously) to perform the operation.</P>
<P>You can bind as the rootdn/rootpw specified in <EM>slapd.conf</EM>(5) to gain full access. Otherwise, you must bind to an entry which has been granted the appropriate rights through access controls.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Invalid DN syntax">C.1.6. ldap_*: Invalid DN syntax</A></H3>
<P>The target (or other) DN of the operation is invalid. This implies that either the string representation of the DN is not in the required form, one of the types in the attribute value assertions is not defined, or one of the values in the attribute value assertions does not conform to the appropriate syntax.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Referral hop limit exceeded">C.1.7. ldap_*: Referral hop limit exceeded</A></H3>
<P>This error generally occurs when the client chases a referral which refers itself back to a server it already contacted. The server responds as it did before and the client loops. This loop is detected when the hop limit is exceeded.</P>
<P>This is most often caused through misconfiguration of the server's default referral. The default referral should not be itself:</P>
<P>That is, on <A HREF="ldap://myldap/">ldap://myldap/</A> the default referral should not be <A HREF="ldap://myldap/">ldap://myldap/</A> (or any hostname/ip which is equivalent to myldap).</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: operations error">C.1.8. ldap_*: operations error</A></H3>
<P>In some versions of <EM>slapd</EM>(8), <EM>operationsError</EM> was returned instead of other.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: other error">C.1.9. ldap_*: other error</A></H3>
<P>The other result code indicates an internal error has occurred. While the additional information provided with the result code might provide some hint as to the problem, often one will need to consult the server's log files.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add/modify: Invalid syntax">C.1.10. ldap_add/modify: Invalid syntax</A></H3>
<P>This error is reported when a value of an attribute does not conform to syntax restrictions. Additional information is commonly provided stating which value of which attribute was found to be invalid. Double check this value and other values (the server will only report the first error it finds).</P>
<P>Common causes include:</P>
<UL>
<LI>extraneous whitespace (especially trailing whitespace)
<LI>improperly encoded characters (LDAPv3 uses UTF-8 encoded Unicode)
<LI>empty values (few syntaxes allow empty values)</UL>
<P>For certain syntax, like OBJECT IDENTIFIER (OID), this error can indicate that the OID descriptor (a "short name") provided is unrecognized. For instance, this error is returned if the <EM>objectClass</EM> value provided is unrecognized.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add/modify: Object class violation">C.1.11. ldap_add/modify: Object class violation</A></H3>
<P>This error is returned with the entry to be added or the entry as modified violates the object class schema rules. Normally additional information is returned the error detailing the violation. Some of these are detailed below.</P>
<P>Violations related to the entry's attributes:</P>
<PRE>
Attribute not allowed
</PRE>
<P>A provided attribute is not allowed by the entry's object class(es).</P>
<PRE>
Missing required attribute
</PRE>
<P>An attribute required by the entry's object class(es) was not provided.</P>
<P>Violations related to the entry's class(es):</P>
<PRE>
Entry has no objectClass attribute
</PRE>
<P>The entry did not state which object classes it belonged to.</P>
<PRE>
Unrecognized objectClass
</PRE>
<P>One (or more) of the listed objectClass values is not recognized.</P>
<PRE>
No structural object class provided
</PRE>
<P>None of the listed objectClass values is structural.</P>
<PRE>
Invalid structural object class chain
</PRE>
<P>Two or more structural objectClass values are not in same structural object class chain.</P>
<PRE>
Structural object class modification
</PRE>
<P>Modify operation attempts to change the structural class of the entry.</P>
<PRE>
Instanstantiation of abstract objectClass.
</PRE>
<P>An abstract class is not subordinate to any listed structural or auxiliary class.</P>
<PRE>
Invalid structural object class
</PRE>
<P>Other structural object class problem.</P>
<PRE>
No structuralObjectClass operational attribute
</PRE>
<P>This is commonly returned when a shadow server is provided an entry which does not contain the structuralObjectClass operational attribute.</P>
<P>Note that the above error messages as well as the above answer assumes basic knowledge of LDAP/X.500 schema.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add: No such object">C.1.12. ldap_add: No such object</A></H3>
<P>The "ldap_add: No such object" error is commonly returned if parent of the entry being added does not exist. Add the parent entry first...</P>
<P>For example, if you are adding "cn=bob,dc=domain,dc=com" and you get:</P>
<PRE>
ldap_add: No such object
</PRE>
<P>The entry "dc=domain,dc=com" likely doesn't exist. You can use ldapsearch to see if does exist:</P>
<PRE>
ldapsearch -b 'dc=domain,dc=com' -s base '(objectclass=*)'
</PRE>
<P>If it doesn't, add it. See <A HREF="#A Quick-Start Guide">A Quick-Start Guide</A> for assistance.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>if the entry being added is the same as database suffix, it's parent isn't required. i.e.: if your suffix is "dc=domain,dc=com", "dc=com" doesn't need to exist to add "dc=domain,dc=com".
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>This error will also occur if you try to add any entry that the server is not configured to hold.</P>
<P>For example, if your database suffix is "dc=domain,dc=com" and you attempt to add "dc=domain2,dc=com", "dc=com", "dc=domain,dc=org", "o=domain,c=us", or an other DN in the "dc=domain,dc=com" subtree, the server will return a "No such object" (or referral) error.</P>
<P><EM>slapd</EM>(8) will generally return "no global superior knowledge" as additional information indicating its return noSuchObject instead of a referral as the server is not configured with knowledge of a global superior server.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap add: invalid structural object class chain">C.1.13. ldap add: invalid structural object class chain</A></H3>
<P>This particular error refers to the rule about STRUCTURAL objectclasses, which states that an object is of one STRUCTURAL class, the structural class of the object. The object is said to belong to this class, zero or more auxiliaries classes, and their super classes.</P>
<P>While all of these classes are commonly listed in the objectClass attribute of the entry, one of these classes is the structural object class of the entry. Thus, it is OK for an objectClass attribute to contain inetOrgPerson, organizationalPerson, and person because they inherit one from another to form a single super class chain. That is, inetOrgPerson SUPs organizationPerson SUPs person. On the other hand, it is invalid for both inetOrgPerson and account to be listed in objectClass as inetOrgPerson and account are not part of the same super class chain (unless some other class is also listed with is a subclass of both).</P>
<P>To resolve this problem, one must determine which class will better serve structural object class for the entry, adding this class to the objectClass attribute (if not already present), and remove any other structural class from the entry's objectClass attribute which is not a super class of the structural object class.</P>
<P>Which object class is better depends on the particulars of the situation. One generally should consult the documentation for the applications one is using for help in making the determination.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add: no structuralObjectClass operational attribute">C.1.14. ldap_add: no structuralObjectClass operational attribute</A></H3>
<P>ldapadd(1) may error:</P>
<PRE>
adding new entry "uid=XXX,ou=People,o=campus,c=ru"
ldap_add: Internal (implementation specific) error (80)
additional info: no structuralObjectClass operational attribute
</PRE>
<P>when slapd(8) cannot determine, based upon the contents of the objectClass attribute, what the structural class of the object should be.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add/modify/rename: Naming violation">C.1.15. ldap_add/modify/rename: Naming violation</A></H3>
<P>OpenLDAP's slapd checks for naming attributes and distinguished values consistency, according to RFC 4512.</P>
<P>Naming attributes are those attributeTypes that appear in an entry's RDN; distinguished values are the values of the naming attributes that appear in an entry's RDN, e.g, in</P>
<PRE>
cn=Someone+mail=someone@example.com,dc=example,dc=com
</PRE>
<P>the naming attributes are cn and mail, and the distinguished values are Someone and someone@example.com.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP's slapd checks for consistency when:</P>
<UL>
<LI>adding an entry
<LI>modifying an entry, if the values of the naming attributes are changed
<LI>renaming an entry, if the RDN of the entry changes</UL>
<P>Possible causes of error are:</P>
<UL>
<LI>the naming attributes are not present in the entry; for example:</UL>
<PRE>
dn: dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: organization
o: Example
# note: "dc: example" is missing
</PRE>
<UL>
<LI>the naming attributes are present in the entry, but in the attributeType definition they are marked as:<UL>
<LI>collective
<LI>operational
<LI>obsolete</UL>
<LI>the naming attributes are present in the entry, but the distinguished values are not; for example:</UL>
<PRE>
dn: dc=example,dc=com
objectClass: domain
dc: foobar
# note: "dc" is present, but the value is not "example"
</PRE>
<UL>
<LI>the naming attributes are present in the entry, with the distinguished values, but the naming attributes:<UL>
<LI>do not have an equality field, so equality cannot be asserted
<LI>the matching rule is not supported (yet)
<LI>the matching rule is not appropriate</UL>
<LI>the given distinguished values do not comply with their syntax
<LI>other errors occurred during the validation/normalization/match process; this is a catchall: look at previous logs for details in case none of the above apply to your case.</UL>
<P>In any case, make sure that the attributeType definition for the naming attributes contains an appropriate EQUALITY field; or that of the superior, if they are defined based on a superior attributeType (look at the SUP field). See RFC 4512 for details.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_add/delete/modify/rename: no global superior knowledge">C.1.16. ldap_add/delete/modify/rename: no global superior knowledge</A></H3>
<P>If the target entry name places is not within any of the databases the server is configured to hold and the server has no knowledge of a global superior, the server will indicate it is unwilling to perform the operation and provide the text "no global superior knowledge" as additional text.</P>
<P>Likely the entry name is incorrect, or the server is not properly configured to hold the named entry, or, in distributed directory environments, a default referral was not configured.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_bind: Insufficient access">C.1.17. ldap_bind: Insufficient access</A></H3>
<P>Current versions of slapd(8) requires that clients have authentication permission to attribute types used for authentication purposes before accessing them to perform the bind operation. As all bind operations are done anonymously (regardless of previous bind success), the auth access must be granted to anonymous.</P>
<P>In the example ACL below grants the following access:</P>
<UL>
<LI>to anonymous users:<UL>
<LI>permission to authenticate using values of userPassword</UL>
<LI>to authenticated users:<UL>
<LI>permission to update (but not read) their userPassword
<LI>permission to read any object excepting values of userPassword</UL></UL>
<P>All other access is denied.</P>
<PRE>
access to attr=userPassword
by self =w
by anonymous auth
access *
by self write
by users read
</PRE>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_bind: Invalid credentials">C.1.18. ldap_bind: Invalid credentials</A></H3>
<P>The error usually occurs when the credentials (password) provided does not match the userPassword held in entry you are binding to.</P>
<P>The error can also occur when the bind DN specified is not known to the server.</P>
<P>Check both! In addition to the cases mentioned above you should check if the server denied access to userPassword on selected parts of the directory. In fact, slapd always returns "Invalid credentials" in case of failed bind, regardless of the failure reason, since other return codes could reveal the validity of the user's name.</P>
<P>To debug access rules defined in slapd.conf, add "ACL" to log level.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_bind: Protocol error">C.1.19. ldap_bind: Protocol error</A></H3>
<P>There error is generally occurs when the LDAP version requested by the client is not supported by the server.</P>
<P>The OpenLDAP Software 2.x server, by default, only accepts version 3 LDAP Bind requests but can be configured to accept a version 2 LDAP Bind request.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>The 2.x server expects LDAPv3 [RFC4510] to be used when the client requests version 3 and expects a limited LDAPv3 variant (basically, LDAPv3 syntax and semantics in an LDAPv2 PDUs) to be used when version 2 is expected.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P>This variant is also sometimes referred to as LDAPv2+, but differs from the U-Mich LDAP variant in a number of ways.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_modify: cannot modify object class">C.1.20. ldap_modify: cannot modify object class</A></H3>
<P>This message is commonly returned when attempting to modify the objectClass attribute in a manner inconsistent with the LDAP/X.500 information model. In particular, it commonly occurs when one tries to change the structure of the object from one class to another, for instance, trying to change an 'apple' into a 'pear' or a 'fruit' into a 'pear'.</P>
<P>Such changes are disallowed by the slapd(8) in accordance with LDAP and X.500 restrictions.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: ..">C.1.21. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: ...</A></H3>
<P>If you intended to bind using a DN and password and get an error from ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s, you likely forgot to provide a '-x' option to the command. By default, SASL authentication is used. '-x' is necessary to select "simple" authentication.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such Object">C.1.22. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such Object</A></H3>
<P>This indicates that LDAP SASL authentication function could not read the Root DSE. The error will occur when the server doesn't provide a root DSE. This may be due to access controls.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such attribute">C.1.23. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: No such attribute</A></H3>
<P>This indicates that LDAP SASL authentication function could read the Root DSE but it contained no supportedSASLMechanism attribute.</P>
<P>The supportedSASLmechanism attribute lists mechanisms currently available. The list may be empty because none of the supported mechanisms are currently available. For example, EXTERNAL is listed only if the client has established its identity by authenticating at a lower level (e.g. TLS).</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>the attribute may not be visible due to access controls
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>SASL bind is the default for all OpenLDAP tools, e.g. ldapsearch(1), ldapmodify(1). To force use of "simple" bind, use the "-x" option. Use of "simple" bind is not recommended unless one has adequate confidentiality protection in place (e.g. TLS/SSL, IPSEC).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Unknown authentication method">C.1.24. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Unknown authentication method</A></H3>
<P>This indicates that none of the SASL authentication supported by the server are supported by the client, or that they are too weak or otherwise inappropriate for use by the client. Note that the default security options disallows the use of certain mechanisms such as ANONYMOUS and PLAIN (without TLS).</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>SASL bind is the default for all OpenLDAP tools. To force use of "simple" bind, use the "-x" option. Use of "simple" bind is not recommended unless one has adequate confidentiality protection in place (e.g. TLS/SSL, IPSEC).
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Local error (82)">C.1.25. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Local error (82)</A></H3>
<P>Apparently not having forward and reverse DNS entries for the LDAP server can result in this error.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_search: Partial results and referral received">C.1.26. ldap_search: Partial results and referral received</A></H3>
<P>This error is returned with the server responses to an LDAPv2 search query with both results (zero or more matched entries) and references (referrals to other servers). See also: ldapsearch(1).</P>
<P>If the updatedn on the replica does not exist, a referral will be returned. It may do this as well if the ACL needs tweaking.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_start_tls: Operations error">C.1.27. ldap_start_tls: Operations error</A></H3>
<P>ldapsearch(1) and other tools will return</P>
<PRE>
ldap_start_tls: Operations error (1)
additional info: TLS already started
</PRE>
<P>When the user (though command line options and/or ldap.conf(5)) has requested TLS (SSL) be started twice. For instance, when specifying both "-H ldaps://server.do.main" and "-ZZ".</P>
<H2><A NAME="Other Errors">C.2. Other Errors</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=34 (Numerical result out of range)">C.2.1. ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=34 (Numerical result out of range)</A></H3>
<P>This slapd error generally indicates that the client sent a message that exceeded an administrative limit. See sockbuf_max_incoming and sockbuf_max_incoming_auth configuration directives in slapd.conf(5).</P>
<H3><A NAME="ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=11 (Resource temporarily unavailable)">C.2.2. ber_get_next on fd X failed errno=11 (Resource temporarily unavailable)</A></H3>
<P>This message is not indicative of abnormal behavior or error. It simply means that expected data is not yet available from the resource, in this context, a network socket. slapd(8) will process the data once it does becomes available.</P>
<H3><A NAME="daemon: socket() failed errno=97 (Address family not supported)">C.2.3. daemon: socket() failed errno=97 (Address family not supported)</A></H3>
<P>This message indicates that the operating system does not support one of the (protocol) address families which slapd(8) was configured to support. Most commonly, this occurs when slapd(8) was configured to support IPv6 yet the operating system kernel wasn't. In such cases, the message can be ignored.</P>
<H3><A NAME="GSSAPI: gss_acquire_cred: Miscellaneous failure; Permission denied;">C.2.4. GSSAPI: gss_acquire_cred: Miscellaneous failure; Permission denied;</A></H3>
<P>This message means that slapd is not running as root and, thus, it cannot get its Kerberos 5 key from the keytab, usually file /etc/krb5.keytab.</P>
<P>A keytab file is used to store keys that are to be used by services or daemons that are started at boot time. It is very important that these secrets are kept beyond reach of intruders.</P>
<P>That's why the default keytab file is owned by root and protected from being read by others. Do not mess with these permissions, build a different keytab file for slapd instead, and make sure it is owned by the user that slapd runs as.</P>
<P>To do this, start kadmin, and enter the following commands:</P>
<PRE>
addprinc -randkey ldap/ldap.example.com@EXAMPLE.COM
ktadd -k /etc/openldap/ldap.keytab ldap/ldap.example.com@EXAMPLE.COM
</PRE>
<P>Then, on the shell, do:</P>
<PRE>
chown ldap:ldap /etc/openldap/ldap.keytab
chmod 600 /etc/openldap/ldap.keytab
</PRE>
<P>Now you have to tell slapd (well, actually tell the gssapi library in Kerberos 5 that is invoked by Cyrus SASL) where to find the new keytab. You do this by setting the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME like this:</P>
<PRE>
export KRB5_KTNAME="FILE:/etc/openldap/ldap.keytab"
</PRE>
<P>Set that environment variable on the slapd start script (Red Hat users might find /etc/sysconfig/ldap a perfect place).</P>
<P>This only works if you are using MIT kerberos. It doesn't work with Heimdal, for instance.</P>
<P>In Heimdal there is a function gsskrb5_register_acceptor_identity() that sets the path of the keytab file you want to use. In Cyrus SASL 2 you can add</P>
<PRE>
keytab: /path/to/file
</PRE>
<P>to your application's SASL config file to use this feature. This only works with Heimdal.</P>
<H3><A NAME="access from unknown denied">C.2.5. access from unknown denied</A></H3>
<P>This related to TCP wrappers. See hosts_access(5) for more information. in the log file: "access from unknown denied" This related to TCP wrappers. See hosts_access(5) for more information. for example: add the line "slapd: .hosts.you.want.to.allow" in /etc/hosts.allow to get rid of the error.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_read: want=# error=Resource temporarily unavailable">C.2.6. ldap_read: want=# error=Resource temporarily unavailable</A></H3>
<P>This message occurs normally. It means that pending data is not yet available from the resource, a network socket. slapd(8) will process the data once it becomes available.</P>
<H3><A NAME="`make test\' fails">C.2.7. `make test' fails</A></H3>
<P>Some times, `make test' fails at the very first test with an obscure message like</P>
<PRE>
make test
make[1]: Entering directory `/ldap_files/openldap-2.4.6/tests'
make[2]: Entering directory `/ldap_files/openldap-2.4.6/tests'
Initiating LDAP tests for BDB...
Cleaning up test run directory leftover from previous run.
Running ./scripts/all...
>>>>> Executing all LDAP tests for bdb
>>>>> Starting test000-rootdse ...
running defines.sh
Starting slapd on TCP/IP port 9011...
Using ldapsearch to retrieve the root DSE...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
./scripts/test000-rootdse: line 40: 10607 Segmentation fault $SLAPD -f $CONF1 -h $URI1 -d $LVL $TIMING >$LOG1 2>&1
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...
./scripts/test000-rootdse: kill: (10607) - No such pid
ldap_sasl_bind_s: Can't contact LDAP server (-1)
>>>>> Test failed
>>>>> ./scripts/test000-rootdse failed (exit 1)
make[2]: *** [bdb-yes] Error 1
make[2]: Leaving directory `/ldap_files/openldap-2.4.6/tests'
make[1]: *** [test] Error 2
make[1]: Leaving directory `/ldap_files/openldap-2.4.6/tests'
make: *** [test] Error 2
</PRE>
<P>or so. Usually, the five lines</P>
<P>Waiting 5 seconds for slapd to start...</P>
<P>indicate that slapd didn't start at all.</P>
<P>In tests/testrun/slapd.1.log there is a full log of what slapd wrote while trying to start. The log level can be increased by setting the environment variable SLAPD_DEBUG to the corresponding value; see loglevel in slapd.conf(5) for the meaning of log levels.</P>
<P>A typical reason for this behavior is a runtime link problem, i.e. slapd cannot find some dynamic libraries it was linked against. Try running ldd(1) on slapd (for those architectures that support runtime linking).</P>
<P>There might well be other reasons; the contents of the log file should help clarifying them.</P>
<P>Tests that fire up multiple instances of slapd typically log to tests/testrun/slapd.<n>.log, with a distinct <n> for each instance of slapd; list tests/testrun/ for possible values of <n>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_*: Internal (implementation specific) error (80) - additional info: entry index delete failed">C.2.8. ldap_*: Internal (implementation specific) error (80) - additional info: entry index delete failed</A></H3>
<P>This seems to be related with wrong ownership of the BDB's dir (/var/lib/ldap) and files. The files must be owned by the user that slapd runs as.</P>
<PRE>
chown -R ldap:ldap /var/lib/ldap
</PRE>
<P>fixes it in Debian</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Can\'t contact LDAP server (-1)">C.2.9. ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Can't contact LDAP server (-1)</A></H3>
<P>Using SASL, when a client contacts LDAP server, the slapd service dies immediately and client gets an error :</P>
<PRE>
SASL/GSSAPI authentication started ldap_sasl_interactive_bind_s: Can't contact LDAP server (-1)
</PRE>
<P>Then check the slapd service, it stopped.</P>
<P>This may come from incompatible of using different versions of BerkeleyDB for installing of SASL and installing of OpenLDAP. The problem arises in case of using multiple version of BerkeleyDB. Solution: - Check which version of BerkeleyDB when install Cyrus SASL.</P>
<P>Reinstall OpenLDAP with the version of BerkeleyDB above.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions">D. Recommended OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions</A></H1>
<P>This appendix details the recommended versions of the software that OpenLDAP depends on.</P>
<P>Please read the <A HREF="#Prerequisite software">Prerequisite software</A> section for more information on the following software dependencies.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Dependency Versions">D.1. Dependency Versions</A></H2>
<TABLE CLASS="columns" BORDER ALIGN='Center'>
<CAPTION ALIGN=top>Table 8.5: OpenLDAP Software Dependency Versions</CAPTION>
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Feature</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Software</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Version</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TERM>Transport Layer Security</TERM>:
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>0.9.7+</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">GnuTLS</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>2.12.0</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">MozNSS</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>3.12.9</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TERM>Simple Authentication and Security Layer</TERM>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>2.1.21+</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<TERM>Kerberos Authentication Service</TERM>:
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/">Heimdal</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Version</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">MIT Kerberos</A></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Version</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Database Software
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> <A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A>:</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>5.3</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Note: It is highly recommended to apply the patches from Oracle for a given release.</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Threads:
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT> </TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>POSIX <EM>pthreads</EM></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Version</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Mach <EM>CThreads</EM></TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Version</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
TCP Wrappers
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Name</TT>
</TD>
<TD>
<TT>Version</TT>
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples">E. Real World OpenLDAP Deployments and Examples</A></H1>
<P>Examples and discussions</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="OpenLDAP Software Contributions">F. OpenLDAP Software Contributions</A></H1>
<P>The following sections attempt to summarize the various contributions in OpenLDAP software, as found in <TT>openldap_src/contrib</TT></P>
<H2><A NAME="Client APIs">F.1. Client APIs</A></H2>
<P>Intro and discuss</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldapc++">F.1.1. ldapc++</A></H3>
<P>Intro and discuss</P>
<H3><A NAME="ldaptcl">F.1.2. ldaptcl</A></H3>
<P>Intro and discuss</P>
<H2><A NAME="Overlays">F.2. Overlays</A></H2>
<H3><A NAME="acl">F.2.1. acl</A></H3>
<P>Plugins that implement access rules. Currently only posixGroup, which implements access control based on posixGroup membership.</P>
<H3><A NAME="addpartial">F.2.2. addpartial</A></H3>
<P>Treat Add requests as Modify requests if the entry exists.</P>
<H3><A NAME="allop">F.2.3. allop</A></H3>
<P>Return operational attributes for root DSE even when not requested, since some clients expect this.</P>
<H3><A NAME="autogroup">F.2.4. autogroup</A></H3>
<P>Automated updates of group memberships.</P>
<H3><A NAME="comp_match">F.2.5. comp_match</A></H3>
<P>Component Matching rules (RFC 3687).</P>
<H3><A NAME="denyop">F.2.6. denyop</A></H3>
<P>Deny selected operations, returning <EM>unwillingToPerform</EM>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="dsaschema">F.2.7. dsaschema</A></H3>
<P>Permit loading DSA-specific schema, including operational attrs.</P>
<H3><A NAME="lastmod">F.2.8. lastmod</A></H3>
<P>Track the time of the last write operation to a database.</P>
<H3><A NAME="nops">F.2.9. nops</A></H3>
<P>Remove null operations, e.g. changing a value to same as before.</P>
<H3><A NAME="nssov">F.2.10. nssov</A></H3>
<P>Handle NSS lookup requests through a local Unix Domain socket.</P>
<H3><A NAME="passwd">F.2.11. passwd</A></H3>
<P>Support additional password mechanisms.</P>
<H3><A NAME="proxyOld">F.2.12. proxyOld</A></H3>
<P>Proxy Authorization compatibility with obsolete internet-draft.</P>
<H3><A NAME="smbk5pwd">F.2.13. smbk5pwd</A></H3>
<P>Make the PasswordModify Extended Operation update Kerberos keys and Samba password hashes as well as <EM>userPassword</EM>.</P>
<H3><A NAME="trace">F.2.14. trace</A></H3>
<P>Trace overlay invocation.</P>
<H3><A NAME="usn">F.2.15. usn</A></H3>
<P>Maintain <EM>usnCreated</EM> and <EM>usnChanged</EM> attrs similar to Microsoft AD.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Tools">F.3. Tools</A></H2>
<P>Intro and discuss</P>
<H3><A NAME="Statistic Logging">F.3.1. Statistic Logging</A></H3>
<P>statslog</P>
<H2><A NAME="SLAPI Plugins">F.4. SLAPI Plugins</A></H2>
<P>Intro and discuss</P>
<H3><A NAME="addrdnvalues">F.4.1. addrdnvalues</A></H3>
<P>More</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Configuration File Examples">G. Configuration File Examples</A></H1>
<H2><A NAME="slapd.conf">G.1. slapd.conf</A></H2>
<H2><A NAME="ldap.conf">G.2. ldap.conf</A></H2>
<H2><A NAME="a-n-other.conf">G.3. a-n-other.conf</A></H2>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="LDAP Result Codes">H. LDAP Result Codes</A></H1>
<P>For the purposes of this guide, we have incorporated the standard LDAP result codes from <EM>Appendix A. LDAP Result Codes</EM> of <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A>, a copy of which can be found in <TT>doc/rfc</TT> of the OpenLDAP source code.</P>
<P>We have expanded the description of each error in relation to the OpenLDAP toolsets. LDAP extensions may introduce extension-specific result codes, which are not part of RFC4511. OpenLDAP returns the result codes related to extensions it implements. Their meaning is documented in the extension they are related to.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Non-Error Result Codes">H.1. Non-Error Result Codes</A></H2>
<P>These result codes (called "non-error" result codes) do not indicate an error condition:</P>
<PRE>
success (0),
compareFalse (5),
compareTrue (6),
referral (10), and
saslBindInProgress (14).
</PRE>
<P>The <EM>success</EM>, <EM>compareTrue</EM>, and <EM>compareFalse</EM> result codes indicate successful completion (and, hence, are referred to as "successful" result codes).</P>
<P>The <EM>referral</EM> and <EM>saslBindInProgress</EM> result codes indicate the client needs to take additional action to complete the operation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Result Codes">H.2. Result Codes</A></H2>
<P>Existing LDAP result codes are described as follows:</P>
<H2><A NAME="success (0)">H.3. success (0)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the successful completion of an operation.</P>
<P><HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left">
<STRONG>Note: </STRONG>this code is not used with the Compare operation. See <A HREF="#compareFalse (5)">compareFalse (5)</A> and <A HREF="#compareTrue (6)">compareTrue (6)</A>.
<HR WIDTH="80%" ALIGN="Left"></P>
<H2><A NAME="operationsError (1)">H.4. operationsError (1)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the operation is not properly sequenced with relation to other operations (of same or different type).</P>
<P>For example, this code is returned if the client attempts to StartTLS (<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A> Section 4.14) while there are other uncompleted operations or if a TLS layer was already installed.</P>
<H2><A NAME="protocolError (2)">H.5. protocolError (2)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the server received data that is not well-formed.</P>
<P>For Bind operation only, this code is also used to indicate that the server does not support the requested protocol version.</P>
<P>For Extended operations only, this code is also used to indicate that the server does not support (by design or configuration) the Extended operation associated with the <EM>requestName</EM>.</P>
<P>For request operations specifying multiple controls, this may be used to indicate that the server cannot ignore the order of the controls as specified, or that the combination of the specified controls is invalid or unspecified.</P>
<H2><A NAME="timeLimitExceeded (3)">H.6. timeLimitExceeded (3)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the time limit specified by the client was exceeded before the operation could be completed.</P>
<H2><A NAME="sizeLimitExceeded (4)">H.7. sizeLimitExceeded (4)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the size limit specified by the client was exceeded before the operation could be completed.</P>
<H2><A NAME="compareFalse (5)">H.8. compareFalse (5)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the Compare operation has successfully completed and the assertion has evaluated to FALSE or Undefined.</P>
<H2><A NAME="compareTrue (6)">H.9. compareTrue (6)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the Compare operation has successfully completed and the assertion has evaluated to TRUE.</P>
<H2><A NAME="authMethodNotSupported (7)">H.10. authMethodNotSupported (7)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the authentication method or mechanism is not supported.</P>
<H2><A NAME="strongerAuthRequired (8)">H.11. strongerAuthRequired (8)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the server requires strong(er) authentication in order to complete the operation.</P>
<P>When used with the Notice of Disconnection operation, this code indicates that the server has detected that an established security association between the client and server has unexpectedly failed or been compromised.</P>
<H2><A NAME="referral (10)">H.12. referral (10)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that a referral needs to be chased to complete the operation (see <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A> Section 4.1.10).</P>
<H2><A NAME="adminLimitExceeded (11)">H.13. adminLimitExceeded (11)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that an administrative limit has been exceeded.</P>
<H2><A NAME="unavailableCriticalExtension (12)">H.14. unavailableCriticalExtension (12)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates a critical control is unrecognized (see <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A> Section 4.1.11).</P>
<H2><A NAME="confidentialityRequired (13)">H.15. confidentialityRequired (13)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that data confidentiality protections are required.</P>
<H2><A NAME="saslBindInProgress (14)">H.16. saslBindInProgress (14)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the server requires the client to send a new bind request, with the same SASL mechanism, to continue the authentication process (see <A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A> Section 4.2).</P>
<H2><A NAME="noSuchAttribute (16)">H.17. noSuchAttribute (16)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the named entry does not contain the specified attribute or attribute value.</P>
<H2><A NAME="undefinedAttributeType (17)">H.18. undefinedAttributeType (17)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that a request field contains an unrecognized attribute description.</P>
<H2><A NAME="inappropriateMatching (18)">H.19. inappropriateMatching (18)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that an attempt was made (e.g., in an assertion) to use a matching rule not defined for the attribute type concerned.</P>
<H2><A NAME="constraintViolation (19)">H.20. constraintViolation (19)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the client supplied an attribute value that does not conform to the constraints placed upon it by the data model.</P>
<P>For example, this code is returned when multiple values are supplied to an attribute that has a SINGLE-VALUE constraint.</P>
<H2><A NAME="attributeOrValueExists (20)">H.21. attributeOrValueExists (20)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the client supplied an attribute or value to be added to an entry, but the attribute or value already exists.</P>
<H2><A NAME="invalidAttributeSyntax (21)">H.22. invalidAttributeSyntax (21)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that a purported attribute value does not conform to the syntax of the attribute.</P>
<H2><A NAME="noSuchObject (32)">H.23. noSuchObject (32)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the object does not exist in the DIT.</P>
<H2><A NAME="aliasProblem (33)">H.24. aliasProblem (33)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that an alias problem has occurred. For example, the code may used to indicate an alias has been dereferenced that names no object.</P>
<H2><A NAME="invalidDNSyntax (34)">H.25. invalidDNSyntax (34)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that an LDAPDN or RelativeLDAPDN field (e.g., search base, target entry, ModifyDN newrdn, etc.) of a request does not conform to the required syntax or contains attribute values that do not conform to the syntax of the attribute's type.</P>
<H2><A NAME="aliasDereferencingProblem (36)">H.26. aliasDereferencingProblem (36)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that a problem occurred while dereferencing an alias. Typically, an alias was encountered in a situation where it was not allowed or where access was denied.</P>
<H2><A NAME="inappropriateAuthentication (48)">H.27. inappropriateAuthentication (48)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the server requires the client that had attempted to bind anonymously or without supplying credentials to provide some form of credentials.</P>
<H2><A NAME="invalidCredentials (49)">H.28. invalidCredentials (49)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the provided credentials (e.g., the user's name and password) are invalid.</P>
<H2><A NAME="insufficientAccessRights (50)">H.29. insufficientAccessRights (50)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the client does not have sufficient access rights to perform the operation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="busy (51)">H.30. busy (51)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the server is too busy to service the operation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="unavailable (52)">H.31. unavailable (52)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the server is shutting down or a subsystem necessary to complete the operation is offline.</P>
<H2><A NAME="unwillingToPerform (53)">H.32. unwillingToPerform (53)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the server is unwilling to perform the operation.</P>
<H2><A NAME="loopDetect (54)">H.33. loopDetect (54)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the server has detected an internal loop (e.g., while dereferencing aliases or chaining an operation).</P>
<H2><A NAME="namingViolation (64)">H.34. namingViolation (64)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the entry's name violates naming restrictions.</P>
<H2><A NAME="objectClassViolation (65)">H.35. objectClassViolation (65)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the entry violates object class restrictions.</P>
<H2><A NAME="notAllowedOnNonLeaf (66)">H.36. notAllowedOnNonLeaf (66)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the operation is inappropriately acting upon a non-leaf entry.</P>
<H2><A NAME="notAllowedOnRDN (67)">H.37. notAllowedOnRDN (67)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the operation is inappropriately attempting to remove a value that forms the entry's relative distinguished name.</P>
<H2><A NAME="entryAlreadyExists (68)">H.38. entryAlreadyExists (68)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the request cannot be fulfilled (added, moved, or renamed) as the target entry already exists.</P>
<H2><A NAME="objectClassModsProhibited (69)">H.39. objectClassModsProhibited (69)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that an attempt to modify the object class(es) of an entry's 'objectClass' attribute is prohibited.</P>
<P>For example, this code is returned when a client attempts to modify the structural object class of an entry.</P>
<H2><A NAME="affectsMultipleDSAs (71)">H.40. affectsMultipleDSAs (71)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates that the operation cannot be performed as it would affect multiple servers (DSAs).</P>
<H2><A NAME="other (80)">H.41. other (80)</A></H2>
<P>Indicates the server has encountered an internal error.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Glossary">I. Glossary</A></H1>
<H2><A NAME="Terms">I.1. Terms</A></H2>
<TABLE CLASS="plain">
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Term</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Definition</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
3DES
</TD>
<TD>
Triple DES
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ABNF
</TD>
<TD>
Augmented Backus-Naur Form
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ACDF
</TD>
<TD>
Access Control Decision Function
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ACE
</TD>
<TD>
ASCII Compatible Encoding
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ASCII
</TD>
<TD>
American Standard Code for Information Interchange
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ACID
</TD>
<TD>
Atomicity, Consistency, Isolation, and Durability
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ACI
</TD>
<TD>
Access Control Information
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ACL
</TD>
<TD>
Access Control List
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AES
</TD>
<TD>
Advance Encryption Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ABI
</TD>
<TD>
Application Binary Interface
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
API
</TD>
<TD>
Application Program Interface
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ASN.1
</TD>
<TD>
Abstract Syntax Notation - One
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AVA
</TD>
<TD>
Attribute Value Assertion
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AuthcDN
</TD>
<TD>
Authentication DN
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AuthcId
</TD>
<TD>
Authentication Identity
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AuthzDN
</TD>
<TD>
Authorization DN
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
AuthzId
</TD>
<TD>
Authorization Identity
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
BCP
</TD>
<TD>
Best Current Practice
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
BDB
</TD>
<TD>
Berkeley DB (Backend)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
BER
</TD>
<TD>
Basic Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
BNF
</TD>
<TD>
Backus-Naur Form
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
C
</TD>
<TD>
The C Programming Language
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CA
</TD>
<TD>
Certificate Authority
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CER
</TD>
<TD>
Canonical Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CLDAP
</TD>
<TD>
Connection-less LDAP
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CN
</TD>
<TD>
Common Name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CRAM-MD5
</TD>
<TD>
SASL MD5 Challenge/Response Authentication Mechanism
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
CRL
</TD>
<TD>
Certificate Revocation List
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DAP
</TD>
<TD>
Directory Access Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DC
</TD>
<TD>
Domain Component
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DER
</TD>
<TD>
Distinguished Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DES
</TD>
<TD>
Data Encryption Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DIB
</TD>
<TD>
Directory Information Base
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DIGEST-MD5
</TD>
<TD>
SASL Digest MD5 Authentication Mechanism
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DISP
</TD>
<TD>
Directory Information Shadowing Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DIT
</TD>
<TD>
Directory Information Tree
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DNS
</TD>
<TD>
Domain Name System
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DN
</TD>
<TD>
Distinguished Name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DOP
</TD>
<TD>
Directory Operational Binding Management Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DSAIT
</TD>
<TD>
DSA Information Tree
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DSA
</TD>
<TD>
Directory System Agent
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DSE
</TD>
<TD>
DSA-specific Entry
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DSP
</TD>
<TD>
Directory System Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DS
</TD>
<TD>
Draft Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
DUA
</TD>
<TD>
Directory User Agent
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
EXTERNAL
</TD>
<TD>
SASL External Authentication Mechanism
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
FAQ
</TD>
<TD>
Frequently Asked Questions
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
FTP
</TD>
<TD>
File Transfer Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
FYI
</TD>
<TD>
For Your Information
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
GSER
</TD>
<TD>
Generic String Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
GSS-API
</TD>
<TD>
Generic Security Service Application Program Interface
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
GSSAPI
</TD>
<TD>
SASL Kerberos V GSS-API Authentication Mechanism
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
HDB
</TD>
<TD>
Hierarchical Database (Backend)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
I-D
</TD>
<TD>
Internet-Draft
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IA5
</TD>
<TD>
International Alphabet 5
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IDNA
</TD>
<TD>
Internationalized Domain Names in Applications
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IDN
</TD>
<TD>
Internationalized Domain Name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ID
</TD>
<TD>
Identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IDL
</TD>
<TD>
Index Data Lookups
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IP
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IPC
</TD>
<TD>
Inter-process communication
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IPsec
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Protocol Security
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IPv4
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Protocol, version 4
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
IPv6
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Protocol, version 6
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
ITS
</TD>
<TD>
Issue Tracking System
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
JPEG
</TD>
<TD>
Joint Photographic Experts Group
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Kerberos
</TD>
<TD>
Kerberos Authentication Service
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LBER
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight BER
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LDAP Sync
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP Content Synchronization
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LDAPv3
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP, version 3
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LDIF
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP Data Interchange Format
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
LMDB
</TD>
<TD>
Lightning Memory-Mapped Database
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
MD5
</TD>
<TD>
Message Digest 5
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
MDB
</TD>
<TD>
Memory-Mapped Database (Backend)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
MIB
</TD>
<TD>
Management Information Base
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
MODDN
</TD>
<TD>
Modify DN
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
MODRDN
</TD>
<TD>
Modify RDN
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
NSSR
</TD>
<TD>
Non-specific Subordinate Reference
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
OID
</TD>
<TD>
Object Identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
OSI
</TD>
<TD>
Open Systems Interconnect
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
OTP
</TD>
<TD>
One Time Password
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PDU
</TD>
<TD>
Protocol Data Unit
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PEM
</TD>
<TD>
Privacy Enhanced eMail
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PEN
</TD>
<TD>
Private Enterprise Number
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PKCS
</TD>
<TD>
Public Key Cryptosystem
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PKI
</TD>
<TD>
Public Key Infrastructure
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PKIX
</TD>
<TD>
Public Key Infrastructure (X.509)
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PLAIN
</TD>
<TD>
SASL Plaintext Password Authentication Mechanism
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
POSIX
</TD>
<TD>
Portable Operating System Interface
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
Proposed Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
RDN
</TD>
<TD>
Relative Distinguished Name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
RFC
</TD>
<TD>
Request for Comments
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
RPC
</TD>
<TD>
Remote Procedure Call
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
RXER
</TD>
<TD>
Robust XML Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SASL
</TD>
<TD>
Simple Authentication and Security Layer
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SDF
</TD>
<TD>
Simple Document Format
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SDSE
</TD>
<TD>
Shadowed DSE
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SHA1
</TD>
<TD>
Secure Hash Algorithm 1
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SLAPD
</TD>
<TD>
Standalone LDAP Daemon
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SLURPD
</TD>
<TD>
Standalone LDAP Update Replication Daemon
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SMTP
</TD>
<TD>
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SNMP
</TD>
<TD>
Simple Network Management Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SQL
</TD>
<TD>
Structured Query Language
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SRP
</TD>
<TD>
Secure Remote Password
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SSF
</TD>
<TD>
Security Strength Factor
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
SSL
</TD>
<TD>
Secure Socket Layer
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
STD
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
TCP
</TD>
<TD>
Transmission Control Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
TLS
</TD>
<TD>
Transport Layer Security
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UCS
</TD>
<TD>
Universal Multiple-Octet Coded Character Set
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UDP
</TD>
<TD>
User Datagram Protocol
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UID
</TD>
<TD>
User Identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
Unicode
</TD>
<TD>
The Unicode Standard
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UNIX
</TD>
<TD>
Unix
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
URI
</TD>
<TD>
Uniform Resource Identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
URL
</TD>
<TD>
Uniform Resource Locator
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
URN
</TD>
<TD>
Uniform Resource Name
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UTF-8
</TD>
<TD>
8-bit UCS/Unicode Transformation Format
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UTR
</TD>
<TD>
Unicode Technical Report
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
UUID
</TD>
<TD>
Universally Unique Identifier
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
WWW
</TD>
<TD>
World Wide Web
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
X.500
</TD>
<TD>
X.500 Directory Services
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
X.509
</TD>
<TD>
X.509 Public Key and Attribute Certificate Frameworks
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
XED
</TD>
<TD>
XML Enabled Directory
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
XER
</TD>
<TD>
XML Encoding Rules
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
XML
</TD>
<TD>
Extensible Markup Language
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
syncrepl
</TD>
<TD>
LDAP Sync-based Replication
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<H2><A NAME="Related Organizations">I.2. Related Organizations</A></H2>
<TABLE CLASS="plain">
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Name</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Long</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Jump</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ansi.org/">ANSI</A>
</TD>
<TD>
American National Standards Institute
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ansi.org/">http://www.ansi.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.bsi-global.com/">BSI</A>
</TD>
<TD>
British Standards Institute
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.bsi-global.com/">http://www.bsi-global.com/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<ORG>COSINE</ORG>
</TD>
<TD>
Co-operation and Open Systems Interconnection in Europe
</TD>
<TD>
<JUMP> </JUMP>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cpan.org/">CPAN</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Comprehensive Perl Archive Network
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cpan.org/">http://cpan.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/">Cyrus</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Project Cyrus
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/">http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.fsf.org/">FSF</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Free Software Foundation
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.fsf.org/">http://www.fsf.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/">GNU</A>
</TD>
<TD>
GNU Not Unix Project
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/">http://www.gnu.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iab.org/">IAB</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Architecture Board
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iab.org/">http://www.iab.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iana.org/">IANA</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Assigned Numbers Authority
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iana.org/">http://www.iana.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ieee.org">IEEE</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ieee.org">http://www.ieee.org</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ietf.org/iesg/">IESG</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Engineering Steering Group
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ietf.org/iesg/">http://www.ietf.org/iesg/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ietf.org/">IETF</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Engineering Task Force
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.ietf.org/">http://www.ietf.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.irtf.org/">IRTF</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Research Task Force
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.irtf.org/">http://www.irtf.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iso.org/">ISO</A>
</TD>
<TD>
International Standards Organisation
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.iso.org/">http://www.iso.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.isoc.org/">ISOC</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Internet Society
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.isoc.org/">http://www.isoc.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.itu.int/">ITU</A>
</TD>
<TD>
International Telephone Union
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.itu.int/">http://www.itu.int/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/foundation/">OLF</A>
</TD>
<TD>
OpenLDAP Foundation
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/foundation/">http://www.openldap.org/foundation/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/project/">OLP</A>
</TD>
<TD>
OpenLDAP Project
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/project/">http://www.openldap.org/project/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A>
</TD>
<TD>
OpenSSL Project
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">http://www.openssl.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/">RFC Editor</A>
</TD>
<TD>
RFC Editor
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/">http://www.rfc-editor.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/">Oracle</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Oracle Corporation
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/">http://www.oracle.com/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/">UM</A>
</TD>
<TD>
University of Michigan
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/">http://www.umich.edu/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">UMLDAP</A>
</TD>
<TD>
University of Michigan LDAP Team
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<H2><A NAME="Related Products">I.3. Related Products</A></H2>
<TABLE CLASS="plain">
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Name</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Jump</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://search.cpan.org/src/IANC/sdf-2.001/doc/catalog.html">SDF</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://search.cpan.org/src/IANC/sdf-2.001/doc/catalog.html">http://search.cpan.org/src/IANC/sdf-2.001/doc/catalog.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">Berkeley DB</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html">http://www.oracle.com/database/berkeley-db/db/index.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/generalinfo.html">Cyrus</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/generalinfo.html">http://cyrusimap.web.cmu.edu/generalinfo.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">Cyrus SASL</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html">http://asg.web.cmu.edu/sasl/sasl-library.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://git-scm.com/">Git</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://git-scm.com/">http://git-scm.com/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/">GNU</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/">http://www.gnu.org/software/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">GnuTLS</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/">http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/">Heimdal</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/">http://www.pdc.kth.se/heimdal/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/jldap/">JLDAP</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/jldap/">http://www.openldap.org/jldap/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">MIT Kerberos</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/">http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/www/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">MozNSS</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS">http://developer.mozilla.org/en/NSS</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">http://www.openldap.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/">OpenLDAP FAQ</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/faq/">http://www.openldap.org/faq/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">OpenLDAP ITS</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/its/">http://www.openldap.org/its/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/">OpenLDAP Software</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/software/">http://www.openldap.org/software/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">OpenSSL</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.openssl.org/">http://www.openssl.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.perl.org/">Perl</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.perl.org/">http://www.perl.org/</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">UMLDAP</A>
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html</A>
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<H2><A NAME="References">I.4. References</A></H2>
<TABLE CLASS="plain">
<TR CLASS="heading">
<TD>
<STRONG>Reference</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Document</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Status</STRONG>
</TD>
<TD>
<STRONG>Jump</STRONG>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/doc/guides/slapd/guide.pdf">UM-GUIDE</A>
</TD>
<TD>
The SLAPD and SLURPD Administrators Guide
</TD>
<TD>
O
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/doc/guides/slapd/guide.pdf">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/doc/guides/slapd/guide.pdf</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2079.txt">RFC2079</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Definition of an X.500 Attribute Type and an Object Class to Hold Uniform Resource Identifers
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2079.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2079.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2296.txt">RFC2296</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Use of Language Codes in LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2296.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2296.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2307.txt">RFC2307</A>
</TD>
<TD>
An Approach for Using LDAP as a Network Information Service
</TD>
<TD>
X
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2307.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2307.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2589.txt">RFC2589</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (v3): Extensions for Dynamic Directory Services
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2589.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2589.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt">RFC2798</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Definition of the inetOrgPerson LDAP Object Class
</TD>
<TD>
I
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2798.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2831.txt">RFC2831</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Using Digest Authentication as a SASL Mechanism
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2831.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2831.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2849.txt">RFC2849</A>
</TD>
<TD>
The LDAP Data Interchange Format
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2849.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2849.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3088.txt">RFC3088</A>
</TD>
<TD>
OpenLDAP Root Service
</TD>
<TD>
X
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3088.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3088.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3296.txt">RFC3296</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Named Subordinate References in LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3296.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3296.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3384.txt">RFC3384</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (version 3) Replication Requirements
</TD>
<TD>
I
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3384.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3384.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3494.txt">RFC3494</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol version 2 (LDAPv2) to Historic Status
</TD>
<TD>
I
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3494.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3494.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4013.txt">RFC4013</A>
</TD>
<TD>
SASLprep: Stringprep Profile for User Names and Passwords
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4013.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4013.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4346.txt">RFC4346</A>
</TD>
<TD>
The Transport Layer Security (TLS) Protocol, Version 1.1
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4346.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4346.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422.txt">RFC4422</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Simple Authentication and Security Layer (SASL)
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4510.txt">RFC4510</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Technical Specification Roadmap
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4510.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4510.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">RFC4511</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): The Protocol
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4511.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">RFC4512</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Directory Information Models
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4512.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4513.txt">RFC4513</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Authentication Methods and Security Mechanisms
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4513.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4513.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt">RFC4514</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): String Representation of Distinguished Names
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4514.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt">RFC4515</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): String Representation of Search Filters
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4515.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4516.txt">RFC4516</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Uniform Resource Locator
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4516.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4516.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4517.txt">RFC4517</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Syntaxes and Matching Rules
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4517.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4517.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4518.txt">RFC4518</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Internationalized String Preparation
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4518.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4518.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4519.txt">RFC4519</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP): Schema for User Applications
</TD>
<TD>
PS
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4519.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4519.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4520.txt">RFC4520</A>
</TD>
<TD>
IANA Considerations for LDAP
</TD>
<TD>
BCP
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4520.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4520.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">RFC4533</A>
</TD>
<TD>
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) Content Synchronization Operation
</TD>
<TD>
X
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt">http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4533.txt</A>
</TD>
</TR>
<TR>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-chu-ldap-ldapi-00">Chu-LDAPI</A>
</TD>
<TD>
Using LDAP Over IPC Mechanisms
</TD>
<TD>
ID
</TD>
<TD>
<A HREF="http://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-chu-ldap-ldapi-00">http://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-chu-ldap-ldapi-00</A>
</TD>
</TR>
</TABLE>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="Generic configure Instructions">J. Generic configure Instructions</A></H1>
<PRE>
Basic Installation
==================
These are generic installation instructions.
The `configure' shell script attempts to guess correct values for
various system-dependent variables used during compilation. It uses
those values to create a `Makefile' in each directory of the package.
It may also create one or more `.h' files containing system-dependent
definitions. Finally, it creates a shell script `config.status' that
you can run in the future to recreate the current configuration, a file
`config.cache' that saves the results of its tests to speed up
reconfiguring, and a file `config.log' containing compiler output
(useful mainly for debugging `configure').
If you need to do unusual things to compile the package, please try
to figure out how `configure' could check whether to do them, and mail
diffs or instructions to the address given in the `README' so they can
be considered for the next release. If at some point `config.cache'
contains results you don't want to keep, you may remove or edit it.
The file `configure.in' is used to create `configure' by a program
called `autoconf'. You only need `configure.in' if you want to change
it or regenerate `configure' using a newer version of `autoconf'.
The simplest way to compile this package is:
1. `cd' to the directory containing the package's source code and type
`./configure' to configure the package for your system. If you're
using `csh' on an old version of System V, you might need to type
`sh ./configure' instead to prevent `csh' from trying to execute
`configure' itself.
Running `configure' takes awhile. While running, it prints some
messages telling which features it is checking for.
2. Type `make' to compile the package.
3. Optionally, type `make check' to run any self-tests that come with
the package.
4. Type `make install' to install the programs and any data files and
documentation.
5. You can remove the program binaries and object files from the
source code directory by typing `make clean'. To also remove the
files that `configure' created (so you can compile the package for
a different kind of computer), type `make distclean'. There is
also a `make maintainer-clean' target, but that is intended mainly
for the package's developers. If you use it, you may have to get
all sorts of other programs in order to regenerate files that came
with the distribution.
Compilers and Options
=====================
Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that
the `configure' script does not know about. You can give `configure'
initial values for variables by setting them in the environment. Using
a Bourne-compatible shell, you can do that on the command line like
this:
CC=c89 CFLAGS=-O2 LIBS=-lposix ./configure
Or on systems that have the `env' program, you can do it like this:
env CPPFLAGS=-I/usr/local/include LDFLAGS=-s ./configure
Compiling For Multiple Architectures
====================================
You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the
same time, by placing the object files for each architecture in their
own directory. To do this, you must use a version of `make' that
supports the `VPATH' variable, such as GNU `make'. `cd' to the
directory where you want the object files and executables to go and run
the `configure' script. `configure' automatically checks for the
source code in the directory that `configure' is in and in `..'.
If you have to use a `make' that does not supports the `VPATH'
variable, you have to compile the package for one architecture at a time
in the source code directory. After you have installed the package for
one architecture, use `make distclean' before reconfiguring for another
architecture.
Installation Names
==================
By default, `make install' will install the package's files in
`/usr/local/bin', `/usr/local/man', etc. You can specify an
installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving `configure' the
option `--prefix=PATH'.
You can specify separate installation prefixes for
architecture-specific files and architecture-independent files. If you
give `configure' the option `--exec-prefix=PATH', the package will use
PATH as the prefix for installing programs and libraries.
Documentation and other data files will still use the regular prefix.
In addition, if you use an unusual directory layout you can give
options like `--bindir=PATH' to specify different values for particular
kinds of files. Run `configure --help' for a list of the directories
you can set and what kinds of files go in them.
If the package supports it, you can cause programs to be installed
with an extra prefix or suffix on their names by giving `configure' the
option `--program-prefix=PREFIX' or `--program-suffix=SUFFIX'.
Optional Features
=================
Some packages pay attention to `--enable-FEATURE' options to
`configure', where FEATURE indicates an optional part of the package.
They may also pay attention to `--with-PACKAGE' options, where PACKAGE
is something like `gnu-as' or `x' (for the X Window System). The
`README' should mention any `--enable-' and `--with-' options that the
package recognizes.
For packages that use the X Window System, `configure' can usually
find the X include and library files automatically, but if it doesn't,
you can use the `configure' options `--x-includes=DIR' and
`--x-libraries=DIR' to specify their locations.
Specifying the System Type
==========================
There may be some features `configure' can not figure out
automatically, but needs to determine by the type of host the package
will run on. Usually `configure' can figure that out, but if it prints
a message saying it can not guess the host type, give it the
`--host=TYPE' option. TYPE can either be a short name for the system
type, such as `sun4', or a canonical name with three fields:
CPU-COMPANY-SYSTEM
See the file `config.sub' for the possible values of each field. If
`config.sub' isn't included in this package, then this package doesn't
need to know the host type.
If you are building compiler tools for cross-compiling, you can also
use the `--target=TYPE' option to select the type of system they will
produce code for and the `--build=TYPE' option to select the type of
system on which you are compiling the package.
Sharing Defaults
================
If you want to set default values for `configure' scripts to share,
you can create a site shell script called `config.site' that gives
default values for variables like `CC', `cache_file', and `prefix'.
`configure' looks for `PREFIX/share/config.site' if it exists, then
`PREFIX/etc/config.site' if it exists. Or, you can set the
`CONFIG_SITE' environment variable to the location of the site script.
A warning: not all `configure' scripts look for a site script.
Operation Controls
==================
`configure' recognizes the following options to control how it
operates.
`--cache-file=FILE'
Use and save the results of the tests in FILE instead of
`./config.cache'. Set FILE to `/dev/null' to disable caching, for
debugging `configure'.
`--help'
Print a summary of the options to `configure', and exit.
`--quiet'
`--silent'
`-q'
Do not print messages saying which checks are being made. To
suppress all normal output, redirect it to `/dev/null' (any error
messages will still be shown).
`--srcdir=DIR'
Look for the package's source code in directory DIR. Usually
`configure' can determine that directory automatically.
`--version'
Print the version of Autoconf used to generate the `configure'
script, and exit.
`configure' also accepts some other, not widely useful, options.
</PRE>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices">K. OpenLDAP Software Copyright Notices</A></H1>
<H2><A NAME="OpenLDAP Copyright Notice">K.1. OpenLDAP Copyright Notice</A></H2>
<P>Copyright 1998-2012 The OpenLDAP Foundation.<BR><EM>All rights reserved.</EM></P>
<P>Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted <EM>only as authorized</EM> by the <A HREF="#OpenLDAP Public License">OpenLDAP Public License</A>.</P>
<P>A copy of this license is available in file <TT>LICENSE</TT> in the top-level directory of the distribution or, alternatively, at <<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/license.html">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/license.html</A>>.</P>
<P>OpenLDAP is a registered trademark of the OpenLDAP Foundation.</P>
<P>Individual files and/or contributed packages may be copyright by other parties and their use subject to additional restrictions.</P>
<P>This work is derived from the University of Michigan LDAP v3.3 distribution. Information concerning this software is available at <<A HREF="http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html">http://www.umich.edu/~dirsvcs/ldap/ldap.html</A>>.</P>
<P>This work also contains materials derived from public sources.</P>
<P>Additional information about OpenLDAP software can be obtained at <<A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/">http://www.OpenLDAP.org/</A>>.</P>
<H2><A NAME="Additional Copyright Notices">K.2. Additional Copyright Notices</A></H2>
<P>Portions Copyright 1998-2012 Kurt D. Zeilenga.<BR>Portions Copyright 1998-2006 Net Boolean Incorporated.<BR>Portions Copyright 2001-2006 IBM Corporation.<BR><EM>All rights reserved.</EM></P>
<P>Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted only as authorized by the <A HREF="#OpenLDAP Public License">OpenLDAP Public License</A>.</P>
<P>Portions Copyright 1999-2008 Howard Y.H. Chu.<BR>Portions Copyright 1999-2008 Symas Corporation.<BR>Portions Copyright 1998-2003 Hallvard B. Furuseth.<BR>Portions Copyright 2007-2011 Gavin Henry.<BR>Portions Copyright 2007-2011 Suretec Systems Limited.<BR><EM>All rights reserved.</EM></P>
<P>Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that this notice is preserved. The names of the copyright holders may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without their specific prior written permission. This software is provided ``as is'' without express or implied warranty.</P>
<H2><A NAME="University of Michigan Copyright Notice">K.3. University of Michigan Copyright Notice</A></H2>
<P>Portions Copyright 1992-1996 Regents of the University of Michigan.<BR><EM>All rights reserved.</EM></P>
<P>Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted provided that this notice is preserved and that due credit is given to the University of Michigan at Ann Arbor. The name of the University may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. This software is provided ``as is'' without express or implied warranty.</P>
<P></P>
<HR>
<H1><A NAME="OpenLDAP Public License">L. OpenLDAP Public License</A></H1>
<PRE>
The OpenLDAP Public License
Version 2.8, 17 August 2003
Redistribution and use of this software and associated documentation
("Software"), with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions in source form must retain copyright statements
and notices,
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce applicable copyright
statements and notices, this list of conditions, and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution, and
3. Redistributions must contain a verbatim copy of this document.
The OpenLDAP Foundation may revise this license from time to time.
Each revision is distinguished by a version number. You may use
this Software under terms of this license revision or under the
terms of any subsequent revision of the license.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION AND ITS
CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION, ITS CONTRIBUTORS, OR THE AUTHOR(S)
OR OWNER(S) OF THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The names of the authors and copyright holders must not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealing
in this Software without specific, written prior permission. Title
to copyright in this Software shall at all times remain with copyright
holders.
OpenLDAP is a registered trademark of the OpenLDAP Foundation.
Copyright 1999-2003 The OpenLDAP Foundation, Redwood City,
California, USA. All Rights Reserved. Permission to copy and
distribute verbatim copies of this document is granted.
</PRE>
</DIV>
<DIV CLASS="footer">
<HR>
<DIV CLASS="navigate">
<P ALIGN="Center"><A HREF="http://www.openldap.org/">Home</A> | <A HREF="../index.html">Catalog</A></P>
</DIV>
<P>
<FONT COLOR="#808080" FACE="Arial,Verdana,Helvetica" SIZE="1"><B>
________________<BR>
<SMALL>© Copyright 2011, <A HREF="http://www.OpenLDAP.org/foundation/">OpenLDAP Foundation</A>, <A HREF="mailto:info@OpenLDAP.org">info@OpenLDAP.org</A></SMALL></B></FONT>
</DIV>
</BODY>
</HTML>
|